Page 1113
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Technical Service Bulletin # 04-054C Date: 110406
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Classification: WT04-004C
Reference: NTB04-054C
Date: April 6, 2011
WHEEL ALIGNMENT INFORMATION
This bulletin has been amended to correct some typographical errors in SERVICE INFORMATION.
No other changes have been made. Discard all previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
Warranty Claim Information: In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the
following item MUST be attached to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
General Information and Recommendations
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When performing a wheel alignment it is important that you read and follow all of the instructions
supplied with your alignment equipment.
^ The information in this bulletin is not intended to be complete wheel alignment instructions.
^ Use the information in this bulletin as a supplement to the instructions for your equipment.
General Information and Recommendations
1. Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should always be performed.
^ This type of alignment is recommended for all Nissan vehicles.
^ The four-wheel thrust process ensures that the vehicle is properly aligned, and helps ensure
proper "centering" of the steering wheel.
2. Use the right alignment machine.
^ You must use a quality alignment machine that will give accurate results when performing
alignment checks.
^ Refer to the Nissan TECH-MATE Service Equipment Catalog for recommended alignment
equipment.
^ The alignment rack itself should be capable of accepting any Nissan vehicle. The rack should be
checked to ensure that it is level.
3. Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
^ Your alignment equipment should be regularly calibrated in order to give accurate readings.
^ If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged, calibration should
be checked immediately.
^ Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended
service/calibration schedule.
NOTE:
In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the following item MUST be attached
to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
Page 3453
Inspection Procedure
Page 4817
Comments regarding R-134a manifold gauge set:
^ Be certain that the gauge face indicates R134a or 134a.
^ Be certain that the manifold gauge set has the 1/2" - 16 ACME threaded connections for service
hoses, ensuring that only R-134a service hoses are used.
^ Be certain that no refrigerants other than R-134a (along with only specified lubricants) are used
with the manifold gauge set.
Engine - Block Heater Precaution
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Block Heater Precaution
Models: All Models
Section: Engine Mechanical
Classification: EM88-004
Bulletin No.: TS88-025
Date: February 22, 1988
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER
APPLIED MODELS: All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Engine antifreeze in more than 50% concentration has been found to adversely affect the life and
performance of the engine block heater. High phosphate content in the antifreeze forms a scale
around the heating element of the block heater, causing the temperature to rise, with subsequent
failure of the seals. Therefore, for best results it is recommended that you use a concentration no
greater than 50% antifreeze and 50% water.
Page 3238
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 786
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper
Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 1111
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 2635
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
(CHECK ENGINE LIGHT ITEM)
Wiring Diagram
The following is necessary to perform this inspection.
1. Pull out E.C.U. from under the passenger seat.
2. Warm up engine sufficiently.
Page 3965
* The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
* As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
* Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
NISSAN SERVICE PROCEDURE:
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062 (BR92-004) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 3205
Fig. 6 Idle Speed Control
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 1689
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation Three Stage Converter
The three-way catalytic converter utilizes a catalyst to accelerate the recombustion of HC and CO
and a catalyst to reduce NOx in the exhaust gas, changing them into harmless CO2, H2O, and N3.
In order to maintain mixture ratios at the ``stoichiometric'' point, the point at which the converter
works most efficiently, a mixture ratio feedback system is employed. In this system, an exhaust gas
sensor monitors oxygen content in the exhaust gasses and signals the fuel system to alter the
air/fuel mixture to maintain the ``stoichiometric'' level.
Locations
A/C Relay: Locations
A/C Components.
Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 634
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 3405
Distributor Cap: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Cap
1. Remove the screws securing the cap to the distributor.
2. Remove the ignition wires from the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for cracks or damage due to heat or arcing.
4. Inspect the terminals inside the cap for excessive corrosion and damage.
5. Inspect the ignition wire terminals for excessive corrosion. If the corrosion cannot be removed
with reasonable measures, replace the cap. Replace the cap if it fails the above tests.
Page 2670
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4818
Comments regarding vacuum pump use:
^ The lubricant contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the lubrication for R-134a
A/C systems.
^ The vent side of the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure, causing the vacuum
pump lubricant to migrate out of the pump if the pump is switched oft after evacuation (vacuuming)
and there is no shut off valve between the pump and the hose.
^ To prevent the migration of vacuum pump lubricant into service hoses, it is necessary to use a
valve (which can be manually opened or closed) near the connection of the service hose to the
pump.
^ On a vacuum pump which is equipped with an isolation valve (usually part of the vacuum pump),
closing this valve will isolate the service hose from the pump.
^ For pumps without an isolation valve, be certain that the service hose is equipped with a manual
shut off valve near the pump end of the hose.
^ Hoses which contain an automatic shut off valve at the end of the service hose must be
disconnected from the vacuum pump to prevent the migration of lubricant; as long as the hose is
connected, the valve is open and lubricant may migrate (with pump off).
^ One-way valves which open when vacuum is applied and close under a no vacuum condition are
not recommended, because this valve may restrict the pump's ability to pull a deep vacuum.
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Caliper: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: Customer Interest Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 1477
Page 2614
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 5374
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Page 5331
12. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed as follows:
a. Working from the trunk, feed the belt male end up through the slot in the parcel shelf support.
b. Install the retractor unit end of the shoulder harness into the mounting hole just above the rear
wheelhouse. Make sure the tang is in its slot to keep the retractor unit from rotating on the
mounting bolt. Torque bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
c. Bolt the shoulder anchor into the rear pillar where the 1" hole was drilled. Torque bolt to 26-32
ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
d. Bolt floor anchor into position and torque to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65- 4.65 kg/m).
13. Reinstall rear parcel shelf.
14. Check retro-fit belts for smooth operation.
15. Reinstall rear high mount stop light and speakers, if equipped.
16. Reinstall rear seat.
200SX Hatchback
1. Remove rear seat cushion and back.
2. Remove seat hinges.
3. Remove original rear belt retractor units.
4. Loosen front seat belt access finisher, then pull back front wheelhouse trim.
Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other Precautions
Exhaust Pipe: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Classification: EL93-028
Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-161
Models: All Models
Date: November 5, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS
Electronic control units (ECU's) control the operation of numerous electrical systems and
components on Nissan vehicles. The ECU's do this by either controlling the supply voltage or
ground path of an electrical component. The following is an explanation of how these systems work
and what precautions should be taken while performing diagnostic procedures.
Systems controlled by electronic control units have three (3) basic requirements, Inputs, Controller
Logic and Outputs.
Inputs
Sensors and switches provide electrical signals to the control unit. These signals are provided to
the ECU to inform it of various vehicle operating conditions. The electrical inputs can be either
analog or digital signals. However, all of the signals are converted to digital signals before the ECU
can process the information.
Control Logic
The ECU uses the electrical input signals to determine what the system should do. This decision
may be based on a few or many inputs. After processing the information the ECU will provide a
signal (output) to various electrical components.
Outputs
The signal that the ECU puts out to an electrical component (actuator) is called the output. These
output signals are what operate and control the system.
Digital Input Signals
Page 2980
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3578
Page 3047
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2510
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 497
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Page 4024
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Power Rack & Pinion
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Power Rack & Pinion
Removal and Installation
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheels.
2. Disconnect power steering hose clamp, then the hose at steering gear and drain fluid into a
suitable container.
3. Disconnect side rod studs from steering knuckles.
4. On Pulsar and Sentra models, support transaxle with a suitable jack, then remove exhaust pipe
and rear engine mounts, if necessary.
5. On all models, remove bolt securing lower joint to steering gear pinion and remove lower joint
from pinion.
6. Remove steering gear attaching bolts and, on 1984-86 Stanza models, the cylinder tubes.
7. Remove steering gear and linkage assembly from vehicle.
8. Reverse procedure to install.
Overhaul
Fig. 28 Rack & pinion type power steering gear disassembled. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
DISASSEMBLY
Refer to Fig. 28 for power steering gear disassembly, noting the following:
1. Remove center bushing and rack oil seal using a 19 mm socket and extension bar. Use caution
not to damage inner surfaces of pinion housing.
2. Thoroughly clean all parts in suitable cleaning solvent and blow dry with compressed air.
3. Discard all O-rings and oil seals upon removal.
INSPECTION
Tie Rod Inner & Outer Sockets
1. Check ball joint swinging force. Swinging force should be 1-20 lbs. on outer ball joint or .37-28
lbs. on inner ball joint.
Page 3697
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type API GL-4
Fluid Viscosity SAE 75w-90
Page 4975
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Page 3363
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2587
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Models All Models
Section Body & Frame
Classification BF91-014
Bulletin No. NTB91-051
Date May 23, 1991
CARE OF LEATHER TRIM
APPLIED MODELS: All Models Equipped With Leather Trim
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Nissan currently uses Cow Hide on all vehicles equipped with Leather Interior Trim (excluding
certain 1988 Maximas which were equipped with Suede Seats). This bulletin refers only to those
vehicles equipped with Cow Hide Leather Interior Trim. Suede seat covers are made of Pig Skin
and should be cared for according to the instructions provided in the U11 Maxima Seat Care Kit
(P/N 999M1-U8000). Leather is typically used on seat surfaces, trim pieces, steering wheels, and
shift knobs in Nissan Vehicles. Maintaining a high quality appearance is best achieved by using the
procedures indicated below.
1. Occasionally, loose dust should be removed from the interior trim and seat surfaces using a
vacuum cleaner or a soft brush. The leather surfaces should be wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
2. Some leather trim, such as the leather wrapped steering wheel, may become grayish in color
with use. The original condition may be restored by rubbing the affected area with a clean soft cloth
dampened in a mild soap solution, and then wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
3. Leather seat surfaces may be regularly coated with a leather conditioner such as saddle soap.
Cautions:
Never use benzene, thinner, or any similar product on leather trim.
Never use car wax on leather trim.
Never use fabric protectors on leather trim unless recommended by the manufacturer. Some fabric
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the leather trim.
Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Models: 4WD & All-WD Models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT89-002
Bulletin No.: TS89-061
Date: April 13, 1989
4WD & ALL-WHEEL DRIVE TIRE REPLACEMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-89 Sentra (B12) 1986-88 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1980-Truck (720, D21)
1987-89 Pathfinder (WD21) 1990 Axxess (M11)
SERVICE INFORMATION
When customers inquire about tire replacement for Applied Model vehicles, please remind them of
the recommended guidelines in their respective Owner's Manual.
TIRE REPLACEMENT CAUTION:
^ Always use tires of the same size, brand, construction (bias, bias-belted or radial), and tread
pattern on all four wheels. Failure to do so may result in a circumference difference between tires
on the front and rear axles which will cause excessive tire wear and may damage the transmission,
transfer case or differential gears.
^ If excessive tire wear is noted, Nissan recommends that all four tires be replaced with tires of the
same size, brand, construction and tread pattern. The tire pressure and wheel alignment should
also be checked and corrected as needed.
^ If you install snow tires, they must also be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern
on all four wheels.
^ Use only the spare tires specified for each 4WD or all-wheel drive models.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Body - Windshield Cracking Information
Windshield: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Windshield Cracking Information
Classification: BT09-052
Reference: NTB09-091
Date: August 25, 2009
WINDSHIELD CRACKING
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Purpose of this bulletin is to give Nissan dealers guidelines to help determine if windshield
breakage is covered under warranty or is the customer's responsibility. Nissan North America
(NNA) is not responsible for damage to glass that is a result of objects striking or scratching the
glass. However, NNA is responsible for manufacturing issues such as distorted glass and cracks
that are due to improper installation or damage to the glass during vehicle assembly. NNA typically
does not find any type of cracks in the windshield due to stress in vehicles with over 5000 miles.
Glass damage can be categorized in 3 general areas:
1. Cracks due to objects striking the glass.
2. Cracks due to scratch in glass surface.
3. Distortion or cracks due to manufacturing issues.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Part Return Process Reminder
Refer to WB/07-010: Nissan is announcing a new requirement in the process for parts return to
assist engineers in analyzing part issues. Dealers are now required to mark glass and other
components returned that have "visible issues" using a grease pencil or similar instrument to
highlight the area damaged.
1) How to determine if glass damage is due to objects striking the glass.
Cracks from objects striking the glass
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Page 1168
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 2732
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 699
Page 4078
^ Batteries installed in vehicles produced in Japan have a JIS number embossed in the plastic on
top of the battery.
^ These vehicles have a VIN that begins with the letter "J".
Batteries with CCA (Cold Cranking Amps) Number
^ Batteries installed in vehicles produced in North America have a CCA number displayed on the
label attached to the top of the battery.
^ These vehicles have a VIN that begins with a number: 1, 3, or 5.
Selecting CCA or JIS in the GR-8 Battery Tester
Vehicles with JIS Battery
^ Select JIS, then choose the option that matches the first five (5) characters of the JIS number on
the battery.
NOTE:
DO NOT select CCA when testing a JIS battery.
Vehicles with CCA Battery
^ Select CCA, then choose the option that matches the number following "Cold Cranking Amps" on
the battery.
Reference Material
The following information can be printed and attached to the GR-8, if needed.
Page 3362
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 908
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Anti-Freeze Ethylene Glycol Base
Page 5147
2. Grind the surface of the repair with 36 grit disc. Grind about 11/2" around the actual damage to
obtain a taper for best adhesion.
3. Featheredge the paint around the repair with 180 grit disc. Wipe with a clean, dry rag and blow
off with air.
4. Apply one wet coat of Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter over the sanded surface and allow to dry for
10 minutes.
IMPORTANT: It will be necessary to reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter after any sanding step.
5. Mix Flexible Parts Repair Material according to the instructions and apply to the repair with a
squeegee, building it up higher than the undamaged area. Allow it to cure for 20-30 minutes at
60-80~F.
6. After curing, sand with 180 grit disc followed by 240 grit disc.
Page 2728
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1756
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 4118
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Testing Procedures/Equipment
Classification: EL99-O16p
Reference: NTB99-048p
Date: September 13, 2007
BATTERY TESTING FOR NISSAN ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT AND GENUINE NISSAN
REPLACEMENT BATTERIES
This bulletin has been amended. Please discard all previous copies of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan SERVICE INFORMATION
The new Battery Service Center (BSC) is the factory-approved battery tester. The Essential Tool
number for this tester is J-48087.
^ For claim reimbursement purposes, use of the "BSC" is required when testing any Nissan
Original Equipment or Genuine Nissan Replacement battery.
^ For more information, refer to the current Nissan Assurance Products Resource Manual.
^ Print-outs from the BSC are required to accurately document the test codes for warranty claims.
^ For the complete BSC User Guide, refer to ASIST - TOOLS & EQUIPMENT.
^ Additional tools and replacement parts can be ordered from TECH-MATE.
When setting up the "BSC" for testing, a [battery CCA] rating is required.
^ CCA stands for Cold Cranking Amps.
Page 466
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 2131
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Specifications
Radiator Cap: Specifications
Release Pressure 13 psi
Page 3898
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Engine Controls - Engine Control Module Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Control Module
Identification
Models: Various Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control Classification: EF & EC94-015 Bulletin
No.: NTB94-097 Date: November 4, 1994
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IDENTIFICATION
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to assure in verifying
that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and
Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new
ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and has the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All vehicles have a label (see illustration above) that has
the vendor part number on the ECM Cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 3941
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Service and Repair
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3136
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 4368
large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4. Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation.
7. Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation.
8. Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service.
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement.
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10. Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based
cleaners degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the
rotor surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 3115
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Adjustments
Inhibitor Switch: Adjustments
1. Loosen inhibitor switch attaching screws.
2. Set selector lever manual shaft at Neutral position.
3. Insert suitable pin into adjustment holes in both inhibitor switch and switch lever as near vertical
as possible, then tighten screws.
4. Check switch for continuity, replacing as necessary.
Fig. 6 Adjusting inhibitor switch. 1985-88 Maxima, 1986-88 Stanza Wagon & 1987-88 Pulsar,
Sentra & Stanza exc. Wagon
INHIBITOR SWITCH VIEW
Page 5220
Finish Kare products are marketed by mobile distributors which will deliver the product directly to
your dealership. If a Finish Kare distributor is not located in your area, Finish Kare can be
contacted at the number above for direct shipment from their national office.
Page 578
Page 342
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 3991
B. For best accuracy, "stabilize" (firmly support) the vehicle with a jack or jack stand as shown in
Figure 1.
^ On some hoists, the vehicle may "wobble" a little while using the on-car brake lathe. Not good.
CAUTION:
Any rocking motion (wobble) of the vehicle during the ProCut(TM) "Automatic compensation"
procedure will reduce the accuracy of the resurfacing.
^ If wobble occurs during the rotor resurfacing process/procedure, the finished rotor runout may be
more than factory specification and should be checked before using the rotor.
C. Prevent metal shavings from contacting or collecting on the ABS speed sensors.
^ Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS speed sensor's magnet. It is best to clean the ABS
sensor with the rotor removed.
D. After a rotor has been resurfaced with the ProCut(TM) brake lathe:
^ If the rotor must be removed for any reason, mark the exact location (rotor to axle hub) before
removing the rotor (see Figure 2).
^ The rotor must be reinstalled back to the same location.
E. Do not tighten the wheel lug nuts with an air impact driver.
^ Use a torque wrench to tighten the lug nuts to the proper torque specification.
^ Uneven or high torque applied to the lug nuts may "distort" (warp) the brake rotor and hub. This
may increase rotor runout and cause excessive rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op
Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Engine Oil: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Classification: EM95-01
Section: Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB95-017
Date: February 8, 1995
ENGINE OIL LEVEL AND GRADE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
The cause of some driveability incidents is incorrect oil level or viscosity. Whenever you evaluate a
vehicle for a driveability problem, check the oil level first. (It is a good practice to check oil level on
every vehicle that you work on.)
Overfilling may cause engine vibration or valve train clatter on vehicles with hydraulic lash
adjusters due to oil aeration when the crankshaft hits the oil. Using the wrong viscosity oil can
cause rough or low idle resulting from improper operation of the hydraulic lash adjusters.
When you add or change the engine oil, follow the service manual recommendations regarding
proper oil fill level. Do not overfill the crankcase. If you find a vehicle to be overfilled with oil, drain
the excess oil and dispose of properly. Remember to wait ten (10) minutes after refilling before
checking. This allows time for the oil to drain back to the pan.
Always use the proper viscosity oil specified by the service manual for the temperature range in
your geographic area. The viscosity specifications ensure proper engine operation and best engine
efficiency.
Page 1536
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 4544
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 837
Distributor Cap: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Cap
1. Remove the screws securing the cap to the distributor.
2. Remove the ignition wires from the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for cracks or damage due to heat or arcing.
4. Inspect the terminals inside the cap for excessive corrosion and damage.
5. Inspect the ignition wire terminals for excessive corrosion. If the corrosion cannot be removed
with reasonable measures, replace the cap. Replace the cap if it fails the above tests.
Page 4313
4. Hold position of cam and torque nut to 83-98 ft. lbs.
5. Ensure toe-in is still within specifications.
1987-88 Sentra
Fig. 2 Rear Toe-in Adjustment.
Rear toe-in is adjusted by rotating the cam bolts which secure the rear parallel link to the
crossmember.
1. Measure total toe-in and toe-in for each wheel following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. Scribe matching mark between cam and parallel link, then loosen nut securing cam bolt.
3. Rotate cam bolt(s) as needed, Fig. 7, to obtain specified toe-in. On graduation on scale varies
toe-in approximately .08 inch. Ensure that total toe-in is within specifications and divided equally
between left and right wheels.
4. Hold position of cam bolt(s) and torque retaining nuts to 72-87 ft. lbs.
5. Ensure toe-in is still within specifications.
Page 1185
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 3267
Inspection Procedure
Page 3666
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "FRONT SUSPENSION / COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND REPAIR PROCEDURES /
AXLE BEARING AND KNUCKLE" before making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 1534
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2547
System description: When the switch is ON, the ECU lights up the lamp.
The VOLTAGE VALUE is based on the body ground.
Page 3967
large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4. Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation.
7. Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation.
8. Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service.
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement.
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10. Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based
cleaners degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the
rotor surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 1497
Page 2802
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Boost Controlled Deceleration Device
Vacuum Control Valve
VACUUM CONTROL VALVE
1. Disconnect air regulator side of air hose connecting 3-way connector to vacuum control valve.
2. Check that vacuum control valve operates when engine speed is decreased from 3500-4000
RPM to idle, by placing fingers on end of hose.
3. If there is no vacuum at end of hose, replace vacuum control valve.
BCDD Operation
1. Place gear shift lever in neutral position and connect rubber hose between vacuum gauge and
intake manifold.
2. With engine at operating temperature, adjust idle to specification.
3. With engine under no load, increase engine speed to 1500-2000 RPM, then quickly close throttle
valve.
4. Manifold vacuum pressure should abruptly rise to 23.62 inches Hg or above, then gradually
decrease to a certain level and stay there for a while. This is the operating pressure. In most cases
it will drop to idle pressure.
5. Check that bypass air control valve pressure is within specified range which should be (at sea
level) 22.83-24.41 inches Hg.
6. If it is lower than specified level, turn adjusting screw counterclockwise until correct adjustment is
made. If it is higher turn adjusting screw clockwise.
7. Race the engine and check for adjustment.
8. If engine speed cannot be reduced to idle when checking BCDD operating pressure, turn
adjusting screw counterclockwise until BCDD operating pressure is on high vacuum side, .98 inch
Hg from specified pressure, then turn adjusting screw 1/4 turn clockwise so that BCDD operating
pressure drops .98 inch Hg.
9. If BCDD operating pressure is still not accurately determined, turn adjusting screw
counterclockwise so that BCDD operating pressure is on high vacuum side, 1.97 inches Hg from
specified pressure, then turn adjusting screw 1/2 turn clockwise.
10. Boost control unit operating pressure should be correctly set within specified range even if
engine speed cannot be decreased to idle.
Page 981
Page 4039
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 3111
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 116
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1013
Comments regarding vacuum pump use:
^ The lubricant contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the lubrication for R-134a
A/C systems.
^ The vent side of the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure, causing the vacuum
pump lubricant to migrate out of the pump if the pump is switched oft after evacuation (vacuuming)
and there is no shut off valve between the pump and the hose.
^ To prevent the migration of vacuum pump lubricant into service hoses, it is necessary to use a
valve (which can be manually opened or closed) near the connection of the service hose to the
pump.
^ On a vacuum pump which is equipped with an isolation valve (usually part of the vacuum pump),
closing this valve will isolate the service hose from the pump.
^ For pumps without an isolation valve, be certain that the service hose is equipped with a manual
shut off valve near the pump end of the hose.
^ Hoses which contain an automatic shut off valve at the end of the service hose must be
disconnected from the vacuum pump to prevent the migration of lubricant; as long as the hose is
connected, the valve is open and lubricant may migrate (with pump off).
^ One-way valves which open when vacuum is applied and close under a no vacuum condition are
not recommended, because this valve may restrict the pump's ability to pull a deep vacuum.
Page 2271
(Switch ON/OFF diagnosis)
Page 1001
^ Do not introduce compressed air to any refrigerant container or refrigerant component, because
contamination will occur.
^ R-134a in the presence of oxygen and under pressure may form a combustible mixture.
Therefore, never introduce compressed air into any R-134a container, cylinder, A/C component,
recover/recycle equipment, or other service equipment. This includes "empty" containers.
Refrigerant Terminology
Please use the correct name or names when specifying refrigerants. The guidelines are listed
below:
^ Freon --> is a registered trademark of DuPont, and should only be used if referring to DuPont
R-12.
^ DuPont's trade name for R-134a (automotive use) is Suva-->Trans A/C.
^ When referring to refrigerants, the terms Freon-->and Suva--> should not be used as a general
reference. The proper terms are R-12 and R-134a
Comments regarding refrigerants:
^ R-12 and R-134a are not compatible with each other and should never be mixed, even in the
smallest amounts.
^ R-134a for automotive use has a special tank fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME) which is compatible
with automotive service equipment
^ When purchasing R-134a, be certain that the fitting size on the tank is 1/2" - 16 ACME. This
thread size is easy to recognize by the square thread, as shown.
^ Although R-134a has no ozone depletion potential (ODP), it does have a slight global warming
potential (GWP). Due to this slight GWP, as well as its high cost, venting of R-134a into the air is
not recommended.
^ Recovery/recycling of R-134a will be required by U.S. Federal Law, Clean Air Act Amendments of
1990.
Page 535
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 5307
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Diagnostic Note
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Diagnostic Note
Whenever control cables are disconnected or heater case is disassembled for service, control
cables and operating rods should be adjusted as outlined in adjustments.
M/T - Clutch Operating Cylinder Service Information
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins M/T - Clutch Operating Cylinder Service
Information
Classification: MT95-003
Reference: NTB95-114
Date: December 6, 1995
CLUTCH OPERATING CYLINDER - DUAL CUP PISTON SEAL ARRANGEMENT SERVICE
INFORMATION
Figure 1
The piston cup for the clutch operating cylinder has been changed from a single cup to a dual cup.
The parts are interchangeable with a piston kit (piston assembly, piston spring and dust cover), see
Figure 1.
Please update the CL section of your service manuals to show the dual cup piston seal
arrangement.
Please refer to your microfiche parts catalog for the appropriate vehicle and part number.
Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Tensioner Lock Nut 12 - 15 ft.lb
Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Models: 4WD & All-WD Models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT89-002
Bulletin No.: TS89-061
Date: April 13, 1989
4WD & ALL-WHEEL DRIVE TIRE REPLACEMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-89 Sentra (B12) 1986-88 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1980-Truck (720, D21)
1987-89 Pathfinder (WD21) 1990 Axxess (M11)
SERVICE INFORMATION
When customers inquire about tire replacement for Applied Model vehicles, please remind them of
the recommended guidelines in their respective Owner's Manual.
TIRE REPLACEMENT CAUTION:
^ Always use tires of the same size, brand, construction (bias, bias-belted or radial), and tread
pattern on all four wheels. Failure to do so may result in a circumference difference between tires
on the front and rear axles which will cause excessive tire wear and may damage the transmission,
transfer case or differential gears.
^ If excessive tire wear is noted, Nissan recommends that all four tires be replaced with tires of the
same size, brand, construction and tread pattern. The tire pressure and wheel alignment should
also be checked and corrected as needed.
^ If you install snow tires, they must also be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern
on all four wheels.
^ Use only the spare tires specified for each 4WD or all-wheel drive models.
Page 5060
Preparation For System Checks
Place console switch in the auto position move the interior lamp switch to the center position and
open driver's side window. Close trunk hood (if open) and remove ignition key and close all doors.
System Diagnosis
Air/Fuel Mixture: Testing and Inspection
PREPARATION
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
- Battery
- Ignition system
- Engine oil and coolant levels
- Fuses
- E.C.C.S. harness connectors
- Vacuum hoses
- Air intake system (oil filler cap, oil level gauge, etc.)
- Fuel pressure
- A.I.V. hose
- Engine compression
- E.G.R. valve operation
- Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is
"OFF". 3. When measuring "CO" percentage, insert probe more than 40cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe.
Overall Inspection Procedure
Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Fluid Type Nissan Brake Fluid or DOT 3
Page 2819
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Heater: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 742
Page 2721
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2658
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 3182
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Air Conditioning - Installation Caution
Hose/Line HVAC: Technical Service Bulletins Air Conditioning - Installation Caution
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-018
Bulletin No. TS87-147
Date October 12, 1987
AIR CONDITIONING INSTALLATION CAUTION
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 & 1988 Sentra and Pulsar Models with E16i or E16S Engine
SERVICE INFORMATION
When installing an A/C kit on 1987 & 1988 Sentra and Pulsar Models with E16i or E16S engine,
carefully route the A/C high pressure tube so that it is flush to the engine wall. A/C high pressure
tube damage and loss of refrigerant may occur if the tube is routed incorrectly. Ensure that the A/C
tube does not contact any hoses or other engine components.
After A/C installation is complete:
1. Verify that the A/C high pressure tube locating clamp is installed.
2. On vehicles with E16S engine, be sure the vacuum line at the E.C.C. System vacuum sensor is
securely connected.
See illustration on page 2/2.
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Page 2039
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
a. Tighten the clamp so its end is 3 mm (0.12 in) from the hose end. b. Make sure that the screw of
the clamp does not contact with any adjacent parts. c. Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
: Fuel hose clamps
1.0 - 1.5 N.m (0.10 - 0.15 kg-m, 0.7 - 1.1 ft-lb)
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose at the electro injection unit.
3. Install a pressure gauge. 4. Start the engine and check the fuel line for fuel leakage. 5. Read fuel
pressure gauge.
At idling speed:
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2, 36.3 psi)
6. Release fuel pressure again. 7. Remove the pressure gauge from the fuel line. 8. Reconnect the
fuel inlet hose.
Page 3045
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2386
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3114
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2473
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Page 994
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Identification
Classification: HA95-017
Reference: NTB95-106
Date: October 18, 1995
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) LUBRICANT/OIL FOR NISSAN VEHICLES
This bulletin supersedes HA94-001. (94-013, 02/01/94)
APPLIED VEHICLES: All equipped with A/C
SERVICE INFORMATION
Nissan has four different A/C lubricant/oil products available. Different systems will require different
types of lubricants/oils. All R134a equipped vehicles have a label under the hood that specifies the
type of lubricant required for the system on that vehicle. A description of the type of compressor
and lubricant/oil required is also listed in the Service Data and Specifications at the end of the HA
section in the appropriate service manual. During A/C servicing, if lubricant/oil needs to be added
to the system, please refer to the list of PAG (poly alkaline glycol) lubricants and refrigerant oils
listed in this bulletin.
NOTE:
Quest vehicles produced on or after November 29, 1993 with R134a refrigerant, will require a
special compressor lubricant. The recommended compressor lubricant for this vehicle only is: Type
F-R134a PAG lubricant, part number KLH00-PAGQF.
Page 2714
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Engine Controls - Engine Control Module Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Control Module
Identification
Models: Various Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control Classification: EF & EC94-015 Bulletin
No.: NTB94-097 Date: November 4, 1994
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IDENTIFICATION
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to assure in verifying
that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and
Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new
ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and has the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All vehicles have a label (see illustration above) that has
the vendor part number on the ECM Cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 5335
12. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed as follows:
b. Install the retractor unit end of the shoulder harness into the mounting hole just above the rear
wheelhouse. Make sure the tang is in its slot to keep the retractor unit from rotating on the
mounting bolt. Torque bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
a. Working from the trunk, feed the belt male end up through the slot in the parcel shelf support.
c. Bolt the shoulder anchor into the rear pillar where the 1" hole was drilled. Torque bolt to 26-32
ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
d. Bolt floor anchor into position and torque to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65- 4.65 kg/m).
13. Reinstall rear parcel shelf.
14. Check retro-fit belts for smooth operation.
15. Reinstall rear high mount stop light and speakers, if equipped.
16. Reinstall rear seat.
Pathfinder
Page 3586
4. Hold the hose and can as high as possible. Spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a continuous
stream into the air cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the air cooler Inlet hose for 5 seconds
(Point A, Figure 8).
5. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the air cooler Outlet hose (see Point B, Figure 9).
6. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the air cooler Outlet hose.
7. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the air cooler Outlet hose
to force any remaining oil or cleaner through the air cooler and out of the air cooler Inlet hose (see
Point A, Figure 9).
8. Proceed with Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles), below.
Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles)
You will be taking a sample of the debris to determine if the radiator/oil cooler must be replaced.
CAUTION:
You must refer to Charts A and B to determine the location of the Inlet and Outlet hoses for the oil
cooler in the radiator of the vehicle you are working on.
If you do not identify the Inlet and Outlet hoses correctly, debris may be left inside the "in radiator"
cooler and transmission damage may occur.
NOTE:
Failure to clean the exterior of the Cooler Inlet hose properly may lead to inaccurate debris
identification.
1. Place an oil drain pan under the automatic transmission "in radiator" cooler Inlet and Outlet
hoses.
2. Clean the exterior and tip of the cooler Inlet hose.
3. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-AM006) into the Outlet hose of the oil cooler in the radiator (see Figure 4).
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath vapors or mist from spray.
4. Hold the hose and can as high as possible and spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a
continuous stream into the cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the cooler Inlet hose for 5
seconds.
NOTE:
For Quest vehicles (V40/V41 Models);
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Regulator Valve: Testing and Inspection
REGULATOR VALVE INSPECTION
1. Visually inspect components for wear and damage. 2. Check oil pressure regulator valve sliding
surface and valve spring. 3. Coat regulator valve with engine oil and check that it falls smoothly into
the valve hole by its own weight.
If damaged, replace regulator valve set or oil pump assembly.
OIL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE INSPECTION
Inspect oil pressure relief valve for movement, cracks and breaks by pushing the ball. If
replacement is necessary, remove valve by prying it out with a screwdriver.
Install a new valve in place by tapping it.
Page 4941
Seat Belt Extension: Technical Service Bulletins Seat Belts - Extender Availability
Classification: BF93-034
Reference: NTB93-112
Date: July 22, 1993
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS APPLIED VEHICLE(S): Maxima (J30) Truck (D21) Stanza (U12)
Pathfinder (WD21) Sentra (4-door) (B13) 240SX (S13) Axxess (M11) NX (KB13) Quest (V40)
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin provides a listing of part numbers and applications for Seat
Belt Extenders. The Seat Belt Extenders are intended for use by customers who cannot fit the
standard seat belts around them. Vehicles which are equipped with Front Seat Motorized Shoulder
Belts require the replacement of the entire Lap Belt Assembly for Seat Belt Extender use. The new
part has a slightly revised tongue to fit into the Seat Belt Extender. Both sides may be replaced to
give the customer the option of using the Seat Belt Extender on either side of the vehicle. Persons
who can use the standard seat belt should not use an extender. Such unnecessary use could result
in serious personal injury in the event of an accident.
Vehicles with NON-motorized seat belts do not require the replacement of the Lap Belt assemblies.
There will not be any Seat Belt Extender for the 300ZX (Z32) or the Sentra (B13) 2-Door vehicles
because of the nature of their seat belt design.
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 1525
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2396
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 3195
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4349
Fig. 3 Rack & pinion manual steering gear. 1987-88 Sentra
When assembling power steering gear, refer to Fig. 3, noting the following:
1. Install rack gear from rack side, then place rack gear in neutral position.
Fig. 6 Installing pinion guide clip. 1987-88 Sentra
2. Install pinion assembly, then with pinion rack held in place, install guide clip as shown in Fig. 6.
3. Apply suitable locking compound to threaded portion of rear cover, then install rear cover using a
suitable tool.
4. Apply suitable grease to sealing lips of dust seal, then wrap suitable tape around pinion gear and
install dust seal.
5. Apply suitable sealing compound to threaded portion of retainer cover, then install retainer,
spring and retainer cover.
6. Adjust pinion rotating torque as follows:
a. Place gear in neutral position and loosen locknut, then torque adjusting screw to 43 inch lbs. b.
Loosen adjusting screw, then retorque to 1.74 inch lbs. c. Move rack over its entire stroke several
times, then return to neutral position. d. Measure pinion rotating torque within a range of ±180°
from neutral position. Find position where rotating torque is at its maximum. e. Loosen adjusting
screw at position where rotating torque is at its maximum, then hand tighten adjusting screw until
its end touches retainer. f.
Torque locknut to 6-8 ft. lbs. while holding adjusting screw in position. Ensure adjusting screw does
not rotate.
g. While rotating pinion in the ±100° range from neutral position, ensure rotating torque is 6-10 inch
lbs. h. If pinion rotating torque is not as specified, readjust as required. If correct adjustment can
not be obtained, replace retainer spring.
7. Apply suitable locking compound to threaded portion of tie rod inner socket, then install inner
socket into rack end together with new lock plate. Ensure lock plate ratchet enters groove at end
portion of rack.
8. Tighten tie rod inner socket, then bend lock plate at two cutout portions of inner socket. Remove
burrs after bending lock plate to prevent damaging boot.
Page 2576
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 3039
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1154
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Page 2945
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2681
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 1785
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 803
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Page 3100
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2479
Page 5050
SYMPTOM: Doors do not lock with remote control
Diagnostic Procedure # 3
SYMPTOM: Doors do not unlock with remote control
Diagnostic Procedure # 4
Page 3337
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Page 5215
You can contact the paint refinish company's technical assistance number listed. Akzo/Sikkens
Procedure ICI AUTOCOLOR Procedure DuPont Procedure Glasurit Procedure Martin Senour
(NAPA) Procedure PPG Procedure R-M Procedure Sherwin Williams Procedure Spies Hecker
Procedure Herberts Standox Procedure
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 798
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
M/T - Shift Lever Vibration or Buzzing
Shift Linkage: All Technical Service Bulletins M/T - Shift Lever Vibration or Buzzing
1987-88 Sentra,
Models 1987 Pulsar
Section Manual Transmission
Classification MT89-001
Bulletin No. TS89-36
Date March 23, 1989
SENTRA/PULSAR SHIFT LEVER VIBRATION
APPLIED MODELS 1987 Pulsar 1987-88 Sentra (2WD)
APPLIED DATES & VINS Pulsar: July, 1987
JN1PN34S HM-044813 JN1EN34S HM-018300
Sentra (Japan built): July, 1987
JN1PB21S JU-523012 JN1PB22S JU-518678 JN1PB24S JU-023334 JN1PB25S JU-014701
JN1Pb26S JU-U14756
Sentra (U.S. built) February, 1988
1N4PB22S7JC778188
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some vehicles with manual transmissions manufactured before the applied dates may exhibit gear
shift lever vibration (or "buzzing") while driving at highway speeds.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-012A Date: 990617
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Classification: BR94-002a
Reference: NTB94-012a
Date: June 17, 1999
This amended version of NTB94-012 adds a caution and a note to the service procedure. Please
discard all paper copies of NTB94-012.
This bulletin supersedes TS89-105/BR89-004
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
SERVICE INFORMATION Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in
any vehicle when excessive rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's
brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in a thickness between the thickest and
thinnest points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy. However, excessive Rotor
Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is the excessive rotor thickness
variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is described in more detail below.
Page 2203
Ignition Cable: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 3314
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 326
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4199
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Testing and Inspection
Bowl Vent Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect vent line hose from carburetor float chamber.
2. With engine running, inhale on vent line of carbon canister and ensure that there is no leak.
3. Check that there is a leak with engine off.
Page 2075
Page 103
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1515
Page 1861
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 3307
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2838
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 1010
Comments regarding tubes and hoses:
^ Some R-134a tubes and hoses have reversed male/female connections to prevent
interchangeability with R-12 components.
R134A Service Tools & Equipment
^ R-12 and R-134a require separate and non-interchangeable sets of recovery, recycle, and
recharge equipment, because the refrigerants and lubricants are not compatible and cannot be
mixed even in the smallest amounts.
^ DO NOT attempt to use one set of equipment for both R-12 and R-134a, as all equipment
contains residual amounts of refrigerant and/or lubricant,
Page 2567
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 2369
Engine Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Wiring Diagram
Page 4189
Ignition Relay: Locations Ignition Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3633
Page 4225
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision Damage
Wheel Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision
Damage
Classification: FA10-006
Reference: NTB10-126
Date: October 21, 2010
WHEEL BEARING COLLISION DAMAGE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Impacts to wheel bearings (such as a collision or other suspension damage) may create slight
indents in the bearing surfaces. These indents may not be visible but can cause bearing noise.
NOTE:
Hub/bearing replacement due to impact (collision or other suspension damage) is not a
warrantable repair
If a vehicle has visible wheel or suspension damage due to impact (collision or other suspension
damage), it is recommended that the wheel bearing assembly be inspected as follows:
1. Remove the hub/bearing assembly from the vehicle.
2. Hold the hub/bearing assembly with both hands.
3. Rotate the hub/bearing assembly in both directions (clockwise and counterclockwise).
4. If any gritty or rough feeling is detected in the bearing replace it with a new one.
Page 2362
Fig. 303b Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 4822
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Refrigerant Oil Type SUNISO 5GS
Page 3469
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plugs for:
^ Improper gap
^ Carbon deposits
^ Cracked center electrode insulator
^ Burned or worn electrodes (may be caused by):
^ Excessive mileage ^ Lean fuel mixture ^ Advanced ignition timing ^ Loose spark plug ^ Plug heat
range too high ^ Insufficient Cooling
^ Fouled plug (may be caused by):
^ Rich fuel mixture ^ Retarded ignition timing ^ Oil in combustion chamber ^ Incorrect spark plug
gap ^ Plug heat range too low ^ Excessive idling/low speed running ^ Clogged air cleaner element
^ Deteriorated ignition coil, coil wire or ignition wires
2. Replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded.
Standard Type
BCPR5ES-11 (NGK)
Hot Type
BCPR4ES-11 (NGK)
Cold Type
BCPR6ES-11 (NGK)
Spark Plug Gap
3. Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool.
Electrode Gap: 0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
Page 5226
area (2' x 2' or less). Spread the liquid around with the pad before turning the buffer "ON". Use an
overlapping pattern to assure even polishing effort on all areas.
3. Second use a dual action sander with either a 3M foam pad or a Meguiar's foam pad, apply
polishing liquid over the work area (2' x 2' or less). Polish with the same technique as above. Do
not polish dry, wipe off excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
If build up occurs, cool the surface with clean water and dry with a clean terry cloth towel and clean
the foam pad. Use a slower speed to prevent heating the surface and ground the vehicle to a metal
water pipe to reduce static electricity.
INSPECTION
Gently clean a small section with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover,
using a clean towel to remove any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing
between buffing scratches and towel scratches. Inspect the surface for swirl marks under full
sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away.
CAUTION:
If you clean with an alcohol and water cleaning solution it will cause damage to plastic lenses. The
damage is not immediately visible, but develops later
Buffing
Buffing is done with a 8" buffer at 1500-1750 RPM to remove sanding scratches.
1. Clean the surface of all residue before buffing.
2. Apply a buffing liquid and spread it over the work area (2' x 2' or less) with the buffing pad before
turning the buffer "ON". Keep the pad nearly flat and move it slowly but continuously over the area.
Use an overlapping pattern to assure even buffing effort on all areas. Do not buff dry, wipe off
excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for sanding marks under full sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held
at an angle about an arms length away. If necessary, gently clean a small section of the surface
with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover, using a clean towel to remove
any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing between buffing scratches and towel
scratches.
Sanding
1. Soak the sand paper in water with lubricant such as Meguiar's # 0016, for at least 15 minutes
before use. Mask the fenders and doors to reduce cleanup time. Wet sanding with a lubricant
prevents buildup on the paper and consequent gouging of the finish.
2. Sand with 2000 grit sand paper using a sanding pad, never by hand alone. Apply plenty of water
while sanding in one direction only, no more than 12-15 strokes. Do not sand in a circular pattern.
Do not sand over body lines and panel edges. Rinse the paper frequently to prevent gouging.
NOTE:
Wet sanding vehicles with the New Cross Link Clear Coat (NCLC) hard clear coat requires a more
aggressive sanding stroke. Vehicles with a conventional clear coat require a normal sanding
stroke.
3. Rinse with water and squeegee gently. As the squeegee clears the water, inspect for damage.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for damage under both strong fluorescent lights and full sunlight (a 500 watt
halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away is necessary on cloudy days). A
smooth dull sanded surface is expected at this time. Bright spots or other irregularities indicate the
damage needs more sanding, up to the 0.5 mil standard.
4. After the damage is removed, measure the paint thickness in several places to determine if less
than 0.5 mil has been removed.
5. If the damage was deeper than 0.5 mil, the surface must be re-clear coated, or re-color coated
on vehicles with no clear coat. Refer to the Warranty Paint and Body Self-Study Course, or the
Warranty Flat Rate Manual for assistance.
6. If the damage has been removed with less than 0.5 mil of the color/clear coat removed, buff and
polish to remove the sanding marks.
Locations
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection: Locations
Engine & Emission Control Components.
Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Applicable to: 1987 Sentra w/E16i Engine
Page 1532
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2464
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 1926
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1495
Page 5034
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 4016
Brake Drum: Specifications
Model LT20A Brake Drum Inside Diameter 8.00 in
Maximum Refinish Diameter 8.05 in
Model LT23A Brake Drum Inside Diameter 9.00 in
Maximum Refinish Diameter 9.06 in
Page 631
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Technical
Service Bulletin # 08-097D Date: 110426
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Page 3877
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 2122
Page 996
Page 762
Page 73
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 4782
Comments regarding liquid tanks:
^ For R-134a, the sight glass has been deleted. Refer to the service procedures section of this
bulletin for additional information regarding the refrigerant charge determination. Pressure switches
are not interchangeable between R-12 and R-134a systems.
Page 1881
9. Use compressed air to remove any metal debris from inside the boss threads.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
10. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
11. Spray the boss threads with rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
12. Run a thread chaser through the boss to clean the threads.
^ Use Kent Moore part number J-43897-18 or J43897-12.
Page 3972
1. Before using the rotor driving unit ensure that all lug nuts are installed on the lugs (including the
lugs not used for the lug adaptor). All lug nuts should be evenly torqued, to at least 40 ft.lbs. Do not
over-tighten the lug nuts as damage may occur to the lug adaptor legs.
2. To prevent chatter and ensure a smooth rotor finish, install the largest and heaviest silencer
band possible around the outside diameter of the rotor.
Rotor Cutting
Before engaging the cutting tool, ensure the following:
1. Using the dial indicator, measure rotor/hub run-out prior to resurfacing rotor and adjust cutting
depth to eliminate this run-out. Each cut may be between 0.05 mm and 0.25 mm (0.002" and
0.010"). Additional cuts may be necessary to eliminate all the run-out.
2. Using a micrometer, measure rotor thickness in at least 8 even locations around the rotor. Do
not cut below the minimum rotor thickness specification. Replace rotor if the run-out cannot be
eliminated without exceeding the minimum rotor thickness specification.
3. After rotor resurfacing is completed, measure the rotor/hub run-out using a dial indicator. Ensure
that the run-out is below the specification for the vehicle. If runout is not within specifications, turn
the rotors again. Properly machined rotors will have almost zero runout (.001" or less) with no
measurable thickness variation.
4. Do not smooth the rotor surface with sand paper or other abrasive material.
Page 1170
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
R12 Refrigerant - Conservation/Recycling
Technical Service Bulletin # HA90006 Date: 900315
R12 Refrigerant - Conservation/Recycling
Classification: Section:
HA90-006 Air Conditioning
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-028 Models: All Models with A/C Date: March 15, 1990
CFC REFRIGERANT CONSERVATION AND RECYCLING
APPLIED MODELS: All models equipped with air conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Because of environmental concerns, it is extremely important that we all take every precaution to
reduce or eliminate the release of CFC refrigerant (R12) into the air.
Recycling Equipment In Your Dealership
If your dealership has not already received one, you will receive a Kent-Moore ACR(3) J- 38100-NI
Refrigerant Recovery and Recycling System within the next few days. This machine will recover
the refrigerant from any vehicle you service, clean the refrigerant, remove all moisture and oil, and
place the refrigerant into a 30 lb. container for re-use. To save our atmosphere, you must use the
machine every time you perform A/C service that requires a purge of the refrigerant.
Maintenance Is Essential
If the recycling equipment is maintained properly, it can clean and purify the removed refrigerant so
that it will exceed the SAE standards for content of moisture, oil, air and noncondensibles. Like any
equipment, however, this machine will operate at its best efficiency only if it is maintained properly.
This means you must check the moisture indicator often and replace the filter drier core whenever
necessary. You must make sure the correct manifold gauge and hoses are used in all cases, and
that the valves in the hoses are working properly. Make sure the unit stays clean and that the
hoses are always hung up away from contamination when the unit is not in use.
Destruction of the Earth's Ozone Layer
Page 3624
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only in areas with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath vapors or mist from spray.
6. Hold the hose and can as high as possible and spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a
continuous stream into the cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the cooler Inlet hose for 5
seconds.
NOTE:
For Quest vehicles (V40/V41 Models), before removing the extension adapter hose from the cooler
Outlet hose, turn the can over and spray only propellant (gas) for a few seconds. This will avoid
fluid spill back out of the cooler hose.
7. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 5).
8. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the cooler Outlet hose
9. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the cooler Outlet hose for
10 seconds to force out any remaining fluid.
10. Repeat steps 5 through 9 three additional times.
11. Place an oil drain pan under the banjo bolts that connect the oil cooler steel lines to the
transmission.
12. Remove the "banjo" bolts at the transmission, and pull the line fittings away from the
transmission.
13. Flush each steel line from the cooler side back toward the transmission by spraying
Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a continuous stream for 5 seconds.
14. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through each steel line from the
cooler side back toward the transmission for 10 seconds to force out any remaining fluid.
15. Ensure all debris is removed from the steel cooler lines.
16. Ensure all debris is removed from the banjo bolts and fittings.
17. Go to the Workflow chart for next step.
Frontier (D22) Cooler Bypass Cleaning
1. Place an oil drain pan under oil cooler hoses or lines before removing them.
2. Remove the lines from the transmission and allow the oil to drain from the lines (See Figure 6).
3. Remove the lines from the bypass valve (see Figure 6).
Page 1723
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 1286
STANZA: Refer to Figures 7 and 8 Mark hose in the middle of lower section of hose inclined at a
45 angle (Fig. 8). From this mark measure 3/8"
toward the radiator end and toward the engine end and mark both places. Using the last two
marks, cut a 3/4" section from the hose. Be sure the cut piece is on a straight section of hose and
try to keep the hose in its original shape.
Truck/Pathfinder: Refer to Figures 9 and 10 Mark hose in the middle of straight section of hose
connected to the engine (Fig. 10). From this mark measure 3/8" to 1/2" toward the radiator end and
toward the engine end and mark both places. Using the last two marks cut a 3/4" to 1" section from
the hose. Be sure the cut piece is on a straight section of hose and try to keep the hose in its
original shape.
Page 2591
Inspection Procedure
Page 1039
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 862
Timing Belt: Service and Repair
TIMING BELT REMOVAL
CAUTION:
- After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will
hit piston heads.
- Do not bend or twist timing belt too tightly.
- Ensure timing belt, camshaft sprocket, crankshaft sprocket and belt tensioner are clean and free
from oil or water.
- Before installing timing belt, confirm that No.1 cylinder is set at top dead center (T.D.C.) on
compression stroke.
- Align arrow in direction of timing belt rotation.
- Adjust timing belt tension with all spark plugs removed.
1. Remove the following parts.
- Front right side splash cover
- Front right side under cover
Page 2977
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4931
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Page 1000
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-001 Date: 920101
A/C - System Changes As Result of R-134A Refrigerant
Classification: HA92-OO1
Reference: NTB92-OO1
Date: January 1992
A/C SYSTEM CHANGES FOR R-134A REFRIGERANT
(ALL MODELS)
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Service Information
Introduction
Due to its harmful effect on the ozone layer, R-12 is being phased out and replaced by R-134a,
which does not harm the ozone layer. While the R-134a A/C system is very similar to an R-12 A/C
system, the differences in the refrigerant, lubricants, and service equipment are important.
Nissan A/C systems will change from R-12 to R-134a at the time of new vehicle (full model change)
introduction, or in some cases by model year update to an existing model line.
This bulletin describes all of the general differences between the R-12 and R-134a systems. For
details of an R-134a system for a specific model, refer to that model's service manual or new
product information.
Refrigerant Handling Precautions
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur.
^ Use only specified lubricant for the R-134a A/C system and R-134a components. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure is likely to occur.
^ The specified R-134a lubricant absorbs moisture from the atmosphere at a rapid rate, therefore
the following handling precautions must be observed:
^ When removing refrigerant components from a vehicle, immediately cap (seal) the component to
minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere.
^ When installing refrigerant components to a vehicle, do not remove the caps (unseal) until just
before connecting the components. Also, complete the connection of all refrigerant tubes and
hoses without delay to minimize the entry of moisture into the system.
^ Use the specified lubricant from a sealed container only. Containers must be re-sealed
immediately after dispensing the lubricant. Lubricant in containers which are not properly sealed
will become moisture saturated. Such lubricant is no longer suitable for use and should be properly
disposed.
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and
throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting SAE standards to discharge R-134a
Systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service.
^ Always wear eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or
air conditioning system.
^ Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 125° (52°C).
^ Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame; if container warming is required, place the
bottom of the container in a pail of warm water.
^ Do not intentionally drop, puncture, or incinerate refrigerant containers.
^ Keep refrigerant away from open flames: hazardous gas will be produced if refrigerant burns.
^ Refrigerant will displace oxygen, therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent
suffocation.
Page 81
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Page 2390
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Top Of Transaxle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4767
Receiver Dryer: Testing and Inspection
A restriction inside the receiver-dehydrator will result in high head pressures if the restriction is on
the inlet side of the unit. A restriction at the outlet side will cause low head pressures and little or no
cooling. An exceedingly cold receiver-dehydrator may be restricted. If the system has been in
service for a considerable amount of time, the desicant element may have lost its moisture
absorbing ability. This condition is indicated by the constant presence of small bubbles in the sight
glass if equipped and a wide difference in temperature between the inlet and outlet
receiver-dehydrator lines.
Page 3985
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 2139
Page 1468
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1989
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 484
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Page 4555
Page 4802
Page 141
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Fuel - Injector Replacement Guidelines
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Injector Replacement Guidelines
Models: All models Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control Classification: EF&EC92-003; Bulletin
No.: NTB92-086 Date: October 13, 1992
FUEL INJECTOR REPLACEMENT
APPLIED MODELS: All multi point fuel injected engines.
SERVICE INFORMATION:
When fuel injector replacement is required, the following guidelines should be followed:
1. Injector body/harness connector color must always be the same. Injector body colors are beige,
blue, brown, green, pink, purple, and red. Therefore red should always be replaced with red and
green should always be replaced with green.
2. Paint dot or metal ring color must be the same when replacing one injector out of a set. Paint dot
or ring colors are black, blue, gray, green, orange, red, white, and yellow. Therefore a red with blue
paint dot should always be replaced with a red with blue paint dot and pink with black paint dot
should always be replaced with pink with black paint dot.
3. When replacing a complete set of injectors any paint dot or ring color is acceptable, however the
injector body/harness connector color must remain the same.
Adjustments
Inhibitor Switch: Adjustments
1. Loosen inhibitor switch attaching screws.
2. Set selector lever manual shaft at Neutral position.
3. Insert suitable pin into adjustment holes in both inhibitor switch and switch lever as near vertical
as possible, then tighten screws.
4. Check switch for continuity, replacing as necessary.
Fig. 6 Adjusting inhibitor switch. 1985-88 Maxima, 1986-88 Stanza Wagon & 1987-88 Pulsar,
Sentra & Stanza exc. Wagon
INHIBITOR SWITCH VIEW
Page 3290
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2001
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Brake Adjustments
Brake Shoe: Adjustments Brake Adjustments
Fig. 1 Measuring brake drum inside diameter
Fig. 2 Adjusting brake shoes to brake drum inside diameter
300ZX models, 1985-88 200SX models and some Maxima models are equipped with four wheel
disc brakes, therefore, no adjustments are necessary on these models. Models equipped with drum
brakes have self-adjusting shoe mechanisms that ensure correct lining-to-drum clearance through
actuation of the parking brake. Although the brakes are self-adjusting, an initial adjustment is
necessary after the brake shoes have been replaced. To perform adjustment, measure brake drum
inside diameter using a suitable brake drum-to-shoe gauge, Fig. 1. Adjust brake shoes to
dimension obtained on outside of gauge, Fig. 2.
Specifications
Valve Cover: Specifications
Valve Cover Bolt 0.7 - 2.2 ft.lb
Page 460
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Page 686
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3654
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
ALL MODELS
Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 1469
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3933
^ while the vehicle is barely moving, with light brake pedal force
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
^ most common on vehicles with automatic transmission
This noise is common on most cars with front disc brakes. There are no repair procedures to
eliminate this noise. 3.
SQUEAKING/SQUEALING NOISE ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during low speed stops (5-20 mph)
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
This noise is common on vehicles with high-performance potential that must be able to stop in
short distances from high speeds. Other brands of brake pads may eliminate this noise, but Nissan
does not recommend them because they may have reduced pad life or inadequate performance in
high speed stops. 4.
HIGH-PITCHED SQUEAKING/SCRAPING NOISE ^
whenever brakes are applied
^ may come from just one wheel
Nissan uses pad wear indicators on many of its disc brake pads to provide an audible warning
when the brake pads need replacement. Spring steel tabs that are riveted to the brake pad scrape
lightly on the rotor surface when the pad is worn down to its lowest limit. The customer should hear
the noise at this time and bring the vehicle to the dealer for brake pad replacement. The pad wear
indicator will not damage the rotor surface if the pad is replaced in a reasonable time. Replace
worn pads with new parts. Check the rotor surface for damage and machine if necessary.
Page 3112
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
2WD Model
Page 4568
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 4710
CAUTION:
When installing high pressure tubes (with flange connections) to their mating parts, make sure the
flange is fully seated onto the mating part before the securing bolt is installed and tightened (see
Figure 4). If the securing bolt is installed and tightened before the tube flange is seated onto its
mating part, 0-ring damage and leaks can result.
Page 771
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Neutral/Park (NP) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1818
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 3364
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3954
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the following flow chart. Use this chart,
as appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE:
If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on the car
brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect alignment
during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications. This could
require the rotor to be turned again.
Brake Rotor Service Flow Chart
(*)CAUTION:
To ensure a proper repair, it is absolutely essential to make these measurements. For example, if
run-out remains high, brake judder and/or shimmy may not be detected while test driving the
vehicle immediately after the repair, but, may return after several thousand miles of rotor wear (due
to thickness variation).
Prior to and, again, after resurfacing a brake rotor, ensure that the rotor thickness is above the
minimum specification.
General Brake Repair Guidelines To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the
following 1.
Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug bolts
may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
Page 4002
1. Before using the rotor driving unit ensure that all lug nuts are installed on the lugs (including the
lugs not used for the lug adaptor). All lug nuts should be evenly torqued, to at least 40 ft.lbs. Do not
over-tighten the lug nuts as damage may occur to the lug adaptor legs.
2. To prevent chatter and ensure a smooth rotor finish, install the largest and heaviest silencer
band possible around the outside diameter of the rotor.
Rotor Cutting
Before engaging the cutting tool, ensure the following:
1. Using the dial indicator, measure rotor/hub run-out prior to resurfacing rotor and adjust cutting
depth to eliminate this run-out. Each cut may be between 0.05 mm and 0.25 mm (0.002" and
0.010"). Additional cuts may be necessary to eliminate all the run-out.
2. Using a micrometer, measure rotor thickness in at least 8 even locations around the rotor. Do
not cut below the minimum rotor thickness specification. Replace rotor if the run-out cannot be
eliminated without exceeding the minimum rotor thickness specification.
3. After rotor resurfacing is completed, measure the rotor/hub run-out using a dial indicator. Ensure
that the run-out is below the specification for the vehicle. If runout is not within specifications, turn
the rotors again. Properly machined rotors will have almost zero runout (.001" or less) with no
measurable thickness variation.
4. Do not smooth the rotor surface with sand paper or other abrasive material.
Page 2073
Paint - 2 and 3 Coat Pearlescent Finishes
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - 2 and 3 Coat Pearlescent Finishes
Models: All
Section: Body & Frame
Classification: BF88-004
Bulletin No.: TS88-013
Date: February 8, 1988
PEARLESCENT PAINT
APPLIED MODELS: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Pearlescent paints containing mica are now being used on some 1988 Nissan models. These
paints differ from solid or metallic paints. Three types of pearlescent paints are currently being used
by Nissan; 2-coat pearl, 2-coat pearl metallic, and 3-coat pearl (see chart).
Page 1645
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Water Valve
Refer to ``Heater Core, Replace'' procedure.
Remanufactured Starter/Alternator - Program
Starter Motor: Technical Service Bulletins Remanufactured Starter/Alternator - Program
Reference: PI95-016
Date: September 28, 1995
GENUINE NISSAN REMANUFACTURED STARTER/ALTERNATOR PROGRAM
APPLIED VEHICLES: Selected models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Beginning October 2, 1995, Nissan will offer remanufactured starters and alternators for selected
Nissan models. Consult the Genuine Nissan Remanufactured Parts Sourcebook for part numbers
and affected models. Refer to the Nissan Parts Bulletin NTB/95-023 for complete program
procedures.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The diagnostic procedure for troubleshooting starter and alternator incidents has not changed.
Refer to the appropriate service manual for specific diagnostic procedures.
Page 3616
Page 3835
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 769
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2120
Page 1085
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker Bolts
Rear Door Striker: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker
Bolts
Section:
Classification:
BF90-003 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-036 Models: All models Date: April 12, 1990
Front door
Page 1719
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VE30DE
MAXIMA (A32) VQ30DE
Page 4641
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 4976
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 4921
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Page 1988
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Battery - Charging/Replacement Procedure
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Battery - Charging/Replacement Procedure
CLASSIFICATION: EL94-001
REFERENCE: NTB94-009
DATE: MARCH 4, 1994
BATTERY CHARGING/REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE APPLIED VEHICLE(S) All
SERVICE INFORMATION As the demands on the vehicle battery increase with the complexity of
electrical systems, there is a need for a usable, consistent and repeatable procedure for
determining the need for charging or replacement of vehicle batteries.
It is the Dealer's responsibility to determine the condition/chargeability of a battery, prior to
replacement of the battery. SERVICE PROCEDURE See the following illustrations for BATTERY
CHARGING/REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE. Battery Charging/Replacement Procedure
Page 2304
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 4 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 5 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) SR20DE
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Page 2755
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Testing and Inspection
Air Conditioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 335a A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 622
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 1774
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Reach under instrument panel and disconnect multi-pin connector from rear of switch.
3. Depress two switch retaining clips and push switch out of panel.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 135
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Classification: PI95-005A
Reference: NTB95-120A
Date: January 10, 2003
COLD WEATHER STARTING TIPS
This bulletin supersedes PI95-005. The Service Information has been amended. Please discard all
paper copies of PI95-005
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
In case a vehicle is hard to start during cold weather, we suggest the following procedure.
^ These steps are a review of the procedure outlined in the Owner's Manual.
^ Use these steps when the weather is cold and the engine is hard to start.
1. Press the accelerator pedal down approximately 1/3 of the way to the floor.
2. Hold the accelerator pedal in this position while cranking the engine.
3. Once the engine has started release the accelerator pedal.
NOTE:
Do not race the engine while warming it up.
4. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, stop cranking, wait at least 10 seconds. Then
repeat steps 1 through 3.
Once an engine is started in cold weather condition:
^ You should keep the engine running for a minimum of 2-3 minutes before shutting it off.
^ Starting and stopping of the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more
difficult to restart.
^ It may also adversely affect a vehicle's fuel economy.
Another factor which may affect a vehicles "startability" is the viscosity or thickness of the oil that is
used.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity engine oil is preferred for all temperatures, all year-round for most models.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity oil makes it easier to start the engine and maintain a stable idle during
warm-up.
Please communicate these cold weather starting tips to your customers.
Disclaimer
Page 4279
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Canada Batteries
Battery: Specifications Standard Battery, Canada
Standard Battery, Canada
BCI Group Number 24F
Cranking Performance 435 A
Page 3658
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 1394
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Camshaft Sprocket Bolts 6.5 - 8.7 ft.lb
Jackshaft Sprocket Bolts 6.5 - 8.7 ft.lb
Page 346
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 1544
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1169
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 787
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4023
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 2866
EGR Control Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Component Testing Procedures
Fig. 342 EGR & canister purge control solenoid valve circuit diagnosis.
EGR Control Solenoid
Page 785
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3132
4. There is no difference between injectors made by different manufacturers.
The following table shows correct injector replacement
CORRECT REPLACEMENT ORIGINAL INJECTOR
REPLACEMENT INJECTOR
connector color/paint dot connector color/paint dot
Red/Blue Red/Blue
Pink/Black Pink/Black
The following table shows incorrect injector replacement
INCORRECT REPLACEMENT
ORIGINAL INJECTOR REPLACEMENT INJECTOR
connector color/paint dot connector color/paint dot
Red/Blue Red/Black
Purple/Black Red/Black
Beige/Blue Brown/Blue
Page 298
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
(CHECK ENGINE LIGHT ITEM)
Wiring Diagram
The following is necessary to perform this inspection.
1. Pull out E.C.U. from under the passenger seat.
2. Warm up engine sufficiently.
Page 1480
Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Fuel Pump Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 2979
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise
Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Page 2095
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3398
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1751
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Page 732
Page 624
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Classification: WT92-003
Section: Wheel & Tire
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-123
Models: All
Date: December 22, 1992
AFTERMARKET CHROMING OF NISSAN ALLOY WHEELS
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Original Equipment Alloy Wheels on Nissan vehicles are specifically developed in order to
achieve the Nissan design and performance standards. These Original Equipment wheels are also
subject to rigorous testing procedure's to ensure they meet Nissan's standards.
Nissan cannot ensure that Original Equipment Alloy Wheels which are subjected to aftermarket
chroming meet these same standards, and therefore Nissan does not recommend the use of such
wheels, nor does Nissan make any representations concerning their performance.
Indeed, if these Original Equipment Alloy Wheels are subjected to aftermarket chroming, there are
serious potential problems which may occur as a result of the chroming process:
1. The chroming process removes the original paint coating by "burning" or "chemical" methods,
both of which cause the alloy surface to be changed. The application of chrome plating has to be
controlled correctly, as the alloy can be harmed by a poorly controlled process.
2. Overall aftermarket chroming may degrade the durability, long term appearance, and may affect
safety and performance of the wheels.
Accordingly, Nissan recommends that Original Equipment Wheels NOT be chrome plated.
Please consult the Nissan Warranty Policies and Procedures Manual pertaining to the Dealer's
responsibility when altering or modifying vehicles.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Note that damage to Nissan Alloy road wheels due to any non-factory-authorized process, such as
chroming, is the responsibility of the customer, and is not covered by the Nissan Warranty, please
consult the "Nissan Warranty Information Booklet" for specific details.
Page 1442
Page 98
This chart indicates appropriate pin voltages for the ASCD system:
Page 2414
Inspection Procedure
Page 1014
Comments regarding leak detector use:
^ Existing R-12 leak detectors currently will not detect R-134a.
^ Many R-134a leak detectors will detect R-12; check with the equipment manufacturer.
^ Always refer to and follow the equipment manufacturers recommendations when operating leak
detectors.
Comments regarding weight scale use:
^ If the scale allows electronic control of the flow of refrigerant through the scale, (i.e. internal
solenoid valves) be certain that the hose fitting size is 1/2"-16 ACME, and that no refrigerant other
than R-134a (along with only specified lubricant) have been used with the scale.
Charging Cylinder
^ The use of a charging cylinder is not recommended because:
^ The refrigerant may be vented into the air from the top valve of cylinder when filling the cylinder
with refrigerant.
^ The accuracy of a charging cylinder is generally less than that of an electronic scale or of quality
recycle/recharge equipment.
Service Procedures
^ The service procedures for R-134a A/C systems are basically the same as for R-12 A/C systems,
however, the following should always be kept in mind:
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose, and
throat. Use only approved recovery/recycling equipment to discharge R-134a systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service work.
^ R-134a and R-12 A/C components are not interchangeable. Cleaning of used (in service)
components for use with another type of refrigerant and/or lubricant is not an acceptable practice,
and may result in A/C system failure.
^ Always use the proper PAG oil when servicing an R-134a A/C system. The Nissan part number
for the appropriate PAG compressor oil can be found on the A/C specification label in the engine
compartment, and also in the Factory Service Manual, and on the label on the compressor. These
oils are only available from your Nissan Parts Department.
^ When leak checking an R-134a system, be certain that you are using a detector which will detect
R-134a.
^ As mentioned previously in this bulletin, the R-134a PAG lubricants absorb moisture; PAG oil
containers and A/C components containing PAG oil must remain tightly sealed until ready for use.
^ Unlike R-12 systems, R-134a systems do not exhibit a "clear sight glass", even when properly
charged. For this reason, the R-134a A/C systems have no sight glass.
^ With R-134a systems it is important to properly control the amount of refrigerant charged into the
system during system charging. A charging machine or weight scale must always be used during
charging for proper charge determination.
^ Questions regarding R-12 or R-134a should be addressed to your Regional Service Staff or the
FIXS Hotline.
Page 3900
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Axle Shaft: Specifications Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
83-87 All MODELS
TORQUE..............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................ft.lbs. (Nm) Axle shaft nut........................................................
...................................................................................................................................................115
156
88-91 PULSAR, SENTRA Axle shaft nut..............................................................................................
...............................................................................................145-203 196-275
88-91 MAXIMA, STANZA, STANZA WAGON, AXXESS. Axle shaft nut..............................................
...............................................................................................................................................174-231
235-314
Tires - Rotation Requirement
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Rotation Requirement
Models 1987-88 Sentra Wagon & 1986-88 Stanza Wagon
Section Wheel & Tire
Classification WT87-005
Bulletin No. TS87-188
Date December 21, 1987
TIRE ROTATION REQUIREMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra Wagon with four-wheel-drive 1986-88 Stanza Wagon with
four-wheel-drive
SERVICE INFORMATION
On all Sentra and Stanza Wagon four-wheel-drive models, it is very important that regular tire
rotation be performed according to the maintenance schedules in the appropriate service manuals.
On these vehicles, difficulty in shifting out of the four-wheel-drive mode could occur if the front tires
are allowed to wear down more than the rear tires. A difference in tire circumference, front to rear,
causes a strain at the driveline between front and rear axles.
Page 320
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 5016
3. Insert the replacement antenna rod with the radio in the "ON" position. Insert antenna rope with
gear section facing the motor assembly [Figure 2].
4. Turn the radio "OFF" to retract the antenna rod. If the antenna motor stops before the antenna
has fully retracted, turn the radio switch "ON" and immediately turn it "OFF" again. Guide the
antenna rope and rod into the antenna assembly.
5. Reinstall the antenna nut and base. Check antenna operation by cycling the radio "ON" and
"OFF".
Power Antenna Maintenance
Clean power antenna rods at every service opportunity by wiping with a damp cloth.
PRECAUTIONS
Please remind the customer to:
1. Always turn the radio "OFF" to prevent bending the antenna rod, whenever going through car
washes or entering parking garages with low ceilings or low hanging garage doors.
2. The antenna rod should be cleaned regularly by wiping off any dirt build up which may cause the
antenna to bind. Customers should verify that their car wash attendants do this regularly.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
NOTE:
The following Claims Information applies to antenna rod replacement for defects in materials and
workmanship. Damaged (bent) rods are not included.
Claim Information
Page 550
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 416
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 2537
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Page 4940
86848-01A10 1978-81 510
86848-01A11 1987 Sentra 1987 Van
1986-87 200SX (Applied Date: from 2/86)
86848-01A12 1987 Pulsar NX 1987 300ZX
1987 Stanza
II. LONGER SEAT BELTS (CONTINUED)
PART NUMBER APPLIED MODEL
86840-D0124 (R.H.) 1982-86 Stanza (4-Door/5-Door)
86841-D0124 (L.H.)
86840-D1024 (R.H.) 1982-84 Stanza (2-Door)
86841-D1024 (L.H.)
86840-37A24 (R.H) 1982.5-86 Sentra (2-Door)
Complete Belt Set ONLY 1983-86 Pulsar NX (2-Door)
86841-37A24 (L.H.) Complete Belt Set ONLY
* 1974-78 B210 - Two seat belt manufacturers were used: NSK Warner and Takata. Be sure to
check the belt for the manufacturers name before ordering.
**No special extenders are available for 1984-1986 720 and some 1986.5 D21 U.S.A. produced
trucks. However, the extender listed for 1983-1987 trucks on page 2/3 can be used if a
replacement seat belt set is ordered from the parts catalogue as noted below:
1984-86 720 Truck
For U.S.A. produced 720 trucks (VIN prefix 1N6...) order the belt set for the equivalent Japanese
produced 720 truck (VIN Prefix JN6...) and the extender listed on page 2/3 will fit. Do not order any
replacement seat belt set with an "S" in the 6th digit of the part number. Example: For a 1984
Brown 2WD (K/Cab) order (Brown C-134) P/N 86840-10W11. Do not order (Brown C-134 USA
make) P/N 86840-S3601.
1986.5 D21 Truck
Check the manufacturer's identification on the female buckle in the D21 truck. If the buckle is
marked "TK - ", no new belt set is needed, just order the extender listed on page 2/3 of this bulletin.
If the buckle is marked with "NSK/Warner", order the correct color replacement seat belt set (male
and female halves) listed in the D21 parts catalog, and the extender listed on page 2/3 will fit. All
replacement seat belt sets listed in the D21 catalog are compatible with the extender.
NOTE: If an extender is needed for a U.S.A. produced 720 or D21 truck, the replacement seat belt
set and the installation is available at no charge to the consumer.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
CS PNC CT OPERATION OP CODE FLAT RATE
9Y 868EX 99 Install Longer Belt SH99AA 0.4/hr.
9Y 868EX 99 Install Extender(s) SH16AA 0.2/hr.
Page 3522
Forward Clutch (Rear)
Page 1327
^ Pulley should turn with some dragging
^ If it locks or has unusual resistance, replace the alternator.
Page 1086
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 2564
Fig. 303c Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 2143
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.) Operation
Idle Speed Control Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.)
Operation
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel
EF&EC88-017; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-115 Models:
1988 Sentra & Pulsar (E16i) Date:
September 8, 1988 IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED MODEL: 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16i
SERVICE INFORMATION
Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988 Sentras and Pulsars (E16i)
is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models. Any attempt to interchange
these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle Speed Control Valve
(I.S.C.V).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below. PARTS INFORMATION
Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number for the 1988
mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your reference, the part
numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
PART DESCRIPTION 1988 PART NUMBER 1987 PART NUMBER
E16i Mixture Heater 16174-61A61 16174-69A10
(B12/N13)
Page 831
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
Ignition Wire
The coil wire connects the ignition coil to the distributor cap, allowing high voltage to flow from the
coil to the distributor cap. The spark plug wires connect the terminals in the distributor cap to the
spark plugs, allowing high voltage to flow to the spark plugs. The ignition wires have an internal
resistance to suppress radio static and to eliminate static that may interfere with sensitive computer
components.
Page 2331
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Page 1075
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Page 2559
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 1999
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 604
2. Position vehicle on the front turn plates as follows:
^ Stop vehicle just behind the turn plates.
^ Center the turn plates to the tires.
^ Move the vehicle onto the turn plates by turning/pushing the rear wheel.
DO NOT push/pull on the vehicle body.
Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Classification: Section: Front Axle
FA89-004 & Suspension
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-150 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra, Pulsar NX, 1989-1990 240SX
Date: October 19, 1989 FRONT STRUT KIT CAMBER
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1989 Sentras (B12) 1987-1989 Pulsar NX (N13) 1989-1990 240SX
(S13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
New Front Strut Kits supplied for the Applied Models are now manufactured with the camber
already set at factory specifications. The adjustable eccentric pin contained in the previously
available kit assemblies has been eliminated. Please note that the new kits will retrofit on a model
by model basis, and adjustment is not required when retrofitting.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 1522
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1841
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 3296
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2410
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: Customer Interest Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 5139
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Classification: BT97-014
Reference: NTB97-060
Date: August 13, 1997
BUMPER REFINISHING TECHNIQUES
Applied Vehicles: All models with plastic bumper covers (fascia) SERVICE INFORMATION This
bulletin describes proper plastic bumper cover refinishing with specific paint manufacturer
procedures and materials. For information on repairing bumpers refer to the 1992 Technical
Bulletin book, page BF-31 for NTB92-043/BF92-013. When refinishing replacement plastic bumper
covers (i.e. service parts), it is important to follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure
exactly. Failure to do so may result with paint not fully adhering to the bumper, and with time, the
paint not adhering to the bumper may peel off. The bumper covers contain mold release agents
which must be removed prior to painting. If the bumper cover is not properly cleaned and prepped,
the paint may not adhere. Please follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure for proper
bumper preparation. NOTE:
You can heat the bumper at 140°F for 45 minutes to bring the mold release agent to the surface.
Allow the bumper cover to cool completely before cleaning. This cleaning (degreasing) is
necessary to remove the mold release agent on the surface completely.
The chart indicates which cover; polyurethane (PUR) or polypropylene (PP) is used on each model.
The procedures and appropriate materials for each paint vendor are attached for your reference. If
you should have any difficulty: ^
Obtaining materials
^ Following the published procedure
^ Obtaining a proper finish
^ If you are in a VOC regulated area
Page 2384
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1777
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Single Stage Converter
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation Single Stage Converter
The catalytic converter accelerates the chemical reaction of hydrocarbons (HC) and carbon
monoxide (CO) in the exhaust gas, and changes them into harmless carbon dioxide (CO2) and
water (H2O). The chemical reaction process requires the proper amount of air. This air, called
secondary air, is supplied by the air injection system through a check valve or through an air
induction valve, or is absorbed from excess air in the unburned portion of the air/fuel mixture. By
means of a chemical reaction process as it passes through the catalytic converter, the excess air in
the air/fuel mixture (which has not been burned during the combustion process) is utilized to
minimize HC and CO emissions. The exhaust gas which is left unburned during combustion
process is gradually oxidized with excess oxygen, and is converted into harmless carbon dioxide
(CO2) and water (H2O). The catalytic converter, located in the exhaust line, further cleans exhaust
gases through catalytic action, and changes residual hydrocarbons (HC) and carbon monoxide
(CO) contained in the exhaust gas into carbon dioxide (CO2) and water (H2O) before the exhaust
gas is discharged to the atmosphere.
Page 4209
2. Position vehicle on the front turn plates as follows:
^ Stop vehicle just behind the turn plates.
^ Center the turn plates to the tires.
^ Move the vehicle onto the turn plates by turning/pushing the rear wheel.
DO NOT push/pull on the vehicle body.
Page 307
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2282
This valve, Figs. 14 and 15, monitors exhaust pressures to activate the diaphragm. The valve
controls vacuum applied to the EGR control valve. This allows the operation of the EGR control
valve to be controlled by engine operating conditions.
Page 1527
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 4258
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 549
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 289
NOTES:
^ Rust penetrant is considered a shop supply.
^ Nissan Rust Penetrant can be ordered through the Nissan Direct Ship Chemical Care Product
Program, Website order via link on dealer portal.
^ WD-40 is available from various local sources.
Removal Tool
^ When removing a seized exhaust sensor with a specialty socket (which contains a slit to
accommodate the wiring harness), it may spread open and
strip the sensor.
^ Before this occurs, it is recommended to cut the wiring harness from the sensor and use a box
end wrench or 6-point deep well socket.
1. Clamp the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube in a vice.
2. Spray the sensor with the rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
^ It is important that the spray is directed at the base of the sensor to ensure it penetrates into the
threads.
Page 743
Page 1624
Index For Main Harness Part 1
Engine Compartment, Left Front Fender Apron Near Battery.
Connector ID is 79M.
Page 1985
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 644
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 2720
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 4740
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair
When replacing evaporator, add 2.7 oz. of new refrigerant oil on 300ZX or 2.4 oz. on all other
models.
Fig. 15 Instrument panel attachment plate removal.
PULSAR & SENTRA
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and discharge system refrigerant.
2. Disconnect refrigerant lines from evaporator, plugging all openings, then remove piping grommet
and cover.
3. Remove passenger side instrument lower cover and glove compartment.
4. Remove attachment plate from instrument panel, Fig. 15.
Fig. 16 Instrument panel cut lines.
Fig. 17 Instrument panel cut lines.
5. Using hacksaw blade, cut instrument panel on cut lines, Figs. 16 and 17. Cover blower motor
vent holes with tape before cutting and brush shavings away from area around blower motor and
remove tape after cutting.
6. Remove blower motor unit.
7. Remove cooling unit.
8. Separate cooling unit case halves and remove evaporator.
9. Disconnect and remove expansion valve.
10. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure that expansion valve is properly positioned.
Page 3857
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 4116
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 2307
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 396
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1048
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 108
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Page 419
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 1762
Vehicle Speed Sensor The vehicle speed sensor produces an alternating voltage signal. This
alternating signal (analog) is converted to a digital signal for processing.
The control unit can only process digital signals. Analog signals must be converted to a digital form
before the information can be used by the control unit.
Control Unit Logic
The control unit processes digital signals in two forms. To the control unit the signal is either ON or
OFF. In computer logic an ON or high voltage signal is a "1" and an OFF or low voltage signal is a
"O". The control unit uses combinations of these signals to control its outputs. The controller uses
inputs from many sensors to determine what outputs it will make and at what time it will make
them. These outputs control a variety of functions from automatic speed control to engine
driveability.
Outputs
An output is simply an action the control unit tells an electrical component to make. Based on the
calculations the control unit makes of the inputs, it will signal an action. The output can tell a
component to perform a function for a period of time.
Power and Ground Control
The ECU controls either a component's power or ground. To understand this, refer to the diagrams.
If the ECU is between the electrical component (load) and the power source, the ECU controls its
power.
^ If the component is between the power source and the ECU, the ECU controls the component
ground.
VOLTAGE DROP TEST
Service and Diagnosis Precautions
Before diagnosing any electronic controlled circuits the following cautions should be followed:
1. Make sure the following parts and systems are in good condition and are operating properly. ^
Battery output
^ Battery terminals
^ Grounds
^ System connectors are properly positioned and connected
2. Never use a test lamp to check an electronically controlled circuit.
3. Do not drop, jar or shake electronic components.
Follow the trouble diagnosis charts in the appropriate section of the Service Manual to isolate
which component may be the incident part.
Voltage Drop Tests
Voltage Drop Tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance.
A voltage drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation. Part of the
available voltage is used by the resistance. When there is excessive resistance, less voltage is
available for other loads (lights, motors, etc.) in the circuit. Since each resistance in a circuit uses
voltage, a voltmeter can be used to isolate the cause of the problem.
A voltage drop across closed contacts can indicate excessive resistance. This can cause the circuit
to operate incorrectly. Remember, a switch is not a load. During diagnosis, use a voltmeter to
measure the voltage drop across each switch contact while the circuit is in operation.
Page 2719
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2144
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1074
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2222
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plugs for:
^ Improper gap
^ Carbon deposits
^ Cracked center electrode insulator
^ Burned or worn electrodes (may be caused by):
^ Excessive mileage ^ Lean fuel mixture ^ Advanced ignition timing ^ Loose spark plug ^ Plug heat
range too high ^ Insufficient Cooling
^ Fouled plug (may be caused by):
^ Rich fuel mixture ^ Retarded ignition timing ^ Oil in combustion chamber ^ Incorrect spark plug
gap ^ Plug heat range too low ^ Excessive idling/low speed running ^ Clogged air cleaner element
^ Deteriorated ignition coil, coil wire or ignition wires
2. Replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded.
Standard Type
BCPR5ES-11 (NGK)
Hot Type
BCPR4ES-11 (NGK)
Cold Type
BCPR6ES-11 (NGK)
Spark Plug Gap
3. Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool.
Electrode Gap: 0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
Page 5514
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Rear
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. To remove, raise rear wiper arm off glass and remove retaining nut.
3. Remove tailgate inner trim panel, if necessary, and disconnect electrical connection at motor.
4. Remove wiper motor retaining bolts.
5. Remove wiper motor.
6. To install, reverse procedure.
Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Top Of Transaxle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2352
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 2454
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 602
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
4. Make sure the "turn plates" and "slide" plates are in good working order:
^ The surface of the front turn plates must be level with (the same height as) the rack surface.
If height is not the same; have the equipment repaired before performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the front turn plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide and turn) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the turn plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
Page 3377
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 5063
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Circuit Board: Service and Repair
Fig. 12 Exploded view of instrument panel. 1987-88 Sentra
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove steering column covers.
3. Remove screws securing cluster lid ``A,'' then remove the cluster lid, Fig. 12.
4. Disconnect electrical connectors from combination meter.
5. Disconnect speedometer cable.
6. Remove combination meter retaining screws, then the combination meter, Fig. 12.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 395
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2204
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Page 4804
A list of Johnstone Supply outlets who stock SUNISO 5GS oil in one quart containers . There may
also be other oulets in your area that carry SUNISO 5GS. This would most commmonly be a firm
specializing in industrial A/C and refrigeration supplies.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
When billing for "SUNISO 5GS" on warranty claims, use "local" part number: LOCALCOMPR.
Audio - Aftermarket Phone/Audio Installation Precautions
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Aftermarket Phone/Audio Installation
Precautions
Classification: Section:
GI92-001 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-003
Models:
All Models
Date:
January 16, 1992
AFTERMARKET CELLULAR PHONE AND AUDIO
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Many customers request installation of aftermarket cellular phones and audio equipment at the
time of new vehicle purchase. Nissan does not authorize or warrant non-Nissan approved parts or
accessories installed in Nissan vehicles. If these installations are made, they should be checked
routinely after sublet work has been performed to help eliminate customer complaints. The
following guidelines should be followed:
1. Route wires at least 18" away from ECU and air bag controller. Use high quality shielded cables
for all signal cables (98% shielded).
2. Do not tap into wires that are part of any safety or ECCS equipment, such as airbag, brake
lights, turn indicators, warning lights, ABS, fuel injection, etc. Power should come from the battery
or the accessory circuit. Ground leads should terminate at the battery. Always use inline fuses as
close to the power source as possible.
3. Use wire ties to securely fasten new harness in vehicle.
4. Before any panels or finishers are replaced, ensure that all fasteners are in good condition and
are properly located.
5. When it is necessary for additional harnesses or cables to pass under the edge of a finisher,
such as a cellular phone antenna coaxial cables, notch the finisher at that point so that it will fit
back into place correctly.
6. Glass-mounted cellular phone antennas are affected by defroster wires in the window. Mount the
antenna as high on the glass as possible and at least 1/2" away from defroster wires.
7 Test drive all vehicles to listen for squeaks or rattles.
NOTE: Please supply a copy of these guidelines to accessory installation shops that your
dealership or customers use regularly.
Page 4255
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 4781
Comments regarding condensers:
^ The parallel flow condenser can be identified by the refrigerant end tanks, and smaller, more
closely spaced center section tubes.
Page 3366
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4473
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Top Of Transaxle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 87
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Locations
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 998
Page 3470
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
Removing Spark Plug Boot
REMOVAL 1.
Remove the ignition wire from the spark plug with a twisting and pulling motion. CAUTION: Pull on
the boot only. Do not pull on the wire.
2. Using compressed air, blow out the area at the base of the spark plug to remove any debris USE
SAFETY GLASSES.
3. Using a 5/8" (16mm) flex socket and extension, remove the spark plugs (counterclockwise
rotation).
INSTALLATION 1.
Using a suitable tool, check and adjust the spark plug gap. ELECTRODE GAP
0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
2. Using a suitable rubber hose or designated tool, start the spark plugs by hand (clockwise
rotation).
3. Tighten and torque the spark plugs. SPARK PLUG TORQUE
14 - 22 ft. lbs. (20 - 29 N-m / 2.0 - 3.0 kg-m)
4. Apply a small amount of di-electric compound to the inside of the spark plug boots.
5. Reinstall the spark plug boots.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 3154
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The electronic control unit adjusts fuel pump operation to engine operating conditions. The signals
from various sensors and switches are used to control fuel pump operation.
Fig. 39 Fuel pump control chart.
Fig. 39
Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Classification: EF & EC 93-013
Section: Engine Fuel
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-167
Models: Various
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED MODELS:
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to determine that a
vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and Date
of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and should have the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part
number on the ECM cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 341
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Locations
Fender: Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Page 3617
Page 3841
condition.
To determine if an electrical component is heat sensitive, heat the component with a heat gun or
equivalent. Do not heat components above 60 degrees Celsius (140 Fahrenheit). If the incident
occurs while heating the unit you will need to replace the component or make sure it is properly
insulated from the heat source.
3. Freezing
If the customer indicates the incident goes away after the car warms up (wintertime) the cause
could be related to water freezing somewhere in the wiring/electrical system.
There are two methods to check for this. The first is to arrange for the owner to leave his car over
night. Make sure it will get cold enough to demonstrate his complaint. Leave the car parked outside
overnight. In the morning, be prepared to do a quick and thorough diagnosis of those electrical
components which could be affected.
The second method to diagnose for a freezing component is to put the suspect component into a
freezer long enough for any water to freeze. If reinstalling the part into the car results in the incident
reoccurring you will need to repair or replace that component.
4. Water Intrusion
If the incident only occurs during high humidity or rainy/snowy periods, it could be caused by water
intrusion on an electrical part. This can be simulated by soaking the car or running it through a car
wash. Do not spray water directly on any electrical components.
5. Electrical Load
If the incident appears to be electrical load sensitive, perform diagnosis while all accessories are
turned on including, A/C, rear defog, radio, fog lamps, etc.
6. Cold or Hot Start Up
On some occasions an electrical incident may only occur when the car is started cold or when the
car is restarted (hot) shortly after being turned off. In these cases you may have to keep the car
overnight to make a proper diagnosis.
Testing Circuits
Page 1516
Page 4540
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 1139
Page 3948
Codes that best describes the operations performed.
Disclaimer
Page 5352
Cruise Control: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 4043
Fig. 5 AD18B type front disc brake disassembled
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1958
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Testing and Inspection
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Testing and Inspection
a. Check to see if throttle valve fully opens when accelerator pedal is fully depressed and if it
returns to idle when released. b. Adjust accelerator wire according to following procedure.
Tighten "Adjusting nut" until "throttle drum" starts to move. From that position turn back "Adjusting
nut" 1.5 - 2 turns, and fasten it with a lock nut.
c. Check accelerator control parts for improper contact with any adjacent parts. d. When
connecting accelerator wire, be careful not to twist or scratch its inner wire. e. Apply a light coat of
recommended multi-purpose grease to all sliding or friction surfaces. Do not apply grease to wire. f.
On automatic transaxle models, adjust A/T throttle wire
Page 5140
You can contact the paint refinish company's technical assistance number listed. Akzo/Sikkens
Procedure ICI AUTOCOLOR Procedure DuPont Procedure Glasurit Procedure Martin Senour
(NAPA) Procedure PPG Procedure R-M Procedure Sherwin Williams Procedure Spies Hecker
Procedure Herberts Standox Procedure
Testing and Inspection
Air Conditioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 335a A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 2173
Idle Speed: Specifications
Base Idle Speed Controlled Idle Speed
Adjusted with Throttle Sensor disconnected.
Manual Transmission 750 +/- 25 rpm 800 +/- 100 rpm
Automatic Transmission 670 +/- 25 rpm 700 +/- 100 rpm
In "D" Position.
Page 3467
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 546
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 1501
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4201
Page 4510
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 2092
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1597
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plugs for:
^ Improper gap
^ Carbon deposits
^ Cracked center electrode insulator
^ Burned or worn electrodes (may be caused by):
^ Excessive mileage ^ Lean fuel mixture ^ Advanced ignition timing ^ Loose spark plug ^ Plug heat
range too high ^ Insufficient Cooling
^ Fouled plug (may be caused by):
^ Rich fuel mixture ^ Retarded ignition timing ^ Oil in combustion chamber ^ Incorrect spark plug
gap ^ Plug heat range too low ^ Excessive idling/low speed running ^ Clogged air cleaner element
^ Deteriorated ignition coil, coil wire or ignition wires
2. Replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded.
Standard Type
BCPR5ES-11 (NGK)
Hot Type
BCPR4ES-11 (NGK)
Cold Type
BCPR6ES-11 (NGK)
Spark Plug Gap
3. Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool.
Electrode Gap: 0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
Page 5511
Wiper Motor: Diagrams Rear Wiper Motor Replace
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. To remove, raise rear wiper arm off glass and remove retaining nut.
3. Remove tailgate inner trim panel, if necessary, and disconnect electrical connection at motor.
4. Remove wiper motor retaining bolts.
5. Remove wiper motor.
6. To install, reverse procedure.
Page 1037
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Page 276
Inspection Procedure
Page 3832
Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal
Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Page 299
Page 657
Fig. 18 Turning angle specifications
STEERING ANGLE
When a vehicle negotiates a turn, the inner wheel must turn at a sharper angle than the outer
wheel, and the outer wheel must travel farther than the inner wheel. Vehicle steering geometry is
calculated to allow for these variations, causing the outer wheel to to-out by a calibrated amount.
This toe-out on turns is also referred to as steering angle and on these models, is generally
checked at two positions. The first position is at a reference point on the inner wheel travel while
the second position of measurement is at full steering lock. To check steering angles, proceed as
follows:
1. Place unladen vehicle on suitable alignment rack and ensure that kingpin angle, caster, camber
and toe settings are within specifications.
Page 2174
Idle Speed: Description and Operation
Idle Speed Control
The idle speed is controlled by the E.C.C.S. control unit, corresponding to the engine operating
conditions. The E.C.C.S. control unit senses the engine condition and determines the best idle
speed at each water temperature and gear position. The control unit then sends an electronic
signal corresponding to the difference between the best idle speed and the actual idle speed to the
A.A.C. valve.
INPUT SIGNAL AND AIR FLOW
The opening of the I.S.C. valve is controlled by an ON-duty signal fed to the opening solenoid.
(When the opening solenoid is "ON", the closing solenoid is "OFF", and vice versa.)
The longer the ON-duty signal on the opening solenoid, the greater the I.S.C. valve opening and
the greater the amount of airflow.
Page 3035
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 4807
Comments regarding PAG refrigerant oils:
^ PAG oil absorbs moisture from the air at an exceptionally fast rate, and moisture can damage the
A/C system.
Page 1494
Page 5045
Diagnostic Procedure # 9 Zone continuity
Diagnostic Procedure # 10 Alarm will not silence with key
Diagnostic Procedure # 11 No alarm with impact
Diagnostic Procedure # 12 Engine will not crank
Diagnostic Procedure # 13 Main Power Supply and Ground Circuit Checks
Impact Sensor Inspection
Siren Check
Console Switch Inspection
System Pin Test
Circuit Diagram
Preparation For System Checks
Service Parts Listing
Control Unit
The control unit is located under the instrument panel. The unit consists of a radio receiver which
receives signals from the remote control transmitters and a micro processor which receives various
input signals and controls the system output. Power is supplied at all times through a 10 amp
in-line fuse to terminals # 2 and # 5. System ground is supplied through terminal # 1.
Inputs
a) The console switch (located on the center console) inputs selected operating modes. When the
switch is in the AUTO mode no signal is supplied to the control unit. When in the IMPACT OFF
mode a 12 volt signal is supplied through terminal # 18 and when in the ALARM OFF mode a 12
volt signal is supplied through terminal # 17.
b) The impact sensor supplies a pulse to the control unit through terminals # 14 (light impact) and #
11 (heavy impact).
c) The trunk room lamp switch supplies input through terminal # 9 indicating that the trunk has
been opened. This will trigger an alarm when the system is armed or an error code when
attempting to arm the system with the trunk open.
d) The hood switch supplies input through terminal # 8 indicating that the hood is open. This will
trigger an alarm if opened with the system armed or an error tone when attempting to arm the
system with the hood open.
e) The door switch supplies input through terminal # 10 indicating that a vehicle door has been
opened. This will trigger an alarm if opened when the system is armed or an error tone when
attempting to arm the system with a door open.
f) The ignition switch supplies input through terminal # 19 indicating that the switch is in the ACC
position. This signal will disarm the system when passively armed, silence the alarm or disallow the
system to be armed.
g) The door lock timer supplies input through terminal # 16 indicating that the doors have been
locked with the power door lock switch (passive arming).
Outputs
a) Terminal # 20 supplies a pulse to the door lock timer to lock the doors when locked or armed
with the remote control.
b) Terminal # 12 supplies a pulse to the door lock timer to unlock the doors when unlocked or
disarmed with the remote control.
c) Terminal # 6 supplies a ground output to sound the siren.
d) Terminal # 13 supplies a ground output to illuminate the LED on the console switch.
e) Terminal # 21 supplies a ground output to turn on the interior light when the system is disarmed
and flashes the light when an alarm is sounding.
Start Cut
The ignition switch start signal is routed to the control unit through terminal # 7 and relayed out
through terminal # 4. In the event that an alarm is sounded the control unit will not relay the start
signal out until the system has been disarmed.
Service Procedure
Single Stage Converter
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation Single Stage Converter
The catalytic converter accelerates the chemical reaction of hydrocarbons (HC) and carbon
monoxide (CO) in the exhaust gas, and changes them into harmless carbon dioxide (CO2) and
water (H2O). The chemical reaction process requires the proper amount of air. This air, called
secondary air, is supplied by the air injection system through a check valve or through an air
induction valve, or is absorbed from excess air in the unburned portion of the air/fuel mixture. By
means of a chemical reaction process as it passes through the catalytic converter, the excess air in
the air/fuel mixture (which has not been burned during the combustion process) is utilized to
minimize HC and CO emissions. The exhaust gas which is left unburned during combustion
process is gradually oxidized with excess oxygen, and is converted into harmless carbon dioxide
(CO2) and water (H2O). The catalytic converter, located in the exhaust line, further cleans exhaust
gases through catalytic action, and changes residual hydrocarbons (HC) and carbon monoxide
(CO) contained in the exhaust gas into carbon dioxide (CO2) and water (H2O) before the exhaust
gas is discharged to the atmosphere.
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Page 1934
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 3351
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Testing and Inspection
Thermostatic Air Cleaner Vacuum Switch: Testing and Inspection
While the engine is cool and idling, disconnect the inlet vacuum hose of the vacuum motor and
make sure that intake manifold vacuum is present at the end of the vacuum hose. If vacuum is
weak or is not present at all, check the vacuum hose for leakage. Replace the temperature sensor
if the vacuum hoses are in good order. And after the engine warms up, make sure that no vacuum
is present there. If any, replace the temperature sensor.
Page 4413
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 5051
SYMPTOM: System will not passive arm when driver's door lock switch is pressed.
Diagnostic Procedure # 5
SYMPTOM: Clearance lights do not flash
Diagnostic Procedure # 6
SYMPTOM: No sound from siren
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Paint - Contamination Identification and Repair
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-015 Date: 940208
Paint - Contamination Identification and Repair
Classification: BF94-003
Reference: NTB94-O15
Date: February 8, 1994
PAINT CONTAMINATION IDENTIFICATION AND REPAIR
This bulletin supersedes NTB93-058 / BF93-014 & NTB91-090 / BF91-023
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
SERVICE INFORMATION
The following procedures and materials have been found effective in removing iron particles, water
or chemical spots, scratches and/or swirl marks which have not penetrated the clear coat/color coat
of painted vehicle surfaces.
NOTE:
The updated repair procedures discussed in this Service Bulletin can be applied to all types of
Nissan clear coat materials, including the new Cross Link clear coat (NCLC)/hard clear coat.
*NOTE:
Measure the paint thickness before and after abrasive cleaning. If abrasive repair is not successful
on the first panel tested, it must be tried on each affected panel (hood, roof, trunk etc.,) to
determine which panel(s) must be re-clear coated or re-color/clear coated and which may be
repaired by abrasive means.
Finish Kare Product Distributors:
1726 Floradale Ave., El Monte, CA 91733 (213) 686-0462
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Sensors and Switches - Engine.
Page 2170
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE:
A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Torque Converter Cover: Customer Interest A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter
Housing
Classification: Section:
AT90-002 Automatic Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-010
Models: 1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: February 8, 1990 F01A AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra XE 1987-1990 Pulsar NX XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some of the Applied Models equipped with the F01A Automatic Transaxles may exhibit
transmission fluid leakage from the converter housing and/or the front cover gasket area(s). To
improve the sealing performance at these locations, new bolts for the torque converter housing and
the front cover are now used in production, and the tightening torque for these bolts has been
changed to eliminate this condition. In addition, a new torque converter housing gasket is available
as a service replacement part for these vehicles.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated areas, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the front cover and/or torque converter housing, thoroughly clean and inspect
(for porosities, surface damage, etc.) all mating surfaces. Install a new converter housing gasket
and new bolts, being certain to apply sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque
as indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
incident area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Testing and Inspection
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Air density becomes thinner at higher altitudes. Therefore, the carburetor produces too rich an
air/fuel mixture at higher altitudes. The altitude compensator automatically corrects air/fuel ratio to
an optimum mixture. When vehicle is operated in a high altitude environment, the bellows in the
compensator extends, causing the lever attached to the bellows to push up the needle. When the
needle is pushed up the air passage becomes wider, allowing larger amounts of air to flow from the
altitude compensator to the carburetor, thereby thinning the air/fuel mixture. Electronic Controlled
Carburetor (ECC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection
Page 2013
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1551
AB-/BC VALVE CONTROL
When the idle switch is OFF, the I.S.C. valve opens in response to the amount of intake air and
engine speed. When the accelerator pedal is released, additional air is led into the intake manifold,
actuating as AB- or BC valve.
Page 440
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 126
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 773
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2301
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VE30DE
MAXIMA (A32) VQ30DE
Page 233
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
The stop light switch is located on the brake pedal support.
1. Disconnect the switch electrical connectors.
2. Loosen switch retaining locknut and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 2322
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
VAN (C22) Z241
200SX (S100) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
Page 1072
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 5279
3M materials:
Meguiar's materials:
Misc:
8" buffer (1500-1750 RPM) Dual action sander, variable speed Terry cloth towels (100% cloth)
NOTE:
Always use separate pads for each liquid (mark the backside of each pad with the type of liquid
used) and clean the pads frequently. Use of a wool pad on clear coat is limited to the polishing type
of pad and is always followed by a foam Dad on a dual action sander to remove swirl marks.
Measuring Paint Film Thickness
Before any abrasive removal, measure the initial film thickness at several places to establish an
average figure. After each abrasive step measure several places again to determine how much
paint film was removed. Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of the mil gauge you
are using for measurement and calibration. If you do not have a thickness gauge use the following
rule of thumb during abrasive removal; When the "orange peel" surface is removed, 0.5 mil has
been removed.
Polishing
Polishing is done in two steps: The first step is with an 8" buffer and the second step with a dual
action sander to remove buffing and swirl marks. Low speed (1500-1750 RPM) is necessary to
prevent overheating the surface.
CAUTION:
Do not polish or buff a surface dry. More than the usual quantity of liquid must be used to keep the
paint surface cool. Wipe the excess material off with a clean soft towel after each operation
1. Clean the surface of all residue before polishing.
2. Use an 8" buffer (at 1500 - 1750 RPM) with either a 3M wool polishing pad or a Meguiar's foam
pad, apply polishing compound over the work
Page 3365
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 829
Ignition Cable: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2996
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1285
4. Loosen the clamps at both ends of the lower radiator hose. Observe how the hose fits and its
shape as installed in the vehicle. Mark the engine end of the hose with tape or chalk. Remove the
hose from the vehicle. (Stanza:
remove end of hose connected to radiator only.)
5. 200SX: Refer to Figures 5 and 6 Measure 15 inches from the engine end of the hose and make
a mark. From this mark measure 1-1/2" towards the radiator end and mark (Fig. 6). Using these
two marks, cut a 1-1/2" section from the hose. Be sure the cut piece is on a straight section of hose
and try to keep the hose in its original shape.
Page 2524
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 3303
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 3758
This vibration/buzzing may be generated from the shift linkage control rod. The fit between the
connecting pin and bushing in the joint at the transmission end of the control rod has been
improved to eliminate this incident (see illustrations).
NOTE: The control rod is available only as an assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If this incident exists on a vehicle manufactured before the applied dates, replace the control rod
assembly as shown in the appropriate Service Manual.
PARTS INFORMATION
CONTROL ROD ASSY
MODEL PART NUMBER
B12 2WD 34103-50M00
N13 E16 34103-50M00
CA16D 34103-55M00
Page 2066
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 150
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 731
Page 1046
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Page 2974
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4261
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
R12 Refrigerant - Conservation/Recycling
Technical Service Bulletin # HA90006 Date: 900315
R12 Refrigerant - Conservation/Recycling
Classification: Section:
HA90-006 Air Conditioning
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-028 Models: All Models with A/C Date: March 15, 1990
CFC REFRIGERANT CONSERVATION AND RECYCLING
APPLIED MODELS: All models equipped with air conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Because of environmental concerns, it is extremely important that we all take every precaution to
reduce or eliminate the release of CFC refrigerant (R12) into the air.
Recycling Equipment In Your Dealership
If your dealership has not already received one, you will receive a Kent-Moore ACR(3) J- 38100-NI
Refrigerant Recovery and Recycling System within the next few days. This machine will recover
the refrigerant from any vehicle you service, clean the refrigerant, remove all moisture and oil, and
place the refrigerant into a 30 lb. container for re-use. To save our atmosphere, you must use the
machine every time you perform A/C service that requires a purge of the refrigerant.
Maintenance Is Essential
If the recycling equipment is maintained properly, it can clean and purify the removed refrigerant so
that it will exceed the SAE standards for content of moisture, oil, air and noncondensibles. Like any
equipment, however, this machine will operate at its best efficiency only if it is maintained properly.
This means you must check the moisture indicator often and replace the filter drier core whenever
necessary. You must make sure the correct manifold gauge and hoses are used in all cases, and
that the valves in the hoses are working properly. Make sure the unit stays clean and that the
hoses are always hung up away from contamination when the unit is not in use.
Destruction of the Earth's Ozone Layer
Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Top Of Transaxle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1663
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 2600
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Switch
This switch, used on some models, is attached on the left side of the instrument panel in the
driver's compartment. This switch consists of a bellows and a microswitch. The switch transmits an
``On'' or ``Off'' signal to the control unit according to change in atmospheric pressure. When the
atmospheric pressure drops below 26 in. Hg, an ``On'' signal is transmitted to decrease fuel by 6%.
Page 791
All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.011 in
Exhaust 0.011 in
Page 986
Comments regarding leak detector use:
^ Existing R-12 leak detectors currently will not detect R-134a.
^ Many R-134a leak detectors will detect R-12; check with the equipment manufacturer.
^ Always refer to and follow the equipment manufacturers recommendations when operating leak
detectors.
Comments regarding weight scale use:
^ If the scale allows electronic control of the flow of refrigerant through the scale, (i.e. internal
solenoid valves) be certain that the hose fitting size is 1/2"-16 ACME, and that no refrigerant other
than R-134a (along with only specified lubricant) have been used with the scale.
Charging Cylinder
^ The use of a charging cylinder is not recommended because:
^ The refrigerant may be vented into the air from the top valve of cylinder when filling the cylinder
with refrigerant.
^ The accuracy of a charging cylinder is generally less than that of an electronic scale or of quality
recycle/recharge equipment.
Service Procedures
^ The service procedures for R-134a A/C systems are basically the same as for R-12 A/C systems,
however, the following should always be kept in mind:
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose, and
throat. Use only approved recovery/recycling equipment to discharge R-134a systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service work.
^ R-134a and R-12 A/C components are not interchangeable. Cleaning of used (in service)
components for use with another type of refrigerant and/or lubricant is not an acceptable practice,
and may result in A/C system failure.
^ Always use the proper PAG oil when servicing an R-134a A/C system. The Nissan part number
for the appropriate PAG compressor oil can be found on the A/C specification label in the engine
compartment, and also in the Factory Service Manual, and on the label on the compressor. These
oils are only available from your Nissan Parts Department.
^ When leak checking an R-134a system, be certain that you are using a detector which will detect
R-134a.
^ As mentioned previously in this bulletin, the R-134a PAG lubricants absorb moisture; PAG oil
containers and A/C components containing PAG oil must remain tightly sealed until ready for use.
^ Unlike R-12 systems, R-134a systems do not exhibit a "clear sight glass", even when properly
charged. For this reason, the R-134a A/C systems have no sight glass.
^ With R-134a systems it is important to properly control the amount of refrigerant charged into the
system during system charging. A charging machine or weight scale must always be used during
charging for proper charge determination.
^ Questions regarding R-12 or R-134a should be addressed to your Regional Service Staff or the
FIXS Hotline.
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 5221
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Repairs of environmental contamination discovered and reported at the time of vehicle delivery to
the dealership can be claimed utilizing procedures outlined in Warranty Bulletin WB92-003 dated
January 24, 1992.
Outline of Procedures
A. Wash with detergent such as (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), then dry.
B. Identify the type of contamination using fluorescent lights and magnification. If paint over-spray
is found, a specialized repair process is needed.
If paint contamination other than paint over spray is suspected, test a 2' x 2' section on each
affected panel as follows to determine the severity of damage and repair effort needed:
C. Re-wash several times to remove detergent and water soluble spots. If spots are removed,
wash affected panels.
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover for solvent soluble spots. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
E. To remove iron particles and acid rain residue, use Finish Kare # 1119 followed by # 883 (apply
# 883 several times if necessary) and always neutralize with # 118SC.
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 696
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 1328
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Poly-Groove Belt - Tension Inspection
Classification: Section:
GI89-008 General Information
Reference: SERVICE ADVISORY TS89-077 Models:
All models Date:
May 18, 1989
When installing a new poly-groove belt or replacing a used one, use the following procedure.
1. Install the belt and set the belt tension.
2. Start the engine and run it for approximately 30 seconds. Switch the engine off.
3. Check the belt tension and reset as needed.
Locations
Engine Compartment Component Locations
Page 2604
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 2480
Inspection Procedure
Page 5315
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3350
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1160
^ Any tools, equipment cones, or other wheel balancing equipment items should not touch the
outside surface of chrome type wheels.
Wheel Alignment:
^ Alignment sensors with metal mounting hooks should not be used on chrome type wheels.
^ Some alignment equipment manufacturers may have protective rubber pads available that can be
used to cover the metal mounting hooks.
Page 727
Wheels/Tires - Accessory Wheel Lock
Installation/Removal
Wheel Fastener: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Accessory Wheel Lock
Installation/Removal
Classification: WT09-002
Reference: NTB09-056
Date: July 14, 2009
ACCESSORY WHEEL LOCKS INSTALLATION AND REMOVAL
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Always use hand tools when installing or removing accessory wheel lock nuts.
WARNING:
Do not use power tools to install or remove accessory wheel lock nuts.
Use of an impact wrench or other power tool may cause permanent damage to the wheel lock nut
and/or key.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Accessory wheel locks, wheel lock keys, or vehicle wheels that are damaged due to improper
installation or removal will not be considered a manufacturer defect and will not be covered under
warranty.
Accessory Wheel Lock Installation / Removal Guidelines
^ For ease of removal, the wheel lock nut should always be the first lug nut removed.
^ If needed, clean threads on lug studs with a wire brush.
^ The wheel lock nut should always be the last lug nut tightened.
^ Always use the special key supplied in the wheel lock set to install and remove the wheel locks.
^ Always tighten the wheel lock nuts using a hand torque wrench to the torque specification in the
Service Manual.
Disclaimer
A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Classification: HA93-014
Reference: NTB93-132
Date: September 12, 1993
WHITE FLAKES FROM VENTS
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Sentra (B13) and Altima (U13)
APPLIED DATE(S): Sentra built before 7/29/93 Altima built before 7/29/93
SERVICE INFORMATION Some air conditioning units may exhibit white flakes blowing from the
vents for a short time when the air conditioning is first turned on. The flakes are 1 mm or less in
diameter and fall on interior surfaces like a light snow. This incident can be resolved by replacing
the evaporator with an improved unit according to the procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the appropriate Service Manual instructions to replace the evaporator with the countermeasure
unit listed on the following page (there is no new part number -- check for the proper date stamp
indicated in the Parts Information section). When installing the new evaporator into the vehicle,
make sure that the evaporator case drain tube is correctly aligned to the drain hose and that there
are no obstructions.
NOTE:
To minimize the flakes remaining in the heater and air conditioning system, vacuum or blow out
with compressed air any visible flakes in the heater assembly before reinstalling the new
evaporator assembly. Warm soapy water may be used to clean the inside of the evaporator case,
heater case, and all ductwork.
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 1720
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
Page 4342
FIGURE 6
14. Remove the center exhaust tube (Figure 6).
15. Remove the plastic finisher from the steering gear access hole at the left wheel well.
FIGURE 7
16. Remove the shift linkage from the transaxle.
17. Position the jack under the transaxle (Figure 7).
18. Remove the 3 body side bolts on the transfer case rear mount. Slowly lower the jack 3 inches.
NOTE: Be careful not to lower unit more than 3 inches. This may over-stretch electrical harnesses
and cooling hoses.
19. Remove the remaining steering gear support clamp bolts.
20. Slide the gear out through the access hole at the left wheel well.
FIGURE 8
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE:
1. Adjust "L" dimension on both tie rods. Tie rod "L" length is 175.9 mm (6.9 in) (Figure 8).
2. Slide rack into place as it was removed. Be careful not to bend lines or damage boots. Place
right and left steering gear clamps on rack before moving into final position.
3. Hand tighten the 2 bolts on the right steering gear clamp.
Locations
Power Transistor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 471
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Page 3038
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1546
All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
Testing and Inspection
Thermal Vacuum Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 54 Thermal vacuum valve test
1. Drain a portion of engine coolant, then remove thermal vacuum valve from engine.
2. Inhale air from air cleaner side port, Fig. 54. Ensure valve opens at temperatures between 59°F
and 140°F and is closed at all other temperatures. Do not allow water to get inside valve.
Page 3839
When probing a connector it is possible to enlarge the contact spring opening. Refer to figure. If
this occurs it may create an intermittent signal in the circuit. When probing a connector, use care
not to enlarge the opening. If the probe of the Digital Multimeter (DMM) you are using will not fit into
the connector cavity, you can back probe the connector with a "T" pin to create an extension. Most
DMM's have accessory alligator clips which slide over the probe to allow clipping the "T" pin for a
better contact. Refer to figure. If you have any difficulty probing a terminal, inspect the terminal to
ensure you have not accidentally opened the contact spring or pulled a wire loose.
Behind The Instrument Panel
Page 3011
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Classification: WT06-002
Reference: NTB06-076
Date: November 7, 2006
PRECAUTIONS FOR HANDLING CHROME TYPE WHEELS
APPLIED VEHICLE: All Nissan vehicles with chrome type wheels
SERVICE INFORMATION
The appearance of chrome type wheels can be damaged if they are not handled correctly during
wheel and tire service.
Tire Changing:
^ Make sure to use tire changing equipment that clamps (secures) the wheel from the inside
(internal jaws).
^ Do not use any metal tools that may touch the outside of the wheel.
^ Tools and machine equipment that touch the outside of the rim should be made of plastic, or
have rubber/plastic protective covers.
Wheel Balancing:
Description and Operation
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation
This system is designed to reduce oil consumption when intake manifold vacuum increases to an
extremely high level during deceleration. This system consists of a boost control unit which acts as
a vacuum manifold sensor and a bypass control unit which acts as an activator. The boost control
unit senses manifold vacuum and when the level of manifold vacuum increases above preset
value, the boost control valve opens and transmits the manifold vacuum to the air bypass control
unit. The manifold vacuum then pulls the diaphragm and opens the bypass air control valve,
causing the air to be bypassed to the intake manifold, lowering manifold vacuum. This results in
closing of the boost control valve and then closing of the air control valve. This system operates in
a tightly controlled circuit so that manifold vacuum can be kept very close to the preset value during
deceleration.
Page 548
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 698
M/T - F30A/F31A Fluid Leaks
Case: All Technical Service Bulletins M/T - F30A/F31A Fluid Leaks
Classification: Section:
MT90-001 Manual Transaxle
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-024 Models:
1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: March 15, 1990
F30A & F31A MANUAL TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra (B12) 1987-1990 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The F30A/F31A manual transaxles used on the Applied Models listed above (check the appropriate
model Service Manual for manual transaxle application) may exhibit transmission oil leakage
between the clutch housing and the transaxle case due to insufficient case bolt torque.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
To improve the sealing performance at this area, a higher grade bolt is now used in production, and
the housing bolt tightening torque has been increased.
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated area, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the transaxle case halves, thoroughly clean and inspect the mating surfaces
for porosities, surface damage, etc. Apply sealant to the mating surfaces, then install the new bolts,
being certain to apply additional sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque as
indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
indicated area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Page 2063
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 978
Page 410
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1502
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1254
Tune-Up Kit Contents
This kit provides three, 12 ounce plastic bottles and related fittings to replace the existing 7 ounce
bottles. These bottles will accommodate the proper lubricant charge when retrofitting from R-12 to
R-134a refrigerant systems.
PARTS INFORMATION
DESCRIPTION KENT-MOORE PART #
Variable Timing Control (VTC) Sprocket Rebuild Kit J41471
A/C Leak Detector Tune-up Kit J39400-Tune up
ACR4 Lubricant Injection Bottle Conversion Kit J39500-71N
Page 3986
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 1324
DRIVE BELT / PULLEY NOISE DIAGNOSIS FLOW CHART
Transverse Link & Radius Rod
Radius Arm: Service and Repair Transverse Link & Radius Rod
Fig. 25 Rear suspension. 4WD Sentra
4WD SENTRA
Page 737
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Classification: EL88-008 Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-094
Models: 1987-88 Sentra/Pulsar
Date: July 11, 1988
SPEEDOMETER CABLE NOISE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra, 1987-88 Pulsar except 1988 Pulsar SE
APPLIED VINs: JAPAN BUILT SENTRA Before JN1PB22SXJU 028662
04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB24SXJU 044462 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB22SXJU 574774 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB21SXJU 555932 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB26SXJU 016707 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25SXJU 021285 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25YXJU 005931 04/01/88 production
U.S. BUILT SENTRA 1987 1988
All
PULSAR Before JN1PN34SXJM 500050
05/01/88 production
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987-88 Sentra and Pulsar vehicles may exhibit a rattle or buzzing noise from the center of
the instrument panel at engine speeds of 2500-3500 RPM.
If a customer complains of this type of noise, perform the following diagnostics to determine if the
speedometer cable is the cause.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to verify speedometer cable noise:
1. Start engine with transmission in neutral (M/T) or park (A/T). Raise RPM to 3500 and hold for
5-10 seconds.
2. Listen for rattling or buzzing from the speedometer head area.
3. Return engine to idle and turn off ignition.
4. Disconnect speedometer cable from transaxle and let hang. Be sure to position the cable so that
it isn't touching the engine or transaxle.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3.
If the noise can be heard in Step 2, but is not present during Step 5, replace the speedometer
cable assembly with the improved (insulated) cable assembly listed below. If the noise is still
present, reinstall the speedometer cable and contact the FIXS Hotline for additional information.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART DESCRIPTION NEW PART NUMBER FORMER PART NUMBER
Speedometer 25050-01Y00 25050-60A01
Cable Assembly 25050-60A00
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5199
DOOR MIRROR REPLACEMENT GLASS
Page 4119
NOTE:
^ The BSC is equipped with a scanner that can be used to scan the VIN on most vehicles.
^ Scanning the VIN will give the tester the [CCA rating] information for original equipment batteries.
^ For replacement batteries, the [CCA rating] from the battery label must be entered into the BSC
manually.
For Nissan Original Equipment Batteries:
^ When using the BSC, make sure the correct vehicle [CCA rating] is entered by scanning the VIN,
or entering it manually from the battery label.
NOTE:
If the VIN cannot be scanned, enter it manually.
^ Make sure to select "ORG EQUIPMENT" on the tester.
^ The [CCA RATING] entered during testing is recorded in the 12-character test output code
required for warranty repairs.
^ Claims that are submitted with incorrect [CCA RATING] may be suspended or denied.
Genuine Nissan Replacement Batteries (service part replacements for Nissan Original Equipment
Batteries):
^ Scan the VIN, select "GEN REPLACEMENT", then Manually enter the CCA rating from the
battery label into the BSC.
NOTE:
If the VIN cannot be scanned, enter it manually.
IMPORTANT:
When using the BSC, you will get inaccurate test results if you don't enter the correct [CCA
RATING]
^ The [CCA RATING] entered during testing is recorded in the 12-character test output code
required for warranty repairs.
^ Claims that are submitted with incorrect [CCA RATING] may be suspended or denied.
Disclaimer
Page 1998
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Page 4178
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4799
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Identification
Classification: HA95-017
Reference: NTB95-106
Date: October 18, 1995
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) LUBRICANT/OIL FOR NISSAN VEHICLES
This bulletin supersedes HA94-001. (94-013, 02/01/94)
APPLIED VEHICLES: All equipped with A/C
SERVICE INFORMATION
Nissan has four different A/C lubricant/oil products available. Different systems will require different
types of lubricants/oils. All R134a equipped vehicles have a label under the hood that specifies the
type of lubricant required for the system on that vehicle. A description of the type of compressor
and lubricant/oil required is also listed in the Service Data and Specifications at the end of the HA
section in the appropriate service manual. During A/C servicing, if lubricant/oil needs to be added
to the system, please refer to the list of PAG (poly alkaline glycol) lubricants and refrigerant oils
listed in this bulletin.
NOTE:
Quest vehicles produced on or after November 29, 1993 with R134a refrigerant, will require a
special compressor lubricant. The recommended compressor lubricant for this vehicle only is: Type
F-R134a PAG lubricant, part number KLH00-PAGQF.
Page 1990
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3367
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1288
Engine Block Heater: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Block Heater Precaution
Models: All Models
Section: Engine Mechanical
Classification: EM88-004
Bulletin No.: TS88-025
Date: February 22, 1988
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER
APPLIED MODELS: All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Engine antifreeze in more than 50% concentration has been found to adversely affect the life and
performance of the engine block heater. High phosphate content in the antifreeze forms a scale
around the heating element of the block heater, causing the temperature to rise, with subsequent
failure of the seals. Therefore, for best results it is recommended that you use a concentration no
greater than 50% antifreeze and 50% water.
Air Injection Valve
Air Induction Valve: Testing and Inspection Air Injection Valve
1. Disconnect air injection hose from injection pipe side of valve.
2. Apply vacuum to air injection control valve using a suitable hand vacuum pump and ensure air
flows only on injection pipe side while control valve is operated.
Page 2132
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4005
Fig. 5 AD18B type front disc brake disassembled
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Page 4226
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications Harmonic Balancer
Harmonic Balancer
Vibration Damper Or Pulley 87 ft.lb
Page 1884
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 4619
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Air Control
1. Set air control lever at DEF position.
2. Move link lever toward passenger compartment.
3. Connect air control cable to link lever and clamp the cable.
4. Move floor door lever toward passenger compartment.
5. Connect floor door control rod to floor door lever.
6. Ensure that knob moves smoothly.
Page 3558
- Adjust throttle wire stroke when throttle wire/accelerator wire is installed or after carburetor has
been adjusted.
- Put marks on throttle wire to facilitate measuring wire stroke.
If throttle wire stroke is improperly adjusted, the following problems may arise. When full-open position "P1" of throttle drum is closer to direction "T", shift schedule will be as
shown by (2) in figure above, and kickdown range will greatly increase.
- When full-open position "P1" of throttle drum is closer to direction "U", shift schedule will be as
shown by (1) in figure above, and kickdown range will not occur.
5. After properly adjusting throttle wire, ensure the parting line is as straight as possible.
Page 2526
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 4974
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Page 5262
Reference: TS87-145
Date: September 28, 1987
PAINT SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Paint spotting incidents occurring in the U.S. market are not unique to Nissan, but are being
experienced by all manufacturers. To date, two separate types of paint spotting incidents have
been identified as follows:
1. Particulate Fallout - Tiny solid particles which collect on horizontal panels, causing a dark stain
which will penetrate into the paint if not cleaned.
2. Water Spotting - A ringlet or multiple water-drop-shaped light discoloration on dark painted
horizontal panels.
THESE TYPES OF SPOTTING ARE NOT DUE TO PAINT DEFICIENCY, AND CAN BE
PREVENTED THROUGH PROPER CARE.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Particulate Fallout
Ash, dust, soot and other tiny solid particulate matter from industrial and other sources can be
carried many miles. Particulate fallout is most noticeable on the horizontal surfaces (hood, luggage
compartment lid, and roof) of the vehicle.
If left on a moist, painted surface, the particles will slowly dissolve and bond to the paint, frequently
leaving a red stain. This stain can be present even on plastic surfaces such as bumpers if the
fallout has an iron content. These spots may be visible on both solid and metallic paints (especially
light colors). The particulate can be felt as a sharp point on the paint surface. When viewed through
a magnifying lens, the staining may be evident.
VEHICLE CARE
Every 10 days, or more frequently depending upon local conditions, particulate fallout must be
washed off with mild detergent and water to prevent its bonding and staining action. A good
carnuba wax coating can help protect against damage from particulate fallout.
PARTICULATE FALLOUT REPAIR PROCEDURE
In most cases, thoroughly washing the affected area with a water and mild detergent solution (to
avoid scratching the finish with dislodged particles) will remove the particulates.
After washing the vehicle, a stain, generally orange or red, may still be visible on white or other
light colored vehicles. This stain can be removed with a fine compound material. DO NOT APPLY
THE COMPOUNDING MATERIAL BEFORE ALL PARTICLES IN THE AFFECTED AREA ARE
REMOVED BY THOROUGH WASHING.
Water Spotting
A photograph of typical water spotting is shown on page 26 of the Nissan Paint Refinishing Guide*
(PIN 5REFGD). The spots are most visible when viewed at an angle, usually under fluorescent
light. The paint surface is usually smooth to the touch because the spotting is a change in the top
surface itself. This is not hard-water residue which will wash off with soap and water. These spots
are visible on both solid and metallic paints with dark colors.
VEHICLE CARE
When a vehicle is stored outside and unprotected, dust patterns develop on the painted surfaces.
These patterns guide moisture droplets from a light rain or morning dew to the same location each
time. The strong sunlight, repeatedly concentrated on these water droplets, greatly contributes to
the spotting. When storing a vehicle unprotected, where the painted surface is repeatedly exposed
to a combination of sunlight and light rain (or morning dew), the vehicle MUST be washed AND
thoroughly dried at least every two weeks, or more frequently if there is light rain or dew followed
by strong sunlight.
When washing any vehicle, it must be out of direct sunlight and the painted surfaces should be cool
to the touch.
WATER SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
The method of repairing a water spotted finish varies with the severity (depth of spot in finish) of the
spotting. After a thorough washing, perform the
Page 3907
Brake Pad: Specifications
Pad Minimum Thickness 0.079 in
Page 4776
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant (R12) Recycling
Models: All Models
Section: Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification: HA90-003
Bulletin No.: NTB90-016
Date: February 15, 1990
REFRIGERANT (R12) RECYCLING
APPLIED MODEL: All models equipped with air conditioning
SERVICE INFORMATION:
It has been established and documented that when the Chlorofluorocarbon refrigerant (R-12) most
commonly used in automotive air conditioning systems is released into the air, it works its way
upward and, by chemical reaction, eventually results in the destruction of the "ozone layer" in the
earth's upper atmosphere. Ozone, a special form of oxygen, protects the surface of the earth by
reflecting powerful ultra violet radiation from the sun back into space. Among other dangers, ultra
violet radiation causes skin cancer and eye cataracts in humans and it causes damage and
decreased production in food crops.
In order to prevent further damage to the earth's ozone, the U.S. government joined a group of
nations in signing the Montreal protocol to reduce and eventually halt all production of
chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) over the next few years.
Nissan supports all efforts to avoid release of these hazardous materials into the environment. As
part of this effort, A/C systems are being re-designed to use less refrigerant. The next step is to
design systems that will use an alternate, non-damaging refrigerant.
In the interim, it is imperative that the release of R-12 into the air be slowed and stopped as soon
as possible. During the period February 19 to March 9, 1990, a refrigerant recycling unit will be
shipped to your dealership from Kent-Moore Tool Co. as a mandatory special tool. This machine
will remove the refrigerant from any vehicle whose A/C system you service or dismantle for scrap,
recycle the refrigerant by removing all moisture and contaminants, and place it into a safe container
for re-use.
Until that recycling equipment arrives and is put to use in your dealership, here are some things
you can do to decrease the amount of R-12 that you release into the environment:
1. Make sure your A/C service tools are in good working order, especially your leak detector and
the vacuum pump you use for evacuating any A/C system you install or service.
2. Evacuate only once. Do not evacuate, charge, and then evacuate again before installing the final
charge of refrigerant. Any extra evacuation allows excess refrigerant to spill into the atmosphere.
3. Wherever possible, do not use one-pound cans of refrigerant. Each time you change cans during
a recharge, some refrigerant is lost to the atmosphere. Therefore, it is better to charge from a
larger container (e.g., 30 lb.) and charge all at once instead of changing containers during the
process.
4. When installing A/C kits or when repairing an in-service air conditioning system, use care and
proper installation techniques to avoid introducing potential leaks into the system. This includes
using a small amount of clean refrigerant oil to lubricate the tube and hose O-rings, using the
correct torque wrench and backup wrench for tube and hose connections, and applying the correct
torque specifications.
5. When repairing an in-service A/C system, always use new O-rings when re-assembling the
connections. Your Nissan A/C Component Service Kit (p/n 999A1-A6000) contains O-rings for all
popular Nissan air conditioners, as well as a detailed diagram of which O-ring to use at each
connection.
6. Before charging any system with refrigerant, perform a "vacuum leak check." This procedure is
described in your factory Service Manual under the heading "Checking Airtightness."
Page 3585
4. Use hose clamps and temporarily connect a length of suitable hose between the bypass valve
fittings that go to the oil cooler (see Figure 6).
5. Pinch/clamp the temporary hose to prevent flow through the loop (see Figure 6).
6. Cover the end of the bypass inlet line with a shop rag to catch any oil spray.
7. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) into the outlet for 10 second
intervals, three times (see Figure 6).
8. Re-connect the transmission lines and remove the temporary hose loop (see Figure 7).
9. Go to Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles).
1996-98 Pathfinder (R50) Cleaning the Optional Air Cooled Oil-Cooler (Air Cooler)
1. Place an oil drain pan under the A/T air cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses (see Points A and B,
Figure 8).
2. Disconnect the Inlet and Outlet hoses from the air cooler (see Points A and B, Figure 8).
3. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-AM006) into the air cooler Outlet hose (see Point B, Figure 8).
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath the vapors or the spray mist.
Page 4296
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
4. Make sure the "turn plates" and "slide" plates are in good working order:
^ The surface of the front turn plates must be level with (the same height as) the rack surface.
If height is not the same; have the equipment repaired before performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the front turn plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide and turn) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the turn plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other Precautions
Catalytic Converter: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Service and Repair
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove ashtray with bracket.
3. Remove radio attaching bolts, then the radio control knobs and trim panel.
4. Disconnect electrical connectors from radio, then remove radio from vehicle.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 1579
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 400
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2440
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 775
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 5137
2. Grind the surface of the repair with 36 grit disc. Grind about 1-1/2" around the actual damage to
obtain a taper for best adhesion.
3. Featheredge the paint around the repair with 180 grit disc. Wipe with a clean, dry rag and blow
off with air.
4. Mix Flexible Parts Repair Material according to the instructions and apply to the repair with a
squeegee, building it up higher than the undamaged area. Allow it to cure for 20-30 minutes at
60-80~F.
5. After curing, sand with 180 grit disc followed by 240 grit disc.
6. Fill sand scratches and pinholes with Flexible Parts Putty. Allow at least 15 minutes to dry then
sand with 320 grit disc.
Tools - Essential Tool Release, Engine, A/C
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Essential Tool Release, Engine, A/C
Classification: T&E95-03;
Reference: NTB95-030
Date: March 22, 1995
ESSENTIAL TOOL RELEASE
SERVICE INFORMATION
During the week of February 6, 1995, all Nissan dealers were sent the following special tools as
part of the Essential Service Tool Program.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. J41471 Variable Timing Control (VTC) Sprocket Rebuild Kit. This kit provides the necessary
tools to rebuild the VTC intake camshaft sprockets on the VE30DE engine. The initial shipment of
this tool has been provided to all Nissan dealers at no charge. Additional kits can be purchased
through the Tech-Mate Service Equipment and Special Tools program by calling 800-NMC-2001.
Refer to Technical Bulletin NTB95-022 for proper usage of these tools.
2. J39400-A/C Leak Detector Tune-up Kit. This kit provides all the items necessary to perform
preventive maintenance on the J39400 A/C Leak Detector.
J 39400-TUNEUP Leak Detector Kit
Page 1499
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Page 3649
Fig. 12 Rear axle replacement. 4WD Sentra
4WD SENTRA
Refer to Fig. 12 for replacement, noting the following:
1. When raising and supporting vehicle, do not jack up at transverse links.
2. Disconnect brake hydraulic line and parking brake cable at equalizer.
3. Remove exhaust pipe and muffler attaching bolts.
4. Remove upper shock absorber attaching bolts.
Mirrors - Installation of Glass On Door Mirror
Mirrors: Technical Service Bulletins Mirrors - Installation of Glass On Door Mirror
Classification: Section:
BF88-012 Body & Frame
Reference TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-101 Models: All Date: August 15, 1988 INSTALLATION
OF GLASS ON DOOR MIRROR
APPLIED MODELS: All, except D21
SERVICE INFORMATION
To improve serviceability, a glass replacement is now available when replacing broken glass on the
door mirrors. Use the following installation procedure.
PRECAUTIONS: ^
Take care when removing the glass.
^ Do not use excessive force.
^ Because of the difference between left and right mirrors, ensure that the proper replacement is
used.
^ Prepare 700 - 1,OOOW heat gun.
Removal
^ Warm up lip of glass base with heat gun.
^ Remove glass from glass base with scraper.
Installation
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1685
Page 2104
Page 4671
Fan Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove A/C-heater control as outlined in ``Control
Assembly, Replace.''
2. Remove screws securing switch to control and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install and adjust control.
Page 1465
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4247
Page 5275
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Repairs of environmental contamination discovered and reported at the time of vehicle delivery to
the dealership can be claimed utilizing procedures outlined in Warranty Bulletin WB92-003 dated
January 24, 1992.
Outline of Procedures
A. Wash with detergent such as (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), then dry.
B. Identify the type of contamination using fluorescent lights and magnification. If paint over-spray
is found, a specialized repair process is needed.
If paint contamination other than paint over spray is suspected, test a 2' x 2' section on each
affected panel as follows to determine the severity of damage and repair effort needed:
C. Re-wash several times to remove detergent and water soluble spots. If spots are removed,
wash affected panels.
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover for solvent soluble spots. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
E. To remove iron particles and acid rain residue, use Finish Kare # 1119 followed by # 883 (apply
# 883 several times if necessary) and always neutralize with # 118SC.
Page 2548
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-009 Date: 100119
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Classification: EM09-015
Reference: NTB10-009
Date: January 19, 2010
REMOVAL PROCEDURE FOR SEIZED EXHAUST SENSOR
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
If an exhaust sensor is seized in the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube, perform the procedure
described in this bulletin to remove the sensor and prevent unnecessary replacement of the
exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
In most cases this procedure is successful. This is because the threads of the exhaust sensors are
made of a softer material than the part they thread into on the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
NOTE:
The replacement of exhaust manifolds/catalysts/front tubes for stripped exhaust sensor threads
may not be considered a warrantable expense.
This procedure can be performed by two methods:
Method #1 - If the Sensor Can Be Easily Accessed
^ The procedure can be performed on the vehicle.
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube will not have to be removed.
Method #2 - If the Sensor Cannot Be Easily Accessed
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube must be removed from the vehicle.
^ The procedure will be performed with the part clamped in a vice.
Method #2 is described in this bulletin. Method #1 is the same as Method #2 except that it is
performed on the vehicle.
Service Procedure
Rust Penetrant
Recommended rust penetrants to be used in this procedure:
Page 1011
which will result in contamination, and damage to recovery/recycle equipment.
^ Use equipment designed to meet Society of Automotive engineers (SAE) standards, which
specify R-134a service equipment fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME), and service hose identification
(black stripe on hose).
^ Adapters to convert from one size fitting to the other must never be used; refrigerant/lubricant
contamination will occur and system failure may result.
^ The use of incorrect equipment will result in refrigerant and/or lubricant contamination, which may
cause A/C system or equipment failure.
^ ACR(4) machine will perform all required service functions (recovery, evacuation, recycle,
recharge).
^ High volume A/C service facilities may benefit from "component" A/C service equipment (vacuum
pump, weight scale, manifold gauge set) to supplement the ACR(4).
Comments regarding recovery/recycling equipment:
^ Be certain to follow the manufacturer's instructions for machine operation and machine
maintenance.
^ Never introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.
^ Only R-134a containers with a 1/2"-16 ACME can be used to add R-134a to the ACR4
recovery/recycle machine.
^ Periodic maintenance of this equipment is required; follow the manufacturer's recommendations
as described in the equipment instruction manual.
Page 2270
Cranking Signal: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Wiring Diagram
Page 2940
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 5326
1. Remove rear seat.
2. Remove rear shock absorber caps and wheelhouse finishers. It is recommended that the shock
absorber caps are replaced with retro-fit caps listed in the parts information section.
3. Remove rear pillar finishers.
4. Locate the drilling point which is factory pre-scribed in the rear pillar finishers.
5. Using a 1" hole saw, drill the finisher at the marked location.
6. Remove original lap belts (female buckle side).
7. Install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit. Torque mounting bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
8. Remove the retracting side of the original lap belts.
9. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed in two steps. First, install the retractor unit
end of the shoulder harness. Then place the wheelhouse finisher and retro-fit shock absorber cap
into position. Bolt the shoulder anchor into the rear side panel where the 1" hole was drilled.
NOTE: Anchor/mounting bolt torque is 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
10. Fully tighten the wheelhouse panel finishers.
11. Check the retro-fit lap belts for smooth operation.
12. Reinstall rear seat.
Pulsar
Page 4891
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Page 468
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Page 1002
Comments regarding PAG refrigerant oils:
^ PAG oil absorbs moisture from the air at an exceptionally fast rate, and moisture can damage the
A/C system.
Service and Repair
Heater Core: Service and Repair
Fig. 12 Exploded view of instrument panel. 1987-88 Sentra
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect heater hose at firewall connections of heater core.
3. Remove instrument panel, Fig. 12.
Page 636
SPECIAL TOOLS
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 296
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 5138
7. Apply a double wet coat of Flexible Parts Coating. After a 10 minute flash time, apply a second
double coat. Let dry 45 minutes and lightly scuff sand the coating with 320 grit disc. Apply color
coats recommended for plastic body parts.
Page 2538
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Page 685
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 584
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Page 3353
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Testing and Inspection
Thermal Vacuum Valve - EVAP: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 21 Thermal vacuum valve operating specifications
Fig. 62 Thermal vacuum valve operating specifications.
1. Drain coolant from engine, then remove valve.
2. Apply vacuum to valve and make sure valve opens or closes in response to engine coolant
temperature as specified, Fig. 21 & 62. Do not allow water to get inside thermal vacuum valve.
Page 1538
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1590
Ignition Rotor: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Rotor
1. Remove the screws securing the distributor cap to the distributor.
2. Confirm that the rotor does not turn on the distributor shaft.
3. Remove the rotor.
4. Visually check the rotor for signs of "Burn Through" from the electrode to the distributor shaft.
5. Check the input (center) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
6. Check the output (outer) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
7. Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between the input (center) electrode and the output
(outer) electrode. Replace the rotor if it fails the above tests.
Page 5426
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
The stop light switch is located on the brake pedal support.
1. Disconnect the switch electrical connectors.
2. Loosen switch retaining locknut and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 642
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 972
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-001 Date: 920101
A/C - System Changes As Result of R-134A Refrigerant
Classification: HA92-OO1
Reference: NTB92-OO1
Date: January 1992
A/C SYSTEM CHANGES FOR R-134A REFRIGERANT
(ALL MODELS)
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Service Information
Introduction
Due to its harmful effect on the ozone layer, R-12 is being phased out and replaced by R-134a,
which does not harm the ozone layer. While the R-134a A/C system is very similar to an R-12 A/C
system, the differences in the refrigerant, lubricants, and service equipment are important.
Nissan A/C systems will change from R-12 to R-134a at the time of new vehicle (full model change)
introduction, or in some cases by model year update to an existing model line.
This bulletin describes all of the general differences between the R-12 and R-134a systems. For
details of an R-134a system for a specific model, refer to that model's service manual or new
product information.
Refrigerant Handling Precautions
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur.
^ Use only specified lubricant for the R-134a A/C system and R-134a components. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure is likely to occur.
^ The specified R-134a lubricant absorbs moisture from the atmosphere at a rapid rate, therefore
the following handling precautions must be observed:
^ When removing refrigerant components from a vehicle, immediately cap (seal) the component to
minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere.
^ When installing refrigerant components to a vehicle, do not remove the caps (unseal) until just
before connecting the components. Also, complete the connection of all refrigerant tubes and
hoses without delay to minimize the entry of moisture into the system.
^ Use the specified lubricant from a sealed container only. Containers must be re-sealed
immediately after dispensing the lubricant. Lubricant in containers which are not properly sealed
will become moisture saturated. Such lubricant is no longer suitable for use and should be properly
disposed.
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and
throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting SAE standards to discharge R-134a
Systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service.
^ Always wear eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or
air conditioning system.
^ Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 125° (52°C).
^ Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame; if container warming is required, place the
bottom of the container in a pail of warm water.
^ Do not intentionally drop, puncture, or incinerate refrigerant containers.
^ Keep refrigerant away from open flames: hazardous gas will be produced if refrigerant burns.
^ Refrigerant will displace oxygen, therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent
suffocation.
Page 3372
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 5346
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Page 1519
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3309
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5049
Diagnostic Procedure # 1
SYMPTOM: No response from remote control
NOTE!
The remote controls that are supplied with the system are pre-programmed to the control unit. If the
control unit or a remote control is replaced, the remote controls will need to be programmed to the
control unit. The control unit can be programmed to receive up to four remote controls. However,
when a remote control is programmed it may be necessary to program all remote controls that are
to be used with the system. Refer to "SYSTEM DESCRIPTION" for programming instructions.
APPLICABLE BATTERIES:
Eveready ECR-2032-BP Duracell DL-2032 Panasonic R-2032 Neda 5004-LC Or equivalent
CR2032 Type Battery
Diagnostic Procedure # 2
Page 2544
Digital signals are ON-OFF (Hi-Low) voltage pulses. This signal is a typical digital signal.
Examples of common digital signals are:
Battery Voltage The ignition switch in the ACC or ON position provides a battery voltage signal to
several control units. This informs the control unit of the ignition position.
Switch to Ground A door switch is a common example of a switch to ground. When the door is
opened the door switch completes the circuit. The interior light is turned on. In addition, the time
control unit is sent an OFF signal indicating the door is open.
Pulse Voltage A pulse voltage is made up of alternating high and low voltage signals of varying
duration. These signals are counted by the control unit within a predetermined time frame.
Analog Input Signals
An analog signal is a voltage that varies over a period of time. Analog signals are produced by
sensors in the vehicle. Sensors change resistance to deliver variable voltage signals. The Oxygen
Sensor sine wave signals shown are typical analog signals. These charts are example signals
printed using CONSULT.
^ The first chart shows an Oxygen Sensor lean (low voltage) condition.
^ The second chart is a normal Oxygen Sensor voltage printout.
^ The third chart illustrates an Oxygen Sensor rich (high voltage) condition.
Examples of common sensors are:
Temperature Sensors Temperature sensors change resistance with a change in temperature. This
temperature is converted into an analog voltage range.
Page 1482
Description and Operation
Auxiliary Air Valve (Idle Speed): Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Air regulator
The air regulator, Fig. 20, bypasses the throttle valve to control the quantity of air for increasing the
engine idling speed when starting the engine at an underhood temperature of below 176°F. A
bi-metal and a heater are incorporated into the air regulator. When the ignition switch is turned to
the ``Start'' position or when the engine is running, electric current flows through the heater, and
the bi-metal, as it is heated by the heater, begins to move and closes the air passage in a few
minutes. The air passage remains closed until the engine is stopped and the underhood air
temperature drops below 176°F.
Page 4739
Evaporator Core: Testing and Inspection
A faulty evaporator will provide insufficient cooling to the vehicle. The core may be restricted with
dirt, the case may be cracked, or a seal may be leaking sufficiently to prevent cooling. If evaporator
restriction is due to icing, the expansion valve, capillary tube or suction throttling valve, if equipped,
may be at fault and should be investigated.
Since there is a constant condensation of atmospheric moisture on the outside of the evaporator
coils, ensure that the draining system is unobstructed and clean.
Page 3638
Axle Bearing: Adjustments
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Bearings" before
making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 2148
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Classification: EF & EC 93-013
Section: Engine Fuel
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-167
Models: Various
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED MODELS:
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to determine that a
vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and Date
of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and should have the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part
number on the ECM cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 3001
Page 4003
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Model AD18V Minimum Refinish Thickness 0.630 in
Lateral Runout (T.I.R.) 0.0028 in
Model CL18B Minimum Refinish Thickness 0.394 in
Lateral Runout (T.I.R.) 0.0028 in
Page 4430
Fig. 9 Upper Spring Seat Installation Direction. 1987-90 2WD Models
Fig. 10 Upper Spring Seat Installation Direction. 1987-90 4WD Models
Fig. 11 Upper Spring Seat Installation Direction. 1991-92 Models
Page 2519
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Page 2474
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 1935
Page 2115
Idle Speed: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Testing and Inspection
PCV Valve Hose: Testing and Inspection
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks. 2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with
compressed air. If any hose cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.) Operation
Idle Speed Control Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.)
Operation
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel
EF&EC88-017; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-115 Models:
1988 Sentra & Pulsar (E16i) Date:
September 8, 1988 IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED MODEL: 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16i
SERVICE INFORMATION
Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988 Sentras and Pulsars (E16i)
is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models. Any attempt to interchange
these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle Speed Control Valve
(I.S.C.V).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below. PARTS INFORMATION
Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number for the 1988
mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your reference, the part
numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
PART DESCRIPTION 1988 PART NUMBER 1987 PART NUMBER
E16i Mixture Heater 16174-61A61 16174-69A10
(B12/N13)
Page 4466
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Page 5336
1. Remove headliner finisher.
2. Measure 9-1/4" from front edge of rear pillar and chalk mark hole location for upper anchor bolt.
Pull headliner about 1" away from roof to check bolt hole alignment with chalk mark. There is a
seam at this point so be very careful when pulling on the headliner. Use a pick or an awl to punch a
starter hole in the headliner. Using a sharp knife, cut the headliner as shown below:
3. Loosen and pull back the rear section of the lower quarter panel trim.
4. Loosen and pull back the rear portion of the opera window trim.
5. Remove rear pillar trim.
6. Remove spare tire (if interior mounted), then remove trunk finisher.
7. Place retractor unit into position and finger tighten bolt. Install locating screw to keep the
retractor unit from rotating on its mount. Torque retractor mounting bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
8. Install upper anchor into roof panel and torque bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
9. Remove original female belt and install 3-point belt lower anchor at this point. Torque bolt to
26-32 ft.lbs (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
10. Remove original retractor unit and install retro-fit female buckle at this location.
11. Check 3-point belt for smooth operation.
12. Install retro-fit trunk finisher (be sure to thread belt through the finisher before installation).
13. Snap belt finisher into place on trunk finisher.
14. Install rear pillar trim.
15. Install headliner trim piece.
16. Snap lower and opera window quarter panel finishers into position.
2WD Model
Page 2388
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4401
When replacing transverse link and/or radius rod, refer to Fig. 25 and note the following:
1. Before removing transverse link attaching bolts, scribe alignment mark on adjusting pin.
2. After installing transverse link, adjust wheel alignment as described in ``Wheel Alignment
Section.''
3. When installing radius rod bracket, ensure arrow points forward.
Page 88
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 3291
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2103
Page 4079
Testing and Inspection
Air Filter Element: Testing and Inspection
Viscous paper type air cleaner filter does not require any cleaning operation until it is replaced
periodically. Brushing or blasting operation should never be conducted, because it causes clogging
and results in enrichment of the mixture ratio.
Page 2136
Page 777
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 97
Page 2690
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 368
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Page 1064
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 2007
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 5314
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 5253
Paint: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 87-145 Date: 870928
Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Classification: BF87-030
Reference: TS87-145
Date: September 28, 1987
PAINT SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Paint spotting incidents occurring in the U.S. market are not unique to Nissan, but are being
experienced by all manufacturers. To date, two separate types of paint spotting incidents have
been identified as follows:
1. Particulate Fallout - Tiny solid particles which collect on horizontal panels, causing a dark stain
which will penetrate into the paint if not cleaned.
2. Water Spotting - A ringlet or multiple water-drop-shaped light discoloration on dark painted
horizontal panels.
THESE TYPES OF SPOTTING ARE NOT DUE TO PAINT DEFICIENCY, AND CAN BE
PREVENTED THROUGH PROPER CARE.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Particulate Fallout
Ash, dust, soot and other tiny solid particulate matter from industrial and other sources can be
carried many miles. Particulate fallout is most noticeable on the horizontal surfaces (hood, luggage
compartment lid, and roof) of the vehicle.
If left on a moist, painted surface, the particles will slowly dissolve and bond to the paint, frequently
leaving a red stain. This stain can be present even on plastic surfaces such as bumpers if the
fallout has an iron content. These spots may be visible on both solid and metallic paints (especially
light colors). The particulate can be felt as a sharp point on the paint surface. When viewed through
a magnifying lens, the staining may be evident.
VEHICLE CARE
Every 10 days, or more frequently depending upon local conditions, particulate fallout must be
washed off with mild detergent and water to prevent its bonding and staining action. A good
carnuba wax coating can help protect against damage from particulate fallout.
PARTICULATE FALLOUT REPAIR PROCEDURE
In most cases, thoroughly washing the affected area with a water and mild detergent solution (to
avoid scratching the finish with dislodged particles) will remove the particulates.
After washing the vehicle, a stain, generally orange or red, may still be visible on white or other
light colored vehicles. This stain can be removed with a fine compound material. DO NOT APPLY
THE COMPOUNDING MATERIAL BEFORE ALL PARTICLES IN THE AFFECTED AREA ARE
REMOVED BY THOROUGH WASHING.
Water Spotting
A photograph of typical water spotting is shown on page 26 of the Nissan Paint Refinishing Guide*
(PIN 5REFGD). The spots are most visible when viewed at an angle, usually under fluorescent
light. The paint surface is usually smooth to the touch because the spotting is a change in the top
surface itself. This is not hard-water residue which will wash off with soap and water. These spots
are visible on both solid and metallic paints with dark colors.
VEHICLE CARE
When a vehicle is stored outside and unprotected, dust patterns develop on the painted surfaces.
These patterns guide moisture droplets from a light rain or morning dew to the same location each
time. The strong sunlight, repeatedly concentrated on these water droplets, greatly contributes to
the spotting.
Page 3004
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 5496
^ These scratches are typically long and have several scratches concentrated together.
^ These scratches can be found anywhere on the glass surface.
^ Thoroughly examine the entire length of the crack to identify any scratch as a start point.
3) How to determine if glass has distortion or cracks due to manufacturing Issue.
Disclaimer
Page 755
Page 4248
SPECIAL TOOLS
Page 3335
Page 2333
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1144
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 54
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 4 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 5 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) SR20DE
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Service Precautions
Timing Belt: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will hit
piston heads and damage to the valves may occur.
Page 4607
Air Conditioning Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch assembly, remove screws securing switch
bracket to air intake housing, then remove switch assembly.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 2633
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3156
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 310
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Altitude Compensation
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Compensation
Altitude compensation prevents deterioration of exhaust emissions caused by an enriched air/fuel
mixture. Atmospheric pressure varies according to the altitude. The higher the altitude, the lower
the atmospheric pressure. At an atmospheric pressure of approximately 26 in. Hg or below, the
altitude switch transmits an ``On'' signal to the control unit, decreasing fuel to provide an
appropriate air/fuel mixture ratio.
Page 802
AB-/BC VALVE CONTROL
When the idle switch is OFF, the I.S.C. valve opens in response to the amount of intake air and
engine speed. When the accelerator pedal is released, additional air is led into the intake manifold,
actuating as AB- or BC valve.
Page 735
Idle Speed: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Page 4440
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 872
Auto tensioner Inspection (if equipped)
1. With the engine running at idle and the AC turned ON, observe the pulley angular (side to side)
movement (see Example 1):
^ See above table for maximum movement specification.
^ Visual comparison of movement with a known good vehicle is recommended.
Page 1828
Power Transistor: Description and Operation
The ignition signal from the E.C.U. is amplified by the power transistor, which turns the ignition coil
primary circuit on and off, inducing the proper high voltage in the secondary circuit. The ignition coil
is a small, molded type.
Page 3185
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1804
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 3139
- After installation, check that there is no fuel leakage and engine idling condition is stable and
proper.
Page 5276
F. Inspect for damage using fluorescent light source and magnification. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
G. Use abrasive cleaning on test section to remove up to 0.5 mil of damaged top/clear coat.* If
damage is less than 0.5 mil deep, clean affected panels with abrasive method. After polishing,
inspect for swirl marks using halogen lights. If damage is more than 0.5 mil deep, the affected
panels must be repaired either by re-clear, re-color/clear coat, or re-color coated (on vehicles with
no final clear coat).
A. Wash Procedure
Wash Equipment and Materials:
Spray wash system (a mobile or stationary unit with hand held spray similar to a coin operated car
wash that provides soap solution, rinse water and de-ionized final rinse).
Car wash detergent containing no phosphates, (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100).
Clean 100% cotton terry cloth towels.
De-ionized water for the final rinse. De-ionized water is highly recommended as it reduces water
spotting. De-ionizing cylinders can be purchased or rented from water purification companies
1. During the summer months, the early morning hours are the best time to wash a car unless you
can wash and dry it in the shade. Never wash a car under the hot sun. All paint is subject to water
spot damage when washed under the sun due to high surface temperature.
2. Thoroughly rinse oft the surface dirt and foreign materials with a spray of clean tap water.
3. Gently apply detergent and water solution (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), keeping it wet for 4-5
minutes. To avoid scratching the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light
pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry
cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt.
Replace the towel with a clean one once it becomes soiled.
Caution:
When washing a convertible rear window use gentle horizontal and vertical strokes, do not use a
circular motion.Use a clean terry cloth towel. Also refer to NTB92-092 for additional information on
convertible wash procedure.
4. Rinse with a spray of clean tap water. Make sure all detergent is flushed off the body. If soap
dries on the convertible rear window or some moldings it may cause streaking. Use a spray of
de-ionized water for the final rinse.
5. Use a clean damp terry cloth towel and gentle pressure to remove the majority of the rinse water
allowing the remaining water film to air dry. Replace the towel frequently to avoid scratches from
entrapped dirt.
6. Always wash, rinse, and dry a vehicle beginning with the roof and glass. Then the hood and
trunk followed by the vertical surfaces. Wash, rinse, and dry one section at a time if low humidity
causes fast drying. Do not allow soap solution or rinse water to dry on the finish.
B. Identifying Contamination
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier with
a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp or a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is most easily done with a
8X and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Page 4121
Quick Battery Charge
Locations
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5225
3M materials:
Meguiar's materials:
Misc:
8" buffer (1500-1750 RPM) Dual action sander, variable speed Terry cloth towels (100% cloth)
NOTE:
Always use separate pads for each liquid (mark the backside of each pad with the type of liquid
used) and clean the pads frequently. Use of a wool pad on clear coat is limited to the polishing type
of pad and is always followed by a foam Dad on a dual action sander to remove swirl marks.
Measuring Paint Film Thickness
Before any abrasive removal, measure the initial film thickness at several places to establish an
average figure. After each abrasive step measure several places again to determine how much
paint film was removed. Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of the mil gauge you
are using for measurement and calibration. If you do not have a thickness gauge use the following
rule of thumb during abrasive removal; When the "orange peel" surface is removed, 0.5 mil has
been removed.
Polishing
Polishing is done in two steps: The first step is with an 8" buffer and the second step with a dual
action sander to remove buffing and swirl marks. Low speed (1500-1750 RPM) is necessary to
prevent overheating the surface.
CAUTION:
Do not polish or buff a surface dry. More than the usual quantity of liquid must be used to keep the
paint surface cool. Wipe the excess material off with a clean soft towel after each operation
1. Clean the surface of all residue before polishing.
2. Use an 8" buffer (at 1500 - 1750 RPM) with either a 3M wool polishing pad or a Meguiar's foam
pad, apply polishing compound over the work
Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Classification: EF & EC 93-013
Section: Engine Fuel
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-167
Models: Various
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED MODELS:
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to determine that a
vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and Date
of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and should have the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part
number on the ECM cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 558
Page 980
Page 3576
Page 5322
1. Remove rear seat backs and lower cushion.
2. Remove front belt upper anchor bolts.
3. Loosen and pull back front portion of lower trunk finishers.
4. Remove right arid left quarter panel finishers. It is recommended that the finishers are replaced
with the retro-fit finishers listed in the parts information section. However, the existing finishers can
be trimmed for belt access as follows:
a. Locate the drilling point which is factory pre-scribed in the back side of the quarter panel trim.
b. Using a hole saw, drill a 1" hole in the trim piece at the marked location.
c. Locate scribed area in side trim and cut the opening for the three point belt. Refer to the
illustration below for the opening location.
5. Remove original lap belts (female buckle side).
6. Install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit. Torque mounting bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
Page 4808
^ The graph on the following page shows that PAG oil left open to air (e.g. in an unsealed
container) will absorb 2% moisture (by weight) in 120 hours (5 days).
^ PAG containers, and any A/C component which contains PAG oil (such as the compressor)
should remain tightly capped and sealed until ready for use.
^ If you believe that a container of PAG oil may not have been adequately re-sealed after opening,
dispose of the oil properly and use oil from a new sealed container.
^ When installing or servicing an A/C system, the refrigerant tube and hose connections should be
sealed (all connections made and tightened to specification) without delay.
^ The above precautions will keep the absorption of moisture into the system to a minimum. Using
moisture saturated PAG oil in R-134a systems may lead to the formation of acids and related
system damage or failure.
^ Do not allow refrigerant oil (Nissan A/C System Oil Type S) to contact styrofoam, as the lubricant
will damage this material.
Page 2276
Inspection Procedure
Page 3452
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 3430
Power Transistor: Testing and Inspection
Power Transistor Test
Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between terminals as per the image. Replace power
transistor if it fails the above tests.
Page 759
Adjustments
Inhibitor Switch: Adjustments
1. Loosen inhibitor switch attaching screws.
2. Set selector lever manual shaft at Neutral position.
3. Insert suitable pin into adjustment holes in both inhibitor switch and switch lever as near vertical
as possible, then tighten screws.
4. Check switch for continuity, replacing as necessary.
Fig. 6 Adjusting inhibitor switch. 1985-88 Maxima, 1986-88 Stanza Wagon & 1987-88 Pulsar,
Sentra & Stanza exc. Wagon
INHIBITOR SWITCH VIEW
Page 733
Page 1012
Comments regarding R-134a manifold gauge set:
^ Be certain that the gauge face indicates R134a or 134a.
^ Be certain that the manifold gauge set has the 1/2" - 16 ACME threaded connections for service
hoses, ensuring that only R-134a service hoses are used.
^ Be certain that no refrigerants other than R-134a (along with only specified lubricants) are used
with the manifold gauge set.
Page 3610
WITHDRAWAL LEVER ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 7 Withdrawal lever adjustment. Pulsar & Sentra Type 2
2. Adjust withdrawal lever play, dimension B, Figs. 6 & 7, with the adjuster or locknuts, to
specifications.
3. Measure clutch pedal freeplay as shown in Fig. 4, dimension A. Freeplay should be as shown in
specification table.
4. After the above adjustments have been completed, cycle clutch pedal several times to ensure
that clutch linkage operates smoothly without binding.
Page 1865
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 2563
Fig. 303b Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Brake Rotor/Disc: Customer Interest Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Classification: BR94-002 Section: Brake Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB94-012 Models:
All models Date: February 3, 1993
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
GENERAL INFORMATION:
Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in any vehicle when excessive
rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in thickness between the thickest and thinnest
points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy.
However, excessive Rotor Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is
the excessive rotor thickness variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is
described in more detail below.
POSSIBLE CAUSE OF BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of
events occur:
Page 2172
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 494
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Page 1840
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Page 4816
which will result in contamination, and damage to recovery/recycle equipment.
^ Use equipment designed to meet Society of Automotive engineers (SAE) standards, which
specify R-134a service equipment fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME), and service hose identification
(black stripe on hose).
^ Adapters to convert from one size fitting to the other must never be used; refrigerant/lubricant
contamination will occur and system failure may result.
^ The use of incorrect equipment will result in refrigerant and/or lubricant contamination, which may
cause A/C system or equipment failure.
^ ACR(4) machine will perform all required service functions (recovery, evacuation, recycle,
recharge).
^ High volume A/C service facilities may benefit from "component" A/C service equipment (vacuum
pump, weight scale, manifold gauge set) to supplement the ACR(4).
Comments regarding recovery/recycling equipment:
^ Be certain to follow the manufacturer's instructions for machine operation and machine
maintenance.
^ Never introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.
^ Only R-134a containers with a 1/2"-16 ACME can be used to add R-134a to the ACR4
recovery/recycle machine.
^ Periodic maintenance of this equipment is required; follow the manufacturer's recommendations
as described in the equipment instruction manual.
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 2504
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
QUEST (V40) VG30E
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
Page 1899
Inspection Procedure
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3063
Page 250
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Classification: Section: Front Axle
FA89-004 & Suspension
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-150 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra, Pulsar NX, 1989-1990 240SX
Date: October 19, 1989 FRONT STRUT KIT CAMBER
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1989 Sentras (B12) 1987-1989 Pulsar NX (N13) 1989-1990 240SX
(S13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
New Front Strut Kits supplied for the Applied Models are now manufactured with the camber
already set at factory specifications. The adjustable eccentric pin contained in the previously
available kit assemblies has been eliminated. Please note that the new kits will retrofit on a model
by model basis, and adjustment is not required when retrofitting.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 2705
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Specifications
Fig. 2 Compression Pressure Specifications
Page 3752
This vibration/buzzing may be generated from the shift linkage control rod. The fit between the
connecting pin and bushing in the joint at the transmission end of the control rod has been
improved to eliminate this incident (see illustrations).
NOTE: The control rod is available only as an assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If this incident exists on a vehicle manufactured before the applied dates, replace the control rod
assembly as shown in the appropriate Service Manual.
PARTS INFORMATION
CONTROL ROD ASSY
MODEL PART NUMBER
B12 2WD 34103-50M00
N13 E16 34103-50M00
CA16D 34103-55M00
Page 700
Locations
Thermal Limiting Fuse: Locations
A/C Components.
On Top Of Compressor
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3025
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Page 85
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Page 629
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 695
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Technical Service Bulletin # 04-054C Date: 110406
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Classification: WT04-004C
Reference: NTB04-054C
Date: April 6, 2011
WHEEL ALIGNMENT INFORMATION
This bulletin has been amended to correct some typographical errors in SERVICE INFORMATION.
No other changes have been made. Discard all previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
Warranty Claim Information: In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the
following item MUST be attached to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
General Information and Recommendations
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When performing a wheel alignment it is important that you read and follow all of the instructions
supplied with your alignment equipment.
^ The information in this bulletin is not intended to be complete wheel alignment instructions.
^ Use the information in this bulletin as a supplement to the instructions for your equipment.
General Information and Recommendations
1. Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should always be performed.
^ This type of alignment is recommended for all Nissan vehicles.
^ The four-wheel thrust process ensures that the vehicle is properly aligned, and helps ensure
proper "centering" of the steering wheel.
2. Use the right alignment machine.
^ You must use a quality alignment machine that will give accurate results when performing
alignment checks.
^ Refer to the Nissan TECH-MATE Service Equipment Catalog for recommended alignment
equipment.
^ The alignment rack itself should be capable of accepting any Nissan vehicle. The rack should be
checked to ensure that it is level.
3. Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
^ Your alignment equipment should be regularly calibrated in order to give accurate readings.
^ If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged, calibration should
be checked immediately.
^ Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended
service/calibration schedule.
NOTE:
In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the following item MUST be attached
to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
Locations
Ignition Coil Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2858
This valve, Figs. 14 and 15, monitors exhaust pressures to activate the diaphragm. The valve
controls vacuum applied to the EGR control valve. This allows the operation of the EGR control
valve to be controlled by engine operating conditions.
Page 3016
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 2876
EGR Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Check the solenoid valve for electric continuity, after disconnecting the harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
2. Check the solenoid valve for normal operation, after disconnecting the harness connector and all
the vacuum hoses. Supply the solenoid valve with
battery voltage, and check whether there is continuity between ports A, B and C.
Page 4947
Seat Belt Retractor: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Warnings for Aftermarket Rust Proofing
Classification: BF88-005
Reference: TS88-015
Date: February 15, 1988
CAUTIONS FOR AFTERMARKET RUST PROOFING APPLICATION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
Nissan Models
SERVICE INFORMATION The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration has conducted an
investigation into potential failure of the front safety belt systems of certain vehicles due to the
unintentional application of rust-proofing material to the belt retractors in the "B" pillar area. Their
information suggests that the movement of the pendulum inside the belt retractor mechanism can
be restricted if rust-proofing material is inadvertently applied in the pendulum area. Restricting the
pendulum movement can result in the belts failing to protect occupants in an accident. Nissan's
current models have extensive anti-corrosion treatment applied at the factories and we do not
endorse "rust-proofing" at the dealer or aftermarket level. The only instance in which Nissan
recommends rust-proofing be applied is in the case of body panel replacement (Please refer to
Service Bulletin TS82-066, BF82-007 for instructions about rust-proofing replacement body
panels). If additional rust-proofing is applied to Nissan vehicles, DO NOT apply rust-proofing to the
"B" pillar area near the seat belt retractor, or any other location near the seat belt retractors of any
vehicle. Of course, the usual precautions in applying rust-proofing material still apply. For example,
it is important that rust-proofing material not be inadvertently applied to door lock assemblies, drain
holes, the exhaust system or driveshaft. IMPROPER RETRACTOR OPERATION CAUSED BY
THE INSTALLATION OF RUST-PROOFING MATERIAL WILL BE THE RESPONSIBILITY OF
THE INSTALLING AGENCY.
Page 3587
^ before removing the extension adapter hose from the cooler Outlet hose,
^ turn the can over and spray only propellant for a few seconds to avoid fluid spilling back out of the
cooler hose.
5. Tie a common white, basket-type coffee filter to the end of the cooler Inlet hose (see Figure 10).
6. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 11).
7. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 11).
8. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the cooler Outlet hose to
force any remaining cleaner or fluid into the coffee filter (see Figure 11).
9. Remove the coffee filter from the end of the cooler Inlet hose.
10. Proceed with Inspection Procedure.
Inspection Procedure
Page 2674
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Specifications
Fig. 2 Compression Pressure Specifications
Page 1930
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 2733
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4541
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Description and Operation
Vacuum Delay Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Vacuum delay valve (typical)
This valve, Fig. 16, prevents a rapid vacuum drop of the EGR control line. The valve is designed for
one-way operation and consists of a one-way umbrella valve and a sintered steel fluidic restricter.
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Page 1943
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 4448
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "FRONT SUSPENSION / COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND REPAIR PROCEDURES /
AXLE BEARING AND KNUCKLE" before making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 2947
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2072
Page 4906
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Page 3428
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1951
Inspection Procedure
Page 2325
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 766
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 861
1. Check belt tensioner for smooth turning. 2. Check the condition of tensioner spring.
Page 973
^ Do not introduce compressed air to any refrigerant container or refrigerant component, because
contamination will occur.
^ R-134a in the presence of oxygen and under pressure may form a combustible mixture.
Therefore, never introduce compressed air into any R-134a container, cylinder, A/C component,
recover/recycle equipment, or other service equipment. This includes "empty" containers.
Refrigerant Terminology
Please use the correct name or names when specifying refrigerants. The guidelines are listed
below:
^ Freon --> is a registered trademark of DuPont, and should only be used if referring to DuPont
R-12.
^ DuPont's trade name for R-134a (automotive use) is Suva-->Trans A/C.
^ When referring to refrigerants, the terms Freon-->and Suva--> should not be used as a general
reference. The proper terms are R-12 and R-134a
Comments regarding refrigerants:
^ R-12 and R-134a are not compatible with each other and should never be mixed, even in the
smallest amounts.
^ R-134a for automotive use has a special tank fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME) which is compatible
with automotive service equipment
^ When purchasing R-134a, be certain that the fitting size on the tank is 1/2" - 16 ACME. This
thread size is easy to recognize by the square thread, as shown.
^ Although R-134a has no ozone depletion potential (ODP), it does have a slight global warming
potential (GWP). Due to this slight GWP, as well as its high cost, venting of R-134a into the air is
not recommended.
^ Recovery/recycling of R-134a will be required by U.S. Federal Law, Clean Air Act Amendments of
1990.
Page 4970
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
Page 1376
Also remove traces of liquid gasket from mating surface of cylinder block.
2. Apply a continuous bead of liquid gasket to mating surface of oil pan.
^ Use Genuine Liquid Gasket or equivalent.
^ Be sure liquid gasket is 3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in) wide.
3. Apply liquid gasket to inner sealing surface instead of surface where there is no groove at bolt
hole.
^ Attach oil pan to cylinder block within five minutes after coating.
^ Wait at least 30 minutes before refilling engine oil or starting engine.
Page 4307
Alignment: Specifications
Rear Camber Angle -1 11/12 to - 5/12 deg
Camber Angle Desired - 1/5 deg
Toe Per Wheel +.04 to +.12 in
Total Degrees - 1/10 to + 9/30 deg
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Drum: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5058
Page 5231
2. Mix a solution of water and remover into a bucket. The solution should be mixed at 1 part
remover to 8 parts of water. Using a clean wash mit, gently spread the solution onto the vehicle
with long sweeping strokes.
The remover works chemically, so there is no need for rubbing the surface at this point.
Caution: the use of any chemical other than the one supplied to remove the paint guard coating,
(KATS UL 6000), may make the coating harder to remove and it could damage the paint.
3. Keep the solution wet for 3 to 5 minutes. Don't let it dry.
Apply additional solution to areas which begin to dry too quickly.
4. Rinse with water.
This rinses off the coating and remover.
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Page 323
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 999
A list of Johnstone Supply outlets who stock SUNISO 5GS oil in one quart containers . There may
also be other oulets in your area that carry SUNISO 5GS. This would most commmonly be a firm
specializing in industrial A/C and refrigeration supplies.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
When billing for "SUNISO 5GS" on warranty claims, use "local" part number: LOCALCOMPR.
Page 4773
Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCS) are chemical compounds made up of molecules that contain atoms of
chlorine and fluorine bonded to carbon atoms. CFCs are used in a number of applications, the
most common of which are in automotive air conditioners, in the blowing of plastic foam products,
and as solvents in electronic component manufacturing. Ozone is a special form of oxygen which
combines three oxygen atoms into O3. Ozone in the Earth's upper atmosphere serves as a shield
from harmful ultra violet solar radiation by reflecting the rays back into space.
When CFCs are released into the air, here's what happens: the molecules work their way upward
in the atmosphere slowly, taking as long as ten years to reach the middle stratosphere, 20 to 40
kilometers above the surface of the earth, where the "ozone layer" resides. The CFC molecules are
bombarded by ultra violet light from the sun, which tends to break the chemical bonds that hold
chlorine and fluorine to the carbon. The fluorine atoms can combine with moisture to form acids.
When the chlorine breaks away, it becomes a chemical "catalyst," which means that it can cause
chemical reactions to occur rapidly. Thus, a chlorine atom can break the chemical bonds that hold
O3 together and O3 becomes O2 and O. It is now no longer "ozone" and it no longer has its
reflective quality to turn ultra violet radiation away from the earth. Given the right conditions, the
chlorine from one CFC molecule could destroy up to 100,000 ozone molecules.
Page 4694
Control Assembly: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove control cables by unfastening clamps at door levers.
3. Disconnect electrical connector.
4. Remove control assembly finisher and mounting bolts, then the control assembly.
5. Reverse procedure to install, then adjust control cables.
Page 4288
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 1512
PDI - Paint Guard Coating (PGC) Removal
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins PDI - Paint Guard Coating (PGC) Removal
Classification: Section:
BF88-015 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-120 Models: All Models
Date: September 15, 1988 PAINT GUARD COATING REMOVAL
This Bulletin supersedes the previously issued "Paint Guard Coating Removal",
BF88-006/TS88-043, dated May 5, 1988. Due to duplicate numbering this Bulletin is being
re-issued with new Classification/Reference numbers. There are NO changes to the contents of the
Bulletin. Please discard the original Bulletin. APPLIED MODELS: All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
The following information should be used to help your wash and detail personnel in the clean-up of
vehicles delivered with PGC (paint guard coating). The paint guard coating remover solution is
supplied with each vehicle and can be found in the glove box. In order to make the removal
process easier, the Ports have improved the application process and are careful to avoid sags and
thick coats of the material.
Please post these directions in your car wash area and review with clean-up personnel. A good
understanding of the PGC and remover will greatly speed your clean-up and preserve the new car
finish.
A Material Safety Data Sheet on PGC has been distributed as part of a National Parts Bulletin.
1. Park vehicle in shade and rinse thoroughly using a spray of water. If the vehicle is extremely
dirty, wash it with soap and water. This will loosen dirt and cool the sheet metal. The surface must
not be allowed to dry during the cleaning process.
When applying the remover solution in the next step, a pair of rubber gloves, eye protection, and
boots should be worn for protection.
Page 2026
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 4855
Fan Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove A/C-heater control as outlined in ``Control
Assembly, Replace.''
2. Remove screws securing switch to control and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install and adjust control.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1789
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 106
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 2030
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 617
The chart (Figure 5) shows the relationship between the common units of Total Toe measurement.
Conversions vary with wheel size. Reference the appropriate service manual for exact
specifications.
NOTE: When adjusting Total Toe on a vehicle with oversized tires, use the angle values on the
alignment machine. Oversized tires have a larger diameter.
Page 2009
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 3910
Fig. 6 AD18V type front disc brake disassembled
Brake Pad, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Remove lock pin, Figs. 4, 5 and 6, and pivot caliper body upwards.
3. Remove pad retainers, then the pads.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Install inner pad, then pull cylinder body out and install outer pad.
Caliper, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Disconnect brake hose from brake tube.
3. Remove caliper attaching bolts, then the caliper assembly from vehicle.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Caliper Overhaul
1. Separate cylinder body and torque member, Figs. 4, 5 and 6.
2. Remove brake hose, then press out piston with dust seal and retainer ring.
3. Remove piston seal, guide pin and lock pin from torque member.
4. Reverse procedure to assemble.
Page 496
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Page 2385
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3199
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3062
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Page 3906
PARTS INFORMATION
Use the following chart to find the correct part numbers for the new brake pad kits with HP12
material. Models that are not listed on this chart (i.e. Z31, certain D21 models), use brake pads
from a different vendor. Use the original pads listed in the Parts Microfiche. Original pads on these
models are equivalent to HP12 material.
Lower, Rear
Control Arm: Service and Repair Lower, Rear
Fig. 25 Rear suspension. 4WD Sentra
4WD SENTRA
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Page 2621
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 637
Page 5047
Page 4426
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Overhaul
Fig. 1 Rear Suspension (Part 1 Of 2). 2WD Models
Page 1880
3. Loosen the sensor approximately 10 degrees.
4. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
5. Tighten the sensor 10 degrees, then loosen the sensor 10 degrees.
^ Repeat this motion several times until the sensor begins to turn more easily.
6. Continue the tightening/loosening motion while gradually unscrewing the sensor. Stop when the
sensor will not unscrew any further.
7. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 until the sensor is removed.
Page 1740
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
VAN (C22) Z241
200SX (S100) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
Page 2817
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2955
Page 4311
Fig. 18 Turning angle specifications
STEERING ANGLE
When a vehicle negotiates a turn, the inner wheel must turn at a sharper angle than the outer
wheel, and the outer wheel must travel farther than the inner wheel. Vehicle steering geometry is
calculated to allow for these variations, causing the outer wheel to to-out by a calibrated amount.
This toe-out on turns is also referred to as steering angle and on these models, is generally
checked at two positions. The first position is at a reference point on the inner wheel travel while
the second position of measurement is at full steering lock. To check steering angles, proceed as
follows:
1. Place unladen vehicle on suitable alignment rack and ensure that kingpin angle, caster, camber
and toe settings are within specifications.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Page 4044
Fig. 6 AD18V type front disc brake disassembled
Brake Pad, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Remove lock pin, Figs. 4, 5 and 6, and pivot caliper body upwards.
3. Remove pad retainers, then the pads.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Install inner pad, then pull cylinder body out and install outer pad.
Caliper, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Disconnect brake hose from brake tube.
3. Remove caliper attaching bolts, then the caliper assembly from vehicle.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Caliper Overhaul
1. Separate cylinder body and torque member, Figs. 4, 5 and 6.
2. Remove brake hose, then press out piston with dust seal and retainer ring.
3. Remove piston seal, guide pin and lock pin from torque member.
4. Reverse procedure to assemble.
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan Attachment Bolts 5.3 ft.lb
Page 57
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4386
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the flow chart. Use this chart, as
appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
GENERAL BRAKE REPAIR GUIDELINES
To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the following.
1. Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug
bolts may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3. Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip
on the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with
Page 84
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper
Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Engine - Coding System to Match Bearings to Crankshaft
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Coding System to Match Bearings
to Crankshaft
Classification: Section:
EM90-002 Engine Mech.
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-011 Models: All 1987-90 Models
Date: February 15, 1990 IDENTIFYING CRANKSHAFT BEARINGS FOR SERVICE
APPLICATIONS
APPLIED MODELS: All 1987-90 Models.
SERVICE INFORMATION
Beginning with engines manufactured in 1987, Nissan has utilized a coding system to precisely
match bearings to the crankshaft. Certain ways of marking/coding the crankshaft have varied. The
purpose of this bulletin is to explain those coding variations so that the correct replacement
crankshaft bearings can be selected.
Some Crankshafts utilize marks on the No. 1 Counterbalance. There may be one or two rows. If
there are two rows, the top one identifies the grade for the main bearings; the bottom one identifies
the grade for the connecting rod bearings. If there is only one row, it will indicate the grade for the
main bearings and the engine rebuilder should use the "standard" bearings for the connecting rod
application. NOTE:
Some Crankshafts were additionally marked on the No. 5 Counterbalance. In this application, the
marks on the No. 5 Counterbalance represent the grade for the connecting rod bearings and the
marks on the No. 1 Counterbalance represent the grade for the main bearings.
One other variation in Crankshaft marking is the use of horizontal scribe marks on certain
Crankshafts and Arabic numerals (1, 2, 3, etc.) for others.
^ Those Crankshafts graded with Arabic numerals need no interpretation because their grades
directly correspond to the Parts Microfiche and Service Manual for the respective vehicle.
^ Those Crankshafts graded with vertical scribe marks can be interpreted by using the following
table.
Crank BRG. Counterbalance "vertical slash"
Grade Grade #
0 no mark
1I
2 II
3 III
Refer to the "S.D.S." chart at the back of the EM section of the appropriate Service Manual for
bearing color code application.
Page 1539
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4663
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 4085
JIS = Japan Industrial Standard, used for Japan produced batteries CCA = Cold Cranking Amps,
standard for North American produced batteries
IMPORTANT:
^ JIS batteries have different testing specifications than CCA batteries.
^ If you must use the GR-8 Battery Tester in a mode other than MODEL mode, JIS Mode MUST
ALWAYS BE USED for JIS batteries otherwise an
incorrect result will occur. NEVER test a JIS battery using the CCA test in the GR-8; the test
software in the GR-8 is different for JIS and CCA modes. ANY CCA value you may have for a
JIS-type battery is inaccurate for testing purposes.
^ ALWAYS test with the GR-8 using the MODEL mode (if available).
^ Selecting MODEL and vehicle type will automatically select the proper JIS or CCA value for the
Original Equipment battery.
^ If the applicable vehicle is not listed, update the GR-8 to make sure it has the most recent data
package. (1)
(1) To run the Midtronics Update Wizard for the GR-8 tester in CONSULT III:
^ Make sure the cables from the GR-8 to the multitasker are connected and both units are turned
on.
^ Click on the ASIST icon.
^ Click on INFO. Tool Box.
^ Select Midtronics GR-8.
^ Midtronics Update Wizard file screen displays.
^ Click on Change MUP File.
^ The Select a MUP file window displays with the path: C:\ProgramFiles\Midtronics\MUW.
^ Select 192-725C and click OK.
^ Click on next and follow the prompts on the Midtronics Update Wizard screen.
If the applicable vehicle still is not listed:
1) Determine which type of battery (CCA or JIS) is installed in the vehicle. See below for
descriptions of each battery.
2) Select CCA or JIS in the GR-8 based on the type of battery installed. See below for more
information.
Determine the Battery Type
Batteries with JIS (Japanese Industrial Standard) Number
Page 2145
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing Information
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing
Information
Classification: Section:
GI88-023 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-150 Models:
All models 1987-1989 Date:
November 17, 1988 TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h. and distances of less than 40
miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic Transmission vehicles with four
wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when towing Automatic Transmission
vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following limitations apply when towing Manual
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for example behind a motor home).
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES *
These are maximum distances these vehicles may be towed without damage to the gear rain. In
general, any Nissan vehicle should be started, warmed up, and driven at least two miles after it has
been towed these distances - more frequently if possible.
Page 4973
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Page 4472
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Blower Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 3977
^ while the vehicle is barely moving, with light brake pedal force
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
^ most common on vehicles with automatic transmission
This noise is common on most cars with front disc brakes. There are no repair procedures to
eliminate this noise. 3.
SQUEAKING/SQUEALING NOISE ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during low speed stops (5-20 mph)
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
This noise is common on vehicles with high-performance potential that must be able to stop in
short distances from high speeds. Other brands of brake pads may eliminate this noise, but Nissan
does not recommend them because they may have reduced pad life or inadequate performance in
high speed stops. 4.
HIGH-PITCHED SQUEAKING/SCRAPING NOISE ^
whenever brakes are applied
^ may come from just one wheel
Nissan uses pad wear indicators on many of its disc brake pads to provide an audible warning
when the brake pads need replacement. Spring steel tabs that are riveted to the brake pad scrape
lightly on the rotor surface when the pad is worn down to its lowest limit. The customer should hear
the noise at this time and bring the vehicle to the dealer for brake pad replacement. The pad wear
indicator will not damage the rotor surface if the pad is replaced in a reasonable time. Replace
worn pads with new parts. Check the rotor surface for damage and machine if necessary.
Page 96
System description: When the switch is ON, the ECU lights up the lamp.
The VOLTAGE VALUE is based on the body ground.
Page 2281
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Description and Operation
Fig. 14 Back pressure transducer valve.
Fig. 15 Back pressure transducer valve.
Chassis - Warnings for Aftermarket Rust Proofing
Seat Belt Retractor: Technical Service Bulletins Chassis - Warnings for Aftermarket Rust Proofing
Models: All Models
Section: Body & Frame
Classification: BF88-005
Bulletin No.: TS88-015
Date: February 15, 1988
CAUTIONS FOR AFTERMARKET RUST PROOFING APPLICATION
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration has conducted an investigation into potential
failure of the front safety belt systems of certain vehicles due to the unintentional application of
rust-proofing material to the belt retractors in the "B" pillar area. Their information suggests that the
movement of the pendulum inside the belt retractor mechanism can be restricted if rust-proofing
material is inadvertently applied in the pendulum area. Restricting the pendulum movement can
result in the belts failing to protect occupants in an accident.
Nissan's current models have extensive anti-corrosion treatment applied at the factories and we do
not endorse "rust-proofing" at the dealer or aftermarket level. The only instance in which Nissan
recommends rust-proofing be applied is in the case of body panel replacement (Please refer to
Service Bulletin TS82-066, BF82-007 for instructions about rust-proofing replacement body
panels).
If additional rust-proofing is applied to Nissan vehicles, DO NOT apply rust-proofing to the "B" pillar
area near the seat belt retractor, or any other location near the seat belt retractors of any vehicle.
Of course, the usual precautions in applying rust-proofing material still apply. For example, it is
important that rust-proofing material not be inadvertently applied to door lock assemblies, drain
holes, the exhaust system or driveshaft.
IMPROPER RETRACTOR OPERATION CAUSED BY THE INSTALLATION OF
RUST-PROOFING MATERIAL WILL BE THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE INSTALLING AGENCY.
Page 3743
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 1619
5. Fill reservoir tank with coolant up to "MAX" level. 6. Run engine at approximately 2,000 rpm for
about one minute. 7. Stop engine and cool it down, then refill radiator and reservoir tank.
Description and Operation
Fuel Shut-off Solenoid: Description and Operation
Fig. 31a Fuel cut operation chart.
Fig. 31b Fuel cut operation chart.
Fuel cut is accomplished during deceleration when the engine does not require fuel. The fuel cut
specifications for manual and automatic transmission equipped models are shown in Fig. 31.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision Damage
Wheel Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision
Damage
Classification: FA10-006
Reference: NTB10-126
Date: October 21, 2010
WHEEL BEARING COLLISION DAMAGE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Impacts to wheel bearings (such as a collision or other suspension damage) may create slight
indents in the bearing surfaces. These indents may not be visible but can cause bearing noise.
NOTE:
Hub/bearing replacement due to impact (collision or other suspension damage) is not a
warrantable repair
If a vehicle has visible wheel or suspension damage due to impact (collision or other suspension
damage), it is recommended that the wheel bearing assembly be inspected as follows:
1. Remove the hub/bearing assembly from the vehicle.
2. Hold the hub/bearing assembly with both hands.
3. Rotate the hub/bearing assembly in both directions (clockwise and counterclockwise).
4. If any gritty or rough feeling is detected in the bearing replace it with a new one.
Page 3245
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The electronic control unit adjusts fuel pump operation to engine operating conditions. The signals
from various sensors and switches are used to control fuel pump operation.
Fig. 39 Fuel pump control chart.
Fig. 39
Page 4220
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Page 3905
Page 958
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
API Classification API SF Grade
Energy Conserving Oils.
Oil Viscosity Temperatures Below 32 deg F 5w-30
Temperatures Above 0 deg F 10w-30 or 10w-40
Page 142
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The electronic control unit adjusts fuel pump operation to engine operating conditions. The signals
from various sensors and switches are used to control fuel pump operation.
Fig. 39 Fuel pump control chart.
Fig. 39
Page 5057
IMPACT SENSOR INSPECTION, SIREN INSPECTION, CONSOLE SWITCH INSPECTION
Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4343
FIGURE 9
4. Align the groove (if there is one) or mark on pinion gear cap and slit in lower joint (Figure 9), then
push steering gear up into lower joint and reinstall pinch bolt.
5. Reinstall left clamp lower bolt and hand tighten. Then torque right clamp bolts and left lower
clamp bolt to 54-72 ft/lbs.
6. Replace O-ring (soak with ATF before installation) on high pressure line. Reinstall high pressure
and return lines. Tighten fittings finger tight first, then torque to 11-18 ft/lbs.
7. Raise transfer case with jack and reinstall the 3 body side bolts on the transfer case rear mount.
Torque to 22-30 ft/lbs.
8. Align match marks on transfer case flange and propeller shaft, then reinstall propeller shaft onto
transfer case flange. Torque bolts to 25-33 ft/lbs.
9. Reconnect center exhaust assembly to front exhaust assembly and the catalytic converter. Use
new gaskets as required.
10. Lower vehicle to halfway point. Reconnect both tie rod ends to knuckle arms and torque to
22-29 ft/lbs.
11. Install both front wheels and torque wheel nuts to 72-87 ft/lbs.
12. Lower vehicle until wheels are just above the floor. Reinstall left steering gear clamp upper 17
mm bolt and torque to 54-72 ft/lbs.
13. Reinstall carbon canister and reconnect negative cable to battery terminal.
14. Fill reservoir with Genuine Nissan ATF and bleed system as follows:
a. With engine off, turn steering wheel from right lock to left lock fifteen to twenty times or until fluid
level in reservoir stops dropping and air bubbles no longer appear in fluid. Be sure to add fluid to
reservoir during this process to maintain proper fluid level.
b. Start engine and let it idle for one minute. Rev engine under no load two or three times.
c. With engine idling, turn the steering wheel from right lock to left lock seven to eight times or until
fluid level in reservoir stops dropping and there are no more air bubbles in the fluid. If necessary, fill
reservoir to proper fluid level.
CAUTION: Do not hold steering wheel against right or left lock for more than 15 seconds while
bleeding.
15. Lower vehicle and remove lifting arms. Test drive the vehicle in a straight line for 500 feet to
verify steering wheel angle, and at the same time mark the steering wheel position.
16. Reset front toe and steering wheel angle at tie rod ends, using an alignment rack.
17. Reset radio to preset stations noted before battery cable disconnection.
Page 2796
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation Three Stage Converter
The three-way catalytic converter utilizes a catalyst to accelerate the recombustion of HC and CO
and a catalyst to reduce NOx in the exhaust gas, changing them into harmless CO2, H2O, and N3.
In order to maintain mixture ratios at the ``stoichiometric'' point, the point at which the converter
works most efficiently, a mixture ratio feedback system is employed. In this system, an exhaust gas
sensor monitors oxygen content in the exhaust gasses and signals the fuel system to alter the
air/fuel mixture to maintain the ``stoichiometric'' level.
Page 4531
Disclaimer
Page 583
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 1038
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 1769
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 989
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Type R-12
Page 1063
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 4468
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 2167
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3355
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1083
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 1763
Check the wire in the illustration. If an ohmmeter is used to measure resistance, the single strand
of wire still making contact would give an ohmmeter reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a good
circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand of wire is not able to carry the current. It will
become hot and have a high resistance to the current. This will be picked up as a voltage drop.
Unwanted resistance can be caused by many situations: -Undersized wiring (single strand)
-Corrosion on switch contacts -Loose wire connections or splices
If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge (lower number).
Measuring Voltage Drop
1. Connect the voltmeter across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive
lead of the voltmeter should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
2. Operate the circuit
3. The voltmeter will indicate how many volts (voltage drop) are being used to "push" current
through that part of the circuit. Note in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop
between the battery and the bulb, or a 4.0 v. drop between the switch and the bulb.
Relationship between Open/Short circuit and the ECU pin control
Page 2859
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Testing and Inspection
1. Connect vacuum pump to two uppermost ports one at a time and check them for leakage.
2. When vacuum is applied to uppermost port and port immediately below that is open to
atmosphere, uppermost port should open at 2.36 inches Hg.
3. When vacuum is applied to top two ports, they should both open at 19.69 inches Hg.
4. When two uppermost ports are open to atmosphere, valve should be closed.
5. If valve does not operate as described above, it should be replaced.
Page 1986
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4213
Once you have set the target position, DO NOT reset it at anytime during the alignment process.
6. Begin the alignment procedure.
^ Follow all of the instructions for your particular equipment.
^ Refer to the Service Manual for alignment specifications.
If your equipment requires "rolling compensation". follow these additional tips:
^ DO NOT push or pull on the vehicle body.
IMPORTANT:
After performing "rolling compensation", DO NOT reset the target position.
When performing "caster sweep". follow these tips:
Page 4905
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Page 1518
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Classification: BF87-030
Reference: TS87-145
Date: September 28, 1987
PAINT SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Paint spotting incidents occurring in the U.S. market are not unique to Nissan, but are being
experienced by all manufacturers. To date, two separate types of paint spotting incidents have
been identified as follows:
1. Particulate Fallout - Tiny solid particles which collect on horizontal panels, causing a dark stain
which will penetrate into the paint if not cleaned.
2. Water Spotting - A ringlet or multiple water-drop-shaped light discoloration on dark painted
horizontal panels.
THESE TYPES OF SPOTTING ARE NOT DUE TO PAINT DEFICIENCY, AND CAN BE
PREVENTED THROUGH PROPER CARE.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Particulate Fallout
Ash, dust, soot and other tiny solid particulate matter from industrial and other sources can be
carried many miles. Particulate fallout is most noticeable on the horizontal surfaces (hood, luggage
compartment lid, and roof) of the vehicle.
If left on a moist, painted surface, the particles will slowly dissolve and bond to the paint, frequently
leaving a red stain. This stain can be present even on plastic surfaces such as bumpers if the
fallout has an iron content. These spots may be visible on both solid and metallic paints (especially
light colors). The particulate can be felt as a sharp point on the paint surface. When viewed through
a magnifying lens, the staining may be evident.
VEHICLE CARE
Every 10 days, or more frequently depending upon local conditions, particulate fallout must be
washed off with mild detergent and water to prevent its bonding and staining action. A good
carnuba wax coating can help protect against damage from particulate fallout.
PARTICULATE FALLOUT REPAIR PROCEDURE
In most cases, thoroughly washing the affected area with a water and mild detergent solution (to
avoid scratching the finish with dislodged particles) will remove the particulates.
After washing the vehicle, a stain, generally orange or red, may still be visible on white or other
light colored vehicles. This stain can be removed with a fine compound material. DO NOT APPLY
THE COMPOUNDING MATERIAL BEFORE ALL PARTICLES IN THE AFFECTED AREA ARE
REMOVED BY THOROUGH WASHING.
Water Spotting
A photograph of typical water spotting is shown on page 26 of the Nissan Paint Refinishing Guide*
(PIN 5REFGD). The spots are most visible when viewed at an angle, usually under fluorescent
light. The paint surface is usually smooth to the touch because the spotting is a change in the top
surface itself. This is not hard-water residue which will wash off with soap and water. These spots
are visible on both solid and metallic paints with dark colors.
VEHICLE CARE
When a vehicle is stored outside and unprotected, dust patterns develop on the painted surfaces.
These patterns guide moisture droplets from a light rain or morning dew to the same location each
time. The strong sunlight, repeatedly concentrated on these water droplets, greatly contributes to
the spotting. When storing a vehicle unprotected, where the painted surface is repeatedly exposed
to a combination of sunlight and light rain (or morning dew), the vehicle MUST be washed AND
thoroughly dried at least every two weeks, or more frequently if there is light rain or dew followed
by strong sunlight.
Locations
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations
A/C Components.
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Technical Service Bulletin # 04-054C Date: 110406
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Classification: WT04-004C
Reference: NTB04-054C
Date: April 6, 2011
WHEEL ALIGNMENT INFORMATION
This bulletin has been amended to correct some typographical errors in SERVICE INFORMATION.
No other changes have been made. Discard all previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
Warranty Claim Information: In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the
following item MUST be attached to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
General Information and Recommendations
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When performing a wheel alignment it is important that you read and follow all of the instructions
supplied with your alignment equipment.
^ The information in this bulletin is not intended to be complete wheel alignment instructions.
^ Use the information in this bulletin as a supplement to the instructions for your equipment.
General Information and Recommendations
1. Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should always be performed.
^ This type of alignment is recommended for all Nissan vehicles.
^ The four-wheel thrust process ensures that the vehicle is properly aligned, and helps ensure
proper "centering" of the steering wheel.
2. Use the right alignment machine.
^ You must use a quality alignment machine that will give accurate results when performing
alignment checks.
^ Refer to the Nissan TECH-MATE Service Equipment Catalog for recommended alignment
equipment.
^ The alignment rack itself should be capable of accepting any Nissan vehicle. The rack should be
checked to ensure that it is level.
3. Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
^ Your alignment equipment should be regularly calibrated in order to give accurate readings.
^ If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged, calibration should
be checked immediately.
^ Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended
service/calibration schedule.
NOTE:
In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the following item MUST be attached
to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3031
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 4273
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
Specifications
Fig. 7 Fuel System Pressure Specifications
Page 3879
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 5285
2. Mix a solution of water and remover into a bucket. The solution should be mixed at 1 part
remover to 8 parts of water. Using a clean wash mit, gently spread the solution onto the vehicle
with long sweeping strokes.
The remover works chemically, so there is no need for rubbing the surface at this point.
Caution: the use of any chemical other than the one supplied to remove the paint guard coating,
(KATS UL 6000), may make the coating harder to remove and it could damage the paint.
3. Keep the solution wet for 3 to 5 minutes. Don't let it dry.
Apply additional solution to areas which begin to dry too quickly.
4. Rinse with water.
This rinses off the coating and remover.
Page 3186
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2409
Fig. 6 Idle Speed Control
Page 340
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Testing and Inspection
Air Induction Valve (AIV): Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect air induction hose at air induction pipe side. Suck or blow hose to make sure that air
flow does not exist.
2. Connect a vacuum handy pump to the air induction control valve.
3. Suck or blow air induction hose to make sure that air flows only on the air induction pipe side
while control valve is operated. 4. Check air induction valve and air induction control valve for
binding or damage. If necessary, replace.
Page 300
Inspection Procedure
Page 1274
Crankshaft: Specifications
Rod Journal Diameter 1.5733-1.5738 in
Main Journal Diameter 1.9661-1.9671 in
Main Bearing Clearance
Note: Nos. 1, 3 and 5, 0.0012- 0.0022; nos. 2 and 4,
0.0012- 0.0036.
Crankshaft Endplay .002-.007 in
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Page 4501
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 55
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 4606
Fig. 335b A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 4326
Power Steering Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Recommended Fluid DEXRON ATF
Page 566
2. Position vehicle on the front turn plates as follows:
^ Stop vehicle just behind the turn plates.
^ Center the turn plates to the tires.
^ Move the vehicle onto the turn plates by turning/pushing the rear wheel.
DO NOT push/pull on the vehicle body.
Page 4558
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 4525
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Page 4999
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Page 2990
Page 2348
This chart indicates appropriate pin voltages for the ASCD system:
Page 1009
Charging System - No Crank, Dead Battery Incidents
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Charging System - No Crank, Dead Battery Incidents
Classification: Section:
EL88-007 Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-085
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar XE Date: June 2, 1988 DEAD BATTERY INCIDENTS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar XE vehicles may experience repeated no restart incidents
resulting from dead batteries after, low speed driving conditions with heavy accessory load. This
may be due to insufficient alternator output. As a countermeasure, a higher output alternator (70
amp) is available to replace the 60 amp alternator. When installing the 70 amp alternator, a
countermeasure adjusting bar and fan belt must also be installed.
NOTE: Before installing a new alternator verify that the charging system is working correctly.
PARTS INFORMATION WARRANTY INFORMATION
Refer to Section EE of the Warranty Flat Rate Manual. R&R; adjust bar and fan belt is included in
R&R; alternator flat rate time.
Page 4513
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Page 3619
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 3310
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2632
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 2096
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5246
When washing any vehicle, it must be out of direct sunlight and the painted surfaces should be cool
to the touch.
WATER SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
The method of repairing a water spotted finish varies with the severity (depth of spot in finish) of the
spotting. After a thorough washing, perform the following:
1. Water spots on light colored vehicles and some vehicles which have had minimal exposure to
the elements can be repaired by buffing. First, apply a fine cutting compound using an orbital buffer
to remove a thin layer of the top coat or clear coat. After removal of the spots, buff with glazing
compound to remove the fine scratches.
2. More severe spotting can be removed with a coarser cutting compound followed by finer
compound and glazing compound to remove the scratches.
3. The most severe water spots on clear coated, dark vehicles can be repaired by wet sanding the
affected areas with 1200 grit sandpaper to prepare the surface then spraying a fresh clear coat on
those areas. Non-clear coated vehicles should be repairable with either step 1 or 2.
* Available through Dyment Distribution Services.
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transaxle Fluid Capacity 6.6 qt (US)
Approximate, Make final check with dipstick.
Page 2863
EGR Control Solenoid: Description and Operation
Fig. 52 Vacumm switching valve.
This valve is activated by current from the vacuum switch for the purpose of supplying vacuum to
the EGR control valve from the vacuum reserve tank.
Page 1279
Procedure
1. Remove engine undercover on right side only.
2. After the engine coolant and engine components have cooled down, drain engine coolant from
radiator and remove threaded freeze plug. (For plug location refer to application chart section
"Location".
3. Apply a thin layer of gasket sealant (Nissan P/N 999MP-A7007) on both sides of the gasket.
Slide it over the engine block heater threads.
4. Install engine block heater to engine block being careful not to damage the threads. Torque
heater to 32 +/- 4 ft.lb. (4.5 +/- 0.5 kg.m.).
5. Connect power cord to engine block heater and route cord as follows:
A. From engine block heater route cord down, between drive shaft and engine block, toward front
of the vehicle between exhaust pipe and engine oil pan (Figure 2). Attach cord to engine block ear
on left side of compressor with a tie wrap. Continue routing cord along the left side of the
compressor and attach it to the compressor high pressure hose (rubber portion) with a tie wrap.
Page 3334
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4086
^ Batteries installed in vehicles produced in Japan have a JIS number embossed in the plastic on
top of the battery.
^ These vehicles have a VIN that begins with the letter "J".
Batteries with CCA (Cold Cranking Amps) Number
^ Batteries installed in vehicles produced in North America have a CCA number displayed on the
label attached to the top of the battery.
^ These vehicles have a VIN that begins with a number: 1, 3, or 5.
Selecting CCA or JIS in the GR-8 Battery Tester
Vehicles with JIS Battery
^ Select JIS, then choose the option that matches the first five (5) characters of the JIS number on
the battery.
NOTE:
DO NOT select CCA when testing a JIS battery.
Vehicles with CCA Battery
^ Select CCA, then choose the option that matches the number following "Cold Cranking Amps" on
the battery.
Reference Material
The following information can be printed and attached to the GR-8, if needed.
Page 603
^ Make sure the rear slide plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the slide plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
5. Make sure the lock pins for the front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates" are in place.
NOTE:
Lock pins should remain in place until caster sweep.
The Alignment Process
The Alignment Process
IMPORTANT:
Use only the alignment specifications listed in the appropriate Service Manual when adjusting the
alignment.
1. Make sure the vehicle is straight on the alignment rack.
^ Vehicle must be straight (in line) with the alignment rack before entering the rack as shown in
Figure 4.
^ Do not straighten the vehicle while on the rack (see Figure 5).
^ If the vehicle needs to be straightened, exit the alignment rack, straighten the vehicle and then
re-enter the rack.
^ Once the vehicle is straight on the rack, do not turn/center the steering wheel-keep the front
wheels straight.
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Models All Models
Section General Information
Classification G191-005
Bulletin No. NTB91-049
Date May 16, 1991
A CLARIFICATION OF TOE SPECIFICATIONS FOR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
APPLIED MODELS: All
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Toe, front or rear, is the position of the tire and wheel assembly in relation to the center line of the
vehicle, as viewed from the top. This alignment measurement influences the track holding
characteristics of the vehicle. Incorrect Toe alignment can cause excessive tire wear.
Nissan service manuals give toe specifications as either "total toe-in" or "total too-out." Total toe-in
or -out, means that one-half (1/2) of the listed dimension should be applied, equally, to each wheel.
^ Toe-In is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the front (Figure 1a).
Page 1897
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 436
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 2338
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 308
Page 4746
b. Evacuate and recharge system, then check for leaks.
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Classification: BR87-005
Reference: TS87-103
Date: June 29, 1987
DISC BRAKE NOISE INFORMATION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models with disc brakes (front or
rear)
SERVICE INFORMATION Some Nissan vehicles may exhibit brake noise under certain driving
conditions. This Bulletin provides some information about normal and common noises and
appropriate service procedures for each noise. Some of this information may be useful when
explaining brake noises to the customer.
Refer to Technical Bulletin BR87-006, "Disc Brake Noise Countermeasure", for information about
abnormal brake noises on Maxima, Stanza, and Stanza Wagon. General Brake Information Nissan
brake systems have been carefully designed to provide optimum braking performance under
various driving conditions. One of the most important components in the brake system is the brake
pad material. The following factors have been taken into consideration to select the best pad
material. ^
technical and government regulations
^ stopping distance
^ vehicle control while braking
^ high operating temperatures
^ pedal force
^ pad and rotor wear rates
^ moisture resistance
^ friction coefficient stability
^ operating noise level
Unfortunately, there is no one brake pad material that provides perfect performance in all of these
areas. Changing the material to improve some factors often causes a performance reduction in
other areas. Higher brake operating noise levels in some instances occur as a result of factors
which ensure proper brake performance and safety.
Common Brake Noises
The following brake noises occur most frequently on Nissan vehicles. These noises do not indicate
any malfunction or improper operation. 1.
GROANING NOISE AT LOW MILEAGE (0-300 MILES) ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during medium speed stops (20-40 mph)
^ noise usually does not occur on the first or second stop
^ noise occurs with warm or hot brakes (not cold)
^ there may be a low frequency "judder" vibration
Nissan applies protective coatings to the brake rotors and pads to reduce corrosion during shipping
and storage. These coatings may cause this groaning noise until they are worn off. Under normal
driving conditions, this usually takes about 300 miles. If this noise occurs during the first 300 miles,
it is not necessary to attempt any repairs. Service Procedure:
There is no service procedure to eliminate this noise permanently. Replacing the brake pads or
machining the rotors may cause the noise to disappear temporarily, but it will return and continue
until the coatings are worn off the rotor and pads. 2.
GROANING NOISE (AFTER 300 MILES)
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 5278
on the towel to avoid scratching the paint with any loosened iron particles.
3. Apply Finish Kare # 883 directly from the bottle using the applicator provided. Keep the affected
areas wet for 5 minutes and allow the solution to lift the particles. Agitate gently, but do not rub as
this will scratch the color coat or clear coat of paint. Reapply # 883 to spots which start to dry
before rinsing
CAUTION:
Do not exceed the 5 minute soak time as this solution may damage the paint or trim.
4. Rinse thoroughly with tap water, dry and inspect the surface.
5. Reapply # 883 as often as needed to remove more difficult spots.
6. When all iron particles are removed, wash with Finish Kare # 118SC (Neutralizer and Shampoo)
and rinse thoroughly. Gently dry with a fresh towel. Do not use towels used in the above steps, as
they may have iron particles in the nap and could scratch the color coat or clear coat.
F. Inspect For Damage Severity
After washing and iron particle/chemical removal are performed on the test section, inspect the
surface to determine the severity of damage. Levels 2 and 3 are determined using abrasive
removal on test sections on each affected panel.
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and/or indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier
with a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp and a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is easily done with an 8X
and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Level 1 No damage, the contamination did not penetrate the paint surface and washed off using
the detergent and water and the iron particle remover.
Level 2 Minor damage, the contamination did not penetrate more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Abrasive cleaning will resolve.
Level 3 Substantial damage, the contamination penetrated more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Re-color and clear coat is necessary
G. Abrasive Cleaning
IMPORTANT:
All iron particles and acids must be removed and the surface neutralized with the above procedure
before proceeding. Iron particles and acids which remain will not be fully removed by abrasive
cleaning. Small amounts of contamination will wick moisture into the clear coat or through a
re-color/clear coat and cause blistering
The goal of abrasive cleaning is to remove the damaged layer of color coat or clear coat (up to 0.5
mil in thickness) using the least abrasive process. The steps below demonstrate the sequence of
operations to use on the test section to identify the severity of damage and the repair needed.
1. Measure paint film thickness.
2. Polish and evaluate. If OK Polish all affected surfaces. If NG go to step 3.
Also determine film thickness removed.
3. Buff and evaluate. If OK Buff and then polish all If NG go to step 4.
affected surfaces.
Also determine film thickness removed
4. Wet sand and evaluate. If OK wet sand then buff and If NG go to step 5.
polish affected surfaces
Also determine film thickness removed.
5. Re-clear/color coat after neutralizing surfaces.
6. Apply color coat and clear coat if damage is completely through clear coat
NOTE:
Polishing to remove buffing or swirl marks requires a foam finishing pad on a dual action sander.
Page 2776
Air Induction Valve: Testing and Inspection Air Injection Valve Case
1. Disconnect vacuum hose to vacuum motor and connect a hand vacuum pump to the hose.
2. Disconnect vacuum hose between air injection valve case and box.
3. Apply vacuum to vacuum motor and attempt to blow into air injection valve case through the
hose. Air should flow freely only when vacuum is applied to the vacuum motor.
Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Classification: WT06-002
Reference: NTB06-076
Date: November 7, 2006
PRECAUTIONS FOR HANDLING CHROME TYPE WHEELS
APPLIED VEHICLE: All Nissan vehicles with chrome type wheels
SERVICE INFORMATION
The appearance of chrome type wheels can be damaged if they are not handled correctly during
wheel and tire service.
Tire Changing:
^ Make sure to use tire changing equipment that clamps (secures) the wheel from the inside
(internal jaws).
^ Do not use any metal tools that may touch the outside of the wheel.
^ Tools and machine equipment that touch the outside of the rim should be made of plastic, or
have rubber/plastic protective covers.
Wheel Balancing:
Page 1398
Timing Belt: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Timing belt
1. Visually check the condition of the timing belt. Replace if any abnormality is found.
Belt tensioner and return spring
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 4968
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Page 3627
^ before removing the extension adapter hose from the cooler Outlet hose,
^ turn the can over and spray only propellant for a few seconds to avoid fluid spilling back out of the
cooler hose.
5. Tie a common white, basket-type coffee filter to the end of the cooler Inlet hose (see Figure 10).
6. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 11).
7. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 11).
8. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the cooler Outlet hose to
force any remaining cleaner or fluid into the coffee filter (see Figure 11).
9. Remove the coffee filter from the end of the cooler Inlet hose.
10. Proceed with Inspection Procedure.
Inspection Procedure
Recall 95V103002: Safety Belt Buckle Release Button
Seat Belt Buckle: Recalls Recall 95V103002: Safety Belt Buckle Release Button
The front safety belt buckle release buttons can break. These red plastic release buttons are
marked "press." If a button breaks, pieces can fall into the buckle assembly causing the buckle to
operate improperly. The safety belts would not provide adequate protection to an occupant in a
vehicle crash.
Owners should promptly check the condition and operation of both front safety belt buckles and
carefully inspect the red release button for any breaks or cracks. They should ensure that both
buckles are operating properly by inserting each latch plate into its buckle, tugging on the belt to
make sure the latch is securely locked, and then pressing the release button. The latch plate
should pop out of the buckle when the button is pressed. If either release button shows a sign of
breaking or cracking or if either buckle fails to operate properly, owners should promptly contact
their authorized dealer to schedule an appointment to have the buckle replaced or repaired free of
charge.
System: Interior; Seat Belts; Belt Buckles.
Vehicle Description: Passenger, Multi-Purpose Vehicles and Light Duty Trucks Equipped with
Safety Belts made by Takata Corporation.
NOTE: If your vehicle is presented to an authorized dealer on an agreed upon service date and the
remedy is not provided free of charge within a reasonable time, please contact NISSAN at
1-800-647-7261. Also contact the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
Page 4998
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Locations
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
Lower Left Corner Of Radiator
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2554
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Service and Repair
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair
1. Remove air cleaner duct at air cleaner on 200SX models, as required.
2. Loosen idler pulley locknut, turn adjusting nut counterclockwise, and remove power steering
pump drive belt. On some air conditioned models, remove air conditioning compressor drive belt.
3. Loosen power steering hoses at pump and remove bolts securing power steering pump to
brackets.
4. Raise pump and disconnect power steering hoses. Catch fluid in a suitable container, plug hose
ends and ports in power steering pump, and remove pump from vehicle.
5. Reinstall power steering pump by reversing procedure and bleed system as follows:
a. Raise and support front of vehicle. b. Run engine for 3-5 seconds, stop engine, check and fill
power steering pump reservoir as needed. c. Quickly turn steering wheel all the way to right and
left 10 times. d. Start engine and idle for 3-5 second. Stop engine, check and fill power steering
pump reservoir as needed. e. With steering wheel all the way to the right, open bleeder screw, to
expel air and tighten bleeder screw. f.
Repeat procedure until all air has been bled from system.
g. If air cannot be bled completely after repeated attempts, repeat step e with engine running.
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 4556
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications Lubricant Capacity
Lubricant Capacity
Refrigerant Oil Capacity 6.8 oz (US)
Refrigerant Oil Type SUNISO 5GS
Page 3235
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 2471
9. Use compressed air to remove any metal debris from inside the boss threads.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
10. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
11. Spray the boss threads with rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
12. Run a thread chaser through the boss to clean the threads.
^ Use Kent Moore part number J-43897-18 or J43897-12.
Page 2359
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Seat Belts - Extender Availability
Seat Belt Extension: Technical Service Bulletins Seat Belts - Extender Availability
Models All Models
Section Body & Frame
Classification BF87-026
Bulletin No. TS87-114
Date July 27, 1987
FRONT SEAT BELT EXTENDERS, LONGER FRONT SEAT BELTS
This Technical Bulletin contains a complete list of seat belt extenders and longer seat belt sets
currently available for use on all Nissan Models except 1987 Maxima vehicles with automatic seat
belts. These assemblies should be used when body size or driving position do not allow for proper
fit of the factory installed lap-shoulder belts. Use the information in this bulletin in place of that
found in previously issued Technical Bulletin BF86-012 (TS86-082). Make note of this on page
BF-30 of the 1986 Technical Bulletin Reprint Manual.
When a customer requests information regarding better fitting seat belts:
^ Inspect the original lap-shoulder belt assembly to ensure proper function. Refer to Section MA of
the appropriate model Service Manual.
^ Inform the customer that the extenders/longer seat belts are designed for his/her specific use
only. Individuals who can use the standard seat belt may not receive full restraint system protection
when using an extender/longer belt.
^ If a longer belt is installed, return the old belt to the customer for use if and when the extended
length belt is no longer required.
Listed below are the revised part numbers for the extenders and longer seat belts with the applied
models. These belts should be provided to the customer free of charge, and should be ordered
through the Parts Department system. They are available only in black.
I. EXTENDERS
PART NUMBER APPLIED MODEL
86848-01A00 *1974-78 B210 (NSK Warner) 1975-78 280ZX
1974-76 610 1976-78 F10
1974-77 710 1977-80 810
86848-01A01 1979-81 210 (2-Door) 1979-81 280ZX 1979-81 310
86848-01A02 1981 Maxima
I. EXTENDERS (CONTINUED)
PART NUMBER APPLIED MODEL
86848-01A03 1982 210 (2-Door) 1982-84 Maxima
1982 310 1982-83 280ZX
86848-01A04 1984-86 300ZX 1986-87 Stanza Wagon
1985-87 Maxima
86848-01A05 *1974-76 B210 (Takata) 1976-78 620
86848-01A06 *1977-78 B210 (Takata) 1979 Truck 1977-79 200SX
86848-01A07 1979-82 210 (4-Door) 1980-81 200SX
86848-01A08 1982.5-86 Sentra (4-Door) 1987 Pathfinder 1983-86 Pulsar (4-Door) **1983-87 Truck
1982-86 200SX (Applied date: prior to 2/86)
86848-01A09 1980-82 Truck
Page 764
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3040
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: Customer Interest A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 2238
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 5313
T-Top: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 2461
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 3960
1. Before using the rotor driving unit ensure that all lug nuts are installed on the lugs (including the
lugs not used for the lug adaptor). All lug nuts
should be evenly torqued, to at least 40 ft/lbs. Do not over-tighten the lug nuts as damage may
occur to the lug adaptor legs.
2. To prevent chatter and ensure a smooth rotor finish, install the largest and heaviest silencer
band possible around the outside diameter of the rotor.
ROTOR CUTTING Before engaging the cutting tool, ensure the following:
1. Using the dial indicator, measure rotor/hub run-out prior to resurfacing rotor and adjust cutting
depth to eliminate this run-out. Each cut may be
between 0.05 mm and 0.25 mm (0.002" and 0.010"). Additional cuts may be necessary to eliminate
all the run-out.
2. Using a micrometer, measure rotor thickness in at least 8 even locations around the rotor. Do
not cut below the minimum rotor thickness
specification. Replace rotor if the run-out cannot be eliminated without exceeding the minimum
rotor thickness specification.
3. After rotor resurfacing is completed, measure the rotor/hub run-out using a dial indicator. Ensure
that the run-out is below the specification for the
vehicle. If run-out is not within specifications, turn the rotors again. Properly machined rotors will
have almost zero run-out (.001" or less) with no measurable thickness variation.
CAUTION: When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from
contacting or collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the
ABS wheel speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE: If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on
the car brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect
alignment during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications.
This could require the rotor to be turned again.
4. Do not smooth the rotor surface with sand paper or other abrasive material.
Page 3588
1. Inspect the coffee filter for debris (see Figure 12).
A. If small metal debris less than 1 mm (0.040 inch) in size or metal powder is found in the coffee
filter, this is normal. If normal debris is found, the radiator/oil cooler can be re-used.
B. If one or more pieces of debris are found that are over 1 mm in size and/or peeled clutch facing
material is found in the coffee filter (see Figure 13), the oil-cooler is not serviceable. The radiator/oil
cooler must be replaced.
Final Inspection:
After performing all procedures, ensure that all remaining oil is cleaned from all components.
Page 985
Comments regarding vacuum pump use:
^ The lubricant contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the lubrication for R-134a
A/C systems.
^ The vent side of the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure, causing the vacuum
pump lubricant to migrate out of the pump if the pump is switched oft after evacuation (vacuuming)
and there is no shut off valve between the pump and the hose.
^ To prevent the migration of vacuum pump lubricant into service hoses, it is necessary to use a
valve (which can be manually opened or closed) near the connection of the service hose to the
pump.
^ On a vacuum pump which is equipped with an isolation valve (usually part of the vacuum pump),
closing this valve will isolate the service hose from the pump.
^ For pumps without an isolation valve, be certain that the service hose is equipped with a manual
shut off valve near the pump end of the hose.
^ Hoses which contain an automatic shut off valve at the end of the service hose must be
disconnected from the vacuum pump to prevent the migration of lubricant; as long as the hose is
connected, the valve is open and lubricant may migrate (with pump off).
^ One-way valves which open when vacuum is applied and close under a no vacuum condition are
not recommended, because this valve may restrict the pump's ability to pull a deep vacuum.
Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Towing Information: By Symptom Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Classification: GI88-023
Reference: TS88-150
Date: November 17, 1988
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
APPLIED VEHICLES All Models 1987-1989
SERVICE INFORMATION The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h.
and distances of less than 40 miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when
towing Automatic Transmission vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following
limitations apply when towing Manual Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for
example behind a motor home.)
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
Page 3834
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 4780
^ The graph on the following page shows that PAG oil left open to air (e.g. in an unsealed
container) will absorb 2% moisture (by weight) in 120 hours (5 days).
^ PAG containers, and any A/C component which contains PAG oil (such as the compressor)
should remain tightly capped and sealed until ready for use.
^ If you believe that a container of PAG oil may not have been adequately re-sealed after opening,
dispose of the oil properly and use oil from a new sealed container.
^ When installing or servicing an A/C system, the refrigerant tube and hose connections should be
sealed (all connections made and tightened to specification) without delay.
^ The above precautions will keep the absorption of moisture into the system to a minimum. Using
moisture saturated PAG oil in R-134a systems may lead to the formation of acids and related
system damage or failure.
^ Do not allow refrigerant oil (Nissan A/C System Oil Type S) to contact styrofoam, as the lubricant
will damage this material.
Specifications
Fig. 7 Fuel System Pressure Specifications
Page 5198
Page 473
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 1524
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 4768
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
Refer to ``Condenser, Replace'' procedure.
Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Classification: WT06-002
Reference: NTB06-076
Date: November 7, 2006
PRECAUTIONS FOR HANDLING CHROME TYPE WHEELS
APPLIED VEHICLE: All Nissan vehicles with chrome type wheels
SERVICE INFORMATION
The appearance of chrome type wheels can be damaged if they are not handled correctly during
wheel and tire service.
Tire Changing:
^ Make sure to use tire changing equipment that clamps (secures) the wheel from the inside
(internal jaws).
^ Do not use any metal tools that may touch the outside of the wheel.
^ Tools and machine equipment that touch the outside of the rim should be made of plastic, or
have rubber/plastic protective covers.
Wheel Balancing:
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1526
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications System Capacity
System Capacity
Refrigerant Capacity 1.8-2.0 lb (US)
Refrigerant Type R-12
Page 5135
2. Grind the surface of the repair with 36 grit disc. Grind about 11/2" around the actual damage to
obtain a taper for best adhesion.
3. Featheredge the paint around the repair with 180 grit disc. Wipe with a clean, dry rag and blow
off with air.
4. Apply one wet coat of Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter over the sanded surface and allow to dry for
10 minutes.
IMPORTANT: It will be necessary to reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter after any sanding step.
5. Mix Flexible Parts Repair Material according to the instructions and apply to the repair with a
squeegee, building it up higher than the undamaged area. Allow it to cure for 20-30 minutes at
60-80~F.
6. After curing, sand with 180 grit disc followed by 240 grit disc.
Page 536
Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Main Harness Part 1
Page 1005
Comments regarding liquid tanks:
^ For R-134a, the sight glass has been deleted. Refer to the service procedures section of this
bulletin for additional information regarding the refrigerant charge determination. Pressure switches
are not interchangeable between R-12 and R-134a systems.
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise
Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Page 201
Fig. 335b A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 4200
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 4669
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 3621
Workflow
Page 5453
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Page 1112
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Page 2636
Page 2364
Fig. 303d Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 2221
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Spark Plug Construction
PURPOSE
Ignites the combustion mixture.
LOCATION
Screwed into the cylinder head, at the combustion chamber.
OPERATION
The spark plug provides a path for the high current of the secondary circuit to flow to ground. The
only paths for this current are through the ground electrode and center electrode across the spark
gap. The spark produced when the current jumps the gap and ignites the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinder.
Spark Plug Heat Range
CONSTRUCTION
The temperature of the spark plug is determined by the length of the insulator and the size of the
heatsink area. The longer the insulator is, the smaller the heatsink area will be and this will cause
the spark plug to be hotter.
Page 1207
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 925
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type API GL-4
Fluid Viscosity SAE 75w-90
Page 345
Page 344
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 4902
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Page 4028
Brake Shoe: Adjustments Parking Brake Adjust
1. Pull parking brake lever with a force of 44 lbs. and ensure lever travels 6-7 notches on 1984-86
Sentra and Pulsar, 7-8 notches on 1984-86 Stanza, 7-11 notches on 1987-88 Pulsar, 11-13
notches on 1987 Stanza and 1987-88 Sentra, or 9-11 notches on 1988 Stanza.
2. Rotate adjuster until proper stroke is obtained, then tighten locknut.
Fig. 6 Parking brake adjustment. 1987-88 Maxima, Pulsar, Sentra & Stanza
3. Parking Brake Adjuster View
Page 2332
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 93
Digital signals are ON-OFF (Hi-Low) voltage pulses. This signal is a typical digital signal.
Examples of common digital signals are:
Battery Voltage The ignition switch in the ACC or ON position provides a battery voltage signal to
several control units. This informs the control unit of the ignition position.
Switch to Ground A door switch is a common example of a switch to ground. When the door is
opened the door switch completes the circuit. The interior light is turned on. In addition, the time
control unit is sent an OFF signal indicating the door is open.
Pulse Voltage A pulse voltage is made up of alternating high and low voltage signals of varying
duration. These signals are counted by the control unit within a predetermined time frame.
Analog Input Signals
An analog signal is a voltage that varies over a period of time. Analog signals are produced by
sensors in the vehicle. Sensors change resistance to deliver variable voltage signals. The Oxygen
Sensor sine wave signals shown are typical analog signals. These charts are example signals
printed using CONSULT.
^ The first chart shows an Oxygen Sensor lean (low voltage) condition.
^ The second chart is a normal Oxygen Sensor voltage printout.
^ The third chart illustrates an Oxygen Sensor rich (high voltage) condition.
Examples of common sensors are:
Temperature Sensors Temperature sensors change resistance with a change in temperature. This
temperature is converted into an analog voltage range.
Page 218
Fan Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 68 Testing fan switch.
1. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch and check continuity with ohmmeter.
2. Meter should indicate continuity as shown in Fig. 68.
Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Classification: EM95-01
Section: Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB95-017
Date: February 8, 1995
ENGINE OIL LEVEL AND GRADE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
The cause of some driveability incidents is incorrect oil level or viscosity. Whenever you evaluate a
vehicle for a driveability problem, check the oil level first. (It is a good practice to check oil level on
every vehicle that you work on.)
Overfilling may cause engine vibration or valve train clatter on vehicles with hydraulic lash
adjusters due to oil aeration when the crankshaft hits the oil. Using the wrong viscosity oil can
cause rough or low idle resulting from improper operation of the hydraulic lash adjusters.
When you add or change the engine oil, follow the service manual recommendations regarding
proper oil fill level. Do not overfill the crankcase. If you find a vehicle to be overfilled with oil, drain
the excess oil and dispose of properly. Remember to wait ten (10) minutes after refilling before
checking. This allows time for the oil to drain back to the pan.
Always use the proper viscosity oil specified by the service manual for the temperature range in
your geographic area. The viscosity specifications ensure proper engine operation and best engine
efficiency.
Page 4775
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Warranty Claim Reimbursement
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN
WB/90-010
Date: June 25, 1990 TO:
ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT REIMBURSEMENT WARRANTY POLICY
As a result of the implementation of the new refrigerant recycling equipment, the National Warranty
Department has adopted the following policy pertaining to warranty claim refrigerant
reimbursement.
1. When requesting reimbursement for newly added refrigerant, reimbursement use the special
part number LOCALFREON.
2. When requesting reimbursement for use of recycled refrigerant, use the special part number
LOCALRECYC.
3. In both cases, up to $4.00 may be claimed for each quantity of one (1). Note:
Quantity 1 = 1 lb.
4. A quantity of two (2) is the maximum allowed per repair ($8.00 total).
This policy is effective immediately. Should you have questions pertaining to refrigerant
reimbursement, please contact your District Service Manager or Regional Parts & Service
Department.
Page 2671
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1783
Fig. 303d Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 2206
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
Ignition Wire Visual Inspection
1. Visually inspect the ignition wires for the following:
a. Insulation for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... b. Insulation for cracks or
breaks. c. Insulator boots for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... d. Insulator
boots for cracks or breaks. e. Terminal ends for corrosion, cracks or looseness.
Ignition Wire Resistance Test
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance between the terminal ends.
Resistance: Less than 30k ohms
Replace the wire if it fails the above test.
Page 4497
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 2551
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Specifications
Fig. 7 Fuel System Pressure Specifications
Page 610
^ DO NOT push/pull on the tire to perform the caster sweep.
7. Make sure the steering wheel is centered when performing toe-in measurements and
adjustments.
NOTE:
If you are using a Hunter alignment machine equipped with the WinToe(R)-Adjustment System:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The WinToe(R) system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ Bumping the tire or re-centering the steering wheel when adjusting "near frozen" tie rods is not
necessary. This makes the adjustment process faster
and easier.
^ WinToe(R) eliminates the effect of lash in the steering system.
If you are using a John Bean alignment machine equipped with EZ Toe:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The EZ Toe system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ This software routine is an improved method of setting front toe, making it easier to obtain a
centered steering wheel.
^ With EZ Toe, it is possible to adjust toe with the steering wheel turned at any angle left or right.
This is helpful when setting toe on engine wall
mounted rack and pinion units.
IMPORTANT:
If during the alignment process the vehicle was lifted off of the rack; after lowering, make sure to
jounce (bounce) the vehicle before confirming adjustments are correct.
After you have checked and adjusted vehicle alignment
8. Print the BEFORE and AFTER measurements and attach them to the Repair Order.
9. Road test the vehicle to make sure the steering wheel is "centered" when driving on a straight
flat road.
Page 2164
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4224
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Description and Operation
Ignition Rotor: Description and Operation
Distributor Rotor
The rotor makes the connection between the center terminal and the correct spark plug terminal of
the cap as it is turned by the distributor.
Page 919
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Recommended Fluid Nissan ATF Or DEXRON ATF
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 1280
NX: Route cord under radiator core support and out to the front of the vehicle through right side
opening of front lower grille. Secure cord to grille with tie wrap (Figure 3).
Sentra: Route cord up and toward the right, through the opening behind right head lamp, between
the two legs securing the front grille to the radiator core support. Secure cord to vertical member of
front grille with a tie wrap (Figure 4).
CAUTION: Make sure that power cord is not routed close to or touching any of the vehicle's moving
parts or hot surfaces.
6. Refill cooling system; pressurize to radiator cap relief pressure and check for leaks. Operate
engine to check further for leaks. Refer to manufacturer's Service Manual "Engine Cooling System"
section.
NOTE: It is recommended that low phosphate anti-freeze be used and that a maximum
anti-freeze/water mixture ratio of 50/50 be used. Refer to Nissan Owner's Manual "Engine Cooling
System" section.
7. Reinstall engine undercover.
8. Use cable end protector cap when heater is not plugged into power source.
PART NUMBER: 99998-10282CA
APPLICATION
MODEL ENGINE TYPE YEAR LOCATION ELEMENT
DIRECTION
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 300ZX
VG30E 1986 Driver side, first 6 o'clock
VG30DE & later plug from the rear
VG30ET (1)
Locations
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
On Brake Lever
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3862
Fig. 6 AD18V type front disc brake disassembled
Brake Pad, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Remove lock pin, Figs. 4, 5 and 6, and pivot caliper body upwards.
3. Remove pad retainers, then the pads.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Install inner pad, then pull cylinder body out and install outer pad.
Caliper, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Disconnect brake hose from brake tube.
3. Remove caliper attaching bolts, then the caliper assembly from vehicle.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Caliper Overhaul
1. Separate cylinder body and torque member, Figs. 4, 5 and 6.
2. Remove brake hose, then press out piston with dust seal and retainer ring.
3. Remove piston seal, guide pin and lock pin from torque member.
4. Reverse procedure to assemble.
Page 1888
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
(CHECK ENGINE LIGHT ITEM)
Wiring Diagram
The following is necessary to perform this inspection.
1. Pull out E.C.U. from under the passenger seat.
2. Warm up engine sufficiently.
Page 1909
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 3020
Page 3728
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 3083
Inspection Procedure
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Page 1496
Page 5373
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Page 841
Ignition Rotor: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Rotor
1. Remove the screws securing the distributor cap to the distributor.
2. Confirm that the rotor does not turn on the distributor shaft.
3. Remove the rotor.
4. Visually check the rotor for signs of "Burn Through" from the electrode to the distributor shaft.
5. Check the input (center) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
6. Check the output (outer) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
7. Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between the input (center) electrode and the output
(outer) electrode. Replace the rotor if it fails the above tests.
Page 3008
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4277
Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Top Of Transaxle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2171
All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
Page 2673
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Ignition Rotor: Description and Operation
Distributor Rotor
The rotor makes the connection between the center terminal and the correct spark plug terminal of
the cap as it is turned by the distributor.
Wheel Fastener Torque Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Lug Nuts 72 - 87 ft.lb
Page 609
^ Apply the brakes as shown.
^ Start the engine to allow brake boost.
^ Turn the engine OFF,
^ Remove all lock pins-front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates".
^ Make sure the bridge plate will not interfere with movement of the turn plate.
Put the bridge plate in the down position.
^ Perform caster sweep by turning the steering wheel from outside the vehicle.
Page 4415
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 3109
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 3101
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5053
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE # 9
SYMPTOM: Zone continuity
Page 193
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Service and Repair
THERMO SWITCH
Replace
On Pulsar models, thermo switch is located in radiator lower tank. On Sentra models, thermo
switch is located on center left side of radiator tank.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Drain cooling system into suitable container.
3. Disconnect thermo switch electrical connector, then remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Fig. 1 Testing thermo switch (typical)
Testing
1. Remove thermo switch as outlined above.
2. Connect suitable ohmmeter across switch terminals, then immerse lower part of switch in water,
Fig. 1. Ohmmeter should indicate an open circuit.
3. Place thermometer in water and heat. When water temperature reaches approximately 185°F,
switch contacts should close and the ohmmeter should indicate continuity.
4. If switch does not operate properly, replace it.
Page 645
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Technical
Service Bulletin # 08-097D Date: 110426
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Page 5451
License Plate Bulb: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 293
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Page 870
Page 1686
Catalytic Converter: Service Precautions
a. After installation, check that mounting brackets and mounting insulator are free from undue
stress. If any of above parts are not installed properly,
excessive noises or vibrations may be transmitted to vehicle body.
b. When connecting flanges, use a new gasket to eliminate gas leakage at the joint. c. Check all
tube connections for exhaust gas leaks, and entire system for unusual noises, with engine running.
d. When connecting rear exhaust tube and Main Muffler, use Genuine Nissan Sealant "Exhaust
Sealant Kit 20720-N2225", or an equivalent to
eliminate gas leakage at the joint.
Page 3312
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2077
Specifications
Differential: Specifications
Bearing Preload
Turning Torque (New Bearing)
Page 3373
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 2439
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 647
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
Page 4297
^ Make sure the rear slide plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the slide plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
5. Make sure the lock pins for the front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates" are in place.
NOTE:
Lock pins should remain in place until caster sweep.
The Alignment Process
The Alignment Process
IMPORTANT:
Use only the alignment specifications listed in the appropriate Service Manual when adjusting the
alignment.
1. Make sure the vehicle is straight on the alignment rack.
^ Vehicle must be straight (in line) with the alignment rack before entering the rack as shown in
Figure 4.
^ Do not straighten the vehicle while on the rack (see Figure 5).
^ If the vehicle needs to be straightened, exit the alignment rack, straighten the vehicle and then
re-enter the rack.
^ Once the vehicle is straight on the rack, do not turn/center the steering wheel-keep the front
wheels straight.
Service and Repair
Heater Core: Service and Repair
Fig. 12 Exploded view of instrument panel. 1987-88 Sentra
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect heater hose at firewall connections of heater core.
3. Remove instrument panel, Fig. 12.
Page 3096
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2365
Engine Control Module: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 3443
Power Transistor: Description and Operation
The ignition signal from the E.C.U. is amplified by the power transistor, which turns the ignition coil
primary circuit on and off, inducing the proper high voltage in the secondary circuit. The ignition coil
is a small, molded type.
Page 4971
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 915
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Level Caution
Classification: Section:
AT89-008 Automatic Transmission
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-091 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra 1987-1989 Pulsar NX
Date: June 30, 1989
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
SERVICE INFORMATION
As with all Nissan vehicles with Automatic Transmissions (and as specified in all Nissan Owner's
and Service Manuals), it is especially important that the automatic transmission fluid (ATF) for the
3-speed RL3F01A automatic transmission (used on 1987-1989 Sentra and Pulsar XE models) be
maintained at
the proper level.
CAUTION: Both overfilling and underfilling may cause damage to the transmission.
Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
Filler Plug 18-25 ft.lb
Drain Plug 18-25 ft.lb
Testing and Inspection
Air Filter Element: Testing and Inspection
Viscous paper type air cleaner filter does not require any cleaning operation until it is replaced
periodically. Brushing or blasting operation should never be conducted, because it causes clogging
and results in enrichment of the mixture ratio.
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 1504
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2560
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Page 5327
1. Remove rear luggage compartment floor.
2. Raise rear carpet to gain access to the four seat back hinge screws. After removing the screws,
the seat back may be removed.
3. Remove lower seat cushion.
4. Remove rear seat back hinges.
5. Remove front quarter panel trim.
6. Remove rear end panel trim.
7. Remove quarter panel lower trim and discard (this will be replaced.)
8. Remove front seat belt upper anchors.
9. Remove upper quarter panel trim.
10. Locate the drilling point in the back side of the upper quarter panel trim as shown below. It is
the lightly scribed circle between the coat hanger mount and hatch support notch.
11. Using a hole saw, drill a 1" hole in the trim piece at the marked location.
12. Remove original lap belts (female buckle side).
13. Install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit. Torque mounting bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Speedometer Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Classification: EL88-008 Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-094
Models: 1987-88 Sentra/Pulsar
Date: July 11, 1988
SPEEDOMETER CABLE NOISE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra, 1987-88 Pulsar except 1988 Pulsar SE
APPLIED VINs: JAPAN BUILT SENTRA Before JN1PB22SXJU 028662
04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB24SXJU 044462 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB22SXJU 574774 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB21SXJU 555932 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB26SXJU 016707 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25SXJU 021285 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25YXJU 005931 04/01/88 production
U.S. BUILT SENTRA 1987 1988
All
PULSAR Before JN1PN34SXJM 500050
05/01/88 production
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987-88 Sentra and Pulsar vehicles may exhibit a rattle or buzzing noise from the center of
the instrument panel at engine speeds of 2500-3500 RPM.
If a customer complains of this type of noise, perform the following diagnostics to determine if the
speedometer cable is the cause.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to verify speedometer cable noise:
1. Start engine with transmission in neutral (M/T) or park (A/T). Raise RPM to 3500 and hold for
5-10 seconds.
2. Listen for rattling or buzzing from the speedometer head area.
3. Return engine to idle and turn off ignition.
4. Disconnect speedometer cable from transaxle and let hang. Be sure to position the cable so that
it isn't touching the engine or transaxle.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3.
If the noise can be heard in Step 2, but is not present during Step 5, replace the speedometer
cable assembly with the improved (insulated) cable assembly listed below. If the noise is still
present, reinstall the speedometer cable and contact the FIXS Hotline for additional information.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART DESCRIPTION NEW PART NUMBER FORMER PART NUMBER
Speedometer 25050-01Y00 25050-60A01
Cable Assembly 25050-60A00
Page 3655
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Note: Preload adjustment of wheel bearing is not necessary.
Rear Wheel Bearing
1. Tighten wheel bearing lock nut to:
137 - 188 ft lbs (186 - 255 Nm)
2. Check bearing for smooth operation.
3. Check axial end play. Should be:
.002in (0.05mm) or less
Page 4275
Page 1047
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 1794
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
With New Filter 3.4 qt (US)
Without New Filter 3.0 qt (US)
Page 805
Page 626
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 1614
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant Tester - Calibration
Classification: Section:
EM90-009 Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB90-093 Models: All Date: October 18, 1990 COOLANT
TESTERS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION: Evaluations have shown that some after-market coolant testers
displayed inaccurate readings which were, in some cases, off by as much as 10~F.
SERVICE INFORMATION: When coolant concentrations are in question, the following advice is
recommended to dealers:
1. Select a name-brand tester, preferably from a specialty tool supplier.
2. Prior to usage, calibrate the coolant tester:
^ Prepare a "known" mixture of exactly 50% fresh anti-freeze and exactly 50% fresh water. Keep
this mixture in a clean, sealed container to use for calibration purposes.
^ To calibrate a coolant tester, draw from the above "known" mixture when it is at room
temperature (65-75~F). Use a "Magic Marker" to place a mark on the coolant tester for the "known"
50/50 mixture.
^ Also, be sure that the coolant you wish to test is between 65-75~F. This means that you may
have to wait for the temperature of the coolant to fall within this range.
NOTE: During extremely hot weather, it may be impractical to wait for the coolant to fall within the
65-75~F range. However, the coolant tester can be re-calibrated for the new, "hot weather"
temperature using the "known" 50/50 mixture - provided both this 50/50 mixture and the coolant are
at ambient temperature.
3. Measure the vehicle's coolant concentration using the calibrated mark on the coolant tester as
an indication of a proper 50/50 solution.
NOTE: Technicians should be equally concerned if the coolant concentration is too high as well as
too low. High coolant concentrations reduce the ability of the coolant to transfer heat, which, in
some cases, may lead to over-heating. In extreme cases, the coolant can sludge and restrict flow
in the radiator.
4. After use, clean the tester by flushing it with fresh water.
NOTE: Testing has shown that, if not properly cleaned, a non-soluble residue remains on the
bouyant devices of the tooters after drying. This residue can effect the density of the bouyant
devices and, consequently, effect the tester's accuracy.
If there are any further questions regarding coolant concentrations, please contact your Technical
service Manager (TSM). The TSM's have access to laboratory-grade hydrometers.
Page 1087
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 490
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Page 4132
Alternator: Specifications
Rated Output 60 A
Test Output 50 A at 2500 rpm
Page 2647
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Page 2868
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Vacuum Switching Valve
Fig. 22 Vacuum switching valve air flow
Page 275
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 776
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2534
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 4916
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Page 3014
Service and Repair
Ignition Lock: Service and Repair
Fig. 3 Ignition lock replacement
The ignition lock is retained by two shear type screws, Fig. 3. It is necessary to drill out these
screws to remove ignition lock from steering tube. When installing, ensure that the shear type
screws are used.
Page 51
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VE30DE
MAXIMA (A32) VQ30DE
Page 2355
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Page 2147
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2277
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 2175
BASIC CHARACTERISTICS
An ON-duty signal is fed to the I.S.C. valve in response to the water temperature.
STARTING CORRECTION
A starting correction signal is added in response to the water temperature for improved engine
startability. This function continues for several seconds after the engine starts.
IDLE SPEED FEEDBACK CONTROL
When the following conditions are met after the starting correction has been completed, the idle
speed feedback control function operates. (1) Idle switch-ON (2) Neutral switch - ON or below 8
km/h (5 MPH) (vehicle speed) *: When battery voltage of less than 12 volts continues for a few
seconds, the target idle speed will be maintained higher, in order to improve
charging function. (M/T only)
Page 2125
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Classification: EM95-01
Section: Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB95-017
Date: February 8, 1995
ENGINE OIL LEVEL AND GRADE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
The cause of some driveability incidents is incorrect oil level or viscosity. Whenever you evaluate a
vehicle for a driveability problem, check the oil level first. (It is a good practice to check oil level on
every vehicle that you work on.)
Overfilling may cause engine vibration or valve train clatter on vehicles with hydraulic lash
adjusters due to oil aeration when the crankshaft hits the oil. Using the wrong viscosity oil can
cause rough or low idle resulting from improper operation of the hydraulic lash adjusters.
When you add or change the engine oil, follow the service manual recommendations regarding
proper oil fill level. Do not overfill the crankcase. If you find a vehicle to be overfilled with oil, drain
the excess oil and dispose of properly. Remember to wait ten (10) minutes after refilling before
checking. This allows time for the oil to drain back to the pan.
Always use the proper viscosity oil specified by the service manual for the temperature range in
your geographic area. The viscosity specifications ensure proper engine operation and best engine
efficiency.
Page 2731
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
A/T - Fluid Application
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Application
Classification: AT96-001
Reference: NTB98-042
Date: May 15, 1998
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
This amended version of NTB95-055 updates information regarding the Recommendation ATF
usage.
Please disregard previous NTB95-055 and NTB93-065.
SERVICE INFORMATION
IMPORTANT NOTE:
Nissan Matic "D" ATF must be used in performing repairs paid by Nissan, such as warranty,
service contract, or goodwill repairs. Nissan will not reimburse dealers for repairs when
non-genuine Nissan Matic "D" is used.
For current and prior production Nissan vehicles, front wheel and/or rear wheel drive, only Nissan
Matic "D", or other ashless petroleum based ATF, is formulated to meet the requirements of Nissan
automatic transmissions and automatic transaxles. Nissan Matic "D", or other ashless petroleum
based ATF, assists in ensuring transmission durability, smooth driveability, low exhaust emissions
and customer satisfaction.
Only an ashless type petroleum based ATF should be used to repair Nissan vehicles because
other types of ATF may contain compounds which adversely affect transmission performance.
Specifically, ash will impact friction response. In addition, ATF with ash is likely to have a higher
Zinc (Zn) content. Zinc will adhere to clutch linings and cause slippage, resulting in transmission
damage.
For ordering procedures, please refer to the "Dealer Confidential Parts Price List".
Testing and Inspection
Expansion Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 8 Expansion Valve Diagnosis Chart
Faulty expansion valves will be indicated by low suction and discharge pressures on the manifold
gauge set. In most cases the power element fails and the valve closes. Occasionally the inlet
screen becomes clogged with contamination or desicant beads loose in the system.
Page 2387
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5091
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Page 2873
EGR Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 6 EGR control valve.
Fig. 7 EGR control valve.
Page 1628
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Service and Repair
THERMO SWITCH
Replace
On Pulsar models, thermo switch is located in radiator lower tank. On Sentra models, thermo
switch is located on center left side of radiator tank.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Drain cooling system into suitable container.
3. Disconnect thermo switch electrical connector, then remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Fig. 1 Testing thermo switch (typical)
Testing
1. Remove thermo switch as outlined above.
2. Connect suitable ohmmeter across switch terminals, then immerse lower part of switch in water,
Fig. 1. Ohmmeter should indicate an open circuit.
3. Place thermometer in water and heat. When water temperature reaches approximately 185°F,
switch contacts should close and the ohmmeter should indicate continuity.
4. If switch does not operate properly, replace it.
Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tire - Replacement Caution 4WD & All-Wheel Drive
Models: 4WD & All-WD Models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT89-002
Bulletin No.: TS89-061
Date: April 13, 1989
4WD & ALL-WHEEL DRIVE TIRE REPLACEMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-89 Sentra (B12) 1986-88 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1980-Truck (720, D21)
1987-89 Pathfinder (WD21) 1990 Axxess (M11)
SERVICE INFORMATION
When customers inquire about tire replacement for Applied Model vehicles, please remind them of
the recommended guidelines in their respective Owner's Manual.
TIRE REPLACEMENT CAUTION:
^ Always use tires of the same size, brand, construction (bias, bias-belted or radial), and tread
pattern on all four wheels. Failure to do so may result in a circumference difference between tires
on the front and rear axles which will cause excessive tire wear and may damage the transmission,
transfer case or differential gears.
^ If excessive tire wear is noted, Nissan recommends that all four tires be replaced with tires of the
same size, brand, construction and tread pattern. The tire pressure and wheel alignment should
also be checked and corrected as needed.
^ If you install snow tires, they must also be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern
on all four wheels.
^ Use only the spare tires specified for each 4WD or all-wheel drive models.
A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Classification: HA93-014
Reference: NTB93-132
Date: September 12, 1993
WHITE FLAKES FROM VENTS
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Sentra (B13) and Altima (U13)
APPLIED DATE(S): Sentra built before 7/29/93 Altima built before 7/29/93
SERVICE INFORMATION Some air conditioning units may exhibit white flakes blowing from the
vents for a short time when the air conditioning is first turned on. The flakes are 1 mm or less in
diameter and fall on interior surfaces like a light snow. This incident can be resolved by replacing
the evaporator with an improved unit according to the procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the appropriate Service Manual instructions to replace the evaporator with the countermeasure
unit listed on the following page (there is no new part number -- check for the proper date stamp
indicated in the Parts Information section). When installing the new evaporator into the vehicle,
make sure that the evaporator case drain tube is correctly aligned to the drain hose and that there
are no obstructions.
NOTE:
To minimize the flakes remaining in the heater and air conditioning system, vacuum or blow out
with compressed air any visible flakes in the heater assembly before reinstalling the new
evaporator assembly. Warm soapy water may be used to clean the inside of the evaporator case,
heater case, and all ductwork.
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 94
Vehicle Speed Sensor The vehicle speed sensor produces an alternating voltage signal. This
alternating signal (analog) is converted to a digital signal for processing.
The control unit can only process digital signals. Analog signals must be converted to a digital form
before the information can be used by the control unit.
Control Unit Logic
The control unit processes digital signals in two forms. To the control unit the signal is either ON or
OFF. In computer logic an ON or high voltage signal is a "1" and an OFF or low voltage signal is a
"O". The control unit uses combinations of these signals to control its outputs. The controller uses
inputs from many sensors to determine what outputs it will make and at what time it will make
them. These outputs control a variety of functions from automatic speed control to engine
driveability.
Outputs
An output is simply an action the control unit tells an electrical component to make. Based on the
calculations the control unit makes of the inputs, it will signal an action. The output can tell a
component to perform a function for a period of time.
Power and Ground Control
The ECU controls either a component's power or ground. To understand this, refer to the diagrams.
If the ECU is between the electrical component (load) and the power source, the ECU controls its
power.
^ If the component is between the power source and the ECU, the ECU controls the component
ground.
VOLTAGE DROP TEST
Service and Diagnosis Precautions
Before diagnosing any electronic controlled circuits the following cautions should be followed:
1. Make sure the following parts and systems are in good condition and are operating properly. ^
Battery output
^ Battery terminals
^ Grounds
^ System connectors are properly positioned and connected
2. Never use a test lamp to check an electronically controlled circuit.
3. Do not drop, jar or shake electronic components.
Follow the trouble diagnosis charts in the appropriate section of the Service Manual to isolate
which component may be the incident part.
Voltage Drop Tests
Voltage Drop Tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance.
A voltage drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation. Part of the
available voltage is used by the resistance. When there is excessive resistance, less voltage is
available for other loads (lights, motors, etc.) in the circuit. Since each resistance in a circuit uses
voltage, a voltmeter can be used to isolate the cause of the problem.
A voltage drop across closed contacts can indicate excessive resistance. This can cause the circuit
to operate incorrectly. Remember, a switch is not a load. During diagnosis, use a voltmeter to
measure the voltage drop across each switch contact while the circuit is in operation.
Page 3137
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
With New Filter 3.4 qt (US)
Without New Filter 3.0 qt (US)
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision Damage
Wheel Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision
Damage
Classification: FA10-006
Reference: NTB10-126
Date: October 21, 2010
WHEEL BEARING COLLISION DAMAGE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Impacts to wheel bearings (such as a collision or other suspension damage) may create slight
indents in the bearing surfaces. These indents may not be visible but can cause bearing noise.
NOTE:
Hub/bearing replacement due to impact (collision or other suspension damage) is not a
warrantable repair
If a vehicle has visible wheel or suspension damage due to impact (collision or other suspension
damage), it is recommended that the wheel bearing assembly be inspected as follows:
1. Remove the hub/bearing assembly from the vehicle.
2. Hold the hub/bearing assembly with both hands.
3. Rotate the hub/bearing assembly in both directions (clockwise and counterclockwise).
4. If any gritty or rough feeling is detected in the bearing replace it with a new one.
Page 616
When the specification is labeled "Toe-Out" and the dimensions are positive (+) numbers (ie: 2 to 6
mm), the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 3).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-out specification = Toe-Out wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-Out
specification = Toe-In wheel setting.
4. Rear Toe is adjustable on some Nissan vehicles with independent rear suspensions. Usually,
the adjustment, itself, is not difficult but, it is extremely important.
Nissan uses two (2) different terms to describe "Rear Toe". "Toe-In" and "Toe-Out". Contemporary
wheel alignment equipment measures rear "Toe-In" and, if the wheels are actually "Toed-Out",
displays the measured values as a negative (Figure 4).
5. Toe is measured as a distance or as an angle. When measuring toe as a distance, it is found by
measuring the difference between the center of the front of the tire and the center of the rear of the
tire at spindle height. The difference between the distances is Total Toe.
When measured as an angle, the center line of the vehicle is zero degrees (0~, 0.00~, or 0~00')
and the angle of a line drawn through the center of the tire and wheel, as viewed from the top, is
the Toe angle for the individual wheel.
6. Nissan Total Toe specifications are given two (2) ways:
Distance: Millimeters and Decimal Inches
Angle: Degrees and Minutes
Diagrams
Oil Pump
Page 1725
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 4212
5. Make sure the targets are mounted correctly.
^ Mount the top claws first.
^ Claws must be flush against the wheel as shown in Figure 13.
^ Target must be flush against the center support as shown in Figure 14.
^ Make sure the targets are positioned with the arrow UP or level.
IMPORTANT:
Testing and Inspection
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Testing and Inspection
With engine running at idle, remove ventilation hose from P.C.V. valve; if valve is working properly
a hissing noise will be heard as air passes through it and a strong vacuum should be felt
immediately when a finger is placed over valve inlet.
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Page 4982
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Page 3032
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4262
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
With Heater Automatic Transmission 5.6 qt (US)
Manual Transmission 5.0 qt (US)
Without Heater Automatic Transmission 5.0 qt (US)
Manual Transmission 4.4 qt (US)
Page 2161
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 4407
When replacing transverse link and/or radius rod, refer to Fig. 25 and note the following:
1. Before removing transverse link attaching bolts, scribe alignment mark on adjusting pin.
2. After installing transverse link, adjust wheel alignment as described in ``Wheel Alignment
Section.''
3. When installing radius rod bracket, ensure arrow points forward.
Locations
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
On Brake Lever
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1036
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration
Correction
Classification: BR94-002 Section: Brake Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB94-012 Models:
All models Date: February 3, 1993
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
GENERAL INFORMATION:
Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in any vehicle when excessive
rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in thickness between the thickest and thinnest
points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy.
However, excessive Rotor Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is
the excessive rotor thickness variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is
described in more detail below.
POSSIBLE CAUSE OF BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of
events occur:
Page 1184
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 3293
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5384
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 1493
Locations
Ignition Coil Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2133
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Page 2993
Page 659
4. Hold position of cam and torque nut to 83-98 ft. lbs.
5. Ensure toe-in is still within specifications.
1987-88 Sentra
Fig. 2 Rear Toe-in Adjustment.
Rear toe-in is adjusted by rotating the cam bolts which secure the rear parallel link to the
crossmember.
1. Measure total toe-in and toe-in for each wheel following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. Scribe matching mark between cam and parallel link, then loosen nut securing cam bolt.
3. Rotate cam bolt(s) as needed, Fig. 7, to obtain specified toe-in. On graduation on scale varies
toe-in approximately .08 inch. Ensure that total toe-in is within specifications and divided equally
between left and right wheels.
4. Hold position of cam bolt(s) and torque retaining nuts to 72-87 ft. lbs.
5. Ensure toe-in is still within specifications.
Page 3466
Spark Plug: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 640
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 547
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Specifications
Fig. 2 Ignition Coil Specifications
Page 2361
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Fig. 303a Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 1399
1. Check belt tensioner for smooth turning. 2. Check the condition of tensioner spring.
Altitude Compensation
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Compensation
Altitude compensation prevents deterioration of exhaust emissions caused by an enriched air/fuel
mixture. Atmospheric pressure varies according to the altitude. The higher the altitude, the lower
the atmospheric pressure. At an atmospheric pressure of approximately 26 in. Hg or below, the
altitude switch transmits an ``On'' signal to the control unit, decreasing fuel to provide an
appropriate air/fuel mixture ratio.
Page 5011
2. The antenna sleeve should release from the antenna assembly when the rod is removed. If the
antenna sleeve is bound, the rod may not release after the removal of the nut and base. In this
case, use pliers to carefully remove the antenna sleeve (with the radio "OFF"). After the antenna
sleeve is removed, continue with the procedure to remove and replace the antenna rod.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Submit a Primary Failed Part (PFP) claim using the coding as shown.
Page 114
Fig. 303d Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 4504
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
System Diagnosis
Air/Fuel Mixture: Testing and Inspection
PREPARATION
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
- Battery
- Ignition system
- Engine oil and coolant levels
- Fuses
- E.C.C.S. harness connectors
- Vacuum hoses
- Air intake system (oil filler cap, oil level gauge, etc.)
- Fuel pressure
- A.I.V. hose
- Engine compression
- E.G.R. valve operation
- Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is
"OFF". 3. When measuring "CO" percentage, insert probe more than 40cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe.
Overall Inspection Procedure
Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN
WB/88-007
Date: April 18, 1988 TO:
ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: TIRE ASSISTANCE CUSTOMER/DEALER HOTLINE
This is a revised list of the Tire Assistance Customer/Dealer Hotline telephone numbers. Please
discard warranty bulletin (WB/88-004) issued on February 3, 1988.
The following general information toll-free telephone numbers may be used to assist you with your
tire replacement needs:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-423-4544 (Except California) 1-800-221-8744 (Inside California)
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-800-662-0200 (Except New York) 1-800-334-4646 (Inside New York)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
For customer assistance or emergency tire orders, please use the telephone numbers listed below:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-722-9888
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-716-879-8494 (Mr. Wagner 8:30am-5:00pm EST) 1-213-781-2001 (Mr. Yanacek
2:00pm-5:00pm PST)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
If you have further questions pertaining to tires, please contact your District Service Manager or
Regional Service Department.
Page 3196
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Fuel Pump Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 4809
Comments regarding condensers:
^ The parallel flow condenser can be identified by the refrigerant end tanks, and smaller, more
closely spaced center section tubes.
Page 789
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
Lower Left Corner Of Radiator
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid 1.0 - 1.1 qt (US)
Page 3421
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4928
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 2415
Idle Speed Control Valve: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Do not pour oil or solvent into the I.S.C. valve.
- Do not disassemble I.S.C. valve.
- Do not peck the valve portion of I.S.C. valve.
1. Check resistance between the terminals.
(A) - (B) : 9.5-10.5 ohms (B) - (C) : 8.5 - 9.5 ohms
2. Confirm insulation between each terminal and I.S.C. valve body.
3. Apply battery voltage between (B) (+) and (C) (-) and confirm the opening of I.S.C. valve.
Valve: Fully closed.
4. Apply battery voltage between (B) (+) and (A) (-) and confirm the opening of I.S.C. valve.
Valve: Fully open.
5. Check opening clearance of I.S.C. valve without applying voltage to terminals.
Opening clearance: 0 - 2 mm (0 - 0.08 in)
Page 361
Inspection Procedure
Page 2697
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1138
Page 4997
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Page 1972
Inspection Procedure
Page 429
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 3318
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 3324
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 4304
^ DO NOT push/pull on the tire to perform the caster sweep.
7. Make sure the steering wheel is centered when performing toe-in measurements and
adjustments.
NOTE:
If you are using a Hunter alignment machine equipped with the WinToe(R)-Adjustment System:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The WinToe(R) system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ Bumping the tire or re-centering the steering wheel when adjusting "near frozen" tie rods is not
necessary. This makes the adjustment process faster
and easier.
^ WinToe(R) eliminates the effect of lash in the steering system.
If you are using a John Bean alignment machine equipped with EZ Toe:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The EZ Toe system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ This software routine is an improved method of setting front toe, making it easier to obtain a
centered steering wheel.
^ With EZ Toe, it is possible to adjust toe with the steering wheel turned at any angle left or right.
This is helpful when setting toe on engine wall
mounted rack and pinion units.
IMPORTANT:
If during the alignment process the vehicle was lifted off of the rack; after lowering, make sure to
jounce (bounce) the vehicle before confirming adjustments are correct.
After you have checked and adjusted vehicle alignment
8. Print the BEFORE and AFTER measurements and attach them to the Repair Order.
9. Road test the vehicle to make sure the steering wheel is "centered" when driving on a straight
flat road.
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4474
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 1929
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 113
Fig. 303c Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 1503
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2549
This chart indicates appropriate pin voltages for the ASCD system:
Page 3376
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 633
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
Page 4676
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair
When replacing compressor clutch, use care as not to scratch or bend pulley.
Fig. 1 Exploded view of Atsugi compressor
1. Place compressor assembly, Fig. 1, in a suitable holding device.
Fig. 2 Removing center bolt
2. Retain clutch disc, using tool No. KV99231010, then remove center bolt, Fig. 2.
3. Remove clutch disc using tool Nos. KV998VR001 and KV99231010, Fig. 2.
Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory
Set
Classification: Section: Front Axle
FA89-004 & Suspension
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-150 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra, Pulsar NX, 1989-1990 240SX
Date: October 19, 1989 FRONT STRUT KIT CAMBER
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1989 Sentras (B12) 1987-1989 Pulsar NX (N13) 1989-1990 240SX
(S13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
New Front Strut Kits supplied for the Applied Models are now manufactured with the camber
already set at factory specifications. The adjustable eccentric pin contained in the previously
available kit assemblies has been eliminated. Please note that the new kits will retrofit on a model
by model basis, and adjustment is not required when retrofitting.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 4096
NOTE:
^ The BSC is equipped with a scanner that can be used to scan the VIN on most vehicles.
^ Scanning the VIN will give the tester the [CCA rating] information for original equipment batteries.
^ For replacement batteries, the [CCA rating] from the battery label must be entered into the BSC
manually.
For Nissan Original Equipment Batteries:
^ When using the BSC, make sure the correct vehicle [CCA rating] is entered by scanning the VIN,
or entering it manually from the battery label.
NOTE:
If the VIN cannot be scanned, enter it manually.
^ Make sure to select "ORG EQUIPMENT" on the tester.
^ The [CCA RATING] entered during testing is recorded in the 12-character test output code
required for warranty repairs.
^ Claims that are submitted with incorrect [CCA RATING] may be suspended or denied.
Genuine Nissan Replacement Batteries (service part replacements for Nissan Original Equipment
Batteries):
^ Scan the VIN, select "GEN REPLACEMENT", then Manually enter the CCA rating from the
battery label into the BSC.
NOTE:
If the VIN cannot be scanned, enter it manually.
IMPORTANT:
When using the BSC, you will get inaccurate test results if you don't enter the correct [CCA
RATING]
^ The [CCA RATING] entered during testing is recorded in the 12-character test output code
required for warranty repairs.
^ Claims that are submitted with incorrect [CCA RATING] may be suspended or denied.
Disclaimer
Page 5197
^ Before installing new glass, remove adhesive tape from base.
^ Warm up lip of base and back of new glass.
^ Put new glass on warmed lip of glass base. CAUTION:
Put glass on lip evenly; if not done properly, it is possible to damage the glass and glass base.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART NAME NEW PART NO.
FORMER PART NO.
Replacement glass (L) See pages 3
N/A
(R) and 4 N/A
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 873
2. With the engine running at idle and the AC turned ON, observe the pulley axial/lateral (back and
forth) movement (see Example 2):
^ Maximum movement specification is 1 mm.
^ Visual comparison of movement with a known good vehicle is recommended.
Idler Pulley / Manual Tensioner Inspection (if equipped)
No more than 1 mm of pulley rock should be visible.
Alternator One-way Clutch Pulley Inspection
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage the rotor.
NOTE:
The following steps can be done while the alternator is installed on the vehicle if the drive belt is
removed and the alternator electrical connectors are disconnected.
1. Secure the rotor using a medium size screwdriver and a rolled shop towel.
2. Turn the pulley clockwise when viewed from the front.
^ Pulley should be locked.
^ If it rotates in both directions, replace the alternator.
3. Turn the pulley counterclockwise when viewed from the front.
Page 3947
B. For best accuracy, "stabilize" (firmly support) the vehicle with a jack or jack stand as shown in
Figure 1.
^ On some hoists, the vehicle may "wobble" a little while using the on-car brake lathe. Not good.
CAUTION:
Any rocking motion (wobble) of the vehicle during the ProCut(TM) "Automatic compensation"
procedure will reduce the accuracy of the resurfacing.
^ If wobble occurs during the rotor resurfacing process/procedure, the finished rotor runout may be
more than factory specification and should be checked before using the rotor.
C. Prevent metal shavings from contacting or collecting on the ABS speed sensors.
^ Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS speed sensor's magnet. It is best to clean the ABS
sensor with the rotor removed.
D. After a rotor has been resurfaced with the ProCut(TM) brake lathe:
^ If the rotor must be removed for any reason, mark the exact location (rotor to axle hub) before
removing the rotor (see Figure 2).
^ The rotor must be reinstalled back to the same location.
E. Do not tighten the wheel lug nuts with an air impact driver.
^ Use a torque wrench to tighten the lug nuts to the proper torque specification.
^ Uneven or high torque applied to the lug nuts may "distort" (warp) the brake rotor and hub. This
may increase rotor runout and cause excessive rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op
Page 1771
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 2230
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Intake and Exhaust Valve Clearance Adjustment
Adjustment must be made while engine is warm but not running.
1. Set No. 1 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve clearance (1),
(2), (3) and (6). 2. Set No. 4 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve
clearance (4), (5), (7) and (8).
Valve clearance:
Intake and exhaust
0.28 mm (0.011 in) Tighten Pivot lock nut
16 - 21 N.m (1.6 - 2.1 kg-m, 12 - 15 ft-lb)
Page 761
Page 1542
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing Information
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing
Information
Classification: Section:
GI88-023 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-150 Models:
All models 1987-1989 Date:
November 17, 1988 TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h. and distances of less than 40
miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic Transmission vehicles with four
wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when towing Automatic Transmission
vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following limitations apply when towing Manual
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for example behind a motor home).
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES *
These are maximum distances these vehicles may be towed without damage to the gear rain. In
general, any Nissan vehicle should be started, warmed up, and driven at least two miles after it has
been towed these distances - more frequently if possible.
Page 1971
Page 2323
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 846
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 4539
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 4542
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4708
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 3713
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 1882
13. Use compressed air to remove any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
14. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
15. Tilt the manifold/catalyst/front tube so that the metal debris falls out of the part.
16. Apply compressed air through the boss to blow out any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
17. Install the new sensor as described in the applicable Electronic Service Manual (ESM).
Locations
Fig. 1 Timing Mark
Page 1530
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 627
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 4227
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 1736
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Page 4423
Fig. 11 Spring Installation Direction
Fig. 12 Installing Coil Spring
Fig. 13 Upper Spring Seat Installation Direction
10. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. Install coil spring in correct direction, Fig.
11. b. Position coil spring in lower spring seat as shown, Fig. 12. c. Install upper spring seat as
shown, Fig. 13.
2WD
Page 757
Page 4427
Fig. 1 Rear Suspension (Part 2 Of 2). 2WD Models
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove upper and lower strut attaching nuts and/or bolts Figs. 1 through 3 then the strut
assembly.
Fig. 2 Rear Suspension (Part 1 Of 2). 4WD Models
Page 1883
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4562
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 4554
Page 4257
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3871
^ while the vehicle is barely moving, with light brake pedal force
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
^ most common on vehicles with automatic transmission
This noise is common on most cars with front disc brakes. There are no repair procedures to
eliminate this noise. 3.
SQUEAKING/SQUEALING NOISE ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during low speed stops (5-20 mph)
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
This noise is common on vehicles with high-performance potential that must be able to stop in
short distances from high speeds. Other brands of brake pads may eliminate this noise, but Nissan
does not recommend them because they may have reduced pad life or inadequate performance in
high speed stops. 4.
HIGH-PITCHED SQUEAKING/SCRAPING NOISE ^
whenever brakes are applied
^ may come from just one wheel
Nissan uses pad wear indicators on many of its disc brake pads to provide an audible warning
when the brake pads need replacement. Spring steel tabs that are riveted to the brake pad scrape
lightly on the rotor surface when the pad is worn down to its lowest limit. The customer should hear
the noise at this time and bring the vehicle to the dealer for brake pad replacement. The pad wear
indicator will not damage the rotor surface if the pad is replaced in a reasonable time. Replace
worn pads with new parts. Check the rotor surface for damage and machine if necessary.
Page 408
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 3983
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 806
Idle Check and Set Procedure
Page 4811
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 383
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Models All Models
Section General Information
Classification G191-005
Bulletin No. NTB91-049
Date May 16, 1991
A CLARIFICATION OF TOE SPECIFICATIONS FOR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
APPLIED MODELS: All
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Toe, front or rear, is the position of the tire and wheel assembly in relation to the center line of the
vehicle, as viewed from the top. This alignment measurement influences the track holding
characteristics of the vehicle. Incorrect Toe alignment can cause excessive tire wear.
Nissan service manuals give toe specifications as either "total toe-in" or "total too-out." Total toe-in
or -out, means that one-half (1/2) of the listed dimension should be applied, equally, to each wheel.
^ Toe-In is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the front (Figure 1a).
Page 2702
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Description and Operation
Distributor Cap: Description and Operation
Distributor Cap
The distributor cap is used to make the connection between the rotor and the correct spark plug
wire. High tension current from the rotor is distributed to the towers of the distributor cap at a
pre-set sequence and then to the spark plug wires which carry the current on to the spark plugs.
Page 5316
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 3921
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3.
Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip on
the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid
wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4.
Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation
7.
Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation
8.
Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10.
Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based cleaners
degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the rotor
surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 1933
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3352
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5334
5. It is recommended that the rear pillar finishers are replaced with the retro-fit finishers listed in the
parts information section. However, the existing finishers can be drilled for anchor bolt access. To
modify the trim, locate the drilling point in the pillar finishers. The point is marked in the back side of
the finisher at the position as shown below.
6. Drill a 1" hole in each trim piece at the marked location using a hole saw.
7a. Using the dimensions shown in the illustration below, cut the opening in the parcel shelf for the
3-point seat belt. 7b. Install retro-fit finisher on parcel shelf ends as shown above.
8. Reinstall rear pillar finishers and check alignment of anchor bolt holes.
9. Remove lap belts (female buckle side) and install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit.
Torque anchor bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs.(3.65-4.65 kg/m).
10. Remove the retractor side of the original lap belts.
11. Remove the trunk/wheelhouse finishers to access retro-fit retractor mounting point. The finisher
must be trimmed to allow for mounting of the retractor unit. Cut finisher as shown below:
Page 715
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4896
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Page 1447
Page 2105
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Page 1446
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Testing and Inspection
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Air density becomes thinner at higher altitudes. Therefore, the carburetor produces too rich an
air/fuel mixture at higher altitudes. The altitude compensator automatically corrects air/fuel ratio to
an optimum mixture. When vehicle is operated in a high altitude environment, the bellows in the
compensator extends, causing the lever attached to the bellows to push up the needle. When the
needle is pushed up the air passage becomes wider, allowing larger amounts of air to flow from the
altitude compensator to the carburetor, thereby thinning the air/fuel mixture. Electronic Controlled
Carburetor (ECC) See: Testing and Inspection
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Low and Reverse Brake
Low & Reverse Brake
Page 3371
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 4301
5. Make sure the targets are mounted correctly.
^ Mount the top claws first.
^ Claws must be flush against the wheel as shown in Figure 13.
^ Target must be flush against the center support as shown in Figure 14.
^ Make sure the targets are positioned with the arrow UP or level.
IMPORTANT:
Page 498
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 4183
Ignition Relay: Locations Ignition Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5232
5. Dry vehicle with a chamois.
6. After rinsing - inspect the surface for drips, sags, runs and missed areas.
Page 3618
Page 159
Power Transistor: Description and Operation
The ignition signal from the E.C.U. is amplified by the power transistor, which turns the ignition coil
primary circuit on and off, inducing the proper high voltage in the secondary circuit. The ignition coil
is a small, molded type.
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Front Wheel Alignment
Alignment: Specifications
Front Caster Angle + 11/12 to +2 5/12 deg
Caster Angle Desired 1 2/3 deg
Camber Angle -1 1/12 to + 5/12 deg
Camber Angle Desired 3/4 deg
Toe -.03 to +.05 in
King Pin Inclination 14 2/3 in
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 639
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 1764
System description: When the switch is ON, the ECU lights up the lamp.
The VOLTAGE VALUE is based on the body ground.
Page 3268
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 4208
^ Make sure the rear slide plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the slide plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
5. Make sure the lock pins for the front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates" are in place.
NOTE:
Lock pins should remain in place until caster sweep.
The Alignment Process
The Alignment Process
IMPORTANT:
Use only the alignment specifications listed in the appropriate Service Manual when adjusting the
alignment.
1. Make sure the vehicle is straight on the alignment rack.
^ Vehicle must be straight (in line) with the alignment rack before entering the rack as shown in
Figure 4.
^ Do not straighten the vehicle while on the rack (see Figure 5).
^ If the vehicle needs to be straightened, exit the alignment rack, straighten the vehicle and then
re-enter the rack.
^ Once the vehicle is straight on the rack, do not turn/center the steering wheel-keep the front
wheels straight.
Diagnostic Note
Mode Door Motor: Adjustments Diagnostic Note
Whenever control cables are disconnected or heater case is disassembled for service, control
cables and operating rods should be adjusted as outlined in adjustments.
Page 1172
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 217
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 4263
Page 3048
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Page 4152
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect starter wiring from starter.
3. Remove starter retaining bolts and the starter.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 1749
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Page 2911
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper
Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 5223
The table provides a brief description of some types of paint contamination you may encounter.
Select a 2' x 2' test section to perform the following Contamination Test Removal.
C. RE-Wash
C. Re-Wash with detergent and water solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching
the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution
to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the
terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt. Replace the towel with a clean one once it
becomes soiled. Rinse with a spray of clean water. Repeat up to four times.
D. Clean
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover using a clean terry cloth towel and gentle pressure.
Repeat up to four times.
E. Applying Finish Kare
E. Apply Finish Kare to remove iron particles and acids. See procedure below:
Caution:
Attempting to buff iron particles will cause severe scratching.
1. Apply Finish Kare # 1119, solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching the finish,
do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry
before rinsing.
2. After the wash and rinse, gently dry the contaminated surfaces with the terry cloth towels to
remove the majority of the water. Use gentle pressure
Page 5252
When washing any vehicle, it must be out of direct sunlight and the painted surfaces should be cool
to the touch.
WATER SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
The method of repairing a water spotted finish varies with the severity (depth of spot in finish) of the
spotting. After a thorough washing, perform the following:
1. Water spots on light colored vehicles and some vehicles which have had minimal exposure to
the elements can be repaired by buffing. First, apply a fine cutting compound using an orbital buffer
to remove a thin layer of the top coat or clear coat. After removal of the spots, buff with glazing
compound to remove the fine scratches.
2. More severe spotting can be removed with a coarser cutting compound followed by finer
compound and glazing compound to remove the scratches.
3. The most severe water spots on clear coated, dark vehicles can be repaired by wet sanding the
affected areas with 1200 grit sandpaper to prepare the surface then spraying a fresh clear coat on
those areas. Non-clear coated vehicles should be repairable with either step 1 or 2.
* Available through Dyment Distribution Services.
Page 2146
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 3581
Workflow
Page 493
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Page 160
Power Transistor: Testing and Inspection
Power Transistor Test
Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between terminals as per the image. Replace power
transistor if it fails the above tests.
Page 4172
Ignition Relay: Locations Ignition Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 149
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 4933
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Anti-Backfire Valve
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Anti-Backfire Valve
1. Run engine until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect hose from air cleaner assembly and place a finger near outlet.
3. Momentarily increase engine speed to approximately 3000 RPM, then return to idle. If no
vacuum is felt at the air cleaner outlet, the valve is defective and must be replaced.
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance Per Cable 30 K ohms
Page 325
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1489
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications Lubricant Capacity
Lubricant Capacity
Refrigerant Oil Capacity 6.8 oz (US)
Refrigerant Oil Type SUNISO 5GS
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration
Correction
Classification: BR94-002 Section: Brake Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB94-012 Models:
All models Date: February 3, 1993
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
GENERAL INFORMATION:
Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in any vehicle when excessive
rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in thickness between the thickest and thinnest
points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy.
However, excessive Rotor Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is
the excessive rotor thickness variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is
described in more detail below.
POSSIBLE CAUSE OF BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of
events occur:
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The Fuse Panel Is Located Under LH Side Of Instrument Panel
Page 5287
7. Mix one part remover solution to one part water into a bucket. Spread solution directly onto runs,
sags and thick areas of paint guard coating.
Rewash those areas repeatedly with remover and light sponging. Coatings that smear but do not
wash off are not PGC. They're probably engine wax overspray or anti-corrosion wax drips. Use
your normal solvent to remove these.
Caution: Do not let the remover dry.
Be especially careful to watch for drips onto the top surface of the bumpers when using the 1 to 1
mixture. If the solution is allowed to dry on these surfaces, it may cause recoating of the PGC.
Force can damage the paint and other chemicals can make the coating more resistant to removal.
The mixture of 1 part remover to
1 part water is used only on thick areas. Do not use the remover without mixing it with water.
8. Thoroughly rinse and dry vehicle.
Page 3623
2. Identify which hose is the Inlet and which hose is the Outlet to the oil cooler (refer to Charts A
and B).
3. Disconnect the oil cooler Inlet and Outlet rubber hoses from the steel cooler tubes (see Figure
3).
^ For Frontier (D22) w/bypass valve, remove the oil cooler inlet and outlet rubber hoses from the
bypass valve fittings (see Figure 6 shown)
NOTE:
If rubber material from a cooler hose remains on the steel tube or fitting, replace the rubber hose.
4. Allow any transmission fluid that remains in the cooler hoses to drain into the oil pan.
5. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-A0006) into the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 4).
Page 1432
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Testing and Inspection
1. Check hoses and fuel tank filler cap. 2. Disconnect the vapor vent line connecting carbon
canister to fuel tank.
3. Connect a 3-way connector, a manometer and a cock (or an equivalent 3-way charge cock) to
the end of the vent line. 4. Supply fresh air into the vapor vent line through the cock little by little
until pressure becomes 3.923 kPa (400 mmH2O, 15.75 inH2O). 5. Shut the cock completely and
leave it unattended. 6. After 2.5 minutes, measure the height of the liquid in the manometer. 7.
Variation in height should remain at 0.245 kPa (25 mmH20, 0.98 inH20). 8. When filler cap does
not close completely, the height should drop to zero in a short time. 9. If the height does not drop to
zero in a short time when filler cap is removed, the cause is a blocked hose or a clogged fuel check
valve.
In case the vent line is blocked, the fuel tank is not vented properly causing insufficient delivery of
fuel to engine, or vapor lock. It must, therefore, be repaired.
Page 568
> Engine coolant and lubricating oils at specified levels
> Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and floor mats in designated positions
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information about any of the above checks and
inspections.
4. Check the target mounts.
^ If there is any visual damage (bent, worn, cracked, etc), have the equipment repaired before
performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the target mounts are properly adjusted and configured (see Figure 11).
NOTE:
The target mount example shown in Figure 11 is for Hunter "camera type" alignment machines.
Follow the operation manual for your specific equipment.
A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Air Register: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Classification: HA93-014
Reference: NTB93-132
Date: September 12, 1993
WHITE FLAKES FROM VENTS
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Sentra (B13) and Altima (U13)
APPLIED DATE(S): Sentra built before 7/29/93 Altima built before 7/29/93
SERVICE INFORMATION Some air conditioning units may exhibit white flakes blowing from the
vents for a short time when the air conditioning is first turned on. The flakes are 1 mm or less in
diameter and fall on interior surfaces like a light snow. This incident can be resolved by replacing
the evaporator with an improved unit according to the procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the appropriate Service Manual instructions to replace the evaporator with the countermeasure
unit listed on the following page (there is no new part number -- check for the proper date stamp
indicated in the Parts Information section). When installing the new evaporator into the vehicle,
make sure that the evaporator case drain tube is correctly aligned to the drain hose and that there
are no obstructions.
NOTE:
To minimize the flakes remaining in the heater and air conditioning system, vacuum or blow out
with compressed air any visible flakes in the heater assembly before reinstalling the new
evaporator assembly. Warm soapy water may be used to clean the inside of the evaporator case,
heater case, and all ductwork.
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 2704
Inspection Procedure
Page 3349
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Air Bleeder Screw 5 - 7 ft.lb
Page 5274
Finish Kare products are marketed by mobile distributors which will deliver the product directly to
your dealership. If a Finish Kare distributor is not located in your area, Finish Kare can be
contacted at the number above for direct shipment from their national office.
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 565
^ Make sure the rear slide plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the slide plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
5. Make sure the lock pins for the front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates" are in place.
NOTE:
Lock pins should remain in place until caster sweep.
The Alignment Process
The Alignment Process
IMPORTANT:
Use only the alignment specifications listed in the appropriate Service Manual when adjusting the
alignment.
1. Make sure the vehicle is straight on the alignment rack.
^ Vehicle must be straight (in line) with the alignment rack before entering the rack as shown in
Figure 4.
^ Do not straighten the vehicle while on the rack (see Figure 5).
^ If the vehicle needs to be straightened, exit the alignment rack, straighten the vehicle and then
re-enter the rack.
^ Once the vehicle is straight on the rack, do not turn/center the steering wheel-keep the front
wheels straight.
Page 1060
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 3400
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Models All Models
Section Body & Frame
Classification BF91-014
Bulletin No. NTB91-051
Date May 23, 1991
CARE OF LEATHER TRIM
APPLIED MODELS: All Models Equipped With Leather Trim
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Nissan currently uses Cow Hide on all vehicles equipped with Leather Interior Trim (excluding
certain 1988 Maximas which were equipped with Suede Seats). This bulletin refers only to those
vehicles equipped with Cow Hide Leather Interior Trim. Suede seat covers are made of Pig Skin
and should be cared for according to the instructions provided in the U11 Maxima Seat Care Kit
(P/N 999M1-U8000). Leather is typically used on seat surfaces, trim pieces, steering wheels, and
shift knobs in Nissan Vehicles. Maintaining a high quality appearance is best achieved by using the
procedures indicated below.
1. Occasionally, loose dust should be removed from the interior trim and seat surfaces using a
vacuum cleaner or a soft brush. The leather surfaces should be wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
2. Some leather trim, such as the leather wrapped steering wheel, may become grayish in color
with use. The original condition may be restored by rubbing the affected area with a clean soft cloth
dampened in a mild soap solution, and then wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
3. Leather seat surfaces may be regularly coated with a leather conditioner such as saddle soap.
Cautions:
Never use benzene, thinner, or any similar product on leather trim.
Never use car wax on leather trim.
Never use fabric protectors on leather trim unless recommended by the manufacturer. Some fabric
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the leather trim.
Page 3138
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Remove injector cover and pull out injector straight upward.
- Take care not to break or bend injector terminal.
INSTALLATION
- Always replace 0-rings with new ones.
- When installing, smear a little of engine oil to 0-rings.
1. Install lower 0-ring.
2. Install fuel injector and push it using suitable tool (or a socket head of 13 mm).
- Align the direction of the injector terminals.
- Take care not to bend injector terminal.
3. Install upper 0-ring and push it using suitable tool (or a socket head of 19 mm). 4. Install upper
plate (white one).
5. Install injector cover with rubber plug removed.
- Make sure that two 0-rings (small one and big one) are installed in the injector cover.
6. Check the proper connection between injector terminal and injector cover terminal, then install
rubber plug.
Page 3858
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 5256
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Repairs of environmental contamination discovered and reported at the time of vehicle delivery to
the dealership can be claimed utilizing procedures outlined in Warranty Bulletin WB92-003 dated
January 24, 1992.
Outline of Procedures
A. Wash with detergent such as (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), then dry.
B. Identify the type of contamination using fluorescent lights and magnification. If paint over-spray
is found, a specialized repair process is needed.
If paint contamination other than paint over spray is suspected, test a 2' x 2' section on each
affected panel as follows to determine the severity of damage and repair effort needed:
C. Re-wash several times to remove detergent and water soluble spots. If spots are removed,
wash affected panels.
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover for solvent soluble spots. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
E. To remove iron particles and acid rain residue, use Finish Kare # 1119 followed by # 883 (apply
# 883 several times if necessary) and always neutralize with # 118SC.
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Page 2319
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
Page 5332
5. Remove rear speaker assembly.
6. Remove rear end panel finisher.
7. Remove rear wheelhouse trim.
8. Locate the scribed mark in the quarter panel upper finisher as shown below.
9. Using a hole saw, drill a 1" hole in the trim piece at the marked location.
10. It is recommended that the rear wheelhouse finishers are replaced with the retro-fit finishers
listed in the parts information section. However, the existing finishers can be trimmed for belt
access as follows: NOTE:
Be sure to cut all the way through to the rear edge. This will allow the belt to slide into the slot for
installation.
11. Remove original lap belts (female buckle side).
12. Install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit. Torque anchor bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
13. Remove the retracting side of the original lap belts.
14. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed in two steps. First, install the retractor unit
end of the shoulder harness by installing the mounting bolt and locating screw. Then bolt the
shoulder anchor into the quarter panel upper finisher where the 1" hole was drilled. Torque
mounting bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
15. Reinstall wheelhouse trim.
16. Secure seat belt access finisher to wheelhouse trim.
17. Reinstall rear end panel trim.
Page 2570
Engine Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Wiring Diagram
Page 2060
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Tools - Essential Tool Release, Engine, A/C
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Essential Tool Release, Engine, A/C
Classification: T&E95-03;
Reference: NTB95-030
Date: March 22, 1995
ESSENTIAL TOOL RELEASE
SERVICE INFORMATION
During the week of February 6, 1995, all Nissan dealers were sent the following special tools as
part of the Essential Service Tool Program.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. J41471 Variable Timing Control (VTC) Sprocket Rebuild Kit. This kit provides the necessary
tools to rebuild the VTC intake camshaft sprockets on the VE30DE engine. The initial shipment of
this tool has been provided to all Nissan dealers at no charge. Additional kits can be purchased
through the Tech-Mate Service Equipment and Special Tools program by calling 800-NMC-2001.
Refer to Technical Bulletin NTB95-022 for proper usage of these tools.
2. J39400-A/C Leak Detector Tune-up Kit. This kit provides all the items necessary to perform
preventive maintenance on the J39400 A/C Leak Detector.
J 39400-TUNEUP Leak Detector Kit
Page 765
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4903
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 4907
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Description and Operation
Ignition Rotor: Description and Operation
Distributor Rotor
The rotor makes the connection between the center terminal and the correct spark plug terminal of
the cap as it is turned by the distributor.
Page 2142
Page 1822
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2019
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 4441
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 5234
9. Give the vehicle a final inspection.
Page 2117
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 739
Audio - Speaker Noise, Cellular Phone Interference
Cellular Phone: Customer Interest Audio - Speaker Noise, Cellular Phone Interference
Classification: EL99-005
Reference: NTB99-017
Date: April 1, 1999
NISSAN SPEAKER NOISE DUE TO CELLULAR PHONE INTERFERENCE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan Vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION Cellular phone charging may cause a popping or crackling noise in the
audio speakers of Nissan vehicles. If this condition exists, it is most likely to occur when the
customer's cellular phone is turned off, plugged into the 12 volt cigarette lighter socket nearest the
audio head unit, and placed within one foot of the audio head unit. The condition may occur more
frequently in vehicles with audio systems with amplified speakers. Refer to the appropriate owner's
manual for cautions regarding the use of the cigarette lighter socket as a power source for other
accessories. Use the procedure below to verify that the condition exists as described above and
provide instruction for the customer to reduce the possibility of future cellular phone interference.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Perform the following test procedure to verify the condition exists as
described: 1.
Ask the customer for the cellular phone and charging adapter.
2.
Confirm the cellular phone has been turned off for at least 30 minutes before proceeding.
NOTE:
Do not turn the cellular phone on at any time during the procedure. If the phone has to be turned
from on to off, you will have to wait 30 minutes for the phone to reset to proceed with the test.
3. Plug the phone into the 12 volt cigarette lighter socket nearest the audio head unit.
4.
Turn the ignition to the "ON" position (do not turn the cellular phone on).
5.
Turn the audio unit on.
6.
Place the cellular phone close to the front of the audio head unit.
7.
Listen for a popping or crackling noise from the audio speakers.
8.
If the noise is heard, move the cellular phone back from the audio unit. The noise should be
reduced as the cellular phone is moved further away from the audio unit.
9.
If the condition is confirmed through the above procedure, advise the customer to keep the cellular
phone at least one foot away from the audio head unit to reduce the possibility of future cellular
phone interference.
Page 4908
13. Check the position of the ejector mechanism, the springs and rails. In case the spring rails
move from the original position, grasp the middle part between the two rails and place them back to
their original position with a slight force.
14. Install the new button onto the buckle assembly and depress the button, using a small
screwdriver to attach the spring.
Note
This step does not apply to white plastic ejector buckles. See 14a.
14a. To install the button for the white plastic ejector buckle, align the button with the buckle and
press into place.
Note
The white ejector plate button kits contain spare return springs in case one is required.
15. Check the operation of the button and that the spring is attached correctly.
16. Test the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see
that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle. Repeat
this step three (3) times. If it does not latch, replace the buckle assembly. If it does latch, proceed
to step 17.
17. Install the new outer button side, cover half onto the buckle.
18. Carefully install the switch onto the other cover half by applying pressure to the corners of the
switch. Route the switch wires as shown in the photograph below step 19.
Note
Only apply pressure to the corners of the switch. Do not press or apply pressure in the middle of
the switch. Should the switch break, it will be necessary to replace the buckle assembly.
19. Slide the switch upwards (away from the wires) to its original position.
20. Push the buckle release button and carefully assemble the two halves together by first inserting
the top tabs of the switch half of the cover into the button half of the cover.
21. Firmly push the two halves together until a snap is heard and/or felt,
22. Check the operation of the buckle. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to
see that it latches properly by tugging on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle.
Repeat this step three (3) times. If the buckle fails to latch, both buckle assemblies should be
replaced.
23. Check the operation of the seat belt warning light and warning buzzer. Repair as needed
according to the applicable warranty. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information.
Page 1578
Ignition Cable: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 4268
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 2631
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 2241
Inspection Procedure
Page 2121
Page 4557
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 2545
Vehicle Speed Sensor The vehicle speed sensor produces an alternating voltage signal. This
alternating signal (analog) is converted to a digital signal for processing.
The control unit can only process digital signals. Analog signals must be converted to a digital form
before the information can be used by the control unit.
Control Unit Logic
The control unit processes digital signals in two forms. To the control unit the signal is either ON or
OFF. In computer logic an ON or high voltage signal is a "1" and an OFF or low voltage signal is a
"O". The control unit uses combinations of these signals to control its outputs. The controller uses
inputs from many sensors to determine what outputs it will make and at what time it will make
them. These outputs control a variety of functions from automatic speed control to engine
driveability.
Outputs
An output is simply an action the control unit tells an electrical component to make. Based on the
calculations the control unit makes of the inputs, it will signal an action. The output can tell a
component to perform a function for a period of time.
Power and Ground Control
The ECU controls either a component's power or ground. To understand this, refer to the diagrams.
If the ECU is between the electrical component (load) and the power source, the ECU controls its
power.
^ If the component is between the power source and the ECU, the ECU controls the component
ground.
VOLTAGE DROP TEST
Service and Diagnosis Precautions
Before diagnosing any electronic controlled circuits the following cautions should be followed:
1. Make sure the following parts and systems are in good condition and are operating properly. ^
Battery output
^ Battery terminals
^ Grounds
^ System connectors are properly positioned and connected
2. Never use a test lamp to check an electronically controlled circuit.
3. Do not drop, jar or shake electronic components.
Follow the trouble diagnosis charts in the appropriate section of the Service Manual to isolate
which component may be the incident part.
Voltage Drop Tests
Voltage Drop Tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance.
A voltage drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation. Part of the
available voltage is used by the resistance. When there is excessive resistance, less voltage is
available for other loads (lights, motors, etc.) in the circuit. Since each resistance in a circuit uses
voltage, a voltmeter can be used to isolate the cause of the problem.
A voltage drop across closed contacts can indicate excessive resistance. This can cause the circuit
to operate incorrectly. Remember, a switch is not a load. During diagnosis, use a voltmeter to
measure the voltage drop across each switch contact while the circuit is in operation.
Page 5000
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Page 3275
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Brakes - Bleeding Procedure & Fast Fill Master Cylinders
Brake Master Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Bleeding Procedure & Fast Fill Master
Cylinders
Classification: BR88-003 Section: Brakes
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-052
Models: 1986-88 Sentra & 1987-88 Pulsar
Date: March 28, 1988
SENTRA/PULSAR BRAKE BLEEDING PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: 1986-88 Sentra and 1987-88 Pulsar
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1986 and later Sentras and some 1987-88 Pulsars have been equipped with "fast fill" master
cylinders and some have been equipped with standard, non fast fill master cylinders. The type of
master cylinder installed has a significant effect on the procedure for bleeding air out of the brake
system. This bulletin provides bleeding procedures for both types of master cylinders.
FIGURE 1
HOW TO IDENTIFY A "FAST FILL" MASTER CYLINDER:
A "fast fill" master cylinder has two unique features:
a. The rear half of the primary piston and bore are larger in diameter than the secondary bore.
b. It incorporates a "fast fill" valve between the fluid reservoir and the primary bore.
The "fast fill" valve allows fluid to flow quickly into the primary bore, then slowly back into the
reservoir. This causes the secondary piston to return to its normal position very slowly when the
brake pedal is released (Figure 1).
FIGURE 2
The simplest way to identify a "fast fill" master cylinder is to check with your finger along the lower
surface of the cylinder (Figure 2). If the casting is the same diameter for its entire length, then the
cylinder is not "fast fill". If the casting is larger in diameter near its mounting flange where the
primary
Page 4166
Ignition Relay: Locations Ignition Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2416
- When installing I.S.C. valve to throttle body, observe the tightening order.
Tightening order: (A) -> (B) -> (C)
Tightening torque: 4 - 5 N.m (0.4 - 0.5 kg-m, 2.9 - 3.6 ft-lb..)
Page 3928
large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4. Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation.
7. Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation.
8. Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service.
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement.
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10. Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based
cleaners degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the
rotor surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1912
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3458
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 2351
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Strut Kit - Camber Factory Set
Classification: Section: Front Axle
FA89-004 & Suspension
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-150 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra, Pulsar NX, 1989-1990 240SX
Date: October 19, 1989 FRONT STRUT KIT CAMBER
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1989 Sentras (B12) 1987-1989 Pulsar NX (N13) 1989-1990 240SX
(S13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
New Front Strut Kits supplied for the Applied Models are now manufactured with the camber
already set at factory specifications. The adjustable eccentric pin contained in the previously
available kit assemblies has been eliminated. Please note that the new kits will retrofit on a model
by model basis, and adjustment is not required when retrofitting.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 411
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 753
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Page 1874
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 4274
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 1414
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
a. Tighten the clamp so its end is 3 mm (0.12 in) from the hose end. b. Make sure that the screw of
the clamp does not contact with any adjacent parts. c. Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
: Fuel hose clamps
1.0 - 1.5 N.m (0.10 - 0.15 kg-m, 0.7 - 1.1 ft-lb)
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose at the electro injection unit.
3. Install a pressure gauge. 4. Start the engine and check the fuel line for fuel leakage. 5. Read fuel
pressure gauge.
At idling speed:
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2, 36.3 psi)
6. Release fuel pressure again. 7. Remove the pressure gauge from the fuel line. 8. Reconnect the
fuel inlet hose.
Page 1541
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1073
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 3294
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2177
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Page 2008
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 3533
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Level Checking/Precautions
Models: 1987-89 Sentra & Pulsar
Section: Automatic Transmission
Classification: AT89-008
Bulletin No.: TS89-091
Date: June 30, 1989
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
SERVICE INFORMATION
As with all Nissan vehicles with Automatic Transmissions (and as specified in all Nissan Owner's
and Service Manuals), it is especially important that the automatic transmission fluid (ATF) for the
3-speed RL3F01A automatic transmission (used on 1987-1989 Sentra and Pulsar XE models) be
maintained at the proper level.
CAUTION: Both overfilling and underfilling may cause damage to the transmission.
Page 4812
Page 2336
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Page 3468
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Spark Plug Construction
PURPOSE
Ignites the combustion mixture.
LOCATION
Screwed into the cylinder head, at the combustion chamber.
OPERATION
The spark plug provides a path for the high current of the secondary circuit to flow to ground. The
only paths for this current are through the ground electrode and center electrode across the spark
gap. The spark produced when the current jumps the gap and ignites the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinder.
Spark Plug Heat Range
CONSTRUCTION
The temperature of the spark plug is determined by the length of the insulator and the size of the
heatsink area. The longer the insulator is, the smaller the heatsink area will be and this will cause
the spark plug to be hotter.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Page 5192
Rear door
DOOR LOCK & STRIKER BOLTS
This Bulletin gives revised torque specifications for door lock and door striker bolts (see illustration
on next page).
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1062
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 402
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4774
A Dangerous Trend
By the most reliable estimates, the total ozone level in the Earth's upper atmosphere decreased
about 2.5% between 1978 and 1985. A 1% loss of ozone results in an estimated 2% increase in
the amount of ultraviolet radiation (UV) that reaches the surface of the earth. This has dangerous
implications for life as we know it. A 2% increase in UV will increase the number of human deaths
from skin cancer by approximately 5%. UV also increases the number of eye cataracts, causes
damage to the human immune system, damages crops and marine life. The Montreal Protocol
An agreement, called the Montreal Protocol, signed in 1987 by representatives of 31 countries
including the United States, limits world production of CFCs to 1986 levels and calls for further
reductions of 50% by 1999. Another International Conference will be held in June, 1990, with the
likelihood that the schedule for a complete phase-out of CFCs will occur even earlier. This means
that the supply of R12 refrigerant will decrease dramatically over the next few years and the cost
will increase.
Recycling Makes Good Sense
It's already established that making sure CFCs are not vented to the atmosphere is essential for
the environment. With the supply of R12 decreasing and the cost increasing, recycling all of the
refrigerant you remove from vehicles during repairs or before a vehicle is crushed will make more
and more economic sense.
Page 2539
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 2522
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON M10 CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
Page 5258
The table provides a brief description of some types of paint contamination you may encounter.
Select a 2' x 2' test section to perform the following Contamination Test Removal.
C. RE-Wash
C. Re-Wash with detergent and water solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching
the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution
to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the
terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt. Replace the towel with a clean one once it
becomes soiled. Rinse with a spray of clean water. Repeat up to four times.
D. Clean
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover using a clean terry cloth towel and gentle pressure.
Repeat up to four times.
E. Applying Finish Kare
E. Apply Finish Kare to remove iron particles and acids. See procedure below:
Caution:
Attempting to buff iron particles will cause severe scratching.
1. Apply Finish Kare # 1119, solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching the finish,
do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry
before rinsing.
2. After the wash and rinse, gently dry the contaminated surfaces with the terry cloth towels to
remove the majority of the water. Use gentle pressure
Page 1152
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification
Classification: EF & EC 93-013
Section: Engine Fuel
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-167
Models: Various
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED MODELS:
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to determine that a
vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and Date
of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and should have the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part
number on the ECM cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 2998
Page 2303
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
QUEST (V40) VG30E
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
Page 322
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 71
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON M10 CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 3647
1. Assemble wheel side of driveshaft as follows:
a. Install boot and new small boot band on driveshaft. b. Install joint assembly, with new circlip, on
driveshaft, referring to alignment mark made during disassembly. c. Pack driveshaft with suitable
grease. d. Install new large boot band. Tie band two turns around boot, then tighten it with a
screwdriver and pliers and bend approximately 90°. Lock
band in place with a punch, leaving length the same as its width, then bend band back over itself.
e. Position boot so that it does not swell or deform when length L, Fig. 9, meets the following
specifications: 1984-85 Pulsar and Sentra with
Rzeppa joint, 3.94 inches; 1984 Stanza, 4.74 inches; 1984-85 Pulsar and Sentra with Birfield joint,
3.54 inches; 1985 Stanza, 4.69 inches; 1986-88 Pulsar and Sentra with Rzeppa joint, 3.60 inches;
1986 Stanza, 4.70 inches.
f. Install small boot band to boot.
2. Assemble tripod type joint as follows:
a. Install new O-ring, if equipped. b. On 1984 models, install new slide joint cover so that edge of
cover extends over entire circumference of housing. Bend edge of cover at two
positions, 180° apart and ensure that cover does not rattle.
c. Apply suitable sealant to boot, then install boot and new small boot band onto driveshaft. d.
Install driveshaft in suitable soft-jawed vise. e. Install spider assembly, referring to alignment mark
made during disassembly. f.
Install new snap ring so that rounded surface faces spider assembly.
g. Pack spider assembly with suitable grease, then install new large boot band. h. Position boot so
that it does not swell when length L, Fig. 9, meets the following specifications: 1984-86 Stanza,
4.45 inches; 1984 Pulsar
and Sentra, 4.41 inches; 1985 Pulsar, 4.33 inches on right hand side, or 3.82 inches on left hand
side; 1985 Sentra, 3.78 inches on left hand side, or 4.35 inches on right hand side; 1986-88 Pulsar
and Sentra, 3.80 inches.
i. Install new small boot band to boot.
3. Assemble double offset type joint in reverse order of disassembly as outlined previously. Adjust
boot length L, Fig. 9, to 3.31 inches on 1984 Pulsar and Sentra, 3.35 inches on 1985 Pulsar or 3.33
inches on 1986-88 Pulsar and Sentra.
4. Install driveshaft in reverse order of removal as outlined previously.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 2521
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Page 295
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 1898
Page 4038
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 1467
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
System Diagnosis
Air/Fuel Mixture: Testing and Inspection
PREPARATION
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
- Battery
- Ignition system
- Engine oil and coolant levels
- Fuses
- E.C.C.S. harness connectors
- Vacuum hoses
- Air intake system (oil filler cap, oil level gauge, etc.)
- Fuel pressure
- A.I.V. hose
- Engine compression
- E.G.R. valve operation
- Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is
"OFF". 3. When measuring "CO" percentage, insert probe more than 40cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe.
Overall Inspection Procedure
Page 4414
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Steering Knuckle & Drive Axle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 781
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 1547
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-012A Date: 990617
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Classification: BR94-002a
Reference: NTB94-012a
Date: June 17, 1999
This amended version of NTB94-012 adds a caution and a note to the service procedure. Please
discard all paper copies of NTB94-012.
This bulletin supersedes TS89-105/BR89-004
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
SERVICE INFORMATION Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in
any vehicle when excessive rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's
brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in a thickness between the thickest and
thinnest points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy. However, excessive Rotor
Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is the excessive rotor thickness
variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is described in more detail below.
Page 847
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Spark Plug Construction
PURPOSE
Ignites the combustion mixture.
LOCATION
Screwed into the cylinder head, at the combustion chamber.
OPERATION
The spark plug provides a path for the high current of the secondary circuit to flow to ground. The
only paths for this current are through the ground electrode and center electrode across the spark
gap. The spark produced when the current jumps the gap and ignites the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinder.
Spark Plug Heat Range
CONSTRUCTION
The temperature of the spark plug is determined by the length of the insulator and the size of the
heatsink area. The longer the insulator is, the smaller the heatsink area will be and this will cause
the spark plug to be hotter.
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other Precautions
Catalytic Converter: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Page 479
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Page 2857
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Description and Operation
Fig. 14 Back pressure transducer valve.
Fig. 15 Back pressure transducer valve.
Page 3183
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2116
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Maintenance - Cleaning Power Antenna & Wiper Blades
Wiper Blade: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Cleaning Power Antenna & Wiper Blades
Models: See below Section: Electrical Classification: EL92-011 Bulletin No.: NTB92-083 Date:
October 8, 1992
MAINTENANCE OF POWER ANTENNA AND WIPER BLADES
APPLIED MODELS: All with Power Antenna; All Vehicles [Wiper Blades].
SERVICE INFORMATION:
1. Maintenance of Power Antenna
It is recommended that the Power Antenna rod, in its extended position, be periodically wiped with
a clean, soft, dry cloth. This is the most current information from the factory concerning proper
periodic maintenance of the Power Antenna.
I. Maintenance of Wiper Blades
1. To clean the rubber wiper blades, it is recommended to use a clean, soft, wet cloth [the cloth
should be moistened with washer liquid].
2. Before lowering the wiper blades onto the glass, it is advised to first clean the glass area swept
by the wiper blade. Use an appropriate, commercially-available glass cleaner and either paper
towels or a lint-free towel.
NOTE: If the vehicles you service are subject to ice and snow formation on the front or rear
windshields, you may recommend to your customers that wiper blade effectiveness, during these
environmental conditions, may be optimized, if both snow and ice are removed prior to operating
the wiper system(s).
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1513
Page 4613
Mode Door Motor: Adjustments Intake Door Control
1. Set intake lever at RECIRC position.
2. Set intake door at recirculation position.
3. Connect control cable to link lever and securely clamp cable.
4. Ensure that knob moves smoothly.
Page 3134
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Page 542
Wheels/Tires - Accessory Wheel Lock
Installation/Removal
Wheel Fastener: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Accessory Wheel Lock
Installation/Removal
Classification: WT09-002
Reference: NTB09-056
Date: July 14, 2009
ACCESSORY WHEEL LOCKS INSTALLATION AND REMOVAL
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Always use hand tools when installing or removing accessory wheel lock nuts.
WARNING:
Do not use power tools to install or remove accessory wheel lock nuts.
Use of an impact wrench or other power tool may cause permanent damage to the wheel lock nut
and/or key.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Accessory wheel locks, wheel lock keys, or vehicle wheels that are damaged due to improper
installation or removal will not be considered a manufacturer defect and will not be covered under
warranty.
Accessory Wheel Lock Installation / Removal Guidelines
^ For ease of removal, the wheel lock nut should always be the first lug nut removed.
^ If needed, clean threads on lug studs with a wire brush.
^ The wheel lock nut should always be the last lug nut tightened.
^ Always use the special key supplied in the wheel lock set to install and remove the wheel locks.
^ Always tighten the wheel lock nuts using a hand torque wrench to the torque specification in the
Service Manual.
Disclaimer
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 5152
You can contact the paint refinish company's technical assistance number listed. Akzo/Sikkens
Procedure ICI AUTOCOLOR Procedure DuPont Procedure Glasurit Procedure Martin Senour
(NAPA) Procedure PPG Procedure R-M Procedure Sherwin Williams Procedure Spies Hecker
Procedure Herberts Standox Procedure
Locations
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
Lower Left Corner Of Radiator
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4847
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Accessory Relay
Ignition Relay: Locations Accessory Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3909
Fig. 5 AD18B type front disc brake disassembled
Page 3846
Circuit Inspection
1. Connect the voltmeter as described in illustration, starting at the battery and working your way
around the circuit.
2. An unusually large voltage drop will indicate a component or wire that needs to be repaired. As
you can see in the illustration above, the poor connection causes a 4 volt drop.
The chart that follows illustrates some maximum allowable voltage drops. These values are given
as a guideline, the exact value for each component may vary.
COMPONENT VOLTAGE DROP
Wire negligible <.001 volts
Ground Connections Approx. 0.1 volts
Switch Contacts Approx. 0.3 volts
Starter Solenoids Approx. 0.5 volts
Proper Diagnostic Procedures to Avoid Damaging Other Components
In the process of diagnosing electrical incidents you may be required to remove components,
disconnect connectors and inspect parts.
Test equipment
When working with any test equipment, be careful to follow all manufacturers directions and
warnings. Improper use of test equipment can result in damage to either your test equipment or
vehicle electrical components.
SERVICE PRECAUTIONS
When working on a vehicle's electrical system you need to use care. The following guidelines will
help you prevent new problems while diagnosing an electrical incident.
Removing Components
When removing components (such as an engine) which have electrical connectors, disconnect all
of the connectors prior to attempting to take the component out of the car. Stretching the connector
harness can cause wiring to pull loose and may create a short or open circuit as well as a possible
intermittent condition.
Installing Components
When reinstalling components, wait until the component is back in the vehicle before reattaching
connectors. Once the component is back in the car, check to verify that the wires and harness are
properly positioned in the vehicle. Check the male and female connectors to verify there is no
water, grease, dirt, etc. in the connector. Assure that the harness will not be damaged by any
brackets or finishing screws. Reconnect the connector. Make sure the connector has an
appropriate amount of slack to accommodate any component motion without having unnecessary
slack. Secure the harness as required to prevent possible damage to the harness itself.
Disconnecting Connectors
Disconnect the connectors by releasing any locking tabs and pulling on the connector housings.
Never disconnect a connector by pulling on the harness or wires.
Connecting Harnesses
Before connecting the harness connectors, inspect the housings to make sure there is no water,
grease, dirt, etc. in the housing which may interfere with the proper operation of the connector or
component.
Page 4254
Page 4503
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 875
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Poly-Groove Belt - Tension Inspection
Classification: Section:
GI89-008 General Information
Reference: SERVICE ADVISORY TS89-077 Models:
All models Date:
May 18, 1989
When installing a new poly-groove belt or replacing a used one, use the following procedure.
1. Install the belt and set the belt tension.
2. Start the engine and run it for approximately 30 seconds. Switch the engine off.
3. Check the belt tension and reset as needed.
Locations
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4133
Alternator: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn ignition switch to on position and note charge lamp.
2. If lamp lights proceed to step 7. If lamp does not light proceed to next step.
3. Disconnect two wire connectors labeled S and L, then using a jumper wire connect L terminal to
a suitable ground.
4. If charge lamp lights proceed to next step. If lamp does not light the bulb in the instrument cluster
is defective. Steps 5 and 6 do not apply to Pulsar, Stanza, 200SX and 300ZX models equipped
with Mitsubishi alternator. On these models, if charge lamp lights, the internal regulator or some
other internal component is defective and the alternator must be removed for bench testing.
Fig. 1 Grounding field circuit to test alternator output
5. Reconnect two wire connectors, then insert a short stiff length of wire through the access hole at
back of alternator until it contacts outer brush. Ground other end of wire to alternator case which
will actually ground the F terminal internally, Fig. 1. On diesel models, except 1984-86 Sentra and
1984-86 Pickup, to ground F terminal, contact tip of brush with a screwdriver, then ground
screwdriver to alternator case. On 1984-86 Sentra diesel and 1984-86 Pickup models, remove
vacuum pump, then using a suitable length of wire, make contact with brush and ground opposite
end of wire to alternator case.
6. If charge lamp remains lit, the internal regulator is defective and will require disassembly of the
alternator for repair. If lamp goes out, some other internal component is defective therefore
alternator must be removed for bench testing.
7. With engine idling if charge lamp is lit, a defective internal component exists in the alternator and
requires removal for bench testing. If the charge lamp is not lit, proceed to next step.
8. With engine speed at 1500 RPM and headlights on, if charge lamp is not lit proceed to next step.
If lamp is lit dimly, let engine idle and measure voltage across B and L terminals. If voltage is more
than .5 volts a defective internal component exists in the alternator and requires removal for bench
testing. If voltage is less than .5 volts, alternator if considered to be in satisfactory condition.
9. With engine at 1500 RPM measure voltage at B terminal, making sure S terminal is properly
connected.
10. If voltage reading is above 15.5 volts, the internal regulator is faulty and requires removal of
alternator for replacement. If voltage reading is between 13 and 15 volts proceed to next step.
11. With engine idling and headlights on, if charge lamp is lit a defective internal component exists
in the alternator and requires removal for bench testing. If charge lamp is not lit, alternator is
considered to be in satisfactory condition.
Accessory Relay
Ignition Relay: Locations Accessory Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
2WD Opening Temperature 180 F
4WD Opening Temperature 182 F
Page 1329
Drive Belt: Specifications Belt Deflection
Belt Deflection
Alternator Limit 0.53 in
Adjust deflection 0.33 - 0.37 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.29 - 0.33 in
Air conditioner compressor Limit 0.49 in
Adjust deflection 0.35 - 0.39 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.24 - 0.31 in
Power steering oil pump Limit 0.41 in
Adjust deflection 0.28 - 0.35 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.25 - 0.33 in
Component Locations
Interior Moulding / Trim: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Page 485
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Page 3908
Brake Pad: Service and Repair
Fig. 4 CL18B type front disc brake disassembled
Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Classification: WT92-003
Section: Wheel & Tire
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-123
Models: All
Date: December 22, 1992
AFTERMARKET CHROMING OF NISSAN ALLOY WHEELS
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Original Equipment Alloy Wheels on Nissan vehicles are specifically developed in order to
achieve the Nissan design and performance standards. These Original Equipment wheels are also
subject to rigorous testing procedure's to ensure they meet Nissan's standards.
Nissan cannot ensure that Original Equipment Alloy Wheels which are subjected to aftermarket
chroming meet these same standards, and therefore Nissan does not recommend the use of such
wheels, nor does Nissan make any representations concerning their performance.
Indeed, if these Original Equipment Alloy Wheels are subjected to aftermarket chroming, there are
serious potential problems which may occur as a result of the chroming process:
1. The chroming process removes the original paint coating by "burning" or "chemical" methods,
both of which cause the alloy surface to be changed. The application of chrome plating has to be
controlled correctly, as the alloy can be harmed by a poorly controlled process.
2. Overall aftermarket chroming may degrade the durability, long term appearance, and may affect
safety and performance of the wheels.
Accordingly, Nissan recommends that Original Equipment Wheels NOT be chrome plated.
Please consult the Nissan Warranty Policies and Procedures Manual pertaining to the Dealer's
responsibility when altering or modifying vehicles.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Note that damage to Nissan Alloy road wheels due to any non-factory-authorized process, such as
chroming, is the responsibility of the customer, and is not covered by the Nissan Warranty, please
consult the "Nissan Warranty Information Booklet" for specific details.
Page 7
Index For Main Harness Part 1
Engine Compartment, Left Front Fender Apron Near Battery.
Connector ID is 79M.
Page 3356
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
On Top of Receiver Drier
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 324
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 579
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 333
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 5493
Most windshield damage that occurs due to impact is easily identified as shown above.
Cracks can spread and become larger from the original strike point or crush mark due to:
^ Thermal stresses caused by temperature fluctuation
^ External physical stresses, such as hand touch, wind force, or vehicle vibration during driving (pot
holes)
A lead, or crack from one of the star cracked impact points can run to the edge of the glass and
appear to be a low stress crack starting from the glass outside edge.
Single crack beginning or ending at the edge of the glass
Single cracks must be inspected along the entire crack for impact marks.
^ If any impact mark is found anywhere along the crack, it indicates the damage occurred from an
object striking the windshield. This is not covered
under warranty.
Page 3409
Ignition Rotor: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Rotor
1. Remove the screws securing the distributor cap to the distributor.
2. Confirm that the rotor does not turn on the distributor shaft.
3. Remove the rotor.
4. Visually check the rotor for signs of "Burn Through" from the electrode to the distributor shaft.
5. Check the input (center) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
6. Check the output (outer) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
7. Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between the input (center) electrode and the output
(outer) electrode. Replace the rotor if it fails the above tests.
Page 1887
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
The exhaust gas sensor, which is placed into the exhaust manifold, monitors the amount of oxygen
in the exhaust gas. The sensor has a closed-end tube made of ceramic zirconia. The outer surface
of the tube is exposed to exhaust gas, and the inner surface to atmosphere. The zirconia of the
tube compares the oxygen density of exhaust gas with that of atmosphere, and generates
electricity. In order to improve generating power of the zirconia, its tube is coated with platinum.
The voltage is approximately 1V in a richer condition of the mixture ratio than the ideal air fuel ratio,
while approximately 0V in leaner conditions. The radical change from 1V to 0V occurs at around
the ideal mixture ratio. In this way, the exhaust gas sensor detects the amount of oxygen in the
exhaust gas and sends the signal of approximately 1V or 0V to the E.C.U.
Page 3847
Align the male and female halves to prevent bending or breaking terminals.
Make sure the connectors are fully seated when connected. Visually verify that the connector has
seated and is locked into place.
Page 74
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 3886
PARTS INFORMATION
Use the following chart to find the correct part numbers for the new brake pad kits with HP12
material. Models that are not listed on this chart (i.e. Z31, certain D21 models), use brake pads
from a different vendor. Use the original pads listed in the Parts Microfiche. Original pads on these
models are equivalent to HP12 material.
Page 2152
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve
(ISCV) Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
Page 360
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1140
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 2875
Fig. 32 EGR control valve.
Fig. 33 EGR control valve.
This valve, Figs. 6 through 9, 32 and 33, controls the quantity of exhaust gas recirculated to the
intake manifold. It is operated by vacuum created by the opening of the carburetor throttle valve
except on vehicles with diesel engines. On Pickups equipped with diesel engines, the vacuum is
created in response to a sub-venturi vacuum signal that is amplified by a vacuum amplifier. On
Maximas and Sentras equipped with diesel engines, the vacuum is applied in response to the
operation of the solenoid valve. EGR control valve construction and type vary according to year,
model, transmission type and vehicle destination. For identification purposes, the part number is
stamped on the top of the valve.
Page 2756
Inspection Procedure
Page 3064
Page 1959
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 492
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
Page 3370
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 5295
1. It is necessary to match the color of the refinishing base color paint and the original body paint.
On all cars, an exposed portion of the color base coat will be found under the right and left hand sill
plates.
2. The color tone of a pearl base coat varies with the number of overlapped spray strokes (film
thickness). Use the same spraying conditions as those for color matching.
3 Areas to be sanded and coated for Zone repairs.
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 2309
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 5323
7. Remove the retracting side of the original lap belts.
8. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed in two steps. First, install the retractor unit
end of the shoulder harness (see illustration below for location). Then place the quarter finisher into
position and bolt the shoulder anchor into the rear side panel where the 1" hole was drilled.
NOTE: Torque mounting/anchor bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs.. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
9. Fully tighten the quarter panel finishers.
10. Bolt floor anchor into position (where old retractor was bolted). Torque to 26-32 ft.lbs.
(3.65-4.65 kg/m).
11. Check the retro-fit lap belts for smooth operation.
12. Tighten trunk finishers.
13. Reinstall rear seat.
14. Reinstall front seat belt upper anchor bolts. Torque to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
Sentra 2/4-Door Sedan
Page 2006
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 100
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 2401
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2739
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 4995
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
Page 1778
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Page 5321
Technical Service Bulletin # BF89004 Date: 890330
Seat Belts - 3-Point Rear Belt Installation
Classification: Section:
BF89-004 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-050 Models:
Sentra, Stanza, Stanza Wagon, Pulsar Maxima, 200SX, 300ZX 2+2, Pathfinder Date:
March 30, 1989 3-POINT REAR SEAT BELT INSTALLATION
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-89 Sentra Sedan, Coupe and Wagon 1987-88 Sentra 3-Door Hatchback
1987-88 Stanza Sedan 1987-89 Pulsar 1985-87
Maxima Sedan 1984-88 200SX Hatchback 1986-89 Pathfinder
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin describes 3-point rear seat belt installation procedures for the applied models listed
above. These vehicles are already equipped with threaded fittings for installation of the 3-point
belts. However, in most cases, it will be necessary to modify or replace certain trim pieces to
complete the installation. Trim modification requires cutting/drilling of the quarter panel or trunk trim
and, in some cases, the rear parcel shelf. The following pages describe the installation procedures
for each model.
Please make these instructions available to customers who purchase retro-fit kits and choose to
install the belts themselves. Ensure that a copy of the child seat installation instructions are
provided to customers for every installation.
PARTS INFORMATION
The replacement parts necessary to complete the installation on each model are listed beginning
on page 31 of this bulletin.
Child Restraint Installation With Rear 3-Point Seat Belts
Outboard shoulder/lap belt
Before using the locking clip, read the instructions attached to the clip.
Secure the child restraint with the lap belt as illustrated. To prevent slack in the lap belt, it will be
necessary to secure the lap/shoulder belt in place with a locking clip.
Use a genuine locking clip (part number 999JW-A3000, available from your NISSAN dealer), or
one which is the same in dimension and strength. NOTE:
When installing child restraint in a Sentra 3-dr. (Hatchback), unfasten shoulder belt at the buckle
and follow owner's manual instructions for rear lap belts.
Sentra Coupe
Electrical - Battery Testing Procedures/Equipment
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Testing Procedures/Equipment
Classification: EL99-O16p
Reference: NTB99-048p
Date: September 13, 2007
BATTERY TESTING FOR NISSAN ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT AND GENUINE NISSAN
REPLACEMENT BATTERIES
This bulletin has been amended. Please discard all previous copies of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan SERVICE INFORMATION
The new Battery Service Center (BSC) is the factory-approved battery tester. The Essential Tool
number for this tester is J-48087.
^ For claim reimbursement purposes, use of the "BSC" is required when testing any Nissan
Original Equipment or Genuine Nissan Replacement battery.
^ For more information, refer to the current Nissan Assurance Products Resource Manual.
^ Print-outs from the BSC are required to accurately document the test codes for warranty claims.
^ For the complete BSC User Guide, refer to ASIST - TOOLS & EQUIPMENT.
^ Additional tools and replacement parts can be ordered from TECH-MATE.
When setting up the "BSC" for testing, a [battery CCA] rating is required.
^ CCA stands for Cold Cranking Amps.
Page 3880
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Page 2330
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 3065
Idle Check and Set Procedure
Page 1088
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 3942
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 3295
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1721
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
QUEST (V40) VG30E
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
Page 830
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1471
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 997
Page 3041
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 774
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 623
Page 2941
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4245
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Page 784
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Diagrams
Fig. 12 Exploded view of steering column. 1987-88 Sentra
Page 4751
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Water Valve
Refer to ``Heater Core, Replace'' procedure.
Locations
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5136
7. Reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter and let dry.
8. Fill sand scratches and pinholes with a skin coat of Flexible Parts Repair Material. (Do not use
Flexible Parts Putty.) After curing, sand with 320 grit disc.
9. Reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter and let dry.
10. Apply a double wet coat of Flexible Parts Coating. After a 10 minute flash time, apply a second
double coat. Let dry 45 minutes and lightly scuff sand the coating with 320 grit disc. Apply color
coats recommended for plastic body parts.
Polypropylene Bumper Fascia Repair
If extensive reinforcing or patching from the back is required use the following procedure.
1. Scuff the backside with grade 180 abrasives. Apply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter.
2. Cut a glass cloth patch to cover repair area.
3. Mix a quantity of Flexible Parts Repair Material. Lay glass cloth on a clean surface. Use a
squeegee to force the Flexible Parts Repair Material into the glass cloth.
4. Apply glass cloth patch to backside of repair area.
5. Apply additional Flexible Parts Repair Material over surface of glass cloth patch.
FASCIA REPAIR
1. Clean the repair area with soap and water. Remove grease and tar with solvent.
Testing and Inspection
Air Conditioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 335a A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 2402
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4287
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
Page 4500
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Blower Motor: Customer Interest A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 5345
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 5333
18. Reinstall rear speakers.
19. Reinstall front portion of wheelhouse trim and front seat belt access trim.
20. Reinstall retro-fit belt floor anchor where original retractor mounted. Torque anchor bolt to
26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
21. Check the retractor unit and buckle for smooth operation.
22. Reinstall seat back hinges.
23. Reinstall rear seat back and lower cushion.
Maxima Sedan
1. Remove rear lower seat cushion, then remove seat back by:
a. If vehicle has non-folding rear seat, remove the retaining screws, then pull the seat back up and
out. or
b. If vehicle has split/folding rear seat, remove trunk carpeting retaining finishers as shown below.
This will allow access to the seat back retaining screws. After removing six retaining screws, the
seat back may be removed.
2. Remove the rear high mount stop light.
3. Remove rear speakers, if equipped. (Retaining nuts are accessed by removing the speaker
grilles.)
4. Remove rear parcel shelf and rear pillar finishers.
Page 1492
Page 4794
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Type R-12
Diagnostic Note
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Diagnostic Note
Whenever control cables are disconnected or heater case is disassembled for service, control
cables and operating rods should be adjusted as outlined in adjustments.
Page 4350
Fig. 7 Adjusting tie rod length. 1987-88 Maxima, Pulsar, Sentra & Stanza exc. 2WD Wagon
9. Tighten outer socket locknut so tie rod length ``L'' is 6.94 inches and screwed length ``l'' is .98
inch or more, Fig. 7.
10. Measure rack stroke. Ensure stroke is 2.894 inches on both sides.
11. Apply suitable sealing compound to contact surfaces between boot and gear housing, then
install boot and boot clamps. Ensure boot clamps do not interfere with any other parts. Also, use
caution not to twist boot.
Recall 95V103002: Safety Belt Buckle Release Button
Seat Belt Buckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 95V103002: Safety Belt Buckle Release
Button
The front safety belt buckle release buttons can break. These red plastic release buttons are
marked "press." If a button breaks, pieces can fall into the buckle assembly causing the buckle to
operate improperly. The safety belts would not provide adequate protection to an occupant in a
vehicle crash.
Owners should promptly check the condition and operation of both front safety belt buckles and
carefully inspect the red release button for any breaks or cracks. They should ensure that both
buckles are operating properly by inserting each latch plate into its buckle, tugging on the belt to
make sure the latch is securely locked, and then pressing the release button. The latch plate
should pop out of the buckle when the button is pressed. If either release button shows a sign of
breaking or cracking or if either buckle fails to operate properly, owners should promptly contact
their authorized dealer to schedule an appointment to have the buckle replaced or repaired free of
charge.
System: Interior; Seat Belts; Belt Buckles.
Vehicle Description: Passenger, Multi-Purpose Vehicles and Light Duty Trucks Equipped with
Safety Belts made by Takata Corporation.
NOTE: If your vehicle is presented to an authorized dealer on an agreed upon service date and the
remedy is not provided free of charge within a reasonable time, please contact NISSAN at
1-800-647-7261. Also contact the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
Page 4647
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 3927
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the flow chart. Use this chart, as
appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
GENERAL BRAKE REPAIR GUIDELINES
To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the following.
1. Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug
bolts may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3. Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip
on the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with
Page 1003
^ The graph on the following page shows that PAG oil left open to air (e.g. in an unsealed
container) will absorb 2% moisture (by weight) in 120 hours (5 days).
^ PAG containers, and any A/C component which contains PAG oil (such as the compressor)
should remain tightly capped and sealed until ready for use.
^ If you believe that a container of PAG oil may not have been adequately re-sealed after opening,
dispose of the oil properly and use oil from a new sealed container.
^ When installing or servicing an A/C system, the refrigerant tube and hose connections should be
sealed (all connections made and tightened to specification) without delay.
^ The above precautions will keep the absorption of moisture into the system to a minimum. Using
moisture saturated PAG oil in R-134a systems may lead to the formation of acids and related
system damage or failure.
^ Do not allow refrigerant oil (Nissan A/C System Oil Type S) to contact styrofoam, as the lubricant
will damage this material.
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 70
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Classification: EL88-008 Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-094
Models: 1987-88 Sentra/Pulsar
Date: July 11, 1988
SPEEDOMETER CABLE NOISE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra, 1987-88 Pulsar except 1988 Pulsar SE
APPLIED VINs: JAPAN BUILT SENTRA Before JN1PB22SXJU 028662
04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB24SXJU 044462 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB22SXJU 574774 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB21SXJU 555932 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB26SXJU 016707 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25SXJU 021285 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25YXJU 005931 04/01/88 production
U.S. BUILT SENTRA 1987 1988
All
PULSAR Before JN1PN34SXJM 500050
05/01/88 production
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987-88 Sentra and Pulsar vehicles may exhibit a rattle or buzzing noise from the center of
the instrument panel at engine speeds of 2500-3500 RPM.
If a customer complains of this type of noise, perform the following diagnostics to determine if the
speedometer cable is the cause.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to verify speedometer cable noise:
1. Start engine with transmission in neutral (M/T) or park (A/T). Raise RPM to 3500 and hold for
5-10 seconds.
2. Listen for rattling or buzzing from the speedometer head area.
3. Return engine to idle and turn off ignition.
4. Disconnect speedometer cable from transaxle and let hang. Be sure to position the cable so that
it isn't touching the engine or transaxle.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3.
If the noise can be heard in Step 2, but is not present during Step 5, replace the speedometer
cable assembly with the improved (insulated) cable assembly listed below. If the noise is still
present, reinstall the speedometer cable and contact the FIXS Hotline for additional information.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART DESCRIPTION NEW PART NUMBER FORMER PART NUMBER
Speedometer 25050-01Y00 25050-60A01
Cable Assembly 25050-60A00
Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Main Harness Part 1
Page 567
^ Center the front wheels on the turn plates.
^ Chock the left rear wheel.
Preliminary Checks:
3. Perform pre-alignment checks.
^ Tire condition (wear, partial wear, flaws, etc.)
^ Road wheel condition (damage and deformation)
^ Tire pressure
^ Inspect for visible damage to any suspension components
^ Wheel bearing axial play
^ Ball joints of suspension arms
^ Shock absorber operation and visual check for oil leakage
^ Condition of axle and suspension (check for bushing cracks and slack)
^ Vehicle weight
> Empty - no cargo, luggage, or passengers
> Fuel level is full
Page 3046
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 832
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
Ignition Wire Visual Inspection
1. Visually inspect the ignition wires for the following:
a. Insulation for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... b. Insulation for cracks or
breaks. c. Insulator boots for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... d. Insulator
boots for cracks or breaks. e. Terminal ends for corrosion, cracks or looseness.
Ignition Wire Resistance Test
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance between the terminal ends.
Resistance: Less than 30k ohms
Replace the wire if it fails the above test.
Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Models: All models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT90-004
Bulletin No.: NTB90-099
Date: November 8, 1990
NISSAN WINTER TIRES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan Vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some vehicles are equipped with performance tires from the factory to enhance dry weather vehicle
performance. In order to improve vehicle traction during winter driving, all-season or radial mud &
snow (M&S;) tires may be installed.
Upon customer request, dealers may recommend alternative tires for improved traction in snow.
When doing so, these guidelines should be followed:
1. A tire with the M&S; rating is recommended for winter driving in snow.
2. The replacement tires must have the same size and load carrying capacity as the original
equipment tires.
3. All four (4) tires must be replaced, without exception. The mixed use of different types of tires
(i.e., radial mixed with bias ply, M&S; mixed with non-M&S;) should be avoided because of adverse
effects on vehicle handling and ride characteristics.
4. The requesting customer should be informed of the speed rating of the current tires, so that tires
of the same speed rating could be purchased as replacement tires.
NOTE: ^ All-season or snow tires may have lower speed ratings than factory-equipped tires. ^
When 4 mud & snow (M&S;) tires are installed on the vehicle, the tires should be inflated to the
pressures recommended on the vehicle tire placard. The maximum inflation pressure shown on the
side of the tire should never be exceeded.
Page 4778
^ Do not introduce compressed air to any refrigerant container or refrigerant component, because
contamination will occur.
^ R-134a in the presence of oxygen and under pressure may form a combustible mixture.
Therefore, never introduce compressed air into any R-134a container, cylinder, A/C component,
recover/recycle equipment, or other service equipment. This includes "empty" containers.
Refrigerant Terminology
Please use the correct name or names when specifying refrigerants. The guidelines are listed
below:
^ Freon --> is a registered trademark of DuPont, and should only be used if referring to DuPont
R-12.
^ DuPont's trade name for R-134a (automotive use) is Suva-->Trans A/C.
^ When referring to refrigerants, the terms Freon-->and Suva--> should not be used as a general
reference. The proper terms are R-12 and R-134a
Comments regarding refrigerants:
^ R-12 and R-134a are not compatible with each other and should never be mixed, even in the
smallest amounts.
^ R-134a for automotive use has a special tank fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME) which is compatible
with automotive service equipment
^ When purchasing R-134a, be certain that the fitting size on the tank is 1/2" - 16 ACME. This
thread size is easy to recognize by the square thread, as shown.
^ Although R-134a has no ozone depletion potential (ODP), it does have a slight global warming
potential (GWP). Due to this slight GWP, as well as its high cost, venting of R-134a into the air is
not recommended.
^ Recovery/recycling of R-134a will be required by U.S. Federal Law, Clean Air Act Amendments of
1990.
Page 1171
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Adjustments
Control Assembly: Adjustments
Fig. 14 Water valve adjustments.
1. Set temperature control cable at maximum COLD position.
2. With air mix door knob moved in toward passenger compartment, connect temperature control
rod to link lever.
3. Connect control cable to link lever and clamp the cable.
4. Pull water valve control rod in direction of arrow to provide clearance of approximately .08 inch
between ends of rod and link lever and connect rod to door lever, Fig. 14.
Page 2453
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Speedometer Cable: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Classification: EL88-008 Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-094
Models: 1987-88 Sentra/Pulsar
Date: July 11, 1988
SPEEDOMETER CABLE NOISE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra, 1987-88 Pulsar except 1988 Pulsar SE
APPLIED VINs: JAPAN BUILT SENTRA Before JN1PB22SXJU 028662
04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB24SXJU 044462 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB22SXJU 574774 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB21SXJU 555932 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB26SXJU 016707 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25SXJU 021285 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25YXJU 005931 04/01/88 production
U.S. BUILT SENTRA 1987 1988
All
PULSAR Before JN1PN34SXJM 500050
05/01/88 production
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987-88 Sentra and Pulsar vehicles may exhibit a rattle or buzzing noise from the center of
the instrument panel at engine speeds of 2500-3500 RPM.
If a customer complains of this type of noise, perform the following diagnostics to determine if the
speedometer cable is the cause.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to verify speedometer cable noise:
1. Start engine with transmission in neutral (M/T) or park (A/T). Raise RPM to 3500 and hold for
5-10 seconds.
2. Listen for rattling or buzzing from the speedometer head area.
3. Return engine to idle and turn off ignition.
4. Disconnect speedometer cable from transaxle and let hang. Be sure to position the cable so that
it isn't touching the engine or transaxle.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3.
If the noise can be heard in Step 2, but is not present during Step 5, replace the speedometer
cable assembly with the improved (insulated) cable assembly listed below. If the noise is still
present, reinstall the speedometer cable and contact the FIXS Hotline for additional information.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART DESCRIPTION NEW PART NUMBER FORMER PART NUMBER
Speedometer 25050-01Y00 25050-60A01
Cable Assembly 25050-60A00
Page 2820
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Air Bleeder Screw 5 - 7 ft.lb
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Page 2781
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect air injection hose from injection pipe side and ensure air cannot flow in either
direction through hose.
2. Apply vacuum to air injection control valve using a suitable hand vacuum pump and ensure air
flows only on injection pipe side while control valve is operated.
3. Check air injection and air injection control valves for binding or damage and replace if
necessary.
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Diagrams
Final Drive
Page 3311
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 2025
Inspection Procedure
Page 2506
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 3033
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 335
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 865
2. Ensure that marks on camshaft sprocket and upper front cover and marks on crankshaft
sprocket and lower front cover are properly aligned. 3. Temporarily install tensioner and return
spring.
4. Rotate tensioner clockwise about 70° to 80° and temporarily tighten lock nut. 5. Set timing belt.
a. Ensure that timing belt and sprockets are clean and free of oil or water. Do not bend timing belt
tightly. b. Install timing belt with rotating direction mark facing engine rotating direction. c. Ensure
that timing belt is not loose around jack shaft and camshaft sprockets.
6. Loosen tensioner lock nut so that tensioner pushes on timing belt.
7. Turn camshaft sprocket about 20° (2 cogs) clockwise.
NOTE: Ensure that all spark plugs are removed.
8. Tighten nut while preventing tensioner from turning in "free" direction.
Tensioner lock nut: 16 - 21 N.m (12 - 15 ft.lbs.)
9. Install crank sprocket plate and upper and lower dust covers.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3429
Power Transistor: Description and Operation
The ignition signal from the E.C.U. is amplified by the power transistor, which turns the ignition coil
primary circuit on and off, inducing the proper high voltage in the secondary circuit. The ignition coil
is a small, molded type.
Page 2780
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection: Description and Operation
Fig. 116 Air Injecton Valve (AIV) Operation
The air injection valve system delivers secondary air to the exhaust manifold, utilizing a vacuum
caused by exhaust pulsation in the exhaust manifold. Specific operating conditions are outlined in
Fig. 116
Locations
Wiper Amplifier: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Of Cowl
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2478
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
(CHECK ENGINE LIGHT ITEM)
Wiring Diagram
The following is necessary to perform this inspection.
1. Pull out E.C.U. from under the passenger seat.
2. Warm up engine sufficiently.
Page 5185
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Page 2557
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 4760
Hose/Line HVAC: Testing and Inspection
1. A restricted suction line is indicated by low suction pressure at the compressor, low discharge
pressure and little or no cooling.
2. A restricted discharge line will usually cause the pressure relief valve to open.
3. A restricted liquid line will cause low suction and discharge pressures and little or no cooling.
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Page 5376
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 4141
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 1481
Page 4233
^ Toe-Out is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the rear (Figure 1b).
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Toe should be the last alignment specification adjusted. Refer to the Front Axle (FA) and Rear
Axle (RA) sections of the appropriate Service Manual to determine the proper locations to adjust
the front and rear Toe.
2. Toe should be equal, side-to-side.
3. Toe-In
When the specification is labeled "Toe-In" and dimensions are negative numbers (ie: -6 to -2 mm),
the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 2).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-In specification = Toe-In wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-In specification =
Toe-out wheel setting.
Toe-Out
Page 4788
which will result in contamination, and damage to recovery/recycle equipment.
^ Use equipment designed to meet Society of Automotive engineers (SAE) standards, which
specify R-134a service equipment fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME), and service hose identification
(black stripe on hose).
^ Adapters to convert from one size fitting to the other must never be used; refrigerant/lubricant
contamination will occur and system failure may result.
^ The use of incorrect equipment will result in refrigerant and/or lubricant contamination, which may
cause A/C system or equipment failure.
^ ACR(4) machine will perform all required service functions (recovery, evacuation, recycle,
recharge).
^ High volume A/C service facilities may benefit from "component" A/C service equipment (vacuum
pump, weight scale, manifold gauge set) to supplement the ACR(4).
Comments regarding recovery/recycling equipment:
^ Be certain to follow the manufacturer's instructions for machine operation and machine
maintenance.
^ Never introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.
^ Only R-134a containers with a 1/2"-16 ACME can be used to add R-134a to the ACR4
recovery/recycle machine.
^ Periodic maintenance of this equipment is required; follow the manufacturer's recommendations
as described in the equipment instruction manual.
Page 5102
Tape Player: Technical Service Bulletins Cassette - Poor Sound Quality/Loss of Channel/Jamming
REFERENCE: NTB93-017
CLASSIFICATION: EL93-004
DATE: January 21, 1993
TITLE: CASSETTE TAPE PLAYER MAINTENANCE
APPLIED VEHICLES(S): All Nissan vehicles equipped with cassette tape players
SERVICE INFORMATION In normal use, the playback head, capstan and rollers of any cassette
tape player will attract dirt or residues from the tape material each time a cassette is played. This
causes a deterioration of sound quality (i.e., distortion, reduced frequency response, and reduced
clarity). If residues and dirt are not removed, loss of channel(s) or "tape eating" may occur. In order
to help your customers to avoid these incidents and ensure optimum performance from their
cassette tape players, please advise them of the need to perform the following maintenance
procedures:
SERVICE PROCEDURE Use a cassette cleaning kit to clean the cassette tape player (specifically
the tape head and capstan rollers) after every 30 hours of play or once a month, whichever comes
first. You may use the Nissan Cassette Deck Cleaning System, P/N 999U2-AD010 or equivalent.
Be careful to follow the kit usage instructions. CASSETTE TAPE CARE GUIDELINES:
- Before turning off the radio, eject the cassette being played. Allowing the tape mechanism to stop
while a tape is engaged can damage the tape, pinch roller or capstan. After turning off the radio, do
not leave the tape in the cassette door pathway.
- Use tapes which are 90 minutes or less in play time.
- Use protective plastic cases to store cassettes when not in use. This will prevent them from
unwinding and collecting dust.
- Protect tapes from extreme heat, direct sunlight, extreme cold, and from foreign material such as
liquids or sticky substances. Discard damaged or contaminated tapes.
- Do not use tapes that are more than 5 years old. Older tapes suffer from stretch and increased
tape residue.
NOTE: If your customer complains of deterioration of sound quality, loss of channels(s) or "tape
eating," please clean the cassette tape player using the Cassette Deck Cleaning System as
described above. In most cases, this procedure will return the cassette deck to full efficiency.
Page 1580
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
Ignition Wire
The coil wire connects the ignition coil to the distributor cap, allowing high voltage to flow from the
coil to the distributor cap. The spark plug wires connect the terminals in the distributor cap to the
spark plugs, allowing high voltage to flow to the spark plugs. The ignition wires have an internal
resistance to suppress radio static and to eliminate static that may interfere with sensitive computer
components.
Page 5166
Rear door
DOOR LOCK & STRIKER BOLTS
This Bulletin gives revised torque specifications for door lock and door striker bolts (see illustration
on next page).
Page 2588
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 3019
Altitude Compensation
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Compensation
Altitude compensation prevents deterioration of exhaust emissions caused by an enriched air/fuel
mixture. Atmospheric pressure varies according to the altitude. The higher the altitude, the lower
the atmospheric pressure. At an atmospheric pressure of approximately 26 in. Hg or below, the
altitude switch transmits an ``On'' signal to the control unit, decreasing fuel to provide an
appropriate air/fuel mixture ratio.
Page 2065
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 125
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 3277
Inspection Procedure
Page 751
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4963
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Page 2153
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2550
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Brakes - Ammco On Car Brake Lathe Operating
Guidelines
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Ammco On Car Brake Lathe Operating
Guidelines
Classification: BR92-004
Section: Brake
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-062
Models: All models
Date: August 18, 1992
AMMCO ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE OPERATING GUIDELINES
APPLIED MODEL: All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
To ensure the best possible surface finish and least amount of run-out and rotor thickness variation
when using the Ammco on-car brake lathe, the following guidelines should be observed.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Before mounting the brake lathe on the vehicle ensure the following:
1. The V-way between the carriage and carriage jib must be clean and adjusted properly (see
Operation Manual for adjustment procedure). Wipe off sliding surfaces with a soft cloth after each
use.
2. The cutters and cutting bits must be tight in their mounts and positioned properly. Change cutting
bits when they become dull.
3. When securing the adjustable mounting brackets to the caliper mount/knuckle the mounting
surfaces must be smooth and free of burrs.
4. Make sure the adjustable mounting brackets are securely mounted to caliper mount/knuckle.
There should be no movement between the cutting tool and the caliper mount/knuckle.
Rotor Driving Unit Before using the drive unit ensure the following:
Page 2981
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 792
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Engine - Drive Belt Noise Diagnosis
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Noise Diagnosis
Classification: EM09-013
Reference: NTB10-002
Date: January 12, 2010
DRIVE BELT SYSTEM NOISE DIAGNOSIS
APPLIED VEHICLES All Nissan
IF YOU CONFIRM
There is noise coming from the drive belt(s), or drive belt pulley(s),
ACTION
Use the flow chart in this bulletin to help diagnose and identify the source / cause of the noise.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Refer to the current Nissan Warranty Flat Rate Manual and use the indicated claims coding for any
repairs performed.
Page 653
Alignment: Specifications
Rear Camber Angle -1 11/12 to - 5/12 deg
Camber Angle Desired - 1/5 deg
Toe Per Wheel +.04 to +.12 in
Total Degrees - 1/10 to + 9/30 deg
Description and Operation
Vacuum Amplifier: Description and Operation
Fig. 55 Vacumm amplifier.
The vacuum amplifier which receives a weak vacuum signal produced in sub-venturi, activates the
venturi diaphragm. This controls the output vacuum admitted to the EGR control valve.
Page 3084
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 3861
Fig. 5 AD18B type front disc brake disassembled
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.011 in
Exhaust 0.011 in
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Page 2608
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 4006
Fig. 6 AD18V type front disc brake disassembled
Brake Pad, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Remove lock pin, Figs. 4, 5 and 6, and pivot caliper body upwards.
3. Remove pad retainers, then the pads.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Install inner pad, then pull cylinder body out and install outer pad.
Caliper, Replace
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Disconnect brake hose from brake tube.
3. Remove caliper attaching bolts, then the caliper assembly from vehicle.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Caliper Overhaul
1. Separate cylinder body and torque member, Figs. 4, 5 and 6.
2. Remove brake hose, then press out piston with dust seal and retainer ring.
3. Remove piston seal, guide pin and lock pin from torque member.
4. Reverse procedure to assemble.
Page 2237
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Page 3554
3. Move selector lever from "P" range to "1" range. Make sure that selector lever can move
smoothly and without any sliding noise. 4. Place selector lever at "P" range again. 5. Make sure
that selector lever locks at "P" range. 6. Loosen lock nuts.
7. Screw lock nut (X) until it touches select rod end while holding select rod horizontal, and tighten
lock nut (Y). 8. Move selector lever from "P" range to "1" range again Make sure that selector lever
can move smoothly and without any sliding noise. 9. Apply grease to contacting areas of selector
lever and selector rod.
Page 2773
Air Induction Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 116 Air Injecton Valve (AIV) Operation
The air injection valve system delivers secondary air to the exhaust manifold, utilizing a vacuum
caused by exhaust pulsation in the exhaust manifold. Specific operating conditions are outlined in
Fig. 116
Page 115
Engine Control Module: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 1521
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 2676
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2846
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Testing and Inspection
Check carbon canister as follows. (A): Blow air and ensure that there is no leakage. (B): Blow air
and ensure that there is leakage.
Page 68
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Page 968
Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCS) are chemical compounds made up of molecules that contain atoms of
chlorine and fluorine bonded to carbon atoms. CFCs are used in a number of applications, the
most common of which are in automotive air conditioners, in the blowing of plastic foam products,
and as solvents in electronic component manufacturing. Ozone is a special form of oxygen which
combines three oxygen atoms into O3. Ozone in the Earth's upper atmosphere serves as a shield
from harmful ultra violet solar radiation by reflecting the rays back into space.
When CFCs are released into the air, here's what happens: the molecules work their way upward
in the atmosphere slowly, taking as long as ten years to reach the middle stratosphere, 20 to 40
kilometers above the surface of the earth, where the "ozone layer" resides. The CFC molecules are
bombarded by ultra violet light from the sun, which tends to break the chemical bonds that hold
chlorine and fluorine to the carbon. The fluorine atoms can combine with moisture to form acids.
When the chlorine breaks away, it becomes a chemical "catalyst," which means that it can cause
chemical reactions to occur rapidly. Thus, a chlorine atom can break the chemical bonds that hold
O3 together and O3 becomes O2 and O. It is now no longer "ozone" and it no longer has its
reflective quality to turn ultra violet radiation away from the earth. Given the right conditions, the
chlorine from one CFC molecule could destroy up to 100,000 ozone molecules.
Page 740
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2346
System description: When the switch is ON, the ECU lights up the lamp.
The VOLTAGE VALUE is based on the body ground.
Page 3308
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 472
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Engine - Block Heater Precaution
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Block Heater Precaution
Models: All Models
Section: Engine Mechanical
Classification: EM88-004
Bulletin No.: TS88-025
Date: February 22, 1988
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER
APPLIED MODELS: All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Engine antifreeze in more than 50% concentration has been found to adversely affect the life and
performance of the engine block heater. High phosphate content in the antifreeze forms a scale
around the heating element of the block heater, causing the temperature to rise, with subsequent
failure of the seals. Therefore, for best results it is recommended that you use a concentration no
greater than 50% antifreeze and 50% water.
Page 2358
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Page 5160
Rear door
DOOR LOCK & STRIKER BOLTS
This Bulletin gives revised torque specifications for door lock and door striker bolts (see illustration
on next page).
Page 1554
Page 5205
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 1829
Power Transistor: Testing and Inspection
Power Transistor Test
Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between terminals as per the image. Replace power
transistor if it fails the above tests.
Service and Repair
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3034
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2305
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 1448
Page 1798
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 319
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 5382
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Page 1167
Page 1739
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON M10 CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
Page 1770
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1523
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Engine Compartment Component Locations
Page 5286
5. Dry vehicle with a chamois.
6. After rinsing - inspect the surface for drips, sags, runs and missed areas.
Page 1973
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Page 537
SPECIAL TOOLS
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3037
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2169
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3181
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2562
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Fig. 303a Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 1924
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-009 Date: 100119
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Classification: EM09-015
Reference: NTB10-009
Date: January 19, 2010
REMOVAL PROCEDURE FOR SEIZED EXHAUST SENSOR
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
If an exhaust sensor is seized in the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube, perform the procedure
described in this bulletin to remove the sensor and prevent unnecessary replacement of the
exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
In most cases this procedure is successful. This is because the threads of the exhaust sensors are
made of a softer material than the part they thread into on the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
NOTE:
The replacement of exhaust manifolds/catalysts/front tubes for stripped exhaust sensor threads
may not be considered a warrantable expense.
This procedure can be performed by two methods:
Method #1 - If the Sensor Can Be Easily Accessed
^ The procedure can be performed on the vehicle.
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube will not have to be removed.
Method #2 - If the Sensor Cannot Be Easily Accessed
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube must be removed from the vehicle.
^ The procedure will be performed with the part clamped in a vice.
Method #2 is described in this bulletin. Method #1 is the same as Method #2 except that it is
performed on the vehicle.
Service Procedure
Rust Penetrant
Recommended rust penetrants to be used in this procedure:
Page 3099
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2223
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
Removing Spark Plug Boot
REMOVAL 1.
Remove the ignition wire from the spark plug with a twisting and pulling motion. CAUTION: Pull on
the boot only. Do not pull on the wire.
2. Using compressed air, blow out the area at the base of the spark plug to remove any debris USE
SAFETY GLASSES.
3. Using a 5/8" (16mm) flex socket and extension, remove the spark plugs (counterclockwise
rotation).
INSTALLATION 1.
Using a suitable tool, check and adjust the spark plug gap. ELECTRODE GAP
0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
2. Using a suitable rubber hose or designated tool, start the spark plugs by hand (clockwise
rotation).
3. Tighten and torque the spark plugs. SPARK PLUG TORQUE
14 - 22 ft. lbs. (20 - 29 N-m / 2.0 - 3.0 kg-m)
4. Apply a small amount of di-electric compound to the inside of the spark plug boots.
5. Reinstall the spark plug boots.
Page 5048
System Operational Check
Before beginning "System Operational Check", turn the ignition key on, roll down the drivers side
window, turn the ignition off and remove the key. Close all doors, trunk and hood.
Page 2324
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 5150
7. Apply a double wet coat of Flexible Parts Coating. After a 10 minute flash time, apply a second
double coat. Let dry 45 minutes and lightly scuff sand the coating with 320 grit disc. Apply color
coats recommended for plastic body parts.
Page 1775
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 3179
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4122
Slow Battery Charge
CLAIMS INFORMATION Please reference the Nissan "Assurance Products Resource Manual" for
battery claim procedures.
Page 3049
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE:
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 783
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 1750
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3116
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1449
Page 2703
Page 4283
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 2924
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
a. Tighten the clamp so its end is 3 mm (0.12 in) from the hose end. b. Make sure that the screw of
the clamp does not contact with any adjacent parts. c. Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
: Fuel hose clamps
1.0 - 1.5 N.m (0.10 - 0.15 kg-m, 0.7 - 1.1 ft-lb)
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose at the electro injection unit.
3. Install a pressure gauge. 4. Start the engine and check the fuel line for fuel leakage. 5. Read fuel
pressure gauge.
At idling speed:
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2, 36.3 psi)
6. Release fuel pressure again. 7. Remove the pressure gauge from the fuel line. 8. Reconnect the
fuel inlet hose.
Page 4790
Comments regarding vacuum pump use:
^ The lubricant contained inside the vacuum pump is not compatible with the lubrication for R-134a
A/C systems.
^ The vent side of the vacuum pump is exposed to atmospheric pressure, causing the vacuum
pump lubricant to migrate out of the pump if the pump is switched oft after evacuation (vacuuming)
and there is no shut off valve between the pump and the hose.
^ To prevent the migration of vacuum pump lubricant into service hoses, it is necessary to use a
valve (which can be manually opened or closed) near the connection of the service hose to the
pump.
^ On a vacuum pump which is equipped with an isolation valve (usually part of the vacuum pump),
closing this valve will isolate the service hose from the pump.
^ For pumps without an isolation valve, be certain that the service hose is equipped with a manual
shut off valve near the pump end of the hose.
^ Hoses which contain an automatic shut off valve at the end of the service hose must be
disconnected from the vacuum pump to prevent the migration of lubricant; as long as the hose is
connected, the valve is open and lubricant may migrate (with pump off).
^ One-way valves which open when vacuum is applied and close under a no vacuum condition are
not recommended, because this valve may restrict the pump's ability to pull a deep vacuum.
Page 5383
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Fuel Pump Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 876
Drive Belt: Specifications Belt Deflection
Belt Deflection
Alternator Limit 0.53 in
Adjust deflection 0.33 - 0.37 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.29 - 0.33 in
Air conditioner compressor Limit 0.49 in
Adjust deflection 0.35 - 0.39 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.24 - 0.31 in
Power steering oil pump Limit 0.41 in
Adjust deflection 0.28 - 0.35 in
Set deflection of new belt 0.25 - 0.33 in
Locations
Ignition Coil Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2986
Page 1084
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 2091
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Locations
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 782
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4117
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Electronic Component Damage Prevention
Classification: EL09-011
Reference: NTB09-030
Date: April 6, 2009
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT DAMAGE CAN RESULT FROM IMPROPER BATTERY
CONNECTION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ The vehicle 12 volt battery is an important part of the vehicle electrical system and is required to
stay connected when the engine is running.
^ To prevent damage to vehicle electronic components follow the instructions / cautions below.
IMPORTANT:
Damage to electronic components (ECM, TCM, BCM, etc.) due to improper battery connection will
not be covered under warranty.
CAUTION:
^ Make sure the ignition is OFF during battery service and replacement.
^ Do not disconnect or connect any battery cables while the ignition switch is turned ON.
^ When disconnecting a battery, always disconnect the negative cable first.
^ When connecting a battery, always connect the positive cable first.
^ Do not leave a battery cable loose. Tighten battery cables immediately after attachment.
^ If a battery cable is loose, do not operate any electrical loads. (This includes turning the ignition
ON, starting the engine, operating accessories such as
the A/C system, power seats, interior lights, exterior lights etc.).
^ When "jump starting" or "boosting" a battery - be careful. Don't accidentally reverse the polarity of
the cables.
Disclaimer
Page 1923
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Minimum Ring End Gap Compression Ring Top 0.0079 in
Second 0.0059 in
Oil Ring 0.0079 in
Page 4360
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the following flow chart. Use this chart,
as appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE:
If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on the car
brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect alignment
during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications. This could
require the rotor to be turned again.
Brake Rotor Service Flow Chart
(*)CAUTION:
To ensure a proper repair, it is absolutely essential to make these measurements. For example, if
run-out remains high, brake judder and/or shimmy may not be detected while test driving the
vehicle immediately after the repair, but, may return after several thousand miles of rotor wear (due
to thickness variation).
Prior to and, again, after resurfacing a brake rotor, ensure that the rotor thickness is above the
minimum specification.
General Brake Repair Guidelines To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the
following 1.
Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug bolts
may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
Page 3080
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 4957
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Page 3622
Chart A & B
Cooler Inlet And Outlet Locations
Cooler Cleaning (in radiator)
CAUTION:
You must refer to Charts A and B to determine the location of the oil cooler inlet and outlet hoses
for the vehicle your working on.
If these hoses are not identified correctly, debris may be left in the cooler and transmission damage
may occur.
1. Place an oil drain pan under the automatic transmission cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses.
Page 414
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Brakes - On-Car Rotor Refinishing
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - On-Car Rotor Refinishing
Classification: BR04-007
Reference: NTB04-094
Date: August 20, 2004
NISSAN: ON-CAR BRAKE ROTOR RESURFACING
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
If YOU CONFIRM:
A vehicle needs to have the brake rotors resurfaced (front or rear),
ACTION:
Use the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe to perform brake rotor resurfacing and follow
the tips listed in this bulletin.
^ The ProCut(TM) PFM Series brake lathe has been chosen as the approved tool for rotor
resurfacing.
^ The ProCut(TM) PFM Series brake lathe can be ordered from TECH-MATE at 1-800-662-2001.
^ ProCut(TM) technical support or service can be obtained by calling 1-800-543-6618.
NOTE:
Brake rotors may need to be resurfaced during routine brake repair or for brake "Judder" incidents.
^ Brake judder: A brake pedal pulsation and/or steering wheel shimmy when braking that occurs
when there is too much thickness variation of the brake rotors (see NTB00-033).
TIPS FOR USING THE PROCUT(TM) PFM SERIES ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE
^ Read and follow all instructions contained in the Technical Manual provided with your ProCut(TM)
equipment.
^ The ProCut(TM) brake lathe also comes with an instructional video that can be used as a training
aid.
^ Additional training is available from your local ProCut(TM) representative by calling
1-800-543-6618.
A. Make sure the cutting tips are sharp, in good condition and installed "right-side" up.
^ Make sure to use ProCut(TM) brand tips.
^ The cutting tip "UP" side has a groove or letters.
NOTE:
A tip mounted upside-down will produce a surface finish that looks like an old LP record.
^ Each cutting tip has three cutting corners. Rotate or replace the tip as needed.
NOTE:
You should get at least 7 cuts per corner. However, tip life is affected by variables such as rust or
ridges. In order to determine when to rotate tips, monitor the rotor finish. If the rotor finish begins to
look inconsistent or feels rough to the touch, tips should be rotated or replaced. Tips that are
chipped or cracked should never be used.
Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Axle Bearing and Knuckle
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 1682
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Locations
Fig. 1 Timing Mark
Page 1483
Page 3024
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 420
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Service and Repair
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 284
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 1742
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Classification: PI95-005A
Reference: NTB95-120A
Date: January 10, 2003
COLD WEATHER STARTING TIPS
This bulletin supersedes PI95-005. The Service Information has been amended. Please discard all
paper copies of PI95-005
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
In case a vehicle is hard to start during cold weather, we suggest the following procedure.
^ These steps are a review of the procedure outlined in the Owner's Manual.
^ Use these steps when the weather is cold and the engine is hard to start.
1. Press the accelerator pedal down approximately 1/3 of the way to the floor.
2. Hold the accelerator pedal in this position while cranking the engine.
3. Once the engine has started release the accelerator pedal.
NOTE:
Do not race the engine while warming it up.
4. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, stop cranking, wait at least 10 seconds. Then
repeat steps 1 through 3.
Once an engine is started in cold weather condition:
^ You should keep the engine running for a minimum of 2-3 minutes before shutting it off.
^ Starting and stopping of the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more
difficult to restart.
^ It may also adversely affect a vehicle's fuel economy.
Another factor which may affect a vehicles "startability" is the viscosity or thickness of the oil that is
used.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity engine oil is preferred for all temperatures, all year-round for most models.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity oil makes it easier to start the engine and maintain a stable idle during
warm-up.
Please communicate these cold weather starting tips to your customers.
Disclaimer
Page 2833
Canister Purge Control Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Check for fuel vapor leakage in the distributor vacuum line at diaphragm of carbon canister
purge control valve.
a. Disconnect rubber hose in line between ``T'' connector and carbon canister ``T'' connector. b.
Inhale air into opening of rubber hose running to vacuum hole in carbon canister and ensure that
there is no leak.
2. If there is a leak, remove top cover of purge control valve and check for dislocated or cracked
diaphragm. If necessary, replace diaphragm assembly which consists of a retainer, diaphragm, and
spring.
Page 2335
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 1498
Page 3899
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Page 3997
1. Before using the rotor driving unit ensure that all lug nuts are installed on the lugs (including the
lugs not used for the lug adaptor). All lug nuts
should be evenly torqued, to at least 40 ft/lbs. Do not over-tighten the lug nuts as damage may
occur to the lug adaptor legs.
2. To prevent chatter and ensure a smooth rotor finish, install the largest and heaviest silencer
band possible around the outside diameter of the rotor.
ROTOR CUTTING Before engaging the cutting tool, ensure the following:
1. Using the dial indicator, measure rotor/hub run-out prior to resurfacing rotor and adjust cutting
depth to eliminate this run-out. Each cut may be
between 0.05 mm and 0.25 mm (0.002" and 0.010"). Additional cuts may be necessary to eliminate
all the run-out.
2. Using a micrometer, measure rotor thickness in at least 8 even locations around the rotor. Do
not cut below the minimum rotor thickness
specification. Replace rotor if the run-out cannot be eliminated without exceeding the minimum
rotor thickness specification.
3. After rotor resurfacing is completed, measure the rotor/hub run-out using a dial indicator. Ensure
that the run-out is below the specification for the
vehicle. If run-out is not within specifications, turn the rotors again. Properly machined rotors will
have almost zero run-out (.001" or less) with no measurable thickness variation.
CAUTION: When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from
contacting or collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the
ABS wheel speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE: If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on
the car brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect
alignment during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications.
This could require the rotor to be turned again.
4. Do not smooth the rotor surface with sand paper or other abrasive material.
Page 656
Fig. 14 Typical tie rod length measurement.
Fig. 17 Tie rod length specifications
Toe is adjusted by loosening the tie rod locknuts or adjusting sleeve bolts and equally altering the
length of the tie rods. After toe has been adjusted to specifications, the lengths of the left and right
tie rods, Fig. 14, should be nearly equal and close to the length specified in Fig. 17. If tie rod
lengths are incorrect, tie rods should be disassembled and adjusted to specifications, and the toe
setting should be readjusted before checking steering angles. Incorrect tie rod length will adversely
affect steering angles and toe-out on turns.
Page 3066
Idle Speed: Adjustments
Midpoint of range given is the preferred setting speed.
1981-83 L28 Turbo, 1983 E15 Turbo:
With engine at operating temperature, race several times and return to idle. Disconnect idle control
valve and check speed against specified value.
1984-87 E16 2V Federal:
With engine at operating temperature, disconnect vacuum control modulator harness. Race engine
several times and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect vacuum
control modulator harness. Restart engine, race several times, and check idle speed against
specified value.
1987-90 E16 FI, GA16; 1989-90 KA24:
With engine at operating temperature disconnect throttle sensor harness connector. Start engine
and set idle to specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine.
Verify that idle speed is within checking speed. Turn on AC and verify that idle increases to
specified value.
1984-89 VG30 Turbo, 1987-89 CA16, CA18 DOHC:
With engine at operating temperature, turn ignition off and disconnect automatic air control (AAC)
valve harness. Start engine and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect
harness. Restart engine and check idle speed against specified value. Turn AC on and verify that
speed-up is at specified value. All engines, turn AC on and verify that speed-up speed is specified
value.
1987-88 CA18 Turbo, 1987-89 CA20 Stanza:
Disconnect throttle valve and automatic air control valve harness. Start engine and adjust idle to
specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine. Verify that idle is at
specified checking speed.
1989-90 VG30 Maxima:
Turn diagnostic connector on ECU fully clockwise and adjust idle to specified value. Verify that idle
is at specified checking speed. 1990 300ZX:
Attach inductive clamp to loop wire on power transistor behind upper radiator hose. Set idle to
specified value.
Page 3317
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 694
Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Classification: PI95-005A
Reference: NTB95-120A
Date: January 10, 2003
COLD WEATHER STARTING TIPS
This bulletin supersedes PI95-005. The Service Information has been amended. Please discard all
paper copies of PI95-005
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
In case a vehicle is hard to start during cold weather, we suggest the following procedure.
^ These steps are a review of the procedure outlined in the Owner's Manual.
^ Use these steps when the weather is cold and the engine is hard to start.
1. Press the accelerator pedal down approximately 1/3 of the way to the floor.
2. Hold the accelerator pedal in this position while cranking the engine.
3. Once the engine has started release the accelerator pedal.
NOTE:
Do not race the engine while warming it up.
4. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, stop cranking, wait at least 10 seconds. Then
repeat steps 1 through 3.
Once an engine is started in cold weather condition:
^ You should keep the engine running for a minimum of 2-3 minutes before shutting it off.
^ Starting and stopping of the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more
difficult to restart.
^ It may also adversely affect a vehicle's fuel economy.
Another factor which may affect a vehicles "startability" is the viscosity or thickness of the oil that is
used.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity engine oil is preferred for all temperatures, all year-round for most models.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity oil makes it easier to start the engine and maintain a stable idle during
warm-up.
Please communicate these cold weather starting tips to your customers.
Disclaimer
Page 2168
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3859
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Page 4523
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Page 4653
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect wiring harness connector to resistor and check continuity with ohmmeter.
2. Meter should indicate continuity between all terminals although resistance values will vary.
Page 3368
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1282
KIT CONTENTS:
Item No. Qty Item
1 1 Heater assembly
2 1 Power cord
3 1 Power cord end protector cap
4 3 Tie wrap
5 1 Installation Instructions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Center punch Combination pliers
Hammer 4 mm hex wrench
Needle nose pliers Flat blade screwdriver
PROCEDURE
1. Drain coolant and remove specified core plug. (Do not use a screw type freeze plug puller or
similar tool to remove the plug as it may cause damage to the engine block.) Remove freeze plug
by positioning a flat blade screwdriver against the plug's recessed area and hammering it
repeatedly with very short strokes until the freeze plug is loosened and turns. (Do not hammer
freeze plug on the edges as this could damage engine block.) Then remove plug with needle nose
or combination pliers.
2. Thoroughly clean core plug hole, removing any burrs, compound, paint or rough spots. (If
necessary use fine emery paper being careful not to score surface.)
3. Apply a coating of grease to the heater "O" ring and machined surface of the engine block hole
to facilitate installation and prevent "O" ring damage.
NOTE: DO NOT USE GASKET GLUE - it hardens, preventing proper seal and eventually causes
leaks.
4. Refer to element direction shown in chart. Insert heater with element pointing in proper direction
and push flush to block.
5. Tighten screw to 14-19 in.lb.
6. Install the power cord and route it to the front grille, taping it and securing it with plastic tie wraps
where necessary, to insure that the cord does not touch any hot pipes, engine components or
moving parts.
7. Refill cooling system, pressurize to radiator cap relief pressure and check for leaks. Operate
engine to check further for leaks. Refer to manufacturer's Service Manual "Engine Cooling System"
section.
NOTE: It is recommended that low phosphate anti-freeze be used, and that a maximum
anti-freeze/water mixture ratio of 50/50 be used. Refer to the Nissan Owner's Manual "Engine
Cooling System" section.
8. Use cable end protector cap when heater is not plugged into power source.
WARNING: Before connecting heater to power source, make sure that cooling system is filled with
recommended coolant (see appropriate Service Manual).
ENGINE INSTALLATION
Engine Lower Hose Heater Installation Instructions
PART NUMBER: 99998-1024701
APPLICATION:
On-Vehicle Service
Governor: Service and Repair On-Vehicle Service
Governor Valve
1. Remove governor cap.
2. Remove governor valve assembly. 3. Disassemble, check and reassemble governor valve
assembly Refer to Repair for Component Parts. See: Service and Repair/Repair For
Component Parts
Page 2101
Page 3648
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
1987-88 PULSAR & 2WD SENTRA
Fig. 1 Rear Suspension (Part 2 Of 2). 2WD Models
Refer to Fig. 9 for replacement, noting the following:
1. When raising and supporting vehicle, do not jack up at parallel links.
2. Disconnect brake hydraulic line and parking brake cable at equalizer.
Fig. 10 Removing exhaust pipe & radius rod. 1987-88 Pulsar & 2WD Sentra
3. Remove exhaust pipe attaching bolts, Fig. 10, then radius rod attaching bolts and pull out radius
rod, pushing exhaust pipe downward.
4. Remove shock absorber upper attaching bolts.
Page 3198
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 58
240SX (S14) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 2892
Vacuum Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Orally suck in air through venturi-ported vacuum side of check valve and listen for operating sound.
If no sound is heard, replace valve.
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Axle Shaft, Halfshaft U-Joint Type
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Axle Shaft, Halfshaft U-Joint Type
DISASSEMBLY & INSPECTION
Fig. 6 Exploded view of driveshaft assembly. 1982-84 Pulsar, Sentra & Stanza, 1985-88 similar
1. Disassemble tripod type joint as follows:
a. Install driveshaft in suitable soft-jawed vise. b. Remove and discard boot bands, Fig. 6. c.
Separate slide joint housing with cover, and the driveshaft with spider assembly. Scribe an
alignment mark for assembly reference. d. Remove and discard snap ring, then press spider
assembly off of shaft. e. On 1984 models, remove boot, the cut edge of slide joint cover and
remove and discard the cover. Remove and discard O-ring. f.
On 1985-88 models, remove and discard boot bands. Scribe alignment marks on joint assembly
and shaft, then remove joint assembly and boot.
2. Disassemble double offset type joint as follows:
a. Install driveshaft in suitable soft-jawed vise. b. Remove and discard boot bands, Fig. 6. c.
Remove snap ring, then the slide joint housing. d. Clean grease off of bearing cage and drive out
balls, then rotate cage approximately 180° and remove from inner race. e. Remove and discard
small snap ring, then tap inner race off of shaft and remove boot.
3. Remove and discard boot bands from wheel side of shaft.
4. Scribe alignment mark on driveshaft and joint assembly, then remove the joint assembly and
boot.
5. Clean all components with suitable solvent and dry with compressed air.
6. Inspect driveshaft and replace it if twisted or cracked.
7. Inspect wheel side joint assembly for wear or damage and replace as necessary.
8. On tripod type joint, check spider assembly and slide joint housing for wear or damage and
replace as necessary.
9. On double offset type joint, check all components for wear, damage or excessive play and
replace as necessary.
ASSEMBLY & INSTALLATION
Fig. 9 Axle shaft boot installation
Page 4601
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Fastener Tightening Sequence
Lug Nut Torque Patterns
IMPORTANT
Check all parts, including rims, lug studs, lug nuts, and mating surfaces of hubs and tire rims for
rust, damage, or dirt. Clean mating surfaces with a wire brush to remove any foreign material.
Replace any damaged parts as needed. Careless installation of tire/rim assemblies in a vehicle is a
major cause of tire installation problems. Proper installation, including fastener torque, is essential
to economical, safe and trouble free service. Use only the proper sizes and types of fasteners for
safe and proper service. Tighten the fasteners a quarter turn at a time using the tightening
sequence diagram as a guide. This is very important to prevent misalignment of the wheel.
Continue tightening the fasteners in sequence until the fasteners are tightened to the proper torque
(See WHEEL FASTENER TORQUE).
CAUTION: Improper torque or tightening sequence can cause distortion, fatigue cracks, or
alignment problems. After driving the vehicle for a short distance, recheck the wheel fastener
torque. Parts will usually seat naturally, reducing the torque on the fasteners. Retorque all
fasteners to the proper torque.
Page 1433
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
A/C - Refrigerant Leaks From Connections
A/C Coupler O-ring: Customer Interest A/C - Refrigerant Leaks From Connections
Classification: HA09-003
Reference: NTB09-099
Date: September 25, 2009
A/C SYSTEM O-RING SEAL LEAKS
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles with A/C system
IF YOU CONFIRM
A refrigerant leak at a refrigerant pipe/hose joint location,
NOTE:
Follow the leak detection information in the Service Manual to determine the source of refrigerant
leaks.
ACTIONS
NOTE:
The O-ring seal is the most common cause of a refrigerant leak at an A/C joint.
1. Inspect the metal surfaces of the pipe/hose joint for damage or contamination.
NOTE:
Do not replace a refrigerant pipe, hose, or other A/C component if an o-ring seal will solve the leak
incident, if it should occur.
2. If no damage is found to the joint metal surfaces, replace the O-ring seal.
CAUTION:
^ When replacing O-ring seals, use lint-free gloves,
^ Make sure no foreign material is introduced into the system when the joint is open.
^ Apply A/C oil to the O-ring before installation.
^ After recharging the system, recheck for leaks.
PARTS INFORMATION
Reference an electronic parts catalog (FAST or equivalent) for any needed parts.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference the current Nissan Warranty Flat Rate Manual and use the correct coding for repairs
performed.
Page 3143
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation
PRESSURE REGULATOR
The pressure regulator, built into the side of the throttle body, maintains the fuel pressure as
follows.
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0 kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2 , 36.3 psi)
Since the injected fuel amount depends on injection pulse duration, it is necessary to keep
pressure constant.
Description and Operation
Auxiliary Air Valve (Idle Speed): Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Air regulator
The air regulator, Fig. 20, bypasses the throttle valve to control the quantity of air for increasing the
engine idling speed when starting the engine at an underhood temperature of below 176°F. A
bi-metal and a heater are incorporated into the air regulator. When the ignition switch is turned to
the ``Start'' position or when the engine is running, electric current flows through the heater, and
the bi-metal, as it is heated by the heater, begins to move and closes the air passage in a few
minutes. The air passage remains closed until the engine is stopped and the underhood air
temperature drops below 176°F.
Seat Trim - Non-Warrantable Examples
Seats: Technical Service Bulletins Seat Trim - Non-Warrantable Examples
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN WB/90-011
Date: June 15, 1990
TO: ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: SEAT TRIM WARRANTY CLAIMS
An ongoing analysis of Seat Trim returned through the Part Return Program has shown an
increasing volume of non-warrantable seat trim replacements being claimed as a warrantable
repair. Non-warrantable seat trim examples are cigarette burns, cuts and punctures.
Please instruct your Warranty Administration team that seat trim damage as indicated above is not
covered by the Nissan New Vehicle Limited Warranty and should not be submitted for
reimbursement via the Warranty Claim Processing System.
Thank you for your assistance.
Engine - Block Heater Installation Instructions
Technical Service Bulletin # 90086 Date: 901025
Engine - Block Heater Installation Instructions
Models: All Models
Section: Engine Mechanical
Classification: EM90-007
Bulletin No.: NT890-086
Date: October 25, 1990
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
PART NUMBER: 999M4-YA002
APPLICATION:
MODEL ENGINE TYPE YEAR LOCATION
Sentra SR20DE 1991 Rear side of the engine.
NX 2000 & Threaded freeze plug on right
later side of starter motor. (Fig.1)
KIT CONTENTS:
Item No. Qty. Item
1 1 Engine block heater assembly
2 1 Gasket
3 1 Power cord
4 1 Power cord end protector cap
5 3 Tie wrap
6 1 Installation Instructions
TOOLS REQUIRED:
Phillips tip screwdriver 24 mm combination wrench
10 mm socket and ratchet 24 mm socket
12 mm Hex bit w/universal joint Torque wrench
and extension Cutting pliers
Installation Precautions/Notes:
^ Be careful not to damage engine block threads when removing freeze plug or installing block
heater.
^ Handle engine block heater with care to avoid damaging the threads.
^ Do not over-torque engine block heater.
^ Ensure that power cord doesn't contact exhaust pipes, sharp edges or vehicle moving parts.
^ Torque removed vehicle parts to proper specifications.
Page 5103
Tape Player: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Cassette Tape Player Maintenance
Classification: EL90-002
Reference: NTB90-044
Date: May 24, 1990
CASSETTE TAPE PLAYER MAINTENANCE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S) All Nissan vehicles equipped with a cassette tape player
SERVICE INFORMATION The playback head, capstan, and roller will attract dirt or residues from
the tape material each time a cassette is played. This causes a deterioration of sound quality (i.e.
distortion, reduced frequency response, and reduced clarity/fullness). If residues and dirt are not
removed, loss of channel(s) or tape continuity (also referred to as: "tape eating") may occur.
SERVICE PROCEDURE To ensure the optimum performance from a cassette tape player, the
following Periodic Maintenance guidelines should be observed: ^
Clean the cassette tape player (specifically, the tape head and capstan rollers) after 10 hours of
play or once a month (whichever occurs first).
^ Use a cassette cleaning kit (such as: Nissan Cassette Deck Cleaning System, P/N 999U2-A7000
or equivalent), being careful to follow the kit manufacturer's instructions.
Additionally, the following Cassette Tape Care guidelines should be observed: ^
Before turning off the radio, eject the cassette being played. Leaving the tape mechanism stopped
while a tape is engaged can damage the tape, pinch roller, or capstan. Use tapes which are 90
minutes or less in play time.
^ Store cassette tapes properly, when not in use;
1. Use protective plastic case to prevent tape from unwinding and accumulating dust.
2. Protect tapes from extreme heat, direct sun light, and extreme cold. After turning off the radio, do
not leave the tape in the cassette door pathway.
Remove it to allow the tape slot door to close and keep out airborne dirt.
^ Do not use tapes that are more than 5 years old. Older tapes suffer from stretch and increased
tape head residue.
The preceding information should be given to the customer at the time of vehicle purchase (Sales
Department) and during vehicle servicing (Service Department).
Page 5204
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Page 2242
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 2531
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 3061
AB-/BC VALVE CONTROL
When the idle switch is OFF, the I.S.C. valve opens in response to the amount of intake air and
engine speed. When the accelerator pedal is released, additional air is led into the intake manifold,
actuating as AB- or BC valve.
Page 2360
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2211
Distributor Cap: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Cap
1. Remove the screws securing the cap to the distributor.
2. Remove the ignition wires from the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for cracks or damage due to heat or arcing.
4. Inspect the terminals inside the cap for excessive corrosion and damage.
5. Inspect the ignition wire terminals for excessive corrosion. If the corrosion cannot be removed
with reasonable measures, replace the cap. Replace the cap if it fails the above tests.
Page 297
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
The exhaust gas sensor, which is placed into the exhaust manifold, monitors the amount of oxygen
in the exhaust gas. The sensor has a closed-end tube made of ceramic zirconia. The outer surface
of the tube is exposed to exhaust gas, and the inner surface to atmosphere. The zirconia of the
tube compares the oxygen density of exhaust gas with that of atmosphere, and generates
electricity. In order to improve generating power of the zirconia, its tube is coated with platinum.
The voltage is approximately 1V in a richer condition of the mixture ratio than the ideal air fuel ratio,
while approximately 0V in leaner conditions. The radical change from 1V to 0V occurs at around
the ideal mixture ratio. In this way, the exhaust gas sensor detects the amount of oxygen in the
exhaust gas and sends the signal of approximately 1V or 0V to the E.C.U.
Page 4512
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): Customer Interest Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV)
Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
M/T - F30A/F31A Fluid Leaks
Case: Customer Interest M/T - F30A/F31A Fluid Leaks
Classification: Section:
MT90-001 Manual Transaxle
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-024 Models:
1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: March 15, 1990
F30A & F31A MANUAL TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra (B12) 1987-1990 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The F30A/F31A manual transaxles used on the Applied Models listed above (check the appropriate
model Service Manual for manual transaxle application) may exhibit transmission oil leakage
between the clutch housing and the transaxle case due to insufficient case bolt torque.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
To improve the sealing performance at this area, a higher grade bolt is now used in production, and
the housing bolt tightening torque has been increased.
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated area, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the transaxle case halves, thoroughly clean and inspect the mating surfaces
for porosities, surface damage, etc. Apply sealant to the mating surfaces, then install the new bolts,
being certain to apply additional sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque as
indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
indicated area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Page 4677
Fig. 3 Locknut removal
4. Flatten lock washer tab, then remove pulley locknut using tool No. KV99235160, Fig. 3.
5. Reverse procedures to install, noting the following:
a. When assembling clutch disc, ensure clutch surface has been thoroughly cleaned.
Fig. 4 Adjusting pulley clearance
b. Insert feeler gauge between drive plate and pulley as shown, Fig. 4, and ensure clearance is
.012-.024 inch. If clearance is not as specified,
remove clutch plate, then remove or install adjusting shims as necessary.
c. Torque center bolt to 6.7-8.7 ft. lbs. d. Torque clutch locknut to 22-29 ft. lbs. e. After
replacement, perform ``Break-In'' by engaging and disengaging the compressor clutch
approximately thirty times.
Page 1520
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
M/T - Shift Lever Vibration or Buzzing
Shift Linkage: Customer Interest M/T - Shift Lever Vibration or Buzzing
1987-88 Sentra,
Models 1987 Pulsar
Section Manual Transmission
Classification MT89-001
Bulletin No. TS89-36
Date March 23, 1989
SENTRA/PULSAR SHIFT LEVER VIBRATION
APPLIED MODELS 1987 Pulsar 1987-88 Sentra (2WD)
APPLIED DATES & VINS Pulsar: July, 1987
JN1PN34S HM-044813 JN1EN34S HM-018300
Sentra (Japan built): July, 1987
JN1PB21S JU-523012 JN1PB22S JU-518678 JN1PB24S JU-023334 JN1PB25S JU-014701
JN1Pb26S JU-U14756
Sentra (U.S. built) February, 1988
1N4PB22S7JC778188
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some vehicles with manual transmissions manufactured before the applied dates may exhibit gear
shift lever vibration (or "buzzing") while driving at highway speeds.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 119
Engine Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Wiring Diagram
Page 1464
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2154
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Page 2509
240SX (S14) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 2958
Page 2475
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Service and Repair
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 2612
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 4387
large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4. Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation.
7. Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation.
8. Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service.
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement.
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10. Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based
cleaners degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the
rotor surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 863
2. Remove the following belts.
- Power steering oil pump drive belt
- Compressor drive belt
- Alternator drive belt
3. Set No. 1 cylinder at top dead center (T.D.C.) on its compression stroke. 4. Remove the water
pump pulley and crankshaft pulley.
NOTE: The crankshaft pulley is accessible after removing side cover from inside R.H. wheel house.
5. Remove right side engine mounting bracket.
NOTE: Support engine by placing a jack under oil pan. Do not place jack under oil pan drain plug.
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2976
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 435
Inspection Procedure
Page 2737
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 4102
Slow Battery Charge
CLAIMS INFORMATION Please reference the Nissan "Assurance Products Resource Manual" for
battery claim procedures.
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Plug Type Plug Air Gap Plug Torque
Standard Type BPR5ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Hot Type BPR4ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Cold Type BPR6ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Page 4801
Page 4284
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 635
Page 4302
Once you have set the target position, DO NOT reset it at anytime during the alignment process.
6. Begin the alignment procedure.
^ Follow all of the instructions for your particular equipment.
^ Refer to the Service Manual for alignment specifications.
If your equipment requires "rolling compensation". follow these additional tips:
^ DO NOT push or pull on the vehicle body.
IMPORTANT:
After performing "rolling compensation", DO NOT reset the target position.
When performing "caster sweep". follow these tips:
Page 4310
Fig. 14 Typical tie rod length measurement.
Fig. 17 Tie rod length specifications
Toe is adjusted by loosening the tie rod locknuts or adjusting sleeve bolts and equally altering the
length of the tie rods. After toe has been adjusted to specifications, the lengths of the left and right
tie rods, Fig. 14, should be nearly equal and close to the length specified in Fig. 17. If tie rod
lengths are incorrect, tie rods should be disassembled and adjusted to specifications, and the toe
setting should be readjusted before checking steering angles. Incorrect tie rod length will adversely
affect steering angles and toe-out on turns.
Page 592
The chart (Figure 5) shows the relationship between the common units of Total Toe measurement.
Conversions vary with wheel size. Reference the appropriate service manual for exact
specifications.
NOTE: When adjusting Total Toe on a vehicle with oversized tires, use the angle values on the
alignment machine. Oversized tires have a larger diameter.
Page 3010
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2061
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 1491
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Wheel Fastener Torque Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Lug Nuts 72 - 87 ft.lb
Maintenance - Cleaning Power Antenna & Wiper Blades
Antenna: All Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Cleaning Power Antenna & Wiper Blades
Models: See below Section: Electrical Classification: EL92-011 Bulletin No.: NTB92-083 Date:
October 8, 1992
MAINTENANCE OF POWER ANTENNA AND WIPER BLADES
APPLIED MODELS: All with Power Antenna; All Vehicles [Wiper Blades].
SERVICE INFORMATION:
1. Maintenance of Power Antenna
It is recommended that the Power Antenna rod, in its extended position, be periodically wiped with
a clean, soft, dry cloth. This is the most current information from the factory concerning proper
periodic maintenance of the Power Antenna.
I. Maintenance of Wiper Blades
1. To clean the rubber wiper blades, it is recommended to use a clean, soft, wet cloth [the cloth
should be moistened with washer liquid].
2. Before lowering the wiper blades onto the glass, it is advised to first clean the glass area swept
by the wiper blade. Use an appropriate, commercially-available glass cleaner and either paper
towels or a lint-free towel.
NOTE: If the vehicles you service are subject to ice and snow formation on the front or rear
windshields, you may recommend to your customers that wiper blade effectiveness, during these
environmental conditions, may be optimized, if both snow and ice are removed prior to operating
the wiper system(s).
Page 1141
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Service and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and drain cooling system.
2. Remove power steering drive belt and the power steering oil pump.
3. Remove alternator drive belt.
4. Loosen alternator attaching bolts and push alternator toward engine.
5. Remove water pump pulley, then the water pump and gasket.
6. Reverse procedure to install, using new gasket.
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 1281
Maxima VG30E (2) 1986 Front side, first plug 6 o'clock
& later from driver side.
200SX VG30E 1987 Driver side, first 6 o'clock
& later plug from the rear.
Stanza CA20E 1987 Front side, second 7 o'clock
Wagon & later plug from driver side.
Stanza CA20E 1989 Front side, first plug 7 o'clock
Sedan & later from driver side.
Sentra E16 (3) 1987-1988 Rear side, first plug 8 o'clock
Pulsar from passenger side.
Sentra GA16i (3) 1989 Front side, first plug 10 o'clock
Pulsar NX GA16DE (3) & later from passenger side.
Pulsar CA16DE 1987 Front side, first plug 5 o'clock
CA18DE & later from driver side.
(1) Remove exhaust pipe heat shield and steering column lower joint assembly for access to
indicated freeze plug. Remove section of exhaust pipe connected to turbocharger if necessary.
(2) Remove front section of exhaust pipe for access to indicated freeze plug.
(3) Remove alternator for access to indicated freeze plug.
KIT CONTENTS:
Item No. Qty Item
1 1 Heater assembly
2 1 Power cord
3 1 Power cord end protector cap
4 3 Tie wrap
5 1 Installation instructions
TOOLS REQUIRED:
Center punch Combination pliers
Hammer 4 mm hex wrench
Needle nose pliers Flat blade screwdriver
INSTALLATION PRECAUTIONS/NOTES:
^ Do not over torque engine block heater.
^ Ensure that power cord doesn't contact exhaust pipes, sharp edges or vehicle moving parts.
^ Torque removed vehicle parts to proper specifications (refer to appropriate Nissan Service
Manual).
PART NUMBER: 999M1-49000
APPLICATION
MODEL ENGINE TYPE YEAR LOCATION ELEMENT
DIRECTION
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 240SX
KA24E 1989 Driver side of the 12 o'clock
& later engine, first plug from the rear.
Axxess KA24E 1990 Front side of the 12 o'clock
Stanza & later engine, first plug from the driver side.
Truck (1) KA24E 1990 Driver side of the 12 o'clock
(4 cyl/ & later engine, first plug
2WD) from the rear.
(1) Remove section of exhaust pipe in front of indicated freeze plug to facilitate block heater
installation.
Page 3102
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4819
Comments regarding leak detector use:
^ Existing R-12 leak detectors currently will not detect R-134a.
^ Many R-134a leak detectors will detect R-12; check with the equipment manufacturer.
^ Always refer to and follow the equipment manufacturers recommendations when operating leak
detectors.
Comments regarding weight scale use:
^ If the scale allows electronic control of the flow of refrigerant through the scale, (i.e. internal
solenoid valves) be certain that the hose fitting size is 1/2"-16 ACME, and that no refrigerant other
than R-134a (along with only specified lubricant) have been used with the scale.
Charging Cylinder
^ The use of a charging cylinder is not recommended because:
^ The refrigerant may be vented into the air from the top valve of cylinder when filling the cylinder
with refrigerant.
^ The accuracy of a charging cylinder is generally less than that of an electronic scale or of quality
recycle/recharge equipment.
Service Procedures
^ The service procedures for R-134a A/C systems are basically the same as for R-12 A/C systems,
however, the following should always be kept in mind:
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose, and
throat. Use only approved recovery/recycling equipment to discharge R-134a systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service work.
^ R-134a and R-12 A/C components are not interchangeable. Cleaning of used (in service)
components for use with another type of refrigerant and/or lubricant is not an acceptable practice,
and may result in A/C system failure.
^ Always use the proper PAG oil when servicing an R-134a A/C system. The Nissan part number
for the appropriate PAG compressor oil can be found on the A/C specification label in the engine
compartment, and also in the Factory Service Manual, and on the label on the compressor. These
oils are only available from your Nissan Parts Department.
^ When leak checking an R-134a system, be certain that you are using a detector which will detect
R-134a.
^ As mentioned previously in this bulletin, the R-134a PAG lubricants absorb moisture; PAG oil
containers and A/C components containing PAG oil must remain tightly sealed until ready for use.
^ Unlike R-12 systems, R-134a systems do not exhibit a "clear sight glass", even when properly
charged. For this reason, the R-134a A/C systems have no sight glass.
^ With R-134a systems it is important to properly control the amount of refrigerant charged into the
system during system charging. A charging machine or weight scale must always be used during
charging for proper charge determination.
^ Questions regarding R-12 or R-134a should be addressed to your Regional Service Staff or the
FIXS Hotline.
Page 3659
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 4471
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Description and Operation
Distributor Cap: Description and Operation
Distributor Cap
The distributor cap is used to make the connection between the rotor and the correct spark plug
wire. High tension current from the rotor is distributed to the towers of the distributor cap at a
pre-set sequence and then to the spark plug wires which carry the current on to the spark plugs.
Page 4378
Possible Cause of Brake Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy
incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of events occur: ^
The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
^
As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
^
Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
Service Procedure
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062a (BR92-004a) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 4459
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 1535
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2507
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30E
VAN (C22) Z24i
200SX (S110) Z20E
200SX (S110) Z22E
Page 607
5. Make sure the targets are mounted correctly.
^ Mount the top claws first.
^ Claws must be flush against the wheel as shown in Figure 13.
^ Target must be flush against the center support as shown in Figure 14.
^ Make sure the targets are positioned with the arrow UP or level.
IMPORTANT:
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Control Valve Assembly
Valve Body: Service and Repair Control Valve Assembly
Control Valve
1. Remove control valve assembly.
Be careful not to drop manual valve out of valve body.
Page 1936
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 4235
The chart (Figure 5) shows the relationship between the common units of Total Toe measurement.
Conversions vary with wheel size. Reference the appropriate service manual for exact
specifications.
NOTE: When adjusting Total Toe on a vehicle with oversized tires, use the angle values on the
alignment machine. Oversized tires have a larger diameter.
Page 638
Page 3184
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Page 4530
^ Any tools, equipment cones, or other wheel balancing equipment items should not touch the
outside surface of chrome type wheels.
Wheel Alignment:
^ Alignment sensors with metal mounting hooks should not be used on chrome type wheels.
^ Some alignment equipment manufacturers may have protective rubber pads available that can be
used to cover the metal mounting hooks.
Page 2956
Page 2034
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 334
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2837
Canister Purge Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 5151
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Classification: BT97-014
Reference: NTB97-060
Date: August 13, 1997
BUMPER REFINISHING TECHNIQUES
Applied Vehicles: All models with plastic bumper covers (fascia) SERVICE INFORMATION This
bulletin describes proper plastic bumper cover refinishing with specific paint manufacturer
procedures and materials. For information on repairing bumpers refer to the 1992 Technical
Bulletin book, page BF-31 for NTB92-043/BF92-013. When refinishing replacement plastic bumper
covers (i.e. service parts), it is important to follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure
exactly. Failure to do so may result with paint not fully adhering to the bumper, and with time, the
paint not adhering to the bumper may peel off. The bumper covers contain mold release agents
which must be removed prior to painting. If the bumper cover is not properly cleaned and prepped,
the paint may not adhere. Please follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure for proper
bumper preparation. NOTE:
You can heat the bumper at 140°F for 45 minutes to bring the mold release agent to the surface.
Allow the bumper cover to cool completely before cleaning. This cleaning (degreasing) is
necessary to remove the mold release agent on the surface completely.
The chart indicates which cover; polyurethane (PUR) or polypropylene (PP) is used on each model.
The procedures and appropriate materials for each paint vendor are attached for your reference. If
you should have any difficulty: ^
Obtaining materials
^ Following the published procedure
^ Obtaining a proper finish
^ If you are in a VOC regulated area
Brakes - Improved Front Pad Material
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Improved Front Pad Material
Classification: BR89-002
Section: Brake System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-006 Models: All models Date: January 19, 1989
IMPROVED FRONT BRAKE PAD MATERIAL
APPLIED MODELS: 1982-88 Sentra (B11 & B12) 1983-88 Pulsar (N12 & N13) 1982-88 Stanza
(T11 & T12) 1985-88 Stanza Wagon (M10)
1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1984-88 200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 Truck (D21) 1987-88 Pathfinder (WD21)
1987-88 Van (C22)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Service brake pads with improved semi-metallic material are available for the applied models.
These pads have been installed at the factory on some 1987 and most 1988 models. Compared to
the former semi-metallic material, this new material has the following advantages:
^ Reduced brake pedal effort when brakes are cold
^ Firmer brake pedal "feel"
^ Reduced brake rotor wear
^ Reduced brake squeal
^ Reduced brake noise after vehicle has been in storage (less affected by rust on rotor surface)
In addition, this new semi-metallic material has much longer pad life than the equivalent asbestos
pads.
Service brake pad kits with this new material are available and have new part numbers. They can
also be identified by the code stamped in the pad backing plate.
Original pad material (asbestos) NBK NP01 FF
or (semi-metallic) Hitachi HP14 EE
Improved pad material (semi-metallic) Hitachi HP12 FE
The improved pads can be substituted for the original pads and are recommended for all repairs
when the brake pads are replaced.
Page 976
Comments regarding condensers:
^ The parallel flow condenser can be identified by the refrigerant end tanks, and smaller, more
closely spaced center section tubes.
Page 5255
Finish Kare products are marketed by mobile distributors which will deliver the product directly to
your dealership. If a Finish Kare distributor is not located in your area, Finish Kare can be
contacted at the number above for direct shipment from their national office.
Page 2561
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Page 2669
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 1784
Engine Control Module: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2389
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 110
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 2953
Testing and Inspection
Air Filter Element: Testing and Inspection
Viscous paper type air cleaner filter does not require any cleaning operation until it is replaced
periodically. Brushing or blasting operation should never be conducted, because it causes clogging
and results in enrichment of the mixture ratio.
Page 3722
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 153
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3212
- When installing I.S.C. valve to throttle body, observe the tightening order.
Tightening order: (A) -> (B) -> (C)
Tightening torque: 4 - 5 N.m (0.4 - 0.5 kg-m, 2.9 - 3.6 ft-lb..)
Paint - Contamination Identification and Repair
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-015 Date: 940208
Paint - Contamination Identification and Repair
Classification: BF94-003
Reference: NTB94-O15
Date: February 8, 1994
PAINT CONTAMINATION IDENTIFICATION AND REPAIR
This bulletin supersedes NTB93-058 / BF93-014 & NTB91-090 / BF91-023
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
SERVICE INFORMATION
The following procedures and materials have been found effective in removing iron particles, water
or chemical spots, scratches and/or swirl marks which have not penetrated the clear coat/color coat
of painted vehicle surfaces.
NOTE:
The updated repair procedures discussed in this Service Bulletin can be applied to all types of
Nissan clear coat materials, including the new Cross Link clear coat (NCLC)/hard clear coat.
*NOTE:
Measure the paint thickness before and after abrasive cleaning. If abrasive repair is not successful
on the first panel tested, it must be tried on each affected panel (hood, roof, trunk etc.,) to
determine which panel(s) must be re-clear coated or re-color/clear coated and which may be
repaired by abrasive means.
Finish Kare Product Distributors:
1726 Floradale Ave., El Monte, CA 91733 (213) 686-0462
Page 2503
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
Page 4470
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 2118
Page 3707
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 111
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Fig. 303a Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Electrical - Starting/Charging/Battery Testing
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Starting/Charging/Battery Testing
Classification: EL99-016V
Reference: NTB99-048V
Date: March 11, 2010
BATTERY / STARTING / CHARGING SYSTEM TESTING
This bulletin has been amended. The Service Information has been updated. Please discard all
earlier versions.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissans including Altima Hybrid HEV* 12 volt battery
*For information on using this tool with Altima Hybrid 12 volt batteries, refer to NTB07-007.
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Midtronics GR-8 - Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Station is the factory-approved battery,
starter, and alternator tester.
^ For warranty documentation purposes, as of September 30, 2008 the GR-8 is the only approved
diagnostic tool for batteries, starters, and alternators.
^ Print-outs from this tester are required for claim reimbursements related to batteries, starters,
and/or alternators.
^ For additional information regarding claims reimbursements, refer to the current Nissan
Assurance Products Resource Manual.
^ For the complete GR-8 User Guide, refer to ASIST - TOOLS & EQUIPMENT.
^ Additional tools and replacement parts can be ordered from TECH-MATE.
^ This essential tool was shipped to your dealership and invoiced to your Nissan Non-Vehicle
account in three equal installments of $641.00 (plus
applicable taxes) in accordance with your dealer agreement with Nissan North America, Inc. This
price includes both the GR8-1200-NI and the EXP-800-NI shipped in April 2008.
Nissan vehicles equipped with standard lead/acid batteries use one of two different types with
unique battery rating specifications: JIS & CCA.
Page 4425
Fig. 25 Rear suspension. 4WD Sentra
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect brake line and parking brake cable.
3. Remove upper and lower strut attaching bolts and nuts, Figs. 23 and 25.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 1950
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1553
Page 3577
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 2134
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2128
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 107
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Page 3021
Page 3838
Inspect the system to find the cause of the symptom. Start the diagnosis by determining the
location of the electrical units involved. Inspect each component to verify that it is mechanically free
to operate and that all connectors and harnesses are securely connected and properly routed.
Systematically check the circuits involved, using the Harness Layouts and Power Supply Routing in
the service manual. Determine which circuit is the cause of the incident and whether it is a wiring
problem or a component problem.
STEP 5 Repair or replace.
Repair or replace the incident component or electrical circuit.
STEP 6 Verify the system works properly under all conditions.
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component you need to operate the system in all
modes and particularly under the circumstances which resulted in the customers initial complaint.
Incident Simulation Tests
If the symptom is not present when the vehicle is brought in for service, it may be necessary for
you to simulate the conditions and environment under which the incident occurred. Proceeding with
a diagnosis when the vehicle is not displaying the symptom may lead the technician to a No
Trouble Found Diagnosis. The following section illustrates ways to simulate the
conditions/environments under which the owner experiences an electrical incident.
The section is broken into one of the six following topics:
1. Vehicle Vibration
2. Heat Sensitive
3. Freezing
4. Water Intrusion
5. Electrical Load
6. Cold or Hot Start Up
To properly simulate the condition under which the owner experiences the problem, it is important
that you get a thorough description of the incident from the customer.
1. Vehicle Vibration
If the owner indicates the problem occurs or becomes worse while driving on a rough road or
during periods when the engine is vibrating (idle with A/C on), you will want to check for a vibration
related condition. Refer to the illustration below.
Connectors & Harness
Determine which connectors and wiring harness would affect the electrical system you are
inspecting. Gently shake each connector and harness while monitoring the system for the incident
you are trying to duplicate. This test may indicate a loose or poor electrical connection.
HINT Connectors can be exposed to moisture. It is possible to get a thin film of corrosion on the
connector terminals. A visual inspection may not reveal this without disconnecting the connector.
On intermittent incidents it is a good idea to disconnect, inspect and clean the terminals on related
connectors in the system.
Sensors & Relays
Gently apply a slight vibration to sensors and relays in the system your inspecting. This test may
indicate a loose or poorly mounted sensor or relay.
Page 5061
Antitheft and Alarm Systems: Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 684
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2180
Idle Check and Set Procedure
Page 4783
Page 3018
Page 2943
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 2397
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4223
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 3462
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Classification: BR87-005
Reference: TS87-103
Date: June 29, 1987
DISC BRAKE NOISE INFORMATION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models with disc brakes (front or
rear)
SERVICE INFORMATION Some Nissan vehicles may exhibit brake noise under certain driving
conditions. This Bulletin provides some information about normal and common noises and
appropriate service procedures for each noise. Some of this information may be useful when
explaining brake noises to the customer.
Refer to Technical Bulletin BR87-006, "Disc Brake Noise Countermeasure", for information about
abnormal brake noises on Maxima, Stanza, and Stanza Wagon. General Brake Information Nissan
brake systems have been carefully designed to provide optimum braking performance under
various driving conditions. One of the most important components in the brake system is the brake
pad material. The following factors have been taken into consideration to select the best pad
material. ^
technical and government regulations
^ stopping distance
^ vehicle control while braking
^ high operating temperatures
^ pedal force
^ pad and rotor wear rates
^ moisture resistance
^ friction coefficient stability
^ operating noise level
Unfortunately, there is no one brake pad material that provides perfect performance in all of these
areas. Changing the material to improve some factors often causes a performance reduction in
other areas. Higher brake operating noise levels in some instances occur as a result of factors
which ensure proper brake performance and safety.
Common Brake Noises
The following brake noises occur most frequently on Nissan vehicles. These noises do not indicate
any malfunction or improper operation. 1.
GROANING NOISE AT LOW MILEAGE (0-300 MILES) ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during medium speed stops (20-40 mph)
^ noise usually does not occur on the first or second stop
^ noise occurs with warm or hot brakes (not cold)
^ there may be a low frequency "judder" vibration
Nissan applies protective coatings to the brake rotors and pads to reduce corrosion during shipping
and storage. These coatings may cause this groaning noise until they are worn off. Under normal
driving conditions, this usually takes about 300 miles. If this noise occurs during the first 300 miles,
it is not necessary to attempt any repairs. Service Procedure:
There is no service procedure to eliminate this noise permanently. Replacing the brake pads or
machining the rotors may cause the noise to disappear temporarily, but it will return and continue
until the coatings are worn off the rotor and pads. 2.
GROANING NOISE (AFTER 300 MILES)
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2179
Service and Repair
Clutch Disc: Service and Repair
1. Remove transmission.
2. Insert a dummy shaft into the clutch disc hub.
3. Loosen clutch cover attaching bolts alternately.
4. Remove clutch disc and cover assembly.
5. Remove release bearing.
6. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4537
Page 5241
1. It is necessary to match the color of the refinishing base color paint and the original body paint.
On all cars, an exposed portion of the color base coat will be found under the right and left hand sill
plates.
2. The color tone of a pearl base coat varies with the number of overlapped spray strokes (film
thickness). Use the same spraying conditions as those for color matching.
3 Areas to be sanded and coated for Zone repairs.
Description and Operation
Idle/Altitude Compensator (Non Comp. Controlled): Description and Operation
Air density becomes thinner at higher altitudes. Therefore, the carburetor produces too rich an
air/fuel mixture at higher altitudes. The altitude compensator automatically corrects air/fuel ratio to
an optimum mixture. When vehicle is operated in a high altitude environment, the bellows in the
compensator extends, causing the lever attached to the bellows to push up the needle. When the
needle is pushed up the air passage becomes wider, allowing larger amounts of air to flow from the
altitude compensator to the carburetor, thereby thinning the air/fuel mixture.
Page 1431
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 658
2. Turn wheels from straight-ahead position until the inner wheel is at the position specified for
``Toe-Out On Turns'' shown in Fig. 18. If the outer wheel reference angle is incorrect, check for
damaged or improperly adjusted tie rods. Perform check in both left and right directions.
3. On models less rack and pinion steering, proceed as follows:
a. Rotate steering to full lock in each direction. b. Adjust inner wheel ``Turning Angle'' to value
specified in Fig. 18, by adjusting position of steering stop. c. With inner wheel adjusted to
specifications, outer wheel turning angle should be as specified in Fig. 18. If outer wheel turning
angle is
incorrect, repair or replace steering linkage as needed.
4. On models with rack and pinion steering, proceed as follows:
a. Turn steering to full lock and measure inner and outer wheel turning angles. b. If ``Turning
Angles'' at full lock are not within specifications, Fig. 18, check for damaged steering linkage or
improperly adjusted tie rods. c. If steering linkage and tie rods are satisfactory, check for improper
rack or rack piston stroke and repair steering gear as needed.
Rear Wheels
The proper alignment of the rear suspension and wheels is essential for proper handling and to
providing a reference for front wheel alignment. Always ensure that rear wheel alignment is within
specifications prior to checking and adjusting front wheel alignment.
CAMBER
On models with independent rear suspension, rear wheel camber must be within specifications for
proper vehicle handling and to prevent uneven tire wear. Rear camber cannot be adjusted. If rear
camber is not within specifications, check for damaged or worn suspension components and
deformed sheet metal, and repair as needed.
Fig. 1 Measuring Toe-in
TOE-IN
On models with independent rear suspension, rear toe is the measurement of the rear wheels in
relation to the vehicle centerline, Fig. 1. The leading edge of each rear wheel should toe-in slightly
toward the vehicle centerline to ensure proper vehicle tracking. Rear toe should be inspected using
suitable alignment gauges, following manufacturer's instructions. When checking or adjusting rear
toe, always ensure that the amount that the left and right wheels toe-in is as nearly equal as
possible.
Fig. 6 Rear toe-in adjustment. 1986-88 Stanza Wagon, 1987-88 Sentra w/4WD similar
1986-88 Stanza Wagon & 1987-88 Sentra 4WD
Rear toe-in is adjusted by rotating the cam bolts which secure the transverse link to the axle
carrier, Fig. 6.
1. Measure total toe-in and toe-in for each wheel following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. Scribe matching mark between cam and control arm, then loosen nut securing cam bolt.
3. Rotate cam bolt as needed, Fig. 6, to bring toe-in within specifications. Ensure that total toe-in is
within specifications and divided equally between left and right wheels.
Page 2283
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Testing and Inspection
1. Connect vacuum pump to two uppermost ports one at a time and check them for leakage.
2. When vacuum is applied to uppermost port and port immediately below that is open to
atmosphere, uppermost port should open at 2.36 inches Hg.
3. When vacuum is applied to top two ports, they should both open at 19.69 inches Hg.
4. When two uppermost ports are open to atmosphere, valve should be closed.
5. If valve does not operate as described above, it should be replaced.
Locations
Ignition Coil Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2899
Vacuum Delay Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove vacuum delay valve from engine.
2. Blow into port on EGR control valve side. Air should flow through valve.
3. Blow into other port. Air flow resistance should be greater than in step 2.
4. If condition of valve is questionable, dip port into water and blow air from brown or violet face
side. Air bubbles should appear. Avoid entry of oil or dirt into valve.
Page 605
^ Center the front wheels on the turn plates.
^ Chock the left rear wheel.
Preliminary Checks:
3. Perform pre-alignment checks.
^ Tire condition (wear, partial wear, flaws, etc.)
^ Road wheel condition (damage and deformation)
^ Tire pressure
^ Inspect for visible damage to any suspension components
^ Wheel bearing axial play
^ Ball joints of suspension arms
^ Shock absorber operation and visual check for oil leakage
^ Condition of axle and suspension (check for bushing cracks and slack)
^ Vehicle weight
> Empty - no cargo, luggage, or passengers
> Fuel level is full
Page 778
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2151
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 856
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Intake and Exhaust Valve Clearance Adjustment
Adjustment must be made while engine is warm but not running.
1. Set No. 1 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve clearance (1),
(2), (3) and (6). 2. Set No. 4 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve
clearance (4), (5), (7) and (8).
Valve clearance:
Intake and exhaust
0.28 mm (0.011 in) Tighten Pivot lock nut
16 - 21 N.m (1.6 - 2.1 kg-m, 12 - 15 ft-lb)
Page 4511
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 3939
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 444
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 4588
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 2079
Page 2138
Page 5040
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 3194
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3940
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 4993
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Paint - 2 and 3 Coat Pearlescent Finishes
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - 2 and 3 Coat Pearlescent Finishes
Models: All
Section: Body & Frame
Classification: BF88-004
Bulletin No.: TS88-013
Date: February 8, 1988
PEARLESCENT PAINT
APPLIED MODELS: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Pearlescent paints containing mica are now being used on some 1988 Nissan models. These
paints differ from solid or metallic paints. Three types of pearlescent paints are currently being used
by Nissan; 2-coat pearl, 2-coat pearl metallic, and 3-coat pearl (see chart).
Page 3897
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 2343
Digital signals are ON-OFF (Hi-Low) voltage pulses. This signal is a typical digital signal.
Examples of common digital signals are:
Battery Voltage The ignition switch in the ACC or ON position provides a battery voltage signal to
several control units. This informs the control unit of the ignition position.
Switch to Ground A door switch is a common example of a switch to ground. When the door is
opened the door switch completes the circuit. The interior light is turned on. In addition, the time
control unit is sent an OFF signal indicating the door is open.
Pulse Voltage A pulse voltage is made up of alternating high and low voltage signals of varying
duration. These signals are counted by the control unit within a predetermined time frame.
Analog Input Signals
An analog signal is a voltage that varies over a period of time. Analog signals are produced by
sensors in the vehicle. Sensors change resistance to deliver variable voltage signals. The Oxygen
Sensor sine wave signals shown are typical analog signals. These charts are example signals
printed using CONSULT.
^ The first chart shows an Oxygen Sensor lean (low voltage) condition.
^ The second chart is a normal Oxygen Sensor voltage printout.
^ The third chart illustrates an Oxygen Sensor rich (high voltage) condition.
Examples of common sensors are:
Temperature Sensors Temperature sensors change resistance with a change in temperature. This
temperature is converted into an analog voltage range.
Page 4538
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 4543
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 1928
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 251
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 4341
tubing wrench. The return line is retained by a screw clamp.
FIGURE 3
8. Raise vehicle about halfway up on hoist being certain to use the appropriate lifting points (Figure
3).
FIGURE 4
9. Remove both front wheels.
10. Disconnect both tie rod ends from knuckle arms, using the appropriate separating tool (Figure
4).
FIGURE 5
11. Raise vehicle all the way up on hoist.
12. Remove right and left stabilizer rod rear mount clamps (Figure 5).
13. Loosen the A.I.V. tube mounting bracket.
Page 1203
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Note: Preload adjustment of wheel bearing is not necessary.
Rear Wheel Bearing
1. Tighten wheel bearing lock nut to:
137 - 188 ft lbs (186 - 255 Nm)
2. Check bearing for smooth operation.
3. Check axial end play. Should be:
.002in (0.05mm) or less
Page 2628
9. Use compressed air to remove any metal debris from inside the boss threads.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
10. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
11. Spray the boss threads with rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
12. Run a thread chaser through the boss to clean the threads.
^ Use Kent Moore part number J-43897-18 or J43897-12.
Page 3028
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1737
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
Page 1479
Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The vehicle speed sensor provides a vehicle speed signal to the E.C.U. for fuel cut, recovery and
idle speed control.
- Needle type speedometer models The speed sensor consists of a reed switch, which is installed
in the speed meter unit and transforms vehicle speed into a pulse signal.
Page 1922
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Page 3153
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1146
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 643
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 254
Inspection Procedure
Page 2123
Page 5308
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 2126
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4013
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 83
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Page 321
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.011 in
Exhaust 0.011 in
Page 4314
Alignment: Service and Repair Preliminary Inspection
Prior to checking and adjusting wheel alignment angles, perform the following checks:
1. Check tire pressures and adjust as needed.
2. Ensure tires are of the proper size and that tires are properly matched.
3. Ensure wheel bearings (front and rear) are properly adjusted.
4. Check steering gear adjustment and ensure that steering gear is properly secured to frame.
5. Inspect steering linkage and suspension components for damage and wear, and repair or
replace components as needed.
6. Measure vehicle ride height with vehicle unloaded, and ensure springs are not collapsed.
7. Place unladen vehicle on suitable alignment rack following manufacturer's instructions, then
jounce vehicle several times to settle suspension.
8. Check and correct rear wheel camber and toe first, if applicable, then check and correct front
suspension angles in in the following order: caster and kingpin inclination, camber, toe setting and
turning angle (toe-out on turns).
Page 2888
Vacuum Amplifier: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect hose that connects vacuum amplifier to EGR control valve and install ``T'' connector
and vacuum gauge.
2. With engine idling vacuum gauge should read 5.31-6.5 inches Hg. If reading is excessively
outside range, replace amplifier.
3. With engine speed at approximately 2000 RPM, vacuum gauge should read 11.18-12.76 inches
Hg. If reading is outside range, replace amplifier.
Page 4784
Description and Operation
Ignition Rotor: Description and Operation
Distributor Rotor
The rotor makes the connection between the center terminal and the correct spark plug terminal of
the cap as it is turned by the distributor.
Page 971
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant (R12) Recycling
Models: All Models
Section: Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification: HA90-003
Bulletin No.: NTB90-016
Date: February 15, 1990
REFRIGERANT (R12) RECYCLING
APPLIED MODEL: All models equipped with air conditioning
SERVICE INFORMATION:
It has been established and documented that when the Chlorofluorocarbon refrigerant (R-12) most
commonly used in automotive air conditioning systems is released into the air, it works its way
upward and, by chemical reaction, eventually results in the destruction of the "ozone layer" in the
earth's upper atmosphere. Ozone, a special form of oxygen, protects the surface of the earth by
reflecting powerful ultra violet radiation from the sun back into space. Among other dangers, ultra
violet radiation causes skin cancer and eye cataracts in humans and it causes damage and
decreased production in food crops.
In order to prevent further damage to the earth's ozone, the U.S. government joined a group of
nations in signing the Montreal protocol to reduce and eventually halt all production of
chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) over the next few years.
Nissan supports all efforts to avoid release of these hazardous materials into the environment. As
part of this effort, A/C systems are being re-designed to use less refrigerant. The next step is to
design systems that will use an alternate, non-damaging refrigerant.
In the interim, it is imperative that the release of R-12 into the air be slowed and stopped as soon
as possible. During the period February 19 to March 9, 1990, a refrigerant recycling unit will be
shipped to your dealership from Kent-Moore Tool Co. as a mandatory special tool. This machine
will remove the refrigerant from any vehicle whose A/C system you service or dismantle for scrap,
recycle the refrigerant by removing all moisture and contaminants, and place it into a safe container
for re-use.
Until that recycling equipment arrives and is put to use in your dealership, here are some things
you can do to decrease the amount of R-12 that you release into the environment:
1. Make sure your A/C service tools are in good working order, especially your leak detector and
the vacuum pump you use for evacuating any A/C system you install or service.
2. Evacuate only once. Do not evacuate, charge, and then evacuate again before installing the final
charge of refrigerant. Any extra evacuation allows excess refrigerant to spill into the atmosphere.
3. Wherever possible, do not use one-pound cans of refrigerant. Each time you change cans during
a recharge, some refrigerant is lost to the atmosphere. Therefore, it is better to charge from a
larger container (e.g., 30 lb.) and charge all at once instead of changing containers during the
process.
4. When installing A/C kits or when repairing an in-service air conditioning system, use care and
proper installation techniques to avoid introducing potential leaks into the system. This includes
using a small amount of clean refrigerant oil to lubricate the tube and hose O-rings, using the
correct torque wrench and backup wrench for tube and hose connections, and applying the correct
torque specifications.
5. When repairing an in-service A/C system, always use new O-rings when re-assembling the
connections. Your Nissan A/C Component Service Kit (p/n 999A1-A6000) contains O-rings for all
popular Nissan air conditioners, as well as a detailed diagram of which O-ring to use at each
connection.
6. Before charging any system with refrigerant, perform a "vacuum leak check." This procedure is
described in your factory Service Manual under the heading "Checking Airtightness."
Antenna - Inoperative, Rod Maintenance & Replacement
Antenna: Customer Interest Antenna - Inoperative, Rod Maintenance & Replacement
CLASSIFICATION: EL95-008
REFERENCE: NTB95-074
DATE: August 2, 1995
POWER ANTENNA ROD MAINTENANCE AND REPLACEMENT
This Bulletin contains revised Warranty information. Please discard NTB94-019 dated February 17,
1994.
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models equipped with power antennas
SERVICE INFORMATION
Power antenna incidents for no operation or improper retraction are almost always caused by the
following:
^ The antenna rod is broken or bent due to misuse. Common examples of this include the antenna
contacts the top of a garage door opening or a tree branch. Also, a customer may forget to lower
the antenna before entering an automated car wash.
^ Dirt, road grime, and other foreign matter collects on the rod interrupting proper operational
movement. This occurs most frequently during winter months in areas where road salt and other
chemicals are splashed onto the antenna rod.
REPAIRS COMPLETED FOR THE TWO CAUSES DESCRIBED ABOVE ARE NOT COVERED
UNDER WARRANTY. ONLY REPAIRS UNDERTAKEN DUE TO DEFECTS IN MATERIAL OR
WORKMANSHIP WILL BE COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
In a large majority of cases, the antenna motor is fully operational and receiving proper power.
Therefore, replacement of the entire power antenna assembly is not usually necessary to restore
power antenna operation. Prior to removing any power antenna assembly, an attempt should be
made to repair the power antenna by removing dirt, road grime, and other foreign matter, and then
lubricating the antenna rod sections as appropriate. if still inoperative, replacement of the rod only
should be made. A sample replacement procedure is provided on the following page. Check the EL
section under Audio and Power Antenna in the Service Manual for specifics on your respective
vehicle.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
REPLACING THE ANTENNA ROD
1. Remove antenna nut and base. (Figure 1)
2. Turn the radio to "ON" and the antenna rod will extend*. Assist the antenna rod to fully separate
from the antenna base. Note the direction of the gear section on the antenna rope. [The new
antenna rod must be installed in the same direction].
* If the antenna rod does not extend, always check the power supply to the power antenna before
replacing the power antenna assembly.
Page 2660
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Model RN4F31A 5.75 pt (US)
Model RS4F31A 5.875 pt (US)
Specifications
Camshaft: Specifications
Camshaft Sprocket Torque 8 ft.lb
Page 3015
Audio - Cassette Player Maintenance
Tape Player: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Cassette Player Maintenance
Classification: Section:
EL90-002 Electrical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-044 Models: All with cassette Date: May 24, 1990
CASSETTE TAPE PLAYER MAINTENANCE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles equipped with a cassette tape player
SERVICE INFORMATION: The playback head, capstan, and roller will attract dirt or residues from
the tape material each time a cassette is played. This causes a deterioration of sound quality (i.e.
distortion, reduced frequency response, and reduced clarity/fullness). If residues and dirt are not
removed, loss of channel(s) or tape continuity (also referred to as: "tape eating") may occur.
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURE: To ensure the optimum performance from a cassette tape player,
the following Periodic maintenance guidelines should be observed: ^
Clean the cassette tape player (specifically, the tape head and capstan rollers) after 10 hours of
play or once a month (whichever occurs first).
^ Use a cassette cleaning kit (such as: Nissan Cassette Deck Cleaning System, P/N 999U2-A7000
or equivalent), being careful to follow the kit manufacturer's instructions.
Additionally, the following Cassette Tape Care guidelines should be observed: ^
Before turning off the radio, eject the cassette being played. Leaving the tape mechanism stopped
while a tape is engaged can damage the tape, pinch roller, or capstan. Use tapes which are 90
minutes or less in play time.
^ Store cassette tapes properly, when not in use;
1. Use protective plastic case to prevent tape from unwinding and accumulating dust.
2. Protect tapes from extreme heat, direct sun light, and extreme cold. After turning off the radio, do
not leave the tape in the cassette door pathway. Remove it to allow the tape slot door to close and
keep out airborne dirt.
^ Do not use tapes that are more than 5 years old. Older tapes suffer from stretch and increased
tape head residue.
The preceding information should be given to the customer at the time of vehicle purchase (Sales
Department) and during vehicle servicing (Service Department).
Page 5059
VSS Control Unit Pin Test
Page 5495
condition.
A magnifying glass (10X magnification) must be used to identify wiper scratches as a start point of
cracks in the glass.
^ Inspect the wiper paths (may be a single scratch of a group of scratches)
^ Small scratches can cause a small rupture in the outer glass surface, which can lead to a crack
from thermal conditions, vehicle vibration during
driving, or wind pressure.
A magnifying glass (10X magnification) must be used to identify metal object scratches as a start
point of cracks in the glass.
^ Scratches can occur from metal objects such as keys and metal buttons.
^ These scratches are typically sharp and can be found anywhere on the glass surface.
^ Thoroughly examine the entire length of the crack to identify any scratch as a start point.
^ Small scratches can cause a small rupture in the outer glass surface, which can lead to a crack
from thermal conditions, vehicle vibration during
driving, or wind pressure.
A magnifying glass (10X magnification) must be used to identify scratches caused by a
contaminated towel as a start point of cracks in the glass.
^ Scratches can occur from wiping the glass with a towel that has sand particles or dirt on it.
Page 3966
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the flow chart. Use this chart, as
appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
GENERAL BRAKE REPAIR GUIDELINES
To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the following.
1. Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug
bolts may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3. Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip
on the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Tools - Rivnut Installation
Roof Rack Frame: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Rivnut Installation
Models: All Models
Section: Body & Frame
Classification: BF89-026
Bulletin No.: TS89-132
Date: August 31, 1989
RIVNUT INSTALLATION
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Rivnuts used for installation of a roof rack and deck rack require a substantial amount of time
to install by hand. A Rivnut installation tool which will reduce the installation time is available from
most automotive supply stores.
EXAMPLE: B.F. Goodrich C-6000 Speed Header
Page 2736
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2334
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 1548
Idle Speed: Specifications
Base Idle Speed Controlled Idle Speed
Adjusted with Throttle Sensor disconnected.
Manual Transmission 750 +/- 25 rpm 800 +/- 100 rpm
Automatic Transmission 670 +/- 25 rpm 700 +/- 100 rpm
In "D" Position.
Page 4670
Fan Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 68 Testing fan switch.
1. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch and check continuity with ohmmeter.
2. Meter should indicate continuity as shown in Fig. 68.
Page 4789
Comments regarding R-134a manifold gauge set:
^ Be certain that the gauge face indicates R134a or 134a.
^ Be certain that the manifold gauge set has the 1/2" - 16 ACME threaded connections for service
hoses, ensuring that only R-134a service hoses are used.
^ Be certain that no refrigerants other than R-134a (along with only specified lubricants) are used
with the manifold gauge set.
Page 2455
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 2004
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 979
Page 5454
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 2354
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 3597
2. Disassemble, inspect and assemble control valve assembly. Refer to Control Valve Body. See:
Service and Repair/Repair For Component Parts
- Set manual shaft at Neutral, then align manual plate with groove in manual valve of control valve
assembly.
- Install detent valve with its groove facing forward.
- After installing control valve to transmission case, make sure that selector lever can be moved to
all positions.
Page 2370
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 3009
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 434
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1911
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2130
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1174
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 3135
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
Fig. 105 Fuel Injector
The fuel injector is a kind of small, elaborate solenoid valve. As the E.C.U. sends injection signals
to the injector, high-pressure fuel, which is supplied to the coil built in the injector, pulls the ball
valve back, and then fuel is injected onto the throttle valve through the nozzle. The amount of
injected fuel is controlled by the E.C.U. in terms of injection pulse duration.
Page 112
Fig. 303b Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 687
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 544
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 905
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant Tester - Calibration
Classification: Section:
EM90-009 Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB90-093 Models: All Date: October 18, 1990 COOLANT
TESTERS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION: Evaluations have shown that some after-market coolant testers
displayed inaccurate readings which were, in some cases, off by as much as 10~F.
SERVICE INFORMATION: When coolant concentrations are in question, the following advice is
recommended to dealers:
1. Select a name-brand tester, preferably from a specialty tool supplier.
2. Prior to usage, calibrate the coolant tester:
^ Prepare a "known" mixture of exactly 50% fresh anti-freeze and exactly 50% fresh water. Keep
this mixture in a clean, sealed container to use for calibration purposes.
^ To calibrate a coolant tester, draw from the above "known" mixture when it is at room
temperature (65-75~F). Use a "Magic Marker" to place a mark on the coolant tester for the "known"
50/50 mixture.
^ Also, be sure that the coolant you wish to test is between 65-75~F. This means that you may
have to wait for the temperature of the coolant to fall within this range.
NOTE: During extremely hot weather, it may be impractical to wait for the coolant to fall within the
65-75~F range. However, the coolant tester can be re-calibrated for the new, "hot weather"
temperature using the "known" 50/50 mixture - provided both this 50/50 mixture and the coolant are
at ambient temperature.
3. Measure the vehicle's coolant concentration using the calibrated mark on the coolant tester as
an indication of a proper 50/50 solution.
NOTE: Technicians should be equally concerned if the coolant concentration is too high as well as
too low. High coolant concentrations reduce the ability of the coolant to transfer heat, which, in
some cases, may lead to over-heating. In extreme cases, the coolant can sludge and restrict flow
in the radiator.
4. After use, clean the tester by flushing it with fresh water.
NOTE: Testing has shown that, if not properly cleaned, a non-soluble residue remains on the
bouyant devices of the tooters after drying. This residue can effect the density of the bouyant
devices and, consequently, effect the tester's accuracy.
If there are any further questions regarding coolant concentrations, please contact your Technical
service Manager (TSM). The TSM's have access to laboratory-grade hydrometers.
Component Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Page 3383
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 1699
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 572
^ DO NOT push/pull on the tire to perform the caster sweep.
7. Make sure the steering wheel is centered when performing toe-in measurements and
adjustments.
NOTE:
If you are using a Hunter alignment machine equipped with the WinToe(R)-Adjustment System:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The WinToe(R) system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ Bumping the tire or re-centering the steering wheel when adjusting "near frozen" tie rods is not
necessary. This makes the adjustment process faster
and easier.
^ WinToe(R) eliminates the effect of lash in the steering system.
If you are using a John Bean alignment machine equipped with EZ Toe:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The EZ Toe system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ This software routine is an improved method of setting front toe, making it easier to obtain a
centered steering wheel.
^ With EZ Toe, it is possible to adjust toe with the steering wheel turned at any angle left or right.
This is helpful when setting toe on engine wall
mounted rack and pinion units.
IMPORTANT:
If during the alignment process the vehicle was lifted off of the rack; after lowering, make sure to
jounce (bounce) the vehicle before confirming adjustments are correct.
After you have checked and adjusted vehicle alignment
8. Print the BEFORE and AFTER measurements and attach them to the Repair Order.
9. Road test the vehicle to make sure the steering wheel is "centered" when driving on a straight
flat road.
Page 1155
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.) Operation
Idle Speed Control Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.)
Operation
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel
EF&EC88-017; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-115 Models:
1988 Sentra & Pulsar (E16i) Date:
September 8, 1988 IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED MODEL: 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16i
SERVICE INFORMATION
Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988 Sentras and Pulsars (E16i)
is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models. Any attempt to interchange
these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle Speed Control Valve
(I.S.C.V).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below. PARTS INFORMATION
Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number for the 1988
mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your reference, the part
numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
PART DESCRIPTION 1988 PART NUMBER 1987 PART NUMBER
E16i Mixture Heater 16174-61A61 16174-69A10
(B12/N13)
Page 4442
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 4469
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 2155
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4654
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove lower dash panel.
2. Disconnect wiring harness connector to resistor.
3. Remove screws securing resistor to blower housing, then remove resistor.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4962
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Page 1866
Inspection Procedure
A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Torque Converter Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front
Cover/Converter Housing
Classification: Section:
AT90-002 Automatic Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-010
Models: 1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: February 8, 1990 F01A AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra XE 1987-1990 Pulsar NX XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some of the Applied Models equipped with the F01A Automatic Transaxles may exhibit
transmission fluid leakage from the converter housing and/or the front cover gasket area(s). To
improve the sealing performance at these locations, new bolts for the torque converter housing and
the front cover are now used in production, and the tightening torque for these bolts has been
changed to eliminate this condition. In addition, a new torque converter housing gasket is available
as a service replacement part for these vehicles.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated areas, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the front cover and/or torque converter housing, thoroughly clean and inspect
(for porosities, surface damage, etc.) all mating surfaces. Install a new converter housing gasket
and new bolts, being certain to apply sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque
as indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
incident area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Page 2264
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 3211
Idle Speed Control Valve: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Do not pour oil or solvent into the I.S.C. valve.
- Do not disassemble I.S.C. valve.
- Do not peck the valve portion of I.S.C. valve.
1. Check resistance between the terminals.
(A) - (B) : 9.5-10.5 ohms (B) - (C) : 8.5 - 9.5 ohms
2. Confirm insulation between each terminal and I.S.C. valve body.
3. Apply battery voltage between (B) (+) and (C) (-) and confirm the opening of I.S.C. valve.
Valve: Fully closed.
4. Apply battery voltage between (B) (+) and (A) (-) and confirm the opening of I.S.C. valve.
Valve: Fully open.
5. Check opening clearance of I.S.C. valve without applying voltage to terminals.
Opening clearance: 0 - 2 mm (0 - 0.08 in)
Page 804
Page 2734
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Tires - Rotation Requirement
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Rotation Requirement
Models 1987-88 Sentra Wagon & 1986-88 Stanza Wagon
Section Wheel & Tire
Classification WT87-005
Bulletin No. TS87-188
Date December 21, 1987
TIRE ROTATION REQUIREMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra Wagon with four-wheel-drive 1986-88 Stanza Wagon with
four-wheel-drive
SERVICE INFORMATION
On all Sentra and Stanza Wagon four-wheel-drive models, it is very important that regular tire
rotation be performed according to the maintenance schedules in the appropriate service manuals.
On these vehicles, difficulty in shifting out of the four-wheel-drive mode could occur if the front tires
are allowed to wear down more than the rear tires. A difference in tire circumference, front to rear,
causes a strain at the driveline between front and rear axles.
Locations
Power Transistor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 4210
^ Center the front wheels on the turn plates.
^ Chock the left rear wheel.
Preliminary Checks:
3. Perform pre-alignment checks.
^ Tire condition (wear, partial wear, flaws, etc.)
^ Road wheel condition (damage and deformation)
^ Tire pressure
^ Inspect for visible damage to any suspension components
^ Wheel bearing axial play
^ Ball joints of suspension arms
^ Shock absorber operation and visual check for oil leakage
^ Condition of axle and suspension (check for bushing cracks and slack)
^ Vehicle weight
> Empty - no cargo, luggage, or passengers
> Fuel level is full
Page 641
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 4259
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 3103
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 4571
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Page 569
5. Make sure the targets are mounted correctly.
^ Mount the top claws first.
^ Claws must be flush against the wheel as shown in Figure 13.
^ Target must be flush against the center support as shown in Figure 14.
^ Make sure the targets are positioned with the arrow UP or level.
IMPORTANT:
Page 2345
Check the wire in the illustration. If an ohmmeter is used to measure resistance, the single strand
of wire still making contact would give an ohmmeter reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a good
circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand of wire is not able to carry the current. It will
become hot and have a high resistance to the current. This will be picked up as a voltage drop.
Unwanted resistance can be caused by many situations: -Undersized wiring (single strand)
-Corrosion on switch contacts -Loose wire connections or splices
If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge (lower number).
Measuring Voltage Drop
1. Connect the voltmeter across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive
lead of the voltmeter should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
2. Operate the circuit
3. The voltmeter will indicate how many volts (voltage drop) are being used to "push" current
through that part of the circuit. Note in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop
between the battery and the bulb, or a 4.0 v. drop between the switch and the bulb.
Relationship between Open/Short circuit and the ECU pin control
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Synchronizer Ring: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Lights - Plastic Lens Isopropyl Alcohol Caution
Body Emblem: Technical Service Bulletins Lights - Plastic Lens Isopropyl Alcohol Caution
Classification: BF87-013
Reference: TS87-064
Date: April 20, 1987
ISOPROPYL ALCOHOL CAUTION ALL MODELS
APPLIED VEHICLES(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Isopropyl alcohol solution used for general cleaning and for preparing the vehicle surface for
graphics installation will cause the plastic lenses on turn signal lights, side marker lights, corning
lights, tail lights, etc., to crack.
Extreme care must be used to avoid all contact of isopropyl alcohol with any plastic lens (surface).
^ The isopropyl alcohol solution must not drip onto any plastic lens.
^ During cleaning of the vehicle, a wiping cloth soaked with alcohol solution must not contact any
plastic lens.
^ During application of the urethane XE/SE Truck graphics, alcohol solution spray mist (used as the
wetting solution) must not contact any plastic lens.
Page 3521
High Reverse Clutch (Front)
Page 1550
BASIC CHARACTERISTICS
An ON-duty signal is fed to the I.S.C. valve in response to the water temperature.
STARTING CORRECTION
A starting correction signal is added in response to the water temperature for improved engine
startability. This function continues for several seconds after the engine starts.
IDLE SPEED FEEDBACK CONTROL
When the following conditions are met after the starting correction has been completed, the idle
speed feedback control function operates. (1) Idle switch-ON (2) Neutral switch - ON or below 8
km/h (5 MPH) (vehicle speed) *: When battery voltage of less than 12 volts continues for a few
seconds, the target idle speed will be maintained higher, in order to improve
charging function. (M/T only)
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Specifications
Engine Oil Drain Plug: Specifications
Drain Plug 22 - 29 ft.lb
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Caliper: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Page 2959
Page 5328
14. Remove the retracting side of the original lap belts.
15. The retracting side of the retro-fit seat belt is installed as follows:
a. Feed belt through lower quarter panel finisher frame (see illustration).
a. Install the retractor unit end of the shoulder harness by installing the mounting bolt and locating
screw. Refer to illustration on previous page.
b. Place the modified upper quarter finisher into position and bolt the shoulder anchor into the rear
side panel where the 1" hole was drilled.
NOTE: Mounting/anchor bolt torque is 26-32 ft.lbs (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
16. Reinstall front seat belt upper anchors and finisher caps. (26-32 ft.lbs.)
Locations
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Component Locations
T-Top: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3336
Inspection Procedure
Page 970
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Warranty Claim Reimbursement
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN
WB/90-010
Date: June 25, 1990 TO:
ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT REIMBURSEMENT WARRANTY POLICY
As a result of the implementation of the new refrigerant recycling equipment, the National Warranty
Department has adopted the following policy pertaining to warranty claim refrigerant
reimbursement.
1. When requesting reimbursement for newly added refrigerant, reimbursement use the special
part number LOCALFREON.
2. When requesting reimbursement for use of recycled refrigerant, use the special part number
LOCALRECYC.
3. In both cases, up to $4.00 may be claimed for each quantity of one (1). Note:
Quantity 1 = 1 lb.
4. A quantity of two (2) is the maximum allowed per repair ($8.00 total).
This policy is effective immediately. Should you have questions pertaining to refrigerant
reimbursement, please contact your District Service Manager or Regional Parts & Service
Department.
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 754
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 105
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Page 3582
Chart A & B
Cooler Inlet And Outlet Locations
Cooler Cleaning (in radiator)
CAUTION:
You must refer to Charts A and B to determine the location of the oil cooler inlet and outlet hoses
for the vehicle your working on.
If these hoses are not identified correctly, debris may be left in the cooler and transmission damage
may occur.
1. Place an oil drain pan under the automatic transmission cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses.
Page 2256
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Switch
This switch, used on some models, is attached on the left side of the instrument panel in the
driver's compartment. This switch consists of a bellows and a microswitch. The switch transmits an
``On'' or ``Off'' signal to the control unit according to change in atmospheric pressure. When the
atmospheric pressure drops below 26 in. Hg, an ``On'' signal is transmitted to decrease fuel by 6%.
Page 1555
Idle Check and Set Procedure
Page 3197
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3414
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 646
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
Page 211
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Page 2741
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Shoe: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Page 845
Spark Plug: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 5183
Interior Moulding / Trim: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 2629
13. Use compressed air to remove any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
14. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
15. Tilt the manifold/catalyst/front tube so that the metal debris falls out of the part.
16. Apply compressed air through the boss to blow out any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
17. Install the new sensor as described in the applicable Electronic Service Manual (ESM).
Page 2946
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 570
Once you have set the target position, DO NOT reset it at anytime during the alignment process.
6. Begin the alignment procedure.
^ Follow all of the instructions for your particular equipment.
^ Refer to the Service Manual for alignment specifications.
If your equipment requires "rolling compensation". follow these additional tips:
^ DO NOT push or pull on the vehicle body.
IMPORTANT:
After performing "rolling compensation", DO NOT reset the target position.
When performing "caster sweep". follow these tips:
Page 4379
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the following flow chart. Use this chart,
as appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE:
If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on the car
brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect alignment
during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications. This could
require the rotor to be turned again.
Brake Rotor Service Flow Chart
(*)CAUTION:
To ensure a proper repair, it is absolutely essential to make these measurements. For example, if
run-out remains high, brake judder and/or shimmy may not be detected while test driving the
vehicle immediately after the repair, but, may return after several thousand miles of rotor wear (due
to thickness variation).
Prior to and, again, after resurfacing a brake rotor, ensure that the rotor thickness is above the
minimum specification.
General Brake Repair Guidelines To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the
following 1.
Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug bolts
may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
Page 5090
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Diagrams
Page 309
Inspection Procedure
Page 3532
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Level Caution
Classification: Section:
AT89-008 Automatic Transmission
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-091 Models:
1987-1989 Sentra 1987-1989 Pulsar NX
Date: June 30, 1989
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
SERVICE INFORMATION
As with all Nissan vehicles with Automatic Transmissions (and as specified in all Nissan Owner's
and Service Manuals), it is especially important that the automatic transmission fluid (ATF) for the
3-speed RL3F01A automatic transmission (used on 1987-1989 Sentra and Pulsar XE models) be
maintained at
the proper level.
CAUTION: Both overfilling and underfilling may cause damage to the transmission.
Page 263
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Switch
This switch, used on some models, is attached on the left side of the instrument panel in the
driver's compartment. This switch consists of a bellows and a microswitch. The switch transmits an
``On'' or ``Off'' signal to the control unit according to change in atmospheric pressure. When the
atmospheric pressure drops below 26 in. Hg, an ``On'' signal is transmitted to decrease fuel by 6%.
Page 2159
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 144
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 372
Inspection Procedure
Page 2127
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Classification: EL93-028
Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-161
Models: All Models
Date: November 5, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS
Electronic control units (ECU's) control the operation of numerous electrical systems and
components on Nissan vehicles. The ECU's do this by either controlling the supply voltage or
ground path of an electrical component. The following is an explanation of how these systems work
and what precautions should be taken while performing diagnostic procedures.
Systems controlled by electronic control units have three (3) basic requirements, Inputs, Controller
Logic and Outputs.
Inputs
Sensors and switches provide electrical signals to the control unit. These signals are provided to
the ECU to inform it of various vehicle operating conditions. The electrical inputs can be either
analog or digital signals. However, all of the signals are converted to digital signals before the ECU
can process the information.
Control Logic
The ECU uses the electrical input signals to determine what the system should do. This decision
may be based on a few or many inputs. After processing the information the ECU will provide a
signal (output) to various electrical components.
Outputs
The signal that the ECU puts out to an electrical component (actuator) is called the output. These
output signals are what operate and control the system.
Digital Input Signals
Page 3264
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 1008
Page 2005
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 470
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Page 557
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 1927
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4838
Air Conditioning Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch assembly, remove screws securing switch
bracket to air intake housing, then remove switch assembly.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3628
1. Inspect the coffee filter for debris (see Figure 12).
A. If small metal debris less than 1 mm (0.040 inch) in size or metal powder is found in the coffee
filter, this is normal. If normal debris is found, the radiator/oil cooler can be re-used.
B. If one or more pieces of debris are found that are over 1 mm in size and/or peeled clutch facing
material is found in the coffee filter (see Figure 13), the oil-cooler is not serviceable. The radiator/oil
cooler must be replaced.
Final Inspection:
After performing all procedures, ensure that all remaining oil is cleaned from all components.
Page 738
Electrical - Starting/Charging/Battery Testing
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Starting/Charging/Battery Testing
Classification: EL99-016V
Reference: NTB99-048V
Date: March 11, 2010
BATTERY / STARTING / CHARGING SYSTEM TESTING
This bulletin has been amended. The Service Information has been updated. Please discard all
earlier versions.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissans including Altima Hybrid HEV* 12 volt battery
*For information on using this tool with Altima Hybrid 12 volt batteries, refer to NTB07-007.
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Midtronics GR-8 - Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Station is the factory-approved battery,
starter, and alternator tester.
^ For warranty documentation purposes, as of September 30, 2008 the GR-8 is the only approved
diagnostic tool for batteries, starters, and alternators.
^ Print-outs from this tester are required for claim reimbursements related to batteries, starters,
and/or alternators.
^ For additional information regarding claims reimbursements, refer to the current Nissan
Assurance Products Resource Manual.
^ For the complete GR-8 User Guide, refer to ASIST - TOOLS & EQUIPMENT.
^ Additional tools and replacement parts can be ordered from TECH-MATE.
^ This essential tool was shipped to your dealership and invoiced to your Nissan Non-Vehicle
account in three equal installments of $641.00 (plus
applicable taxes) in accordance with your dealer agreement with Nissan North America, Inc. This
price includes both the GR8-1200-NI and the EXP-800-NI shipped in April 2008.
Nissan vehicles equipped with standard lead/acid batteries use one of two different types with
unique battery rating specifications: JIS & CCA.
Page 1879
NOTES:
^ Rust penetrant is considered a shop supply.
^ Nissan Rust Penetrant can be ordered through the Nissan Direct Ship Chemical Care Product
Program, Website order via link on dealer portal.
^ WD-40 is available from various local sources.
Removal Tool
^ When removing a seized exhaust sensor with a specialty socket (which contains a slit to
accommodate the wiring harness), it may spread open and
strip the sensor.
^ Before this occurs, it is recommended to cut the wiring harness from the sensor and use a box
end wrench or 6-point deep well socket.
1. Clamp the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube in a vice.
2. Spray the sensor with the rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
^ It is important that the spray is directed at the base of the sensor to ensure it penetrates into the
threads.
Page 3133
The table shows the injector colors for various models. This is intended as a quick reference guide
to verify that the correct injectors are reinstalled. Please refer to the parts catalog for correct part
numbers.
Page 1402
6. Remove upper and lower dust covers. Use a torx wrench.
7. Loosen timing belt tension lock nut and rotate tension clock- wise. Then tighten tensioner lock
nut. 8. Mark rotating direction mark on timing belt and Remove timing belt.
CAUTION:
After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will hit
piston heads.
9. Remove belt tensioner and return spring.
10. Inspect the condition of belt tensioner and tensioner spring.
INSTALLATION
1. Confirm that No.1 cylinder is set at T.D.C. on its compression stroke.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2430
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): Adjustments
1. Start and operate engine until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. With A/C system OFF, ensure engine idle speed is correct.
3. With A/C system ON and fan control lever set at 4, ensure compressor, F.I.C.D. actuator and
solenoid valve are operating properly.
4. On all models except Federal with gasoline engine, set idle speed at the specified values:
a. On gasoline engine with manual transmission, idle speed should be 750-850 RPM. b. On
gasoline engine with automatic transmission, idle speed should be 580-660 RPM. c. On diesel
engine with manual transmission, idle speed should be 800-850 RPM. d. On diesel engine with
automatic transmission, idle speed should be 900-950 RPM.
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 1153
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 2532
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Description and Operation
Fuel Accumulator: Description and Operation
Fig. 17 Fuel damper (typical)
The fuel damper is provided to suppress pulsation in fuel flow discharged from the fuel pump, Fig.
17. No adjustment is allowed on this damper.
Page 1724
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30E
VAN (C22) Z24i
200SX (S110) Z20E
200SX (S110) Z22E
Page 1142
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 770
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 454
Button Kit Part Numbers
BUCKLE PART NUMBERS
Part numbers for buckles are available in the parts microfiche.
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Page 5148
7. Reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter and let dry.
8. Fill sand scratches and pinholes with a skin coat of Flexible Parts Repair Material. (Do not use
Flexible Parts Putty.) After curing, sand with 320 grit disc.
9. Reapply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter and let dry.
10. Apply a double wet coat of Flexible Parts Coating. After a 10 minute flash time, apply a second
double coat. Let dry 45 minutes and lightly scuff sand the coating with 320 grit disc. Apply color
coats recommended for plastic body parts.
Polypropylene Bumper Fascia Repair
If extensive reinforcing or patching from the back is required use the following procedure.
1. Scuff the backside with grade 180 abrasives. Apply Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter.
2. Cut a glass cloth patch to cover repair area.
3. Mix a quantity of Flexible Parts Repair Material. Lay glass cloth on a clean surface. Use a
squeegee to force the Flexible Parts Repair Material into the glass cloth.
4. Apply glass cloth patch to backside of repair area.
5. Apply additional Flexible Parts Repair Material over surface of glass cloth patch.
FASCIA REPAIR
1. Clean the repair area with soap and water. Remove grease and tar with solvent.
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 877
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Drive Belts Inspection
1. Inspect for cracks, fraying, wear or oil adhesion. If necessary, replace with new one.
The belts should not touch the bottom of the pulley groove.
2. Inspect drive belt deflections by pushing on the belt midway between pulleys.
Adjust if belt deflections exceed the limit.
Inspect drive belt deflections when engine is cold. If engine is hot, wait 30 minutes or more and
check deflections.
Page 2156
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Synchronizer Ring: Customer Interest Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Service and Repair
Power Brake Assist: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove master cylinder as previously described.
2. Disconnect brake booster at brake pedal.
3. Disconnect check valve hose at power booster.
4. Disconnect vacuum hose(s), if equipped.
5. Remove booster attaching bolts and/or nuts and the booster.
INSTALLATION
Reverse remove procedure to install. No adjustments are necessary on these models.
Locations
Combination Flasher: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3057
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Speedometer Head: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedometer Noise
Classification: EL88-008 Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-094
Models: 1987-88 Sentra/Pulsar
Date: July 11, 1988
SPEEDOMETER CABLE NOISE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra, 1987-88 Pulsar except 1988 Pulsar SE
APPLIED VINs: JAPAN BUILT SENTRA Before JN1PB22SXJU 028662
04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB24SXJU 044462 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB22SXJU 574774 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB21SXJU 555932 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB26SXJU 016707 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25SXJU 021285 04/01/88 production
Before JN1PB25YXJU 005931 04/01/88 production
U.S. BUILT SENTRA 1987 1988
All
PULSAR Before JN1PN34SXJM 500050
05/01/88 production
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987-88 Sentra and Pulsar vehicles may exhibit a rattle or buzzing noise from the center of
the instrument panel at engine speeds of 2500-3500 RPM.
If a customer complains of this type of noise, perform the following diagnostics to determine if the
speedometer cable is the cause.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to verify speedometer cable noise:
1. Start engine with transmission in neutral (M/T) or park (A/T). Raise RPM to 3500 and hold for
5-10 seconds.
2. Listen for rattling or buzzing from the speedometer head area.
3. Return engine to idle and turn off ignition.
4. Disconnect speedometer cable from transaxle and let hang. Be sure to position the cable so that
it isn't touching the engine or transaxle.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3.
If the noise can be heard in Step 2, but is not present during Step 5, replace the speedometer
cable assembly with the improved (insulated) cable assembly listed below. If the noise is still
present, reinstall the speedometer cable and contact the FIXS Hotline for additional information.
PARTS INFORMATION
PART DESCRIPTION NEW PART NUMBER FORMER PART NUMBER
Speedometer 25050-01Y00 25050-60A01
Cable Assembly 25050-60A00
Page 2523
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
VAN (C22) Z241
200SX (S100) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
Page 2383
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 1255
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Camshaft Sprocket Bolts 6.5 - 8.7 ft.lb
Jackshaft Sprocket Bolts 6.5 - 8.7 ft.lb
Page 2476
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2716
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1727
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: Customer Interest Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 4276
SPECIAL TOOLS
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 3920
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the following flow chart. Use this chart,
as appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
NOTE:
If the rotor must be removed for cleaning and/or other purposes after resurfacing with an on the car
brake lathe is complete, mark its exact location on the axle prior to removal. Incorrect alignment
during reinstallation will cause the run-out to change, possibly exceeding specifications. This could
require the rotor to be turned again.
Brake Rotor Service Flow Chart
(*)CAUTION:
To ensure a proper repair, it is absolutely essential to make these measurements. For example, if
run-out remains high, brake judder and/or shimmy may not be detected while test driving the
vehicle immediately after the repair, but, may return after several thousand miles of rotor wear (due
to thickness variation).
Prior to and, again, after resurfacing a brake rotor, ensure that the rotor thickness is above the
minimum specification.
General Brake Repair Guidelines To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the
following 1.
Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug bolts
may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
Page 1045
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Page 104
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Page 3042
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 4987
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Air Conditioning - Installation Caution
Hose/Line HVAC: Technical Service Bulletins Air Conditioning - Installation Caution
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-018
Bulletin No. TS87-147
Date October 12, 1987
AIR CONDITIONING INSTALLATION CAUTION
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 & 1988 Sentra and Pulsar Models with E16i or E16S Engine
SERVICE INFORMATION
When installing an A/C kit on 1987 & 1988 Sentra and Pulsar Models with E16i or E16S engine,
carefully route the A/C high pressure tube so that it is flush to the engine wall. A/C high pressure
tube damage and loss of refrigerant may occur if the tube is routed incorrectly. Ensure that the A/C
tube does not contact any hoses or other engine components.
After A/C installation is complete:
1. Verify that the A/C high pressure tube locating clamp is installed.
2. On vehicles with E16S engine, be sure the vacuum line at the E.C.C. System vacuum sensor is
securely connected.
See illustration on page 2/2.
Page 750
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 2571
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Locations
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
On Brake Lever
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3030
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4385
* The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
* As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
* Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
NISSAN SERVICE PROCEDURE:
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062 (BR92-004) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2730
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2555
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Page 4359
Possible Cause of Brake Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy
incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of events occur: ^
The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
^
As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
^
Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
Service Procedure
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062a (BR92-004a) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 1500
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 5259
on the towel to avoid scratching the paint with any loosened iron particles.
3. Apply Finish Kare # 883 directly from the bottle using the applicator provided. Keep the affected
areas wet for 5 minutes and allow the solution to lift the particles. Agitate gently, but do not rub as
this will scratch the color coat or clear coat of paint. Reapply # 883 to spots which start to dry
before rinsing
CAUTION:
Do not exceed the 5 minute soak time as this solution may damage the paint or trim.
4. Rinse thoroughly with tap water, dry and inspect the surface.
5. Reapply # 883 as often as needed to remove more difficult spots.
6. When all iron particles are removed, wash with Finish Kare # 118SC (Neutralizer and Shampoo)
and rinse thoroughly. Gently dry with a fresh towel. Do not use towels used in the above steps, as
they may have iron particles in the nap and could scratch the color coat or clear coat.
F. Inspect For Damage Severity
After washing and iron particle/chemical removal are performed on the test section, inspect the
surface to determine the severity of damage. Levels 2 and 3 are determined using abrasive
removal on test sections on each affected panel.
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and/or indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier
with a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp and a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is easily done with an 8X
and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Level 1 No damage, the contamination did not penetrate the paint surface and washed off using
the detergent and water and the iron particle remover.
Level 2 Minor damage, the contamination did not penetrate more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Abrasive cleaning will resolve.
Level 3 Substantial damage, the contamination penetrated more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Re-color and clear coat is necessary
G. Abrasive Cleaning
IMPORTANT:
All iron particles and acids must be removed and the surface neutralized with the above procedure
before proceeding. Iron particles and acids which remain will not be fully removed by abrasive
cleaning. Small amounts of contamination will wick moisture into the clear coat or through a
re-color/clear coat and cause blistering
The goal of abrasive cleaning is to remove the damaged layer of color coat or clear coat (up to 0.5
mil in thickness) using the least abrasive process. The steps below demonstrate the sequence of
operations to use on the test section to identify the severity of damage and the repair needed.
1. Measure paint film thickness.
2. Polish and evaluate. If OK Polish all affected surfaces. If NG go to step 3.
Also determine film thickness removed.
3. Buff and evaluate. If OK Buff and then polish all If NG go to step 4.
affected surfaces.
Also determine film thickness removed
4. Wet sand and evaluate. If OK wet sand then buff and If NG go to step 5.
polish affected surfaces
Also determine film thickness removed.
5. Re-clear/color coat after neutralizing surfaces.
6. Apply color coat and clear coat if damage is completely through clear coat
NOTE:
Polishing to remove buffing or swirl marks requires a foam finishing pad on a dual action sander.
Page 3420
Ignition Coil: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 3058
Idle Speed: Specifications
Base Idle Speed Controlled Idle Speed
Adjusted with Throttle Sensor disconnected.
Manual Transmission 750 +/- 25 rpm 800 +/- 100 rpm
Automatic Transmission 670 +/- 25 rpm 700 +/- 100 rpm
In "D" Position.
Page 1811
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The electronic control unit adjusts fuel pump operation to engine operating conditions. The signals
from various sensors and switches are used to control fuel pump operation.
Fig. 39 Fuel pump control chart.
Fig. 39
Page 1326
2. With the engine running at idle and the AC turned ON, observe the pulley axial/lateral (back and
forth) movement (see Example 2):
^ Maximum movement specification is 1 mm.
^ Visual comparison of movement with a known good vehicle is recommended.
Idler Pulley / Manual Tensioner Inspection (if equipped)
No more than 1 mm of pulley rock should be visible.
Alternator One-way Clutch Pulley Inspection
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage the rotor.
NOTE:
The following steps can be done while the alternator is installed on the vehicle if the drive belt is
removed and the alternator electrical connectors are disconnected.
1. Secure the rotor using a medium size screwdriver and a rolled shop towel.
2. Turn the pulley clockwise when viewed from the front.
^ Pulley should be locked.
^ If it rotates in both directions, replace the alternator.
3. Turn the pulley counterclockwise when viewed from the front.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 736
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4422
Fig. 10 Exploded View Of Front Suspension. 1991-95 Models
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Disconnect brake line from strut.
3. Place alignment marks on strut lower bracket and camber adjusting pin.
4. Remove strut to steering knuckle attaching bolts, then separate strut from knuckle, Figs. 9 and
10.
5. Remove strut to strut tower attaching nuts, then strut assembly from vehicle.
6. Install strut assembly in a vise, then loosen strut rod locknut. Loosen do not remove.
7. Compress coil spring using a suitable coil spring compression tool.
8. Remove piston rod locknut.
9. Remove spring components from strut.
Page 1910
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4787
Comments regarding tubes and hoses:
^ Some R-134a tubes and hoses have reversed male/female connections to prevent
interchangeability with R-12 components.
R134A Service Tools & Equipment
^ R-12 and R-134a require separate and non-interchangeable sets of recovery, recycle, and
recharge equipment, because the refrigerants and lubricants are not compatible and cannot be
mixed even in the smallest amounts.
^ DO NOT attempt to use one set of equipment for both R-12 and R-134a, as all equipment
contains residual amounts of refrigerant and/or lubricant,
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3580
Use the "Combination" Op Codes as indicated with the appropriate Section "JA", "JC", or "JD"
coding that best represents the A/T R&R; and repair/replacement performed.
Service Procedure
Page 129
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2729
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
A/T - Mandatory Oil Cooler Cleaning
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-056B Date: 021127
A/T - Mandatory Oil Cooler Cleaning
Classification: AT00-001b
Reference: NTB00-056b
Date: November 27, 2002
1988 AND LATER NISSAN VEHICLES AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER CLEANING
ATTENTION:
This bulletin supersedes NTB91-099, NTB93-007, NTB94-050, and NTB95-109B, and amends
NTB00-056a. The applied models/model years and information in the Claims Information section of
NTB00-056a was updated. Please discard all paper copies of NTB91-099, NTB93-007,
NTB94-050, NTB95-109B, and earlier versions of NTB00-056.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All 1988 and later with automatic transmission (including the Xtronic CVT
automatic transmission)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Whenever an automatic transmission (A/T) is repaired, overhauled, or replaced, the A/T oil cooler
mounted in the radiator must be inspected and cleaned.
^ Metal debris and friction material, if present, can become trapped in the A/T oil cooler and may
build up as transmission fluid enters the Cooler Inlet.
^ This debris can contaminate the newly serviced transmission.
^ In severe cases this debris can block or restrict the flow of transmission fluid/oil. In either case,
failure of the newly serviced A/T may result.
It will be necessary to back flush the cooler through the Cooler Outlet in order to flush out any built
up debris.
^ The location of the cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses described in this bulletin determines direction of
transmission fluid flow through the cooler.
^ The Inlet and Outlet position varies from model to model, and you must identify the location of the
Cooler Inlet and Outlet to successfully perform the cleaning procedure.
Refer to the SERVICE PROCEDURE Workflow to determine the procedure for a particular vehicle.
^ Use Charts A and B in the service procedure to establish the correct Cooler Inlet and Outlet
location for the vehicle you are servicing.
^ Then perform the Cleaning, Diagnosis, and Inspection as instructed.
Page 1186
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Page 1637
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Service and Repair
THERMO SWITCH
Replace
On Pulsar models, thermo switch is located in radiator lower tank. On Sentra models, thermo
switch is located on center left side of radiator tank.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Drain cooling system into suitable container.
3. Disconnect thermo switch electrical connector, then remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Fig. 1 Testing thermo switch (typical)
Testing
1. Remove thermo switch as outlined above.
2. Connect suitable ohmmeter across switch terminals, then immerse lower part of switch in water,
Fig. 1. Ohmmeter should indicate an open circuit.
3. Place thermometer in water and heat. When water temperature reaches approximately 185°F,
switch contacts should close and the ohmmeter should indicate continuity.
4. If switch does not operate properly, replace it.
Page 5055
SYMPTOM: No alarm with impact.
Diagnostic Procedure # 12
SYMPTOM: Engine will not crank
Set parking brake, (A/T) place transmission in drive or neutral, (M/T) do not depress clutch.
Page 2659
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Windshield Wiper Motor & Linkage Replace
Wiper Motor: Diagrams Windshield Wiper Motor & Linkage Replace
Fig. 15 Windshield wiper system (typical)
1. Remove wiper arms by raising the arms off the glass and removing locknut.
2. Disconnect electrical connector from motor.
3. Remove top grille retaining screws and top grille, where possible, to gain access to wiper
linkage.
4. Remove wiper motor mounting bolts.
5. Pull motor away from firewall if necessary to gain access. Disconnect motor shaft from linkage
taking care not to bend linkage.
6. Remove wiper motor.
7. Remove flange nuts or screws holding pivot to top cowl panel and remove linkage. To install,
reverse procedure. See Fig. 15 for typical installation.
Page 2003
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3537
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Preliminary Checks (Prior to Road Testing)
FLUID LEAKAGE
If the governor cap is suspected:
1. Open hood. 2. Remove snap retainer, governor cap and seal ring, then reinstall them. Refer to
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE. See: Service and Repair/On Vehicle
Service
3. Clean the area around the governor cap. 4. Run the vehicle at highway speeds. 5. Check the
governor cap for fresh leakage.
To detect a fluid leak:
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Clean areas suspected of leaking. 3. Start engine, apply foot brake, place
selector lever in drive, and wait a few minutes. 4. Stop engine. 5. Check for fresh leakage.
FLUID CONDITION
Examine the A.T.F. and note its color, texture, and odor.
1. Dark of Black Fluid:
With a burned odor Worn friction material.
2. Milky Pink Fluid: Water Contamination
- Road water entering through filler tube or breather.
3. Varnished Fluid, light to dark brown and tacky: Oxidation
- Over or Underfilling.
- Overheating.
Page 3737
Figure 2
3. Replace the 5th input gear, needle bearing, coupling sleeve and hub set, regardless of wear
(Figure 2).
4. Reassemble the transaxle assembly and road test the vehicle.
5. If the incident still exists, contact the FIXS Hotline for further assistance.
Page 2353
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Page 1393
Tune-Up Kit Contents
This kit provides three, 12 ounce plastic bottles and related fittings to replace the existing 7 ounce
bottles. These bottles will accommodate the proper lubricant charge when retrofitting from R-12 to
R-134a refrigerant systems.
PARTS INFORMATION
DESCRIPTION KENT-MOORE PART #
Variable Timing Control (VTC) Sprocket Rebuild Kit J41471
A/C Leak Detector Tune-up Kit J39400-Tune up
ACR4 Lubricant Injection Bottle Conversion Kit J39500-71N
Page 4222
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 1781
Fig. 303b Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Sensors and Switches - Engine.
Page 650
SPECIAL TOOLS
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
A/T - Mandatory Oil Cooler Cleaning
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-056B Date: 021127
A/T - Mandatory Oil Cooler Cleaning
Classification: AT00-001b
Reference: NTB00-056b
Date: November 27, 2002
1988 AND LATER NISSAN VEHICLES AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER CLEANING
ATTENTION:
This bulletin supersedes NTB91-099, NTB93-007, NTB94-050, and NTB95-109B, and amends
NTB00-056a. The applied models/model years and information in the Claims Information section of
NTB00-056a was updated. Please discard all paper copies of NTB91-099, NTB93-007,
NTB94-050, NTB95-109B, and earlier versions of NTB00-056.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All 1988 and later with automatic transmission (including the Xtronic CVT
automatic transmission)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Whenever an automatic transmission (A/T) is repaired, overhauled, or replaced, the A/T oil cooler
mounted in the radiator must be inspected and cleaned.
^ Metal debris and friction material, if present, can become trapped in the A/T oil cooler and may
build up as transmission fluid enters the Cooler Inlet.
^ This debris can contaminate the newly serviced transmission.
^ In severe cases this debris can block or restrict the flow of transmission fluid/oil. In either case,
failure of the newly serviced A/T may result.
It will be necessary to back flush the cooler through the Cooler Outlet in order to flush out any built
up debris.
^ The location of the cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses described in this bulletin determines direction of
transmission fluid flow through the cooler.
^ The Inlet and Outlet position varies from model to model, and you must identify the location of the
Cooler Inlet and Outlet to successfully perform the cleaning procedure.
Refer to the SERVICE PROCEDURE Workflow to determine the procedure for a particular vehicle.
^ Use Charts A and B in the service procedure to establish the correct Cooler Inlet and Outlet
location for the vehicle you are servicing.
^ Then perform the Cleaning, Diagnosis, and Inspection as instructed.
Page 3244
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1556
Idle Speed: Adjustments
Midpoint of range given is the preferred setting speed.
1981-83 L28 Turbo, 1983 E15 Turbo:
With engine at operating temperature, race several times and return to idle. Disconnect idle control
valve and check speed against specified value.
1984-87 E16 2V Federal:
With engine at operating temperature, disconnect vacuum control modulator harness. Race engine
several times and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect vacuum
control modulator harness. Restart engine, race several times, and check idle speed against
specified value.
1987-90 E16 FI, GA16; 1989-90 KA24:
With engine at operating temperature disconnect throttle sensor harness connector. Start engine
and set idle to specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine.
Verify that idle speed is within checking speed. Turn on AC and verify that idle increases to
specified value.
1984-89 VG30 Turbo, 1987-89 CA16, CA18 DOHC:
With engine at operating temperature, turn ignition off and disconnect automatic air control (AAC)
valve harness. Start engine and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect
harness. Restart engine and check idle speed against specified value. Turn AC on and verify that
speed-up is at specified value. All engines, turn AC on and verify that speed-up speed is specified
value.
1987-88 CA18 Turbo, 1987-89 CA20 Stanza:
Disconnect throttle valve and automatic air control valve harness. Start engine and adjust idle to
specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine. Verify that idle is at
specified checking speed.
1989-90 VG30 Maxima:
Turn diagnostic connector on ECU fully clockwise and adjust idle to specified value. Verify that idle
is at specified checking speed. 1990 300ZX:
Attach inductive clamp to loop wire on power transistor behind upper radiator hose. Set idle to
specified value.
Page 2505
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 4 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 5 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) SR20DE
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Page 920
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Preliminary Checks (Prior to Road Testing)
FLUID LEAKAGE
If the governor cap is suspected:
1. Open hood. 2. Remove snap retainer, governor cap and seal ring, then reinstall them. Refer to
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE. See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/On Vehicle Service
3. Clean the area around the governor cap. 4. Run the vehicle at highway speeds. 5. Check the
governor cap for fresh leakage.
To detect a fluid leak:
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Clean areas suspected of leaking. 3. Start engine, apply foot brake, place
selector lever in drive, and wait a few minutes. 4. Stop engine. 5. Check for fresh leakage.
FLUID CONDITION
Examine the A.T.F. and note its color, texture, and odor.
1. Dark of Black Fluid:
With a burned odor Worn friction material.
2. Milky Pink Fluid: Water Contamination
- Road water entering through filler tube or breather.
3. Varnished Fluid, light to dark brown and tacky: Oxidation
- Over or Underfilling.
- Overheating.
Page 1193
Disclaimer
Page 4910
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 681
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 5324
1. Remove rear lower seat cushion.
2. Remove the four retaining screws, then pull the seat back up and out.
3. Remove high mount stop light and rear speakers, if equipped.
4. Remove rear parcel shelf.
5. Remove front seat belt upper anchor bolts. (2 dr.)
6. Remove rear quarter glass by removing mounting screws shown below. (2 dr.) This will allow
access to the quarter panel finisher.
7. Pull back top half of lower quarter panel trim.
8. Remove rear pillar finishers.
9. Locate the drilling point on the back side of the rear pillar finishers. The hole location is marked
in the trim as shown below.
10. Using a 1" hole saw, drill the trim piece at the marked location.
11. Cut the opening in the parcel shelf for the 3-point seat belt using the dimensions shown in the
illustration below.
12. Install retro-fit finisher on each end of the parcel shelf.
13. Reinstall rear pillar finishers and check alignment of anchor bolt holes.
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: Customer Interest A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1914
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1284
1. Check the condition of the vehicle's lower radiator hose. (See Figures 5, 7, 9 and 11 for
identification.) If hose is cracked or softened, replace it. If it is in good condition, proceed to Step 2.
2. Working from underneath the vehicle, remove the engine undercover and set it aside.
3. Drain coolant from the engine by opening the drain plug on the bottom of the radiator.
Page 380
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 2062
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 4087
Page 5344
Seats: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 3878
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 2275
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1768
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Antenna - Sleeve Availability/Part Numbers
Antenna: All Technical Service Bulletins Antenna - Sleeve Availability/Part Numbers
Classification: EL96-012
Reference: NTB96-095
Date: October 2, 1996
POWER ANTENNA SLEEVE
APPLIED VEHICLE: All equipped with power antenna
SERVICE INFORMATION
An antenna sleeve (antenna guide) is available as a separate service part to replace bent or
corroded sleeves. A complete listing of available antenna sleeve part numbers is provided in this
bulletin.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Follow the antenna rod removal procedure outlined in "Audio and Power Antenna" located in the
EL section of the appropriate service manual.
Page 1466
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1618
Coolant: Service and Repair
Changing Engine Coolant
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being scalded, never attempt to change the coolant when the
engine is hot.
1. Move heater "TEMP" control lever all the way to "HOT" position.
2. Open drain cock at the bottom of radiator, and remove radiator cap.
Note: Be careful not to allow coolant to contact drive belts.
3. Flush the cooling system.
(1) Close drain cock. (2) Fill radiator with water, then warm up engine. (3) Stop engine and wait
until it cools down. (4) Drain water. (5) Repeat step (1) through step (4) two or three times.
4. Fill radiator with coolant up to filler opening.
^ Follow instructions attached to anti-freeze container for mixing ratio of anti-freeze to water.
Coolant capacity: (Without reservoir tank)
4.6L (4-7/8 US qt, 4 Imp qt) (M/T) 5.2L (5-1/2 US qt, 4-5/8 Imp qt) (A/T)
Reservoir tank:
0.6L (5/8 Us qt, 1/2 Imp qt)
Note: Pour coolant through coolant filler neck slowly to allow air in system to escape.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Page 3305
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3953
Possible Cause of Brake Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy
incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of events occur: ^
The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
^
As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
^
Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
Service Procedure
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062a (BR92-004a) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 3984
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 3374
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 4424
Fig. 23 Rear suspension. 1987-88 Pulsar & 2WD Sentra
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect brake line and parking brake cable.
3. Remove upper and lower strut attaching bolts and nuts, Figs. 23 and 25.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
4WD
Page 5337
Sentra 3 Door H/B
1. Remove front belt access finisher from quarter panel trim.
2. Remove front belt upper anchor.
3. Remove rear quarter glass.
4. Loosen and pull back top portion lower of quarter panel trim.
5. Remove rear speaker grille assembly.
6. Remove upper quarter panel finisher.
7. Remove rear seat lower cushion.
8. Remove existing retractor assembly.
9. Remove existing female buckle assembly.
10. Install upper quarter panel trim from retro-fit kit.
11. Reinstall rear quarter glass.
12. Reinstall speaker grilles.
13. Reinstall front belt access finisher onto lower quarter panel trim.
14. Reinstall front belt upper anchor. Torque bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
15. Install rear 3-point shoulder harness upper anchor into rear pillar. Torque bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs.
(3.65-4.65 kg/m).
16. Install retro-fit retractor unit where original unit bolted in. Torque bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65
kg/m).
17. Install female belt from retro-fit kit. Torque to specification listed above.
18. Reinstall lower seat cushion.
19. Check belts for smooth operation.
20. Make sure all finishers fit up tightly.
Page 5293
Application of 2-coat pearl and 2-coat pearl metallic is similar to that of other 2-coat metallic paints.
However, repairs on 3-coat pearl require special technique and experience since color matching is
much more critical. Also, when spot or partial repairing is required, the full panel or "Zone" must be
repainted (see drawing).
If a Dealer requires assistance in 3-coat pearl paint procedure, the following paint manufacturers
are willing to provide it.
^ Basf/Inmont/Glasurit
^ Dupont
^ P.P.G./Ditzler
^ Sherwin Williams
^ Sikkens
Or contact your local paint jobber.
^ Two types of mica are available, white and colored. They should be used properly to fit the base
color.
^ Pearl mica has complex reflection characteristics without hiding power. This produces minute
changes in color tone and luster as the painted surface is viewed at different angles or under
different lighting conditions. When matching color during repair, you should carefully observe the
paint color under direct sunlight (at a distance of 3 to 7 feet), from every direction.
Page 4932
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Page 4436
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
ALL MODELS
Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 1443
Page 2366
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Locations
A/C Relay: Locations
A/C Components.
Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Bumper - Repair Polyurethane & Polypropylene Fascia
Technical Service Bulletin # BF91011 Date: 910411
Bumper - Repair Polyurethane & Polypropylene Fascia
Classification: BF91-011
Section: Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB91-037
Models: All Models
Date: April 11, 1991
POLYURETHANE & POLYPROPYLENE BUMPER FASCIA REPAIR
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-90 Pulsar XE (KN13) 1990-91 30OZX (Z32)
1988-89 Pulsar SE (KN13) 1989-91 240SX (S13)
1988-90 Sentra Sdn. (B12) 1990 Axxess (M11)
1988-90 Sentra Cpe (B12) 1988-89 Stanza (T12)
1991 Sentra Sdn (B13) 1990-91 Stanza (U12)
1991 Sentra NX (KB13) 1988-90 Van (C22)
1989-91 Maxima (J30)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides detailed instructions to repair polyurethane and polypropylene bumper
fascias. A polyurethane bumper can be distinguished from a polypropylene bumper by using the
following test:
cut a small piece of material from the end of the bumper fascia and hold it over the flame of a
match or lighter until it ignites.
Polyurethane will burn with black smoke and have an odor.
Polypropylene will burn with little smoke and will not have an odor.
Alternate Test:
Sand an area near the damage with a 36 grit disc.
If the material sands cleanly, the bumper is polyurethane.
If the material melts or smears when sanded, it is polypropylene.
BUMPER MATERIAL INFORMATION
MODEL FRONT BUMPER REAR BUMPER
1988-90 Pulsar XE Polypropylene Polypropylene
1988-89 Pulsar SE Polyurethane Polypropylene
1988-90 Sentra Sdn. Polypropylene Polypropylene
1988-90 Sentra Cpe. Polyurethane Polypropylene
1988-91 Stanza Polypropylene Polypropylene
1989-91 240SX Polyurethane Polyurethane
1990-91 300ZX Polyurethane Polyurethane
1988-91 Maxima Polyurethane Polyurethane
1990 Axxess Polyurethane Polyurethane
1988-91 Van Polyurethane Polyurethane
NOTE: OEM replacement bumpers are the same material as original.
Page 1065
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Page 3306
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4214
^ Apply the brakes as shown.
^ Start the engine to allow brake boost.
^ Turn the engine OFF,
^ Remove all lock pins-front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates".
^ Make sure the bridge plate will not interfere with movement of the turn plate.
Put the bridge plate in the down position.
^ Perform caster sweep by turning the steering wheel from outside the vehicle.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Page 2818
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Heater: Description and Operation
The mixture heater is located between the throttle valve and the intake manifold. This is designed
and operated for atomizing fuel in the cold engine start condition. The E.C.U. has control of the
heater.
Testing and Inspection
Flex Plate: Testing and Inspection
- Drive plate runout
Maximum allowable runout: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If this runout is out of allowance, replace drive plate and ring gear.
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Blow air through connector on fuel tank side.
A considerable resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow be directed toward the canister.
2. Blow air through connector on the canister side. Air flow should be smoothly directed toward fuel
tank. 3. If fuel check valve is suspected of not being properly functioning in steps 1 and 2 above,
replace it.
Page 1605
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Intake and Exhaust Valve Clearance Adjustment
Adjustment must be made while engine is warm but not running.
1. Set No. 1 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve clearance (1),
(2), (3) and (6). 2. Set No. 4 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve
clearance (4), (5), (7) and (8).
Valve clearance:
Intake and exhaust
0.28 mm (0.011 in) Tighten Pivot lock nut
16 - 21 N.m (1.6 - 2.1 kg-m, 12 - 15 ft-lb)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4559
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Adjustments
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Adjustments
Fig. 5 Clutch pedal height, withdrawal lever play & freeplay & specifications. Pulsar, Sentra &
1984-86 Stanza
SPECIFICATION TABLE
Fig. 4 Clutch pedal free travel & height adjustment. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
1. Adjust clutch pedal height so that dimension H, Fig. 4, is within specifications.
Page 983
which will result in contamination, and damage to recovery/recycle equipment.
^ Use equipment designed to meet Society of Automotive engineers (SAE) standards, which
specify R-134a service equipment fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME), and service hose identification
(black stripe on hose).
^ Adapters to convert from one size fitting to the other must never be used; refrigerant/lubricant
contamination will occur and system failure may result.
^ The use of incorrect equipment will result in refrigerant and/or lubricant contamination, which may
cause A/C system or equipment failure.
^ ACR(4) machine will perform all required service functions (recovery, evacuation, recycle,
recharge).
^ High volume A/C service facilities may benefit from "component" A/C service equipment (vacuum
pump, weight scale, manifold gauge set) to supplement the ACR(4).
Comments regarding recovery/recycling equipment:
^ Be certain to follow the manufacturer's instructions for machine operation and machine
maintenance.
^ Never introduce any refrigerant other than that specified into the machine.
^ Only R-134a containers with a 1/2"-16 ACME can be used to add R-134a to the ACR4
recovery/recycle machine.
^ Periodic maintenance of this equipment is required; follow the manufacturer's recommendations
as described in the equipment instruction manual.
Page 1844
Inspection Procedure
Page 2637
Inspection Procedure
Service and Repair
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4289
Altitude Compensation
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Compensation
Altitude compensation prevents deterioration of exhaust emissions caused by an enriched air/fuel
mixture. Atmospheric pressure varies according to the altitude. The higher the altitude, the lower
the atmospheric pressure. At an atmospheric pressure of approximately 26 in. Hg or below, the
altitude switch transmits an ``On'' signal to the control unit, decreasing fuel to provide an
appropriate air/fuel mixture ratio.
Page 1006
Page 3919
Possible Cause of Brake Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy
incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of events occur: ^
The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
^
As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
^
Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
Service Procedure
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062a (BR92-004a) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 693
Page 1598
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
Removing Spark Plug Boot
REMOVAL 1.
Remove the ignition wire from the spark plug with a twisting and pulling motion. CAUTION: Pull on
the boot only. Do not pull on the wire.
2. Using compressed air, blow out the area at the base of the spark plug to remove any debris USE
SAFETY GLASSES.
3. Using a 5/8" (16mm) flex socket and extension, remove the spark plugs (counterclockwise
rotation).
INSTALLATION 1.
Using a suitable tool, check and adjust the spark plug gap. ELECTRODE GAP
0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
2. Using a suitable rubber hose or designated tool, start the spark plugs by hand (clockwise
rotation).
3. Tighten and torque the spark plugs. SPARK PLUG TORQUE
14 - 22 ft. lbs. (20 - 29 N-m / 2.0 - 3.0 kg-m)
4. Apply a small amount of di-electric compound to the inside of the spark plug boots.
5. Reinstall the spark plug boots.
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 101
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 397
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 910
5. Fill reservoir tank with coolant up to "MAX" level. 6. Run engine at approximately 2,000 rpm for
about one minute. 7. Stop engine and cool it down, then refill radiator and reservoir tank.
Locations
A/C Relay: Locations
A/C Components.
Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5354
License Lamp RH Connector (Coupe): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 20B, At License Lamp License Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 20B, At License Lamp
License Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door Light Switch Connector (2WD):
130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Light Switch Connector (4WD): 130M, Under LH Side Of I/P Luggage
Room Lamp Connector (Coupe): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector
(Hatchback): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Sedan): 13B, On Deck Lid
Luggage Room Lamp Connector (Wagon): 13B, On Rear Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch
Connector (Coupe): 22B, At Switch Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Hatchback): 4D, In
Rear Of Back Door Luggage Room Lamp Switch Connector (Sedan): 22B, At Switch Luggage
Room Lamp Switch Connector (Wagon): 7D, In Rear Of Back Door Mixture Heater Connector
(2WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine Mixture Heater Connector (4WD): 73M, RH Side Of Engine
Mixture Heater Relay Connector (2WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Mixture Heater Relay Connector
(4WD): 17M, RH Fender Apron Neutral Switch Connector: 13E, At Neutral Switch Oil Pressure
Switch Connector: 3E, RH Side Of Engine Parking Brake Switch Connector (Coupe): 6B, LH Side
Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Hatchback): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake
Switch Connector (Sedan): 6B, LH Side Kick Panel Parking Brake Switch Connector (Wagon): 6B,
LH Side Kick Panel Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (2WD Models): 6M, At Switch
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Connector (4WD Models): 6M, At Switch Radiator Fan Motor
Connector (2WD): 39M, At Motor Radiator Fan Motor Connector (4WD): 39M, At Motor Radio
Connector: 12I, Under I/P Behind Radio Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Coupe): 16B, At
LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 16B, At LH Rear Tail
Lamp Rear Combination Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear
Combination Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 16B, At LH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp
RH Connector (Coupe): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector
(Hatchback): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Sedan): 18B, At
RH Rear Tail Lamp Rear Combination Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 18B, At RH Rear Tail Lamp
Rear Defogger Connector (Sedan): 24B, At Rear Defogger Rear Defogger Connector (Coupe): 4D,
On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Connector (Hatchback): 3D, On LH Side Of Back Door
Rear Defogger Connector (Wagon): 11D, On LH Side Of Back Door Rear Defogger Relay
Connector (2WD): 125M, Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Relay Connector (4WD): 125M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Rear Defogger Switch Connector: 18I, Under I/P Above Heater Control
Assembly Rear Door Switch LH Connector (Sedan): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch LH
Connector (Wagon): 25B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 26B, At
Rear Door Pillar Rear Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 26B, At Rear Door Pillar Rear Door
Harness LH Connector (Sedan): 29B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Door Harness RH Connector
(Sedan): 30B, At Center Pillar Post Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Coupe): 14B, At LH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH Connector (Hatchback): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear
Side Marker LH Connector (Sedan): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker LH
Connector (Wagon): 14B, At LH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Coupe):
19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Hatchback): 19B, At RH Rear
Marker Lamp Rear Side Marker RH Connector (Sedan): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Side
Marker RH Connector (Wagon): 19B, At RH Rear Marker Lamp Rear Speaker LH Connector
(Coupe): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Hatchback): 11B, At LH Rear
Speaker Rear Speaker LH Connector (Sedan): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker LH
Connector (Wagon): 11B, At LH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Coupe): 12B, At RH
Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Hatchback): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker
RH Connector (Sedan): 12B, At RH Rear Speaker Rear Speaker RH Connector (Wagon): 12B, At
RH Rear Speaker
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 418
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1375
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
Removal
1. Drain engine oil. 2. Remove the following parts.
^ Front right side splash cover
^ Front right side under cover
3. Remove center member. 4. Remove front exhaust tube. 5. Remove front buffer rod and buffer
rod bracket. 6. Remove engine gussets. 7. Remove oil pan.
To remove oil pan:
(1) Insert seal cutter (Special Tool) between cylinder block and oil pan.
Caution: Do not use screwdriver. Oil pan flange will be deformed.
(2) Slide seal cutter by tapping its side with a hammer.
Installation
1. Before installing oil pan, remove all traces of liquid gasket from mating surface using a scraper.
Page 415
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Remanufactured Starter/Alternator - Program
Alternator: Technical Service Bulletins Remanufactured Starter/Alternator - Program
Reference: PI95-016
Date: September 28, 1995
GENUINE NISSAN REMANUFACTURED STARTER/ALTERNATOR PROGRAM
APPLIED VEHICLES: Selected models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Beginning October 2, 1995, Nissan will offer remanufactured starters and alternators for selected
Nissan models. Consult the Genuine Nissan Remanufactured Parts Sourcebook for part numbers
and affected models. Refer to the Nissan Parts Bulletin NTB/95-023 for complete program
procedures.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The diagnostic procedure for troubleshooting starter and alternator incidents has not changed.
Refer to the appropriate service manual for specific diagnostic procedures.
Page 3113
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
4WD Wagon Steering Gear - Removal & Installation
Steering Gear: Technical Service Bulletins 4WD Wagon Steering Gear - Removal & Installation
Classification:
Section: ST88-003 Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-105 Steering Models: 1987-1988
Sentra Wagon (4WD) Date: August 15, 1988 SENTRA 4WD WAGON STEERING GEAR
REMOVAL & INSTALLATION
SERVICE INFORMATION
This Technical Bulletin contains the steering gear removal and installation procedures for
1987-1988 4WD Sentra Wagons.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE:
1. Allow vehicle to cool.
2. Write down radio presets, then disconnect negative cable from battery terminal.
3. Place ignition in Accessory ("ACC") position to allow wheels and steering rack to move freely.
4. Remove carbon canister.
5. Remove upper bolt on the driver's side steering gear clamp. Since space is limited, use a 17 mm
short socket, 1" extension and ratchet.
FIGURE 1
6. Disconnect the 12 mm steering shaft lower joint bolt. NOTE:
On most vehicles, the pinion cap has a groove that must be aligned with the slit in the lower joint
during assembly (Figure 1). If there is no groove in the cap, use paint or a grease pencil to put an
alignment mark on the pinion cap and slit prior to disconnecting the 12 mm bolt.
FIGURE 2
7. Place drain pan under steering gear. Remove the pressure and return lines at the pinion
housing. (Figure 2). For the pressure line, use a 14 mm
Page 1221
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Fastener Tightening Sequence
Lug Nut Torque Patterns
IMPORTANT
Check all parts, including rims, lug studs, lug nuts, and mating surfaces of hubs and tire rims for
rust, damage, or dirt. Clean mating surfaces with a wire brush to remove any foreign material.
Replace any damaged parts as needed. Careless installation of tire/rim assemblies in a vehicle is a
major cause of tire installation problems. Proper installation, including fastener torque, is essential
to economical, safe and trouble free service. Use only the proper sizes and types of fasteners for
safe and proper service. Tighten the fasteners a quarter turn at a time using the tightening
sequence diagram as a guide. This is very important to prevent misalignment of the wheel.
Continue tightening the fasteners in sequence until the fasteners are tightened to the proper torque
(See WHEEL FASTENER TORQUE).
CAUTION: Improper torque or tightening sequence can cause distortion, fatigue cracks, or
alignment problems. After driving the vehicle for a short distance, recheck the wheel fastener
torque. Parts will usually seat naturally, reducing the torque on the fasteners. Retorque all
fasteners to the proper torque.
Page 3454
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Rod Bearing Clearance .0004-.0017 in
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The vehicle speed sensor provides a vehicle speed signal to the E.C.U. for fuel cut, recovery and
idle speed control.
- Needle type speedometer models The speed sensor consists of a reed switch, which is installed
in the speed meter unit and transforms vehicle speed into a pulse signal.
Page 860
Timing Belt: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Timing belt
1. Visually check the condition of the timing belt. Replace if any abnormality is found.
Belt tensioner and return spring
Page 1206
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 909
Coolant: Service and Repair
Changing Engine Coolant
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being scalded, never attempt to change the coolant when the
engine is hot.
1. Move heater "TEMP" control lever all the way to "HOT" position.
2. Open drain cock at the bottom of radiator, and remove radiator cap.
Note: Be careful not to allow coolant to contact drive belts.
3. Flush the cooling system.
(1) Close drain cock. (2) Fill radiator with water, then warm up engine. (3) Stop engine and wait
until it cools down. (4) Drain water. (5) Repeat step (1) through step (4) two or three times.
4. Fill radiator with coolant up to filler opening.
^ Follow instructions attached to anti-freeze container for mixing ratio of anti-freeze to water.
Coolant capacity: (Without reservoir tank)
4.6L (4-7/8 US qt, 4 Imp qt) (M/T) 5.2L (5-1/2 US qt, 4-5/8 Imp qt) (A/T)
Reservoir tank:
0.6L (5/8 Us qt, 1/2 Imp qt)
Note: Pour coolant through coolant filler neck slowly to allow air in system to escape.
Page 1507
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Minimum Piston Clearance .0009-.0017 in
Page 2398
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
On Top of Receiver Drier
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Inspection & Adjustment
Alignment: Service and Repair Inspection & Adjustment
Front Wheels
Correct front wheel alignment is necessary to provide proper handling and to prevent uneven tire
wear. To ensure correct alignment, angles should be checked, and if necessary corrected, in the
following sequence: caster and kingpin inclination, camber, toe-setting, and the turning angle and
toe-out on turns. Front wheel alignment should only be checked after ensuring that the rear wheels
are properly aligned in relation to the vehicle centerline, as most equipment uses the rear wheels
as reference for correct front wheel alignment. Front wheel alignment should be checked with the
vehicle unladen, at normal ride height, and following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
CASTER & KINGPIN INCLINATION
Kingpin inclination is a function of the steering knuckle design and cannot be adjusted. Caster, the
alignment angle which provides the self-centering steering effect, is only adjustable on truck
models which do not use strut-type front suspensions. If caster or kingpin angle are not within
specifications on models with strut-type front suspension, check suspension components and sheet
metal for damage, distortion and excessive wear, and repair as needed. For caster adjustment On
Pathfinder, Pickup and Van, refer to camber adjustment, as the caster and camber are both
adjusted by inserting shims between the upper control arm spindle and the crossmember.
CAMBER
Fig. 4 Camber Adjusting Pin.
Camber is adjusted by rotating the eccentric strut mounting pin, Fig. 12. The pin is factory installed
with the flat portion facing down. If camber is not within specifications, the pin must removed and
reinstalled with the flat portion facing up.
1. Check camber following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. If camber is not within specifications, remove adjusting pin as outlined in strut replacement
procedures, then install pin with flat side facing up and leave nut loose to allow adjustment.
3. Turn adjusting pin as needed to bring camber within specifications. One graduation of the
adjusting pin changes camber by approximately 1/4°.
4. When camber is within specifications, hold adjusting pin and torque nut to 72-87 ft. lbs., then
ensure camber is still within specifications.
Fig. 1 Measuring Toe-in
TOE SETTING
The toe setting is the measurement of the wheels in relation to the vehicle centerline, Fig. 1. The
leading edge of each wheel should toe-in or toe-out slightly in relation to the vehicle centerline to
ensure proper vehicle tracking. Toe should be inspected using suitable alignment gauges, following
manufacturer's instructions. When checking or adjusting toe, always ensure that the setting of the
left and right wheels is as nearly equal as possible.
Page 4253
Page 1596
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Spark Plug Construction
PURPOSE
Ignites the combustion mixture.
LOCATION
Screwed into the cylinder head, at the combustion chamber.
OPERATION
The spark plug provides a path for the high current of the secondary circuit to flow to ground. The
only paths for this current are through the ground electrode and center electrode across the spark
gap. The spark produced when the current jumps the gap and ignites the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinder.
Spark Plug Heat Range
CONSTRUCTION
The temperature of the spark plug is determined by the length of the insulator and the size of the
heatsink area. The longer the insulator is, the smaller the heatsink area will be and this will cause
the spark plug to be hotter.
Page 4280
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 2010
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 2942
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1867
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 632
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
Page 4922
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Page 3005
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 1401
2. Remove the following belts.
- Power steering oil pump drive belt
- Compressor drive belt
- Alternator drive belt
3. Set No. 1 cylinder at top dead center (T.D.C.) on its compression stroke. 4. Remove the water
pump pulley and crankshaft pulley.
NOTE: The crankshaft pulley is accessible after removing side cover from inside R.H. wheel house.
5. Remove right side engine mounting bracket.
NOTE: Support engine by placing a jack under oil pan. Do not place jack under oil pan drain plug.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 1173
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 1505
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Specifications
Fill Plug: Specifications
Filler Plug 18-25 ft.lb
Drain Plug 18-25 ft.lb
System Diagnosis
Air/Fuel Mixture: Testing and Inspection
PREPARATION
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
- Battery
- Ignition system
- Engine oil and coolant levels
- Fuses
- E.C.C.S. harness connectors
- Vacuum hoses
- Air intake system (oil filler cap, oil level gauge, etc.)
- Fuel pressure
- A.I.V. hose
- Engine compression
- E.G.R. valve operation
- Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is
"OFF". 3. When measuring "CO" percentage, insert probe more than 40cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe.
Overall Inspection Procedure
Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting Rod Cap Bolts 25 ft.lb
Page 1444
Page 2205
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
Ignition Wire
The coil wire connects the ignition coil to the distributor cap, allowing high voltage to flow from the
coil to the distributor cap. The spark plug wires connect the terminals in the distributor cap to the
spark plugs, allowing high voltage to flow to the spark plugs. The ignition wires have an internal
resistance to suppress radio static and to eliminate static that may interfere with sensitive computer
components.
Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing Information
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing
Information
Classification: Section:
GI88-023 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-150 Models:
All models 1987-1989 Date:
November 17, 1988 TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h. and distances of less than 40
miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic Transmission vehicles with four
wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when towing Automatic Transmission
vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following limitations apply when towing Manual
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for example behind a motor home).
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES *
These are maximum distances these vehicles may be towed without damage to the gear rain. In
general, any Nissan vehicle should be started, warmed up, and driven at least two miles after it has
been towed these distances - more frequently if possible.
Page 1540
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 748
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2093
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 290
3. Loosen the sensor approximately 10 degrees.
4. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
5. Tighten the sensor 10 degrees, then loosen the sensor 10 degrees.
^ Repeat this motion several times until the sensor begins to turn more easily.
6. Continue the tightening/loosening motion while gradually unscrewing the sensor. Stop when the
sensor will not unscrew any further.
7. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 until the sensor is removed.
Page 1202
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
ALL MODELS
Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper
Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 722
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Shift Fork: Customer Interest Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Page 3278
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Page 2158
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3234
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 3027
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4909
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 469
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Page 2137
Page 2975
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 564
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
4. Make sure the "turn plates" and "slide" plates are in good working order:
^ The surface of the front turn plates must be level with (the same height as) the rack surface.
If height is not the same; have the equipment repaired before performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the front turn plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide and turn) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the turn plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN
WB/88-007
Date: April 18, 1988 TO:
ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: TIRE ASSISTANCE CUSTOMER/DEALER HOTLINE
This is a revised list of the Tire Assistance Customer/Dealer Hotline telephone numbers. Please
discard warranty bulletin (WB/88-004) issued on February 3, 1988.
The following general information toll-free telephone numbers may be used to assist you with your
tire replacement needs:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-423-4544 (Except California) 1-800-221-8744 (Inside California)
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-800-662-0200 (Except New York) 1-800-334-4646 (Inside New York)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
For customer assistance or emergency tire orders, please use the telephone numbers listed below:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-722-9888
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-716-879-8494 (Mr. Wagner 8:30am-5:00pm EST) 1-213-781-2001 (Mr. Yanacek
2:00pm-5:00pm PST)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
If you have further questions pertaining to tires, please contact your District Service Manager or
Regional Service Department.
Page 3992
Codes that best describes the operations performed.
Disclaimer
Page 2162
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2738
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 4202
SPECIAL TOOLS
Page 4042
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair
Fig. 4 CL18B type front disc brake disassembled
Page 1529
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2107
Page 3399
Inspection Procedure
Page 1812
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Classification: BR87-005
Reference: TS87-103
Date: June 29, 1987
DISC BRAKE NOISE INFORMATION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models with disc brakes (front or
rear)
SERVICE INFORMATION Some Nissan vehicles may exhibit brake noise under certain driving
conditions. This Bulletin provides some information about normal and common noises and
appropriate service procedures for each noise. Some of this information may be useful when
explaining brake noises to the customer.
Refer to Technical Bulletin BR87-006, "Disc Brake Noise Countermeasure", for information about
abnormal brake noises on Maxima, Stanza, and Stanza Wagon. General Brake Information Nissan
brake systems have been carefully designed to provide optimum braking performance under
various driving conditions. One of the most important components in the brake system is the brake
pad material. The following factors have been taken into consideration to select the best pad
material. ^
technical and government regulations
^ stopping distance
^ vehicle control while braking
^ high operating temperatures
^ pedal force
^ pad and rotor wear rates
^ moisture resistance
^ friction coefficient stability
^ operating noise level
Unfortunately, there is no one brake pad material that provides perfect performance in all of these
areas. Changing the material to improve some factors often causes a performance reduction in
other areas. Higher brake operating noise levels in some instances occur as a result of factors
which ensure proper brake performance and safety.
Common Brake Noises
The following brake noises occur most frequently on Nissan vehicles. These noises do not indicate
any malfunction or improper operation. 1.
GROANING NOISE AT LOW MILEAGE (0-300 MILES) ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during medium speed stops (20-40 mph)
^ noise usually does not occur on the first or second stop
^ noise occurs with warm or hot brakes (not cold)
^ there may be a low frequency "judder" vibration
Nissan applies protective coatings to the brake rotors and pads to reduce corrosion during shipping
and storage. These coatings may cause this groaning noise until they are worn off. Under normal
driving conditions, this usually takes about 300 miles. If this noise occurs during the first 300 miles,
it is not necessary to attempt any repairs. Service Procedure:
There is no service procedure to eliminate this noise permanently. Replacing the brake pads or
machining the rotors may cause the noise to disappear temporarily, but it will return and continue
until the coatings are worn off the rotor and pads. 2.
GROANING NOISE (AFTER 300 MILES)
Page 744
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Page 2011
Page 337
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Toe Specification Clarification
Models All Models
Section General Information
Classification G191-005
Bulletin No. NTB91-049
Date May 16, 1991
A CLARIFICATION OF TOE SPECIFICATIONS FOR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
APPLIED MODELS: All
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Toe, front or rear, is the position of the tire and wheel assembly in relation to the center line of the
vehicle, as viewed from the top. This alignment measurement influences the track holding
characteristics of the vehicle. Incorrect Toe alignment can cause excessive tire wear.
Nissan service manuals give toe specifications as either "total toe-in" or "total too-out." Total toe-in
or -out, means that one-half (1/2) of the listed dimension should be applied, equally, to each wheel.
^ Toe-In is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the front (Figure 1a).
Page 5329
17. Install retro-fit belt floor anchor as shown below: NOTE:
Torque anchor bolt to 26-32 ft.lbs (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
18. Install retro-fit lower quarter panel finishers.
19. Check the retro-fit seat belts for smooth operation.
20. Reinstall rear end panel trim.
21. Reinstall front lower quarter panel finishers.
22. Reinstall rear seat hinges.
23. Reinstall lower seat cushion.
24. Reinstall rear seat back and carpet.
25. Reinstall rear luggage compartment floor.
Stanza Sedan
1. Remove rear lower seat cushion, then remove the back cushion by:
a. If vehicle has non-folding rear seat, remove the retaining screws, then pull the seat back up and
out. or
b. If vehicle has split/folding rear seat, remove trunk carpeting retaining finishers as shown below.
This will allow access to the seat back retaining screws. After removing six retaining screws, the
seat back may be removed.
2. Remove the rear high mount stop light.
3. Remove rear speakers, if equipped. (Retaining nuts may be accessed by removing the speaker
grilles.)
4. Remove rear parcel shelf and rear pillar finishers.
Page 982
Comments regarding tubes and hoses:
^ Some R-134a tubes and hoses have reversed male/female connections to prevent
interchangeability with R-12 components.
R134A Service Tools & Equipment
^ R-12 and R-134a require separate and non-interchangeable sets of recovery, recycle, and
recharge equipment, because the refrigerants and lubricants are not compatible and cannot be
mixed even in the smallest amounts.
^ DO NOT attempt to use one set of equipment for both R-12 and R-134a, as all equipment
contains residual amounts of refrigerant and/or lubricant,
Page 1987
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 80
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 4496
Page 382
Inspection Procedure
Page 2166
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Locations
Engine Compartment Component Locations
Removal and Installation
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front
Fig. 9 Exploded View Of Front Suspension. 1987-90 Models
Page 5233
7. Mix one part remover solution to one part water into a bucket. Spread solution directly onto runs,
sags and thick areas of paint guard coating.
Rewash those areas repeatedly with remover and light sponging. Coatings that smear but do not
wash off are not PGC. They're probably engine wax overspray or anti-corrosion wax drips. Use
your normal solvent to remove these.
Caution: Do not let the remover dry.
Be especially careful to watch for drips onto the top surface of the bumpers when using the 1 to 1
mixture. If the solution is allowed to dry on these surfaces, it may cause recoating of the PGC.
Force can damage the paint and other chemicals can make the coating more resistant to removal.
The mixture of 1 part remover to
1 part water is used only on thick areas. Do not use the remover without mixing it with water.
8. Thoroughly rinse and dry vehicle.
Page 1470
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4467
Page 3626
4. Hold the hose and can as high as possible. Spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a continuous
stream into the air cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the air cooler Inlet hose for 5 seconds
(Point A, Figure 8).
5. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the air cooler Outlet hose (see Point B, Figure 9).
6. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the air cooler Outlet hose.
7. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the air cooler Outlet hose
to force any remaining oil or cleaner through the air cooler and out of the air cooler Inlet hose (see
Point A, Figure 9).
8. Proceed with Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles), below.
Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles)
You will be taking a sample of the debris to determine if the radiator/oil cooler must be replaced.
CAUTION:
You must refer to Charts A and B to determine the location of the Inlet and Outlet hoses for the oil
cooler in the radiator of the vehicle you are working on.
If you do not identify the Inlet and Outlet hoses correctly, debris may be left inside the "in radiator"
cooler and transmission damage may occur.
NOTE:
Failure to clean the exterior of the Cooler Inlet hose properly may lead to inaccurate debris
identification.
1. Place an oil drain pan under the automatic transmission "in radiator" cooler Inlet and Outlet
hoses.
2. Clean the exterior and tip of the cooler Inlet hose.
3. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-AM006) into the Outlet hose of the oil cooler in the radiator (see Figure 4).
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath vapors or mist from spray.
4. Hold the hose and can as high as possible and spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a
continuous stream into the cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the cooler Inlet hose for 5
seconds.
NOTE:
For Quest vehicles (V40/V41 Models);
Page 1455
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Page 4853
1. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Turn the ignition switch to the "ACC" position. Check
the available voltage to the fan motor fuse(s).
^ If the available voltage is 1.5 volts or more below battery voltage, check the power supply circuit
to the fuse box for any source of high resistance.
2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. Check the fuse(s) and fuse holder for continuity and
for any sign of corrosion. Clean or repair as necessary.
3. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and body
ground.
^ If there is continuity, check for a short in the blower fan circuit.
4. Place the fan switch in the highest (# 4) position. Check for continuity between the fuse box and
body ground.
^ If there is no continuity, check for an open in the blower fan circuit.
TEST PROCEDURE # 2:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Visually inspect the thermal limiter (fuse) on the fan resistor assembly. If the fuse has burned
open or has been overheated, replace the fan resistor assembly.
3. Remove the fan motor assembly from the intake air box and check for foreign material or water
corrosion.
4. Check to make sure there is clearance between the fan cage and the motor mounting plate.
5. If the instrument connector was disconnected to remove the blower motor assembly, re-connect
it.
6. Perform the following test:
A. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
B. Turn the ignition key to the "ACC" position.
C. Position the fan motor so that the fan operation can be safely observed.
D. While observing the fan, turn the fan switch to the low speed (# 1) position for 10 seconds, then
move it back to the "OFF" position.
^ If the blower fan does not operate during the 10 second test period, replace the fan motor.
^ If the individual fan blades can be visually identified during the 10 second test period, the fan is
operating too slowly. Replace the fan motor.
TEST PROCEDURE # 3:
1. Place the ignition switch in the "OFF" position.
2. Place the fan switch in the "OFF" position.
3. For safety to your volt-ohmmeter, perform this test with the vehicle battery ground disconnected.
Touch the positive (+) probe of an ohmmeter to the voltage supply wire at the blower fan resistor.
4. Connect the negative (-) probe to body ground.
5. Place the fan switch into the speed position in which the malfunction occurs.
^ If there is no continuity (open circuit to ground), check the circuit from the resistor to fan switch
ground.
Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Reach under instrument panel and disconnect multi-pin connector from rear of switch.
3. Depress two switch retaining clips and push switch out of panel.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Differentials - Recommended Lubricants
Differential Assembly: Technical Service Bulletins Differentials - Recommended Lubricants
Classification: GI94-001
Reference: NTB94-004
Date: January 13, 1994
RECOMMENDED OIL FOR DIFFERENTIALS [CONVENTIONAL OR VISCOUS LIMITED SLIP
TYPES]
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) Nissan Vehicles with Conventional or Viscous
Limited Slip Differentials
SERVICE INFORMATION NOTE:
For Nissan vehicles equipped with most types of Limited Slip Differentials, refer to Nissan
Technical Bulletin NTB93-140 (GI93-011), "Oil for Limited Slip Differential."
To refill the oil for RWD conventional or viscous limited slip differentials applied to Nissan vehicles,
the following criteria should be applied: Lubrication Purpose: Conventional Differential Gear Oil
Differential Gear Oil Capacity: Refer to the "MA" Section in the appropriate Service Manual.
Type: Sulfur-Phosphorus with Extreme Pressure Additives American Petroleum Institute (API)
Rating: GL-5 NOTE:
Oil meeting the "GL-5" Rating is defined as a "lubricant for hypoid gears in severe service,
including "shock loading" ".
80W-90 is preferable for ambient temperature below 40°C (104°F).
Viscosity: Refer to the following chart for differential gear oil viscosity selection with respect to
ambient temperature.
Page 5202
Mirrors: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 3256
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5046
Programming additional remote controls
When programming additional remote controls, it is possible to erase a previously-programmed
remote control. When an additional remote control is added, it may be necessary to program all
remote controls at this time.
1. Sit inside the vehicle with the hood, trunk and all doors closed.
2. Place the console switch in the ALARM OFF position.
3. Turn the ignition key from the OFF position to the ON position SIX times within 10 seconds.
NOTE:
OFF to ON to OFF = 1 time.
4. Move the console switch from the ALARM OFF position to the AUTO position and then to the
ALARM OFF position.
5. Press the Lock / Unlock button on the remote control ONE time.
6. To program additional remote controls, repeat steps 4 & 5.
7. To conclude programming at any time, open any door.
Page 3845
Check the wire in the illustration. If an ohmmeter is used to measure resistance (circuit off), the
single strand of wire still making contact would give a reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a
good circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand of wire is not able to carry the current.
The single strand will have a high resistance to the current. Using the voltmeter this will be picked
up as a slight voltage drop.
Unwanted high resistance can be caused by many factors as illustrated below: Undersized Wiring
(single strand example) Corrosion On Switch Contacts Loose Wire Connections Or Splices.
If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge.
Measuring Voltage Drop-Accumulated Method
1. Connect the voltmeter across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive
lead of the voltmeter should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
2. Operate the circuit
3. The voltmeter will indicate how many volts are being used to "push" current through that part of
the circuit.
Note
in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop between the battery and the bulb.
Measuring Voltage Drop - Step By Step)
The Step by Step method is most useful in isolating excessive drops in low voltage systems, such
as those in "Computer Controlled Systems". Circuits in the "Computer Controlled Systems" operate
on very low amperage. Any variation in resistance in the system due to poor connections, improper
installation, improper wire gauge or corrosion can adversely affect the systems operation. A step by
step voltage drop test can be used to identify a component or wire which is operating under too
much resistance.
Brakes - ABS Self Check Noise Explanation
Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Self Check
Noise Explanation
Classification: BR10-004
Reference: NTB10-077
Date: June 10, 2010
ABS SELF CHECK NOISE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan Vehicles with ABS or ABS/VDC
SERVICE INFORMATION
If you identify:
^ Clicking, knocking, clunking, buzzing, or thumping noise coming from the engine compartment
area; and
^ The noise occurs only once during the first few seconds of driving at approximately 16 MPH; and
^ The noise occurs only once per ignition cycle (ignition OFF > ON) and does not occur again until
the ignition is cycled.
NOTE:
The noise may be louder after the vehicle has not been operated for a prolonged period of time.
The above condition is normal and does not need repair.
Each time the ignition is turned on and the vehicle is driven at about 16 mph, the ABS/VDC system
performs a "Self-Check" to confirm components of the ABS/VDC system are operating correctly.
This "Self-Check" function creates the noise described above.
If the brakes are being applied when the "Self-Check" occurs, a vibration may be felt in the brake
pedal and an increased level of noise may be noticed.
NOTE:
^ Refer customers to the Owners Manual, Section 5, Starting and driving, Brake system on the
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS). The "Self-test feature"
section provides additional explanation.
^ The speeds described above refer specifically to Versa, Sentra, Altima, and Maxima. However,
any vehicle fitted with ABS or ABS/VDC will have a
"Self-Check" which is triggered in similar circumstances.
Page 2163
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 559
SPECIAL TOOLS
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Idle Speed: Customer Interest Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Page 1649
Fig. 26 Exploded view of heater system. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
4. Refer to Fig. 26 to complete removal of heater core.
Fig. 22 Exploded view of heater case.
5. Separate heater case, Fig. 22, and remove core.
6. Reverse procedure to install.
Component Locations
Cruise Control: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Fuel Pump Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 974
Comments regarding PAG refrigerant oils:
^ PAG oil absorbs moisture from the air at an exceptionally fast rate, and moisture can damage the
A/C system.
Page 3292
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2997
Page 2580
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1066
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 2999
Page 5146
PARTS INFORMATION
The following 3M products (or their equivalent) should be obtained from your local body shop
supply.
3M PART
PART DESCRIPTION NUMBER APPLICATION
Flexible Parts Repair Manual 05900 Both types
Flexible Parts Putty 05903 Polyurethane bumpers
Flexible Parts Coating 05905 Both types
Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter 05907 Polypropylene bumpers
solvent (general purpose) -- To remove silicones, tar or grease.
Fiberglass cloth -- To repair holes up to 3" in diameter.
Sanding discs for rotary -- 36 grit
sander 180 grit 240 grit 320 grit
Polyurethane Bumper Fascia Repair
If extensive reinforcing or patching from the back is required use the following procedure.
1. Scuff the backside with grade 180 abrasives.
2. Cut a glass cloth patch to cover repair area.
3. Mix a quantity of Flexible Parts Repair Material. Lay glass cloth on a clean surface. Use a
squeegee to force the Flexible Parts Repair Material into the glass cloth.
4. Apply glass cloth patch to backside of repair area.
5. Apply additional Flexible Parts Repair Material over surface of glass cloth patch.
FASCIA REPAIR
1. Clean the repair area with soap and water. Remove grease and tar with solvent. Avoid solvent
contact with plastic base material - temporary swelling can occur.
Page 4536
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.011 in
Exhaust 0.011 in
Page 5339
Page 3842
In general testing electrical circuits is an easy task if it is approached in a logical and organized
method. Before beginning it is important that you have all available information related to the
system you are going to test. You should also have a thorough understanding of how the system
operates so that you use the appropriate test procedure and equipment.
While testing electrical components, if the incident is reported as intermittent, it may be necessary
to gently shake the wiring harness or electrical component to simulate vehicle vibrations.
DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
A Digital Multimeter DMM (10 megaohm input impedance) can safely be used to diagnose and test
most vehicle systems.
Test lights are not recommended due to the possibility of inadvertently tapping into a computer or
air bag circuit and causing damage.
Before attempting to diagnose a circuit for an open or a short, it is important that you:
1. Have the proper reference material available. Power Supply Routings Applicable Service Manual
sections Fix Tips
2. Understand how the system works.
3. Have a good understanding of what condition you are diagnosing Situation when the problem
occurs (weather, loads, etc.) What systems interact with the one you are diagnosing Is it
intermittent or a consistent problem
4. Have proper equipment to perform the diagnosis such as a digital voltmeter, alligator clips, and
probe leads.
TESTING FOR OPENS IN THE CIRCUIT
Before you begin to diagnose and test the system, you should rough sketch a schematic of the
system. This will help you to logically walk through the diagnosis process. Drawing the sketch will
also reinforce your working knowledge of the system. Refer to the attached drawing for sample
schematics.
Continuity Check Method
The continuity check is used to find an open in the circuit. The Digital Multimeter (DMM) set on the
resistance function will indicate an open circuit as over limit (OL, no beep tone or no ohms symbol).
Make sure to always start with the DMM at the highest resistance level.
To help in understanding the diagnosis of open circuits please refer to the attached diagram.
Page 95
Check the wire in the illustration. If an ohmmeter is used to measure resistance, the single strand
of wire still making contact would give an ohmmeter reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a good
circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand of wire is not able to carry the current. It will
become hot and have a high resistance to the current. This will be picked up as a voltage drop.
Unwanted resistance can be caused by many situations: -Undersized wiring (single strand)
-Corrosion on switch contacts -Loose wire connections or splices
If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge (lower number).
Measuring Voltage Drop
1. Connect the voltmeter across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive
lead of the voltmeter should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
2. Operate the circuit
3. The voltmeter will indicate how many volts (voltage drop) are being used to "push" current
through that part of the circuit. Note in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop
between the battery and the bulb, or a 4.0 v. drop between the switch and the bulb.
Relationship between Open/Short circuit and the ECU pin control
Page 409
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-012A Date: 990617
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Classification: BR94-002a
Reference: NTB94-012a
Date: June 17, 1999
This amended version of NTB94-012 adds a caution and a note to the service procedure. Please
discard all paper copies of NTB94-012.
This bulletin supersedes TS89-105/BR89-004
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
SERVICE INFORMATION Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in
any vehicle when excessive rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's
brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in a thickness between the thickest and
thinnest points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy. However, excessive Rotor
Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is the excessive rotor thickness
variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is described in more detail below.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2321
STANZA WAGON (M10) CA20E (2WD)
STANZA WAGON M10 CA20E (4WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (2WD)
TRUCK (D21) Z24i (4WD)
PATHFINDER (WD21) Z24i (2WD)
Page 3584
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only in areas with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath vapors or mist from spray.
6. Hold the hose and can as high as possible and spray Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a
continuous stream into the cooler Outlet hose until fluid flows out of the cooler Inlet hose for 5
seconds.
NOTE:
For Quest vehicles (V40/V41 Models), before removing the extension adapter hose from the cooler
Outlet hose, turn the can over and spray only propellant (gas) for a few seconds. This will avoid
fluid spill back out of the cooler hose.
7. Insert the tip of an air gun into the end of the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 5).
8. Wrap a shop rag around the air gun tip and end of the cooler Outlet hose
9. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through the cooler Outlet hose for
10 seconds to force out any remaining fluid.
10. Repeat steps 5 through 9 three additional times.
11. Place an oil drain pan under the banjo bolts that connect the oil cooler steel lines to the
transmission.
12. Remove the "banjo" bolts at the transmission, and pull the line fittings away from the
transmission.
13. Flush each steel line from the cooler side back toward the transmission by spraying
Transmission Cooler Cleaner in a continuous stream for 5 seconds.
14. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) through each steel line from the
cooler side back toward the transmission for 10 seconds to force out any remaining fluid.
15. Ensure all debris is removed from the steel cooler lines.
16. Ensure all debris is removed from the banjo bolts and fittings.
17. Go to the Workflow chart for next step.
Frontier (D22) Cooler Bypass Cleaning
1. Place an oil drain pan under oil cooler hoses or lines before removing them.
2. Remove the lines from the transmission and allow the oil to drain from the lines (See Figure 6).
3. Remove the lines from the bypass valve (see Figure 6).
Diagrams
Control Valve Body
Page 5338
Page 2090
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 347
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 4524
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Page 871
DRIVE BELT / PULLEY NOISE DIAGNOSIS FLOW CHART
Page 3313
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 3416
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
Ignition Wire Visual Inspection
1. Visually inspect the ignition wires for the following:
a. Insulation for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... b. Insulation for cracks or
breaks. c. Insulator boots for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... d. Insulator
boots for cracks or breaks. e. Terminal ends for corrosion, cracks or looseness.
Ignition Wire Resistance Test
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance between the terminal ends.
Resistance: Less than 30k ohms
Replace the wire if it fails the above test.
Page 2630
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Page 4282
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 1287
Truck (KA24E): Refer to Figures 11 and 12 Mark hose in the middle of lower half of the straight
section (inclined portion of hose) (Fig. 12). From this mark measure 1/2" toward radiator end and
toward the engine end and mark both places. Using the last two marks, cut a 1" section from the
hose. Be sure the cut piece is on a straight section of hose and try to keep the hose in its original
shape.
6. Insert the lower hose heater into the cut ends of the hose (see appropriate drawing). Slide a
hose clamp (provided in the kit) over the hose on each end and tighten over the lower hose heater.
Again try to keep the hose in its original shape. NOTE: Do not remove electrical cord from heater.
7. Reinstall the lower radiator hose (with lower hose heater) into the vehicle using the original
clamps. Tighten all clamps. Make sure that the hose is installed in its original position.
8. Route cord out around the radiator. Use plastic tie wraps to hold the wire away from hot or
moving parts.
9. Refill radiator with coolant fluid. Start engine and run to expel any air trapped in the system.
Check coolant level and add if required.
NOTE: It is recommended that low phosphate anti-freeze be used, and that a maximum
anti-freeze/water mixture ratio of 50/50 be used. Refer to the Nissan Owner's Manual "Engine
Cooling System" section.
10. Check all hose connections for leaks. Tighten clamps if necessary. Reinstall engine
undercover.
11. Use cable end protector cap when heater is not plugged into power source.
Page 2462
2. If the light is on, perform the ECU self-diagnosis procedure to determine what type of
malfunction is indicated. If the malfunction code is 32 (EGR malfunction), perform the diagnostic
procedure on page 3/7 of this bulletin and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on
page 4 or 5.
If the malfunction code is other than 32, perform the necessary diagnosis and repair as outlined in
the service manual for that code, and then install the appropriate sub-harness as listed on page 4
or 5 of this bulletin.
(NOTE: Warranty information given in this bulletin does not apply to codes other than #32. Repairs
for codes other than #32 should be submitted on a separate claim, if applicable.)
Pulsar SE Modification Procedure
FIGURE 3
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (34F) (Figure 3).
FIGURE 2
FIGURE 4
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
3. Apply the countermeasure application sticker (refer to Figure 2) to the top of the control unit
(Figure 4).
Page 3424
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection Secondary Tests
Secondary Coil Test
1. Disconnect the ignition coil terminal.
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance between the (-) coil and secondary terminal.
Resistance: 8.2 - 12.4 kohms
3. Visually check the coil for leakage and damage. Replace ignition coil if it fails the above test.
Page 1761
Digital signals are ON-OFF (Hi-Low) voltage pulses. This signal is a typical digital signal.
Examples of common digital signals are:
Battery Voltage The ignition switch in the ACC or ON position provides a battery voltage signal to
several control units. This informs the control unit of the ignition position.
Switch to Ground A door switch is a common example of a switch to ground. When the door is
opened the door switch completes the circuit. The interior light is turned on. In addition, the time
control unit is sent an OFF signal indicating the door is open.
Pulse Voltage A pulse voltage is made up of alternating high and low voltage signals of varying
duration. These signals are counted by the control unit within a predetermined time frame.
Analog Input Signals
An analog signal is a voltage that varies over a period of time. Analog signals are produced by
sensors in the vehicle. Sensors change resistance to deliver variable voltage signals. The Oxygen
Sensor sine wave signals shown are typical analog signals. These charts are example signals
printed using CONSULT.
^ The first chart shows an Oxygen Sensor lean (low voltage) condition.
^ The second chart is a normal Oxygen Sensor voltage printout.
^ The third chart illustrates an Oxygen Sensor rich (high voltage) condition.
Examples of common sensors are:
Temperature Sensors Temperature sensors change resistance with a change in temperature. This
temperature is converted into an analog voltage range.
Description and Operation
Distributor Cap: Description and Operation
Distributor Cap
The distributor cap is used to make the connection between the rotor and the correct spark plug
wire. High tension current from the rotor is distributed to the towers of the distributor cap at a
pre-set sequence and then to the spark plug wires which carry the current on to the spark plugs.
Page 189
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 4777
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-001 Date: 920101
A/C - System Changes As Result of R-134A Refrigerant
Classification: HA92-OO1
Reference: NTB92-OO1
Date: January 1992
A/C SYSTEM CHANGES FOR R-134A REFRIGERANT
(ALL MODELS)
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Service Information
Introduction
Due to its harmful effect on the ozone layer, R-12 is being phased out and replaced by R-134a,
which does not harm the ozone layer. While the R-134a A/C system is very similar to an R-12 A/C
system, the differences in the refrigerant, lubricants, and service equipment are important.
Nissan A/C systems will change from R-12 to R-134a at the time of new vehicle (full model change)
introduction, or in some cases by model year update to an existing model line.
This bulletin describes all of the general differences between the R-12 and R-134a systems. For
details of an R-134a system for a specific model, refer to that model's service manual or new
product information.
Refrigerant Handling Precautions
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur.
^ Use only specified lubricant for the R-134a A/C system and R-134a components. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure is likely to occur.
^ The specified R-134a lubricant absorbs moisture from the atmosphere at a rapid rate, therefore
the following handling precautions must be observed:
^ When removing refrigerant components from a vehicle, immediately cap (seal) the component to
minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere.
^ When installing refrigerant components to a vehicle, do not remove the caps (unseal) until just
before connecting the components. Also, complete the connection of all refrigerant tubes and
hoses without delay to minimize the entry of moisture into the system.
^ Use the specified lubricant from a sealed container only. Containers must be re-sealed
immediately after dispensing the lubricant. Lubricant in containers which are not properly sealed
will become moisture saturated. Such lubricant is no longer suitable for use and should be properly
disposed.
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and
throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting SAE standards to discharge R-134a
Systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service.
^ Always wear eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or
air conditioning system.
^ Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 125° (52°C).
^ Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame; if container warming is required, place the
bottom of the container in a pail of warm water.
^ Do not intentionally drop, puncture, or incinerate refrigerant containers.
^ Keep refrigerant away from open flames: hazardous gas will be produced if refrigerant burns.
^ Refrigerant will displace oxygen, therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent
suffocation.
Page 2825
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 1782
Fig. 303c Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 630
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 2845
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 Evaporative emission system. (Typical)
Refer to Fig. 37 for a typical evaporative emission system. Complete system schematics are
located in ``Vacuum Hose Routings.''
This system reduces hydrocarbon emissions from the fuel system by the use of activated charcoal
in the carbon canister. With the engine off, fuel vapor from the fuel tank is led into the carbon for
storage. The vapor is retained in the canister until it is moved by air drawn through the bottom of
the canister to the intake manifold with the engine running. The purge control valve is closed when
the engine is running at idle. A small portion of the stored vapor flows through the constant purge
orifice into the intake manifold. As engine speed increases and throttle vacuum rises, the purge
control valve opens and vapor is drawn into the manifold through both the main and constant purge
orifices.
Page 2727
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2735
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
Page 3026
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1970
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 4570
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 3844
no continuity; short is further down the circuit than the relay.
6. With sw1 closed, relay contacts jumped with jumper wire and probes at the load side of fuse
terminal and ground check for continuity. continuity; short is between relay and sensor (point C). no
continuity; check sensor, retrace steps.
Voltage Check Method
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads (i.e. swl open, relay disconnected and sensor
disconnected) powered through the fuse.
2. Turn the ignition key to the ON or START position and verify battery voltage at the B+side of the
fuse terminal (one lead on the B+terminal side of the fuse block and one lead on a known good
ground).
3. With swl open and the DMM leads across both fuse terminals, check for voltage. voltage; short is
between fuse block and swl (point A). no voltage; short is further down the circuit than sw1.
4. With sw1 closed, relay and sensor disconnected and the DMM leads across both fuse terminals,
check for voltage. voltage; short is between sw1 and the relay (point B). no voltage; short is further
down the circuit than the relay.
5. With swl closed, relay contacts jumped with fused jumper wire check for voltage. voltage; short is
down the circuit of the relay or between the relay and the disconnected sensor (point C). no
voltage; retrace steps and check power to fuse block.
GROUND INSPECTION
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits.
Ground connections are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The
corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted resistance. This resistance can change the way a circuit
operates.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground
can drastically alter an electronically controlled circuit. These circuits generally operate in the 5 volt
range. The components in these circuits can be seriously affected by a voltage change as low as
one tenth (0.1V) of a volt. A poor or corroded ground can easily affect the circuit by that amount.
Even when the ground connection looks clean, there can be a thin film of rust on the surface. When
inspecting a ground connection follow these rules:
1. Remove the ground bolt screw or clip.
2. Inspect all mating surfaces for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for "add-on" accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure
all of the wires are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are
cased in one eyelet make sure one or more of the ground wires does not have excess wire
insulation.
VOLTAGE DROP TESTS
Voltage Drop Tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance.
A voltage drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation. Part of the
available voltage is used by the resistance. When there is excessive resistance less voltage is
available for other loads (lights, motors, etc.) in the circuit. Since each resistance in a circuit uses
voltage, a voltmeter can be used to isolate problems.
A voltage drop across closed contacts can indicate excessive resistance. This can cause the circuit
to operate incorrectly. Remember a switch is not a load. During diagnosis, use a voltmeter to
measure the voltage drop across each switch contact while the circuit is in operation.
Page 2965
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Page 1187
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Page 401
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Specifications
Fig. 6 Specifications
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 4431
c. Install upper spring seat as shown, Figs. 9 through 11.
Page 2525
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 2740
Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Engine Oil: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Cold Weather Engine Starting Tips
Classification: PI95-005A
Reference: NTB95-120A
Date: January 10, 2003
COLD WEATHER STARTING TIPS
This bulletin supersedes PI95-005. The Service Information has been amended. Please discard all
paper copies of PI95-005
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
In case a vehicle is hard to start during cold weather, we suggest the following procedure.
^ These steps are a review of the procedure outlined in the Owner's Manual.
^ Use these steps when the weather is cold and the engine is hard to start.
1. Press the accelerator pedal down approximately 1/3 of the way to the floor.
2. Hold the accelerator pedal in this position while cranking the engine.
3. Once the engine has started release the accelerator pedal.
NOTE:
Do not race the engine while warming it up.
4. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, stop cranking, wait at least 10 seconds. Then
repeat steps 1 through 3.
Once an engine is started in cold weather condition:
^ You should keep the engine running for a minimum of 2-3 minutes before shutting it off.
^ Starting and stopping of the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more
difficult to restart.
^ It may also adversely affect a vehicle's fuel economy.
Another factor which may affect a vehicles "startability" is the viscosity or thickness of the oil that is
used.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity engine oil is preferred for all temperatures, all year-round for most models.
^ SAE 5W-30 viscosity oil makes it easier to start the engine and maintain a stable idle during
warm-up.
Please communicate these cold weather starting tips to your customers.
Disclaimer
Page 3354
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5466
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
The stop light switch is located on the brake pedal support.
1. Disconnect the switch electrical connectors.
2. Loosen switch retaining locknut and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 2661
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4131
Alternator: Technical Service Bulletins Charging System - No Crank, Dead Battery Incidents
Classification: Section:
EL88-007 Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-085
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar XE Date: June 2, 1988 DEAD BATTERY INCIDENTS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar XE vehicles may experience repeated no restart incidents
resulting from dead batteries after, low speed driving conditions with heavy accessory load. This
may be due to insufficient alternator output. As a countermeasure, a higher output alternator (70
amp) is available to replace the 60 amp alternator. When installing the 70 amp alternator, a
countermeasure adjusting bar and fan belt must also be installed.
NOTE: Before installing a new alternator verify that the charging system is working correctly.
PARTS INFORMATION WARRANTY INFORMATION
Refer to Section EE of the Warranty Flat Rate Manual. R&R; adjust bar and fan belt is included in
R&R; alternator flat rate time.
Page 52
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
Page 2682
Page 72
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30i
VAN (C22) Z241
200SX (S100) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
Testing and Inspection
Thermal Vacuum Valve (TVV): Testing and Inspection
Fig. 21 Thermal vacuum valve operating specifications
Fig. 62 Thermal vacuum valve operating specifications.
1. Drain coolant from engine, then remove valve.
2. Apply vacuum to valve and make sure valve opens or closes in response to engine coolant
temperature as specified, Fig. 21 & 62. Do not allow water to get inside thermal vacuum valve.
Page 3833
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Description and Operation
Vacuum Check Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 54 Check valve.
The check valve is located on the VVT valve bracket in the venturi ported vacuum line. This valve
prevents the vacuum acting on the VVT valve from increasing excessively and activates the EGR
system properly.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Page 1885
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Page 2074
Page 369
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Fail-Safe System Description
AIR FLOW METER MALFUNCTIONING
If the air flow meter output voltage is lower or higher than the specified value, E.C.U. senses an air
flow meter malfunctioning. In case air flow meter malfunctions, the throttle sensor substitutes for
the air flow meter. Though air flow meter is malfunctioning, it is possible to drive the vehicle and
start the engine. But engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm in order to inform the driver of
fail-safe system operation while driving.
Operation
Page 2679
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1937
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 767
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 4040
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.
Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Models: All models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT90-004
Bulletin No.: NTB90-099
Date: November 8, 1990
NISSAN WINTER TIRES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan Vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some vehicles are equipped with performance tires from the factory to enhance dry weather vehicle
performance. In order to improve vehicle traction during winter driving, all-season or radial mud &
snow (M&S;) tires may be installed.
Upon customer request, dealers may recommend alternative tires for improved traction in snow.
When doing so, these guidelines should be followed:
1. A tire with the M&S; rating is recommended for winter driving in snow.
2. The replacement tires must have the same size and load carrying capacity as the original
equipment tires.
3. All four (4) tires must be replaced, without exception. The mixed use of different types of tires
(i.e., radial mixed with bias ply, M&S; mixed with non-M&S;) should be avoided because of adverse
effects on vehicle handling and ride characteristics.
4. The requesting customer should be informed of the speed rating of the current tires, so that tires
of the same speed rating could be purchased as replacement tires.
NOTE: ^ All-season or snow tires may have lower speed ratings than factory-equipped tires. ^
When 4 mud & snow (M&S;) tires are installed on the vehicle, the tires should be inflated to the
pressures recommended on the vehicle tire placard. The maximum inflation pressure shown on the
side of the tire should never be exceeded.
Testing and Inspection
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Air density becomes thinner at higher altitudes. Therefore, the carburetor produces too rich an
air/fuel mixture at higher altitudes. The altitude compensator automatically corrects air/fuel ratio to
an optimum mixture. When vehicle is operated in a high altitude environment, the bellows in the
compensator extends, causing the lever attached to the bellows to push up the needle. When the
needle is pushed up the air passage becomes wider, allowing larger amounts of air to flow from the
altitude compensator to the carburetor, thereby thinning the air/fuel mixture. Electronic Controlled
Carburetor (ECC) See: Testing and Inspection
Page 399
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4994
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 4854
Fan Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 68 Testing fan switch.
1. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch and check continuity with ohmmeter.
2. Meter should indicate continuity as shown in Fig. 68.
Locations
Power Transistor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 995
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Availability/Recommendation
Models: All Models
Section: Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification: HA91-010
Bulletin No.: NTB91-052
Date: May 23, 1991
A/C COMPRESSOR OIL - NISSAN
APPLIED MODELS: ALL MODELS
SERVICE INFORMATION:
The recommended refrigerant oil for all Nissan A/C systems is SUNISO 5GS. SUNISO 5GS is now
available from SUNISO distributors in one quart containers. When ordering the oil, specify part
number L315, which is the number for a single, one quart container.
Dealers are encouraged to use one quart containers to prevent oil contamination. When left open
to the atmosphere, compressor oil will absorb moisture that renders it unfit for use. To avoid this,
order one quart containers, open only one at a time, and keep them tightly sealed when not in use.
Due to the higher operating temperatures of our latest generation of A/C compressors, a 5GS oil is
required to ensure optimum compressor performance. The use of lighter viscosity oil commonly
found at auto parts supply stores can cause premature compressor failure.
Page 277
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Adjustments
TIMING PROCEDURE
1981-88 All with vacuum advance: Disconnect and plug vacuum advance hose before adjusting.
Check timing against specified value.
1987-90 E16/GA16 EFI: Check timing against specified value. Disconnect throttle sensor harness
before adjusting.
CA16 CA18 DOHC: Remove spark plug/coil cover. Connect inductive clamp to wire between #1
coil and spark plug. Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
1990 2960cc 300ZX: Remove #1 coil from mount and connect inductive clamp to high tension wire.
Rotate crank angle sensor to adjust.
All Others: Set timing to specified value.
Page 2715
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The Fuse Panel Is Located Under LH Side Of Instrument Panel
Primary Tests
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection Primary Tests
Primary Coil Test
1. Disconnect the ignition coil terminal.
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance across the terminals.
Resistance: 0.81 - 0.99 ohms
3. Visually check the coil for leakage and damage. Replace ignition coil if it fails the above test.
Page 5101
Tape Player: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Cassette Tape Player Diagnosis & Maintenance
Classification: Section:
EL88-021 Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-148 Models: All Date: November 10, 1988 CASSETTE
TAPE PLAYER DIAGNOSIS & MAINTENANCE
SERVICE INFORMATION
A recent survey has shown that a majority of customer complaints about cassette tape player
performance can be resolved by cleaning the tape head. Some of the symptoms of a dirty tape
head are:
^ One channel out
^ Low sound
^ Distortion
^ The cassette deck "eats" tapes
^ No high frequency
If a customer's cassette player exhibits any of these symptoms, please perform the following before
removing the unit:
1. Clean the tape head using Nissan Cassette Deck Cleaning System, P/N 99902-A7000.
2. Test the unit to see if the problem is resolved.
3. If the problem is not resolved, conduct further diagnosis.
In addition, please coordinate with your Sales Department to provide the customer with the
following recommendations for optimum sound quality and system performance:
To prevent heavy accumulation of dirt, clean the tape head at least once every month or after 10
hours of play. ^
Use brand name quality cassette tapes that are 90 minutes or less in play time (120 minute
cassette should not be used).
^ Store cassettes in their protective cases and away from direct sunlight and heat. Direct sunlight
can cause the cassette to become deformed, and a deformed cassette may jam in the player.
^ Do not use extremely old tapes. The presence of a brownish powdery substance, or small pieces
of magnetic tape on the front of the cassette tape indicates that the cassette tape is too old to use.
^ Refer to the Owner's Manual for more information on proper maintenance and operation of the
sound system.
Page 4803
Page 1754
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Page 381
Battery - Charging Precautions
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Battery - Charging Precautions
Models All Models
Section Electrical System
Classification EL87-020
Bulletin No. TS87-158
Date October 26, 1987
CHARGING NISSAN BATTERIES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models built after February, 1985
SERVICE INFORMATION:
A "hybrid" type battery, with calcium and antimony plates, has been installed in all Nissan models
starting with 1986 production. This type of battery has improved recharging capabilities and may be
recharged with a standard shop battery charger, even after deep discharge. Follow the procedures
given in the current Nissan service manuals.
These batteries also have a slightly higher self discharge rate. To eliminate the effects of vehicle
storage and to improve customer satisfaction, each battery should be checked before the new
vehicle is delivered to a customer. This will insure that the battery is fully charged and provide the
customer with the proper battery service life.
BATTERY CHARGING CAUTIONS:
1. Do not attempt to recharge batteries that have low electrolyte (water) levels. Add only distilled
water to bring the levels to between the lines on the battery.
2. Use of any substance other than distilled water will damage the battery and cause reduced
service life.
3. Hybrid batteries do require periodic water level inspection. Water usage varies with driving
conditions and weather.
(Also, see the CAUTIONS listed in the service manual.)
Page 69
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
Page 543
Page 5330
5. Locate the drilling point in the pillar finishers. The point is marked in the back side of the finisher
at the position shown below.
6. Drill a 1" hole in each trim piece at the marked location using a hole saw.
7a. Using the dimensions shown in the illustration below, cut the opening in the parcel shelf for the
3-point seat belt. 7b. Install retro-fit finisher on parcel shelf ends as shown above.
8. Reinstall rear pillar finishers and check alignment of anchor bolt holes.
9. Remove lap belts (female buckle side) and install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit.
Torque mounting bolts to 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
10. Remove the retractor side of the original lap belts.
11. Remove the trunk/wheelhouse finishers to access retro-fit retractor mounting point. The finisher
must be trimmed to allow for mounting of the retractor unit. Cut finisher as shown below:
Page 984
Comments regarding R-134a manifold gauge set:
^ Be certain that the gauge face indicates R134a or 134a.
^ Be certain that the manifold gauge set has the 1/2" - 16 ACME threaded connections for service
hoses, ensuring that only R-134a service hoses are used.
^ Be certain that no refrigerants other than R-134a (along with only specified lubricants) are used
with the manifold gauge set.
Locations
Neutral/Park (NP) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 4502
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 336
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Tank Vacuum Relief Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove filler cap, wipe clean valve housing, and place cap
in mouth.
2. Inhale air. A slight resistance should be felt at first but should disappear when valve can be
heard clicking.
3. If valve is clogged or no resistance is felt, replace cap.
Page 5261
area (2' x 2' or less). Spread the liquid around with the pad before turning the buffer "ON". Use an
overlapping pattern to assure even polishing effort on all areas.
3. Second use a dual action sander with either a 3M foam pad or a Meguiar's foam pad, apply
polishing liquid over the work area (2' x 2' or less). Polish with the same technique as above. Do
not polish dry, wipe off excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
If build up occurs, cool the surface with clean water and dry with a clean terry cloth towel and clean
the foam pad. Use a slower speed to prevent heating the surface and ground the vehicle to a metal
water pipe to reduce static electricity.
INSPECTION
Gently clean a small section with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover,
using a clean towel to remove any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing
between buffing scratches and towel scratches. Inspect the surface for swirl marks under full
sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away.
CAUTION:
If you clean with an alcohol and water cleaning solution it will cause damage to plastic lenses. The
damage is not immediately visible, but develops later
Buffing
Buffing is done with a 8" buffer at 1500-1750 RPM to remove sanding scratches.
1. Clean the surface of all residue before buffing.
2. Apply a buffing liquid and spread it over the work area (2' x 2' or less) with the buffing pad before
turning the buffer "ON". Keep the pad nearly flat and move it slowly but continuously over the area.
Use an overlapping pattern to assure even buffing effort on all areas. Do not buff dry, wipe off
excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for sanding marks under full sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held
at an angle about an arms length away. If necessary, gently clean a small section of the surface
with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover, using a clean towel to remove
any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing between buffing scratches and towel
scratches.
Sanding
1. Soak the sand paper in water with lubricant such as Meguiar's # 0016, for at least 15 minutes
before use. Mask the fenders and doors to reduce cleanup time. Wet sanding with a lubricant
prevents buildup on the paper and consequent gouging of the finish.
2. Sand with 2000 grit sand paper using a sanding pad, never by hand alone. Apply plenty of water
while sanding in one direction only, no more than 12-15 strokes. Do not sand in a circular pattern.
Do not sand over body lines and panel edges. Rinse the paper frequently to prevent gouging.
NOTE:
Wet sanding vehicles with the New Cross Link Clear Coat (NCLC) hard clear coat requires a more
aggressive sanding stroke. Vehicles with a conventional clear coat require a normal sanding
stroke.
3. Rinse with water and squeegee gently. As the squeegee clears the water, inspect for damage.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for damage under both strong fluorescent lights and full sunlight (a 500 watt
halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away is necessary on cloudy days). A
smooth dull sanded surface is expected at this time. Bright spots or other irregularities indicate the
damage needs more sanding, up to the 0.5 mil standard.
4. After the damage is removed, measure the paint thickness in several places to determine if less
than 0.5 mil has been removed.
5. If the damage was deeper than 0.5 mil, the surface must be re-clear coated, or re-color coated
on vehicles with no clear coat. Refer to the Warranty Paint and Body Self-Study Course, or the
Warranty Flat Rate Manual for assistance.
6. If the damage has been removed with less than 0.5 mil of the color/clear coat removed, buff and
polish to remove the sanding marks.
Technical Service Bulletin # 87-145 Date: 870928
Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Classification: BF87-030
Page 1143
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 202
Air Conditioning Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to switch assembly, remove screws securing switch
bracket to air intake housing, then remove switch assembly.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Vacuum Control Modulator
Exhaust Pressure Regulator Vacuum Valve: Description and Operation Vacuum Control Modulator
Fig. 49 Vacuum control modulator.
The vacuum control modulator is composed of a pressure regulator and solenoid valve. Intake
manifold vacuum is used as the vacuum source for the pressure regulator. The passage leading to
the atmosphere is controlled by solenoid valves. The vacuum control modulator provides vacuum
to the EGR valve and AAC valve following the electrical signal from the control unit.
Page 2912
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Brakes - Improved Front Pad Material
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Improved Front Pad Material
Classification: BR89-002
Section: Brake System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-006 Models: All models Date: January 19, 1989
IMPROVED FRONT BRAKE PAD MATERIAL
APPLIED MODELS: 1982-88 Sentra (B11 & B12) 1983-88 Pulsar (N12 & N13) 1982-88 Stanza
(T11 & T12) 1985-88 Stanza Wagon (M10)
1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1984-88 200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 Truck (D21) 1987-88 Pathfinder (WD21)
1987-88 Van (C22)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Service brake pads with improved semi-metallic material are available for the applied models.
These pads have been installed at the factory on some 1987 and most 1988 models. Compared to
the former semi-metallic material, this new material has the following advantages:
^ Reduced brake pedal effort when brakes are cold
^ Firmer brake pedal "feel"
^ Reduced brake rotor wear
^ Reduced brake squeal
^ Reduced brake noise after vehicle has been in storage (less affected by rust on rotor surface)
In addition, this new semi-metallic material has much longer pad life than the equivalent asbestos
pads.
Service brake pad kits with this new material are available and have new part numbers. They can
also be identified by the code stamped in the pad backing plate.
Original pad material (asbestos) NBK NP01 FF
or (semi-metallic) Hitachi HP14 EE
Improved pad material (semi-metallic) Hitachi HP12 FE
The improved pads can be substituted for the original pads and are recommended for all repairs
when the brake pads are replaced.
Page 2663
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Antenna - Inoperative, Rod Maintenance & Replacement
Antenna: All Technical Service Bulletins Antenna - Inoperative, Rod Maintenance & Replacement
CLASSIFICATION: EL95-008
REFERENCE: NTB95-074
DATE: August 2, 1995
POWER ANTENNA ROD MAINTENANCE AND REPLACEMENT
This Bulletin contains revised Warranty information. Please discard NTB94-019 dated February 17,
1994.
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models equipped with power antennas
SERVICE INFORMATION
Power antenna incidents for no operation or improper retraction are almost always caused by the
following:
^ The antenna rod is broken or bent due to misuse. Common examples of this include the antenna
contacts the top of a garage door opening or a tree branch. Also, a customer may forget to lower
the antenna before entering an automated car wash.
^ Dirt, road grime, and other foreign matter collects on the rod interrupting proper operational
movement. This occurs most frequently during winter months in areas where road salt and other
chemicals are splashed onto the antenna rod.
REPAIRS COMPLETED FOR THE TWO CAUSES DESCRIBED ABOVE ARE NOT COVERED
UNDER WARRANTY. ONLY REPAIRS UNDERTAKEN DUE TO DEFECTS IN MATERIAL OR
WORKMANSHIP WILL BE COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
In a large majority of cases, the antenna motor is fully operational and receiving proper power.
Therefore, replacement of the entire power antenna assembly is not usually necessary to restore
power antenna operation. Prior to removing any power antenna assembly, an attempt should be
made to repair the power antenna by removing dirt, road grime, and other foreign matter, and then
lubricating the antenna rod sections as appropriate. if still inoperative, replacement of the rod only
should be made. A sample replacement procedure is provided on the following page. Check the EL
section under Audio and Power Antenna in the Service Manual for specifics on your respective
vehicle.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
REPLACING THE ANTENNA ROD
1. Remove antenna nut and base. (Figure 1)
2. Turn the radio to "ON" and the antenna rod will extend*. Assist the antenna rod to fully separate
from the antenna base. Note the direction of the gear section on the antenna rope. [The new
antenna rod must be installed in the same direction].
* If the antenna rod does not extend, always check the power supply to the power antenna before
replacing the power antenna assembly.
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance Per Cable 30 K ohms
Page 2991
Page 3891
^ while the vehicle is barely moving, with light brake pedal force
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
^ most common on vehicles with automatic transmission
This noise is common on most cars with front disc brakes. There are no repair procedures to
eliminate this noise. 3.
SQUEAKING/SQUEALING NOISE ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during low speed stops (5-20 mph)
^ more noticeable during warm, dry weather
This noise is common on vehicles with high-performance potential that must be able to stop in
short distances from high speeds. Other brands of brake pads may eliminate this noise, but Nissan
does not recommend them because they may have reduced pad life or inadequate performance in
high speed stops. 4.
HIGH-PITCHED SQUEAKING/SCRAPING NOISE ^
whenever brakes are applied
^ may come from just one wheel
Nissan uses pad wear indicators on many of its disc brake pads to provide an audible warning
when the brake pads need replacement. Spring steel tabs that are riveted to the brake pad scrape
lightly on the rotor surface when the pad is worn down to its lowest limit. The customer should hear
the noise at this time and bring the vehicle to the dealer for brake pad replacement. The pad wear
indicator will not damage the rotor surface if the pad is replaced in a reasonable time. Replace
worn pads with new parts. Check the rotor surface for damage and machine if necessary.
Page 2357
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Page 3210
Inspection Procedure
Page 1657
Index For Main Harness Part 1
Engine Compartment, Left Front Fender Apron Near Battery.
Connector ID is 79M.
Page 2160
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1511
Page 1400
Timing Belt: Service and Repair
TIMING BELT REMOVAL
CAUTION:
- After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will
hit piston heads.
- Do not bend or twist timing belt too tightly.
- Ensure timing belt, camshaft sprocket, crankshaft sprocket and belt tensioner are clean and free
from oil or water.
- Before installing timing belt, confirm that No.1 cylinder is set at top dead center (T.D.C.) on
compression stroke.
- Align arrow in direction of timing belt rotation.
- Adjust timing belt tension with all spark plugs removed.
1. Remove the following parts.
- Front right side splash cover
- Front right side under cover
Accessory Relay
Ignition Relay: Locations Accessory Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 591
When the specification is labeled "Toe-Out" and the dimensions are positive (+) numbers (ie: 2 to 6
mm), the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 3).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-out specification = Toe-Out wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-Out
specification = Toe-In wheel setting.
4. Rear Toe is adjustable on some Nissan vehicles with independent rear suspensions. Usually,
the adjustment, itself, is not difficult but, it is extremely important.
Nissan uses two (2) different terms to describe "Rear Toe". "Toe-In" and "Toe-Out". Contemporary
wheel alignment equipment measures rear "Toe-In" and, if the wheels are actually "Toed-Out",
displays the measured values as a negative (Figure 4).
5. Toe is measured as a distance or as an angle. When measuring toe as a distance, it is found by
measuring the difference between the center of the front of the tire and the center of the rear of the
tire at spindle height. The difference between the distances is Total Toe.
When measured as an angle, the center line of the vehicle is zero degrees (0~, 0.00~, or 0~00')
and the angle of a line drawn through the center of the tire and wheel, as viewed from the top, is
the Toe angle for the individual wheel.
6. Nissan Total Toe specifications are given two (2) ways:
Distance: Millimeters and Decimal Inches
Angle: Degrees and Minutes
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Page 1283
MODEL ENGINE YEAR LOCATION
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------200SX CA18ET 1984-1988 Lower radiator hose
CA20E
Stanza Sedan CA20E 1987-1988 Lower radiator hose
Truck VG30i 1986.5 & later Lower radiator hose
Pathfinder VG30i 1987 & later Lower radiator hose
Truck (4Cyl 4WD) KA24E 1990 & later Lower radiator hose
KIT CONTENTS:
Item No. Qty Item
1 1 Lower radiator hose heater (with power cord and plug cap)
2 2 Hose clamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Phillips screwdriver Masking tape or chalk
Flat blade screwdriver Electrical tape or wire tie
Heavy duty utility knife (plastic or wire) Measuring tape or ruler
PROCEDURE:
Page 760
Page 1595
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 1667
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Service and Repair
THERMO SWITCH
Replace
On Pulsar models, thermo switch is located in radiator lower tank. On Sentra models, thermo
switch is located on center left side of radiator tank.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Drain cooling system into suitable container.
3. Disconnect thermo switch electrical connector, then remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Fig. 1 Testing thermo switch (typical)
Testing
1. Remove thermo switch as outlined above.
2. Connect suitable ohmmeter across switch terminals, then immerse lower part of switch in water,
Fig. 1. Ohmmeter should indicate an open circuit.
3. Place thermometer in water and heat. When water temperature reaches approximately 185°F,
switch contacts should close and the ohmmeter should indicate continuity.
4. If switch does not operate properly, replace it.
Engine - Drive Belt Noise Diagnosis
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Noise Diagnosis
Classification: EM09-013
Reference: NTB10-002
Date: January 12, 2010
DRIVE BELT SYSTEM NOISE DIAGNOSIS
APPLIED VEHICLES All Nissan
IF YOU CONFIRM
There is noise coming from the drive belt(s), or drive belt pulley(s),
ACTION
Use the flow chart in this bulletin to help diagnose and identify the source / cause of the noise.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Refer to the current Nissan Warranty Flat Rate Manual and use the indicated claims coding for any
repairs performed.
Page 4805
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-001 Date: 920101
A/C - System Changes As Result of R-134A Refrigerant
Classification: HA92-OO1
Reference: NTB92-OO1
Date: January 1992
A/C SYSTEM CHANGES FOR R-134A REFRIGERANT
(ALL MODELS)
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Service Information
Introduction
Due to its harmful effect on the ozone layer, R-12 is being phased out and replaced by R-134a,
which does not harm the ozone layer. While the R-134a A/C system is very similar to an R-12 A/C
system, the differences in the refrigerant, lubricants, and service equipment are important.
Nissan A/C systems will change from R-12 to R-134a at the time of new vehicle (full model change)
introduction, or in some cases by model year update to an existing model line.
This bulletin describes all of the general differences between the R-12 and R-134a systems. For
details of an R-134a system for a specific model, refer to that model's service manual or new
product information.
Refrigerant Handling Precautions
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur.
^ Use only specified lubricant for the R-134a A/C system and R-134a components. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure is likely to occur.
^ The specified R-134a lubricant absorbs moisture from the atmosphere at a rapid rate, therefore
the following handling precautions must be observed:
^ When removing refrigerant components from a vehicle, immediately cap (seal) the component to
minimize the entry of moisture from the atmosphere.
^ When installing refrigerant components to a vehicle, do not remove the caps (unseal) until just
before connecting the components. Also, complete the connection of all refrigerant tubes and
hoses without delay to minimize the entry of moisture into the system.
^ Use the specified lubricant from a sealed container only. Containers must be re-sealed
immediately after dispensing the lubricant. Lubricant in containers which are not properly sealed
will become moisture saturated. Such lubricant is no longer suitable for use and should be properly
disposed.
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and
throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting SAE standards to discharge R-134a
Systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service.
^ Always wear eye and hand protection (goggles and gloves) when working with any refrigerant or
air conditioning system.
^ Do not store or heat refrigerant containers above 125° (52°C).
^ Do not heat a refrigerant container with an open flame; if container warming is required, place the
bottom of the container in a pail of warm water.
^ Do not intentionally drop, puncture, or incinerate refrigerant containers.
^ Keep refrigerant away from open flames: hazardous gas will be produced if refrigerant burns.
^ Refrigerant will displace oxygen, therefore be certain to work in well ventilated areas to prevent
suffocation.
Page 4125
Battery: Specifications Standard Battery, Except Canada
Standard Battery, Except Canada
BCI Group Number 35
Cranking Performance 380 A
Page 3206
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3620
Use the "Combination" Op Codes as indicated with the appropriate Section "JA", "JC", or "JD"
coding that best represents the A/T R&R; and repair/replacement performed.
Service Procedure
Page 4810
Comments regarding liquid tanks:
^ For R-134a, the sight glass has been deleted. Refer to the service procedures section of this
bulletin for additional information regarding the refrigerant charge determination. Pressure switches
are not interchangeable between R-12 and R-134a systems.
Page 1007
Page 975
^ The graph on the following page shows that PAG oil left open to air (e.g. in an unsealed
container) will absorb 2% moisture (by weight) in 120 hours (5 days).
^ PAG containers, and any A/C component which contains PAG oil (such as the compressor)
should remain tightly capped and sealed until ready for use.
^ If you believe that a container of PAG oil may not have been adequately re-sealed after opening,
dispose of the oil properly and use oil from a new sealed container.
^ When installing or servicing an A/C system, the refrigerant tube and hose connections should be
sealed (all connections made and tightened to specification) without delay.
^ The above precautions will keep the absorption of moisture into the system to a minimum. Using
moisture saturated PAG oil in R-134a systems may lead to the formation of acids and related
system damage or failure.
^ Do not allow refrigerant oil (Nissan A/C System Oil Type S) to contact styrofoam, as the lubricant
will damage this material.
Testing and Inspection
Thermostatic Air Cleaner Vacuum Motor: Testing and Inspection
Disconnect the inlet vacuum hose of the vacuum motor, and connect another hose to the inlet to
apply vacuum to the vacuum motor. Then, confirm that the air control valve moves.
Air control valve operating vacuum: kPa (mmHg, inHg)
Opening starts -6.7 (-50, -1.97) Full opening Over -13.3 (-100-3.94)
Page 2411
Idle Speed Control Valve: Description and Operation
Idle speed control valve is a rotary solenoid valve. It receives a pulse signal from E.C.U. which
determines the position of slider, thereby varying bypass air quantity. Idle speed control valve has
additional functions below. 1. Idle-up after cold start (Air regulator) 2. Idle speed feedback control
(A.A.C. valve) 3. Idle-up for air conditioner and power steering (F.I.C.D.) 4. Deceleration vacuum
control (Dash pot, A.B. valve & Boost control valve)
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Page 1082
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 2952
Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
On Top of Receiver Drier
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Testing and Inspection
Condenser HVAC: Testing and Inspection
The condenser may malfunction either due to leakage or restriction. If restricted, compressor
discharge pressure will be excessive. Icy or frosty spots on the condenser will indicate a partial
restriction within the condenser. Ensure all foreign matter is removed from the front of the
condenser. Similarly, bent cooling fins will block air flow through the condenser and result in high
discharge pressure.
Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T
Vehicles
Classification: GI88-023
Reference: TS88-150
Date: November 17, 1988
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
APPLIED VEHICLES All Models 1987-1989
SERVICE INFORMATION The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h.
and distances of less than 40 miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when
towing Automatic Transmission vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following
limitations apply when towing Manual Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for
example behind a motor home.)
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
Page 5240
REFINISHING GUIDE
CAUTION: Air line respirator with full hood or half mask, or vapor/particulate type respirator that is
recommended as effective for isocyanate vapor and mist, must be worn during the entire painting
process.
CAUTION: When painting with pearlescent paint, be sure to keep the panel surface clean and free
from dirt and dust as it will be very conspicuous and difficult to remove.
2-Coat Pearlescent Paint 1.
In general, use the same painting method which is used for metallic painting.
2. Use the same mica base which was originally used on the vehicle, and match the color by
referring to the data and instructions given by the paint manufacturer.
3. Apply paints to the vehicle body under the same conditions and using the same painting
methods as those used to make the color comparison board.
3-Coat Pearlescent Paint
Page 745
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2683
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 1925
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Adjustments
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Control Cable Adjustment
Move selector lever from the "P" range to "1" range. You should be able to feel the detents in each
range. If the detents cannot be felt or the pointer indicating the range is improperly aligned, the
control cable needs adjustment.
1. Place selector lever at "P" range. 2. Connect control cable end to manual lever in transaxle unit,
and tighten control cable securing bolts.
Page 2552
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 2399
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Page 5494
^ A magnifying glass (10X magnification) must be used to identify impact marks that may be less
than 1 mm in diameter.
NOTE:
A lead, or crack from an impact point can run to the edge of the glass and appear to be a low
stress crack starting from the glass outside edge.
Compound crack beginning or ending at the edge of the glass
This type of crack is always caused by impact to the glass. The point of impact is located where the
crack "branches out".
Cracks that are only in the middle of the glass
This type of crack does not begin or end at the edge of the glass.
^ These cracks are always caused by an impact to the glass and are not covered under warranty.
2) How to determine if glass damage is due to a scratch in the glass surface.
Cracks from a scratch in the glass surface
Glass is produced by fusing together various raw materials such as silica, soda ash, and limestone,
and has a hardness of 5 to 6 on the Mohs scale (for reference, a diamond has a hardness of 10 on
the same scale).
Since earth and sand can contain substances harder than that of glass, glass can be easily
scratched by:
^ Fine sand particles
^ Hard metal
^ Rubbing action of contaminated wiper rubbers, or sand partials caught between the wiper and the
glass, especially when operating the wipers in a dry
Page 2150
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1857
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 2869
1. Remove both hoses and harness, solenoid attaching screws and remove valve.
2. Operate solenoid valve with battery voltage to determine if air flows through valve properly, Fig.
22.
Vacuum Cut or Control Solenoid Valve
1. Disconnect electrical connector from valve and ensure resistance across valve terminals
measures approximately 30-40 ohms.
2. Disconnect vacuum hoses from valve.
3. Check valve port openings. With battery voltage applied to the valve, air should flow freely
between two upper ports. Without battery voltage applied, air should flow freely between center
and lower ports.
Page 4745
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
When replacing evaporator, add 2.7 oz. of new refrigerant oil on 300ZX or 2.4 oz. on all other
models.
Fig. 15 Instrument panel attachment plate removal.
PULSAR & SENTRA
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and discharge system refrigerant.
2. Disconnect refrigerant lines from evaporator, plugging all openings, then remove piping grommet
and cover.
3. Remove passenger side instrument lower cover and glove compartment.
4. Remove attachment plate from instrument panel, Fig. 15.
Fig. 16 Instrument panel cut lines.
Fig. 17 Instrument panel cut lines.
5. Using hacksaw blade, cut instrument panel on cut lines, Figs. 16 and 17. Cover blower motor
vent holes with tape before cutting and brush shavings away from area around blower motor and
remove tape after cutting.
6. Remove blower motor unit.
7. Remove cooling unit.
8. Separate cooling unit case halves and remove evaporator.
9. Disconnect and remove expansion valve.
10. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure that expansion valve is properly positioned.
Page 3002
Page 5269
You can contact the paint refinish company's technical assistance number listed. Akzo/Sikkens
Procedure ICI AUTOCOLOR Procedure DuPont Procedure Glasurit Procedure Martin Senour
(NAPA) Procedure PPG Procedure R-M Procedure Sherwin Williams Procedure Spies Hecker
Procedure Herberts Standox Procedure
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2994
Idle Speed: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Specifications
Fig. 2 Compression Pressure Specifications
Page 1323
Page 4348
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Manual Rack & Pinion
Removal and Installation
1. Raise and support front of vehicle and remove wheels.
2. Disconnect tie rod from steering knuckle.
3. Loosen steering gear attaching bolts, then remove bolt securing lower joint to steering gear
pinion and remove lower joint from pinion.
4. Remove steering gear housing-to-body attaching bolts, then the steering gear and linkage
assembly from vehicle.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY
Fig. 3 Rack & pinion manual steering gear. 1987-88 Sentra
When disassembling power steering gear, refer to Fig. 3
ASSEMBLY
Page 2546
Check the wire in the illustration. If an ohmmeter is used to measure resistance, the single strand
of wire still making contact would give an ohmmeter reading of 0 ohms. This would indicate a good
circuit. When the circuit operates, this single strand of wire is not able to carry the current. It will
become hot and have a high resistance to the current. This will be picked up as a voltage drop.
Unwanted resistance can be caused by many situations: -Undersized wiring (single strand)
-Corrosion on switch contacts -Loose wire connections or splices
If repairs are needed always use wire that is of the same or larger gauge (lower number).
Measuring Voltage Drop
1. Connect the voltmeter across the connector or part of the circuit you want to check. The positive
lead of the voltmeter should be closer to power and the negative lead closer to ground.
2. Operate the circuit
3. The voltmeter will indicate how many volts (voltage drop) are being used to "push" current
through that part of the circuit. Note in the illustration that there is an excessive 4.1 volt drop
between the battery and the bulb, or a 4.0 v. drop between the switch and the bulb.
Relationship between Open/Short circuit and the ECU pin control
Page 4101
Quick Battery Charge
Page 2344
Vehicle Speed Sensor The vehicle speed sensor produces an alternating voltage signal. This
alternating signal (analog) is converted to a digital signal for processing.
The control unit can only process digital signals. Analog signals must be converted to a digital form
before the information can be used by the control unit.
Control Unit Logic
The control unit processes digital signals in two forms. To the control unit the signal is either ON or
OFF. In computer logic an ON or high voltage signal is a "1" and an OFF or low voltage signal is a
"O". The control unit uses combinations of these signals to control its outputs. The controller uses
inputs from many sensors to determine what outputs it will make and at what time it will make
them. These outputs control a variety of functions from automatic speed control to engine
driveability.
Outputs
An output is simply an action the control unit tells an electrical component to make. Based on the
calculations the control unit makes of the inputs, it will signal an action. The output can tell a
component to perform a function for a period of time.
Power and Ground Control
The ECU controls either a component's power or ground. To understand this, refer to the diagrams.
If the ECU is between the electrical component (load) and the power source, the ECU controls its
power.
^ If the component is between the power source and the ECU, the ECU controls the component
ground.
VOLTAGE DROP TEST
Service and Diagnosis Precautions
Before diagnosing any electronic controlled circuits the following cautions should be followed:
1. Make sure the following parts and systems are in good condition and are operating properly. ^
Battery output
^ Battery terminals
^ Grounds
^ System connectors are properly positioned and connected
2. Never use a test lamp to check an electronically controlled circuit.
3. Do not drop, jar or shake electronic components.
Follow the trouble diagnosis charts in the appropriate section of the Service Manual to isolate
which component may be the incident part.
Voltage Drop Tests
Voltage Drop Tests are often used to find components or circuits which have excessive resistance.
A voltage drop in a circuit is caused by a resistance when the circuit is in operation. Part of the
available voltage is used by the resistance. When there is excessive resistance, less voltage is
available for other loads (lights, motors, etc.) in the circuit. Since each resistance in a circuit uses
voltage, a voltmeter can be used to isolate the cause of the problem.
A voltage drop across closed contacts can indicate excessive resistance. This can cause the circuit
to operate incorrectly. Remember, a switch is not a load. During diagnosis, use a voltmeter to
measure the voltage drop across each switch contact while the circuit is in operation.
Page 4988
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Page 109
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Page 5353
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 582
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 3051
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4270
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Specifications
Fig. 7 Fuel System Pressure Specifications
Page 5325
14. Reinstall quarter glass. (2 dr.)
15. Reinstall front shoulder anchor bolt and finisher cap.
16. Remove lap belts (female buckle side) and install female buckle lap belts from retro-fit kit.
17. Remove the retractor side of the original lap belts.
18. The retracting side of the retro-fit lap belt is installed as follows:
a. Install retractor unit end of the shoulder harness. (See illustration.)
b. Feed the belt through the access hole in the inner panel at the base of quarter pillar, then bolt
the shoulder anchor into the rear pillar where the 1" hole was drilled.
NOTE: Mounting/anchor bolt torque is 26-32 ft.lbs. (3.65-4.65 kg/m).
19. Bolt in floor anchor at original retractor location.
20. Secure top half of quarter panel finisher that was pulled back.
21. Reinstall rear parcel shelf.
22. Check retro-fit belts for smooth operation.
23. Reinstall high mount stop light and speakers, if equipped.
24. Reinstall rear seat back and retaining screws.
25. Reinstall lower seat cushion.
Sentra Wagon
Page 963
Power Steering Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Recommended Fluid DEXRON ATF
Page 2119
Component Locations
License Plate Bulb: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Locations
Control Module: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
Under Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3660
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 5263
following:
1. Water spots on light colored vehicles and some vehicles which have had minimal exposure to
the elements can be repaired by buffing. First, apply a fine cutting compound using an orbital buffer
to remove a thin layer of the top coat or clear coat. After removal of the spots, buff with glazing
compound to remove the fine scratches.
2. More severe spotting can be removed with a coarser cutting compound followed by finer
compound and glazing compound to remove the scratches.
3. The most severe water spots on clear coated, dark vehicles can be repaired by wet sanding the
affected areas with 1200 grit sandpaper to prepare the surface then spraying a fresh clear coat on
those areas. Non-clear coated vehicles should be repairable with either step 1 or 2.
* Available through Dyment Distribution Services.
Page 5027
3. Insert the replacement antenna rod with the radio in the "ON" position. Insert antenna rope with
gear section facing the motor assembly [Figure 2].
4. Turn the radio "OFF" to retract the antenna rod. If the antenna motor stops before the antenna
has fully retracted, turn the radio switch "ON" and immediately turn it "OFF" again. Guide the
antenna rope and rod into the antenna assembly.
5. Reinstall the antenna nut and base. Check antenna operation by cycling the radio "ON" and
"OFF".
Power Antenna Maintenance
Clean power antenna rods at every service opportunity by wiping with a damp cloth.
PRECAUTIONS
Please remind the customer to:
1. Always turn the radio "OFF" to prevent bending the antenna rod, whenever going through car
washes or entering parking garages with low ceilings or low hanging garage doors.
2. The antenna rod should be cleaned regularly by wiping off any dirt build up which may cause the
antenna to bind. Customers should verify that their car wash attendants do this regularly.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
NOTE:
The following Claims Information applies to antenna rod replacement for defects in materials and
workmanship. Damaged (bent) rods are not included.
Claim Information
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 2992
Page 4800
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Availability/Recommendation
Models: All Models
Section: Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification: HA91-010
Bulletin No.: NTB91-052
Date: May 23, 1991
A/C COMPRESSOR OIL - NISSAN
APPLIED MODELS: ALL MODELS
SERVICE INFORMATION:
The recommended refrigerant oil for all Nissan A/C systems is SUNISO 5GS. SUNISO 5GS is now
available from SUNISO distributors in one quart containers. When ordering the oil, specify part
number L315, which is the number for a single, one quart container.
Dealers are encouraged to use one quart containers to prevent oil contamination. When left open
to the atmosphere, compressor oil will absorb moisture that renders it unfit for use. To avoid this,
order one quart containers, open only one at a time, and keep them tightly sealed when not in use.
Due to the higher operating temperatures of our latest generation of A/C compressors, a 5GS oil is
required to ensure optimum compressor performance. The use of lighter viscosity oil commonly
found at auto parts supply stores can cause premature compressor failure.
Locations
Fig. 1 Timing Mark
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 2067
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 718
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4266
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 2463
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 2662
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2535
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 1766
This chart indicates appropriate pin voltages for the ASCD system:
Accessory Relay
Ignition Relay: Locations Accessory Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 779
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Specifications
Fig. 7 Fuel System Pressure Specifications
Page 4228
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 2064
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1767
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 1166
Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
With Heater Automatic Transmission 5.6 qt (US)
Manual Transmission 5.0 qt (US)
Without Heater Automatic Transmission 5.0 qt (US)
Manual Transmission 4.4 qt (US)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 4972
function properly or the webbing is damaged as described above, the entire retractor and webbing
assembly should be replaced under the lifetime limited seat belt warranty. The passive belt on 2
point passive models should also be inspected.
Button Replacement Procedure
BUTTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the operation of the seat belt warning lamp on the dash and the warning buzzer. Repair
as necessary.
2. Insert the seat belt "tongue" into the buckle and check to see that it latches properly by tugging
on the seat belt tongue while firmly holding the buckle (this step applies to both front seat buckles).
Repeat this step three (3) times. If either buckle does not latch or unlatch, replace both front buckle
assemblies. If the buckle latches and unlatches properly in both front seats, proceed to step 3.
3. Prepare the vehicle for button replacement by placing a clean shop cloth on the seat and center
console. Position the seat as necessary to easily work on the buckle.
Note
The 1991 Sentra requires seat removal for button replacement. Please see the Vehicle Specific
Information section in this bulletin for details regarding buckle removal and proper reinstallation.
The button replacement procedure is the same for all vehicles except as noted. Please review the
vehicle-specific information that contains torque specifications and other important notes on buckle
replacement.
Note
Some 1986.5 and 1987 vehicles have a white plastic ejector buckle and have a slightly different
procedure - see steps 9a and 14a.
4. Using a small pair of wire cutters (such as Snap-On E710SCG), carefully cut the plastic outer
cover along the separation line between the two covers as shown in the photograph.
5. Using a medium sized, flat blade screwdriver, carefully separate the two halves of the outer
cover by placing the screwdriver into the slot between the edges of the two covers. Do not pry in
the middle of the buckle, as this may damage the switch (if so equipped).
6. Using the wire cutters, cut the three plastic pins retaining the switch to the cover. Cut the bottom
pin first, slide the switch down, then cut the top two retaining pins.
Note
Some buckles are not equipped with switches (e.g. passenger side).
7. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to separate the switch from the cover. Carefully place the
screwdriver between the switch plate and buckle cover at the closest points to the three retaining
pins beginning with the bottom pin, then the two top pins. This will prevent damage to the switch.
8. Remove the cover halves.
Note
Steps 9a and 14a should be utilized on buckles with white ejector plates.
Page 5239
Application of 2-coat pearl and 2-coat pearl metallic is similar to that of other 2-coat metallic paints.
However, repairs on 3-coat pearl require special technique and experience since color matching is
much more critical. Also, when spot or partial repairing is required, the full panel or "Zone" must be
repainted (see drawing).
If a Dealer requires assistance in 3-coat pearl paint procedure, the following paint manufacturers
are willing to provide it.
^ Basf/Inmont/Glasurit
^ Dupont
^ P.P.G./Ditzler
^ Sherwin Williams
^ Sikkens
Or contact your local paint jobber.
^ Two types of mica are available, white and colored. They should be used properly to fit the base
color.
^ Pearl mica has complex reflection characteristics without hiding power. This produces minute
changes in color tone and luster as the painted surface is viewed at different angles or under
different lighting conditions. When matching color during repair, you should carefully observe the
paint color under direct sunlight (at a distance of 3 to 7 feet), from every direction.
Page 4577
Disclaimer
Page 417
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 5062
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 4498
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 1533
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5134
PARTS INFORMATION
The following 3M products (or their equivalent) should be obtained from your local body shop
supply.
3M PART
PART DESCRIPTION NUMBER APPLICATION
Flexible Parts Repair Manual 05900 Both types
Flexible Parts Putty 05903 Polyurethane bumpers
Flexible Parts Coating 05905 Both types
Polyolefin Adhesion Promoter 05907 Polypropylene bumpers
solvent (general purpose) -- To remove silicones, tar or grease.
Fiberglass cloth -- To repair holes up to 3" in diameter.
Sanding discs for rotary -- 36 grit
sander 180 grit 240 grit 320 grit
Polyurethane Bumper Fascia Repair
If extensive reinforcing or patching from the back is required use the following procedure.
1. Scuff the backside with grade 180 abrasives.
2. Cut a glass cloth patch to cover repair area.
3. Mix a quantity of Flexible Parts Repair Material. Lay glass cloth on a clean surface. Use a
squeegee to force the Flexible Parts Repair Material into the glass cloth.
4. Apply glass cloth patch to backside of repair area.
5. Apply additional Flexible Parts Repair Material over surface of glass cloth patch.
FASCIA REPAIR
1. Clean the repair area with soap and water. Remove grease and tar with solvent. Avoid solvent
contact with plastic base material - temporary swelling can occur.
Page 4587
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing
Fig. 5 Exploded view of wheel hub & steering knuckle assembly. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
Removal
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove wheel bearing locknut while depressing brake pedal, Fig. 5.
4. Remove caliper.
5. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove tie rod ball joint.
6. Separate driveshaft from knuckle.
7. Support arm assembly, then remove adjusting pin bolts.
8. Using tool HT72520000 or equivalent, remove lower ball joint attaching nut.
9. Separate knuckle from lower ball joint stud, using a suitable tool.
10. Remove steering knuckle.
Disassembly
1. Remove outer hub inner race from knuckle.
2. Remove outside inner race from wheel hub.
3. Remove inner race from wheel bearing.
4. Remove snap ring.
5. Install inner race (inside) of removed wheel bearing, then remove wheel bearing assembly from
knuckle.
Inspection
Inspect removed components for excessive wear and/or damage. Replace worn or damaged
components as required.
Assembly
1. Press new wheel bearing assembly into knuckle working from outside of knuckle.
2. Install snap ring.
3. Coat seal lip with suitable grease.
4. Press hub into knuckle. Do not exceed 3.3 tons.
Page 1886
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2308
240SX (S14) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 665
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
a. Tighten the clamp so its end is 3 mm (0.12 in) from the hose end. b. Make sure that the screw of
the clamp does not contact with any adjacent parts. c. Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
: Fuel hose clamps
1.0 - 1.5 N.m (0.10 - 0.15 kg-m, 0.7 - 1.1 ft-lb)
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose at the electro injection unit.
3. Install a pressure gauge. 4. Start the engine and check the fuel line for fuel leakage. 5. Read fuel
pressure gauge.
At idling speed:
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2, 36.3 psi)
6. Release fuel pressure again. 7. Remove the pressure gauge from the fuel line. 8. Reconnect the
fuel inlet hose.
Page 697
Page 4522
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 1753
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Page 581
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Page 1931
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 4897
Sentra 764000
1987-1989 Vehicle Torque Specifications
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Sentra (1987-89, except 1989 Coupe)
Seat belt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
PARTS INFORMATION Color Mix by Model
The chart indicates the mix of interior colors by year/model for the vehicles in this campaign. This is
provided to assist dealers in ordering button kits for this campaign. Please note that for most
models there is a dominant color code, with the other colors in smaller quantities to as little as 1%.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Customer Assistance/Dealer Hotline Revision
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN
WB/88-007
Date: April 18, 1988 TO:
ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: TIRE ASSISTANCE CUSTOMER/DEALER HOTLINE
This is a revised list of the Tire Assistance Customer/Dealer Hotline telephone numbers. Please
discard warranty bulletin (WB/88-004) issued on February 3, 1988.
The following general information toll-free telephone numbers may be used to assist you with your
tire replacement needs:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-423-4544 (Except California) 1-800-221-8744 (Inside California)
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-800-662-0200 (Except New York) 1-800-334-4646 (Inside New York)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
For customer assistance or emergency tire orders, please use the telephone numbers listed below:
Bridgestone 1-800-TIRE-BSA
Yokohama 1-800-722-9888
Toyo 1-800-442-TOYO (Except California) 1-800-238-TOYO (Inside California)
Dunlop 1-716-879-8494 (Mr. Wagner 8:30am-5:00pm EST) 1-213-781-2001 (Mr. Yanacek
2:00pm-5:00pm PST)
General 1-800-847-3349 (Except Ohio) 1-800-426-4889 (Inside Ohio)
If you have further questions pertaining to tires, please contact your District Service Manager or
Regional Service Department.
Page 1514
Page 1161
Disclaimer
Page 465
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Page 3226
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): Adjustments
1. Start and operate engine until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. With A/C system OFF, ensure engine idle speed is correct.
3. With A/C system ON and fan control lever set at 4, ensure compressor, F.I.C.D. actuator and
solenoid valve are operating properly.
4. On all models except Federal with gasoline engine, set idle speed at the specified values:
a. On gasoline engine with manual transmission, idle speed should be 750-850 RPM. b. On
gasoline engine with automatic transmission, idle speed should be 580-660 RPM. c. On diesel
engine with manual transmission, idle speed should be 800-850 RPM. d. On diesel engine with
automatic transmission, idle speed should be 900-950 RPM.
Page 3017
Page 4648
Blower Motor: Service and Repair
Fig. 12 Exploded view of instrument panel. 1987-88 Sentra
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect heater hose at firewall connections of heater core.
3. Remove instrument panel, Fig. 12.
ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 763
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Page 4755
Fig. 26 Exploded view of heater system. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
4. Refer to Fig. 26 to complete removal of heater core.
Fig. 22 Exploded view of heater case.
5. Separate heater case, Fig. 22, and remove core.
6. Reverse procedure to install.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2824
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 3860
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair
Fig. 4 CL18B type front disc brake disassembled
A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Case: Customer Interest A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Classification: Section:
AT90-002 Automatic Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-010
Models: 1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: February 8, 1990 F01A AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra XE 1987-1990 Pulsar NX XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some of the Applied Models equipped with the F01A Automatic Transaxles may exhibit
transmission fluid leakage from the converter housing and/or the front cover gasket area(s). To
improve the sealing performance at these locations, new bolts for the torque converter housing and
the front cover are now used in production, and the tightening torque for these bolts has been
changed to eliminate this condition. In addition, a new torque converter housing gasket is available
as a service replacement part for these vehicles.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated areas, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the front cover and/or torque converter housing, thoroughly clean and inspect
(for porosities, surface damage, etc.) all mating surfaces. Install a new converter housing gasket
and new bolts, being certain to apply sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque
as indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
incident area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Testing and Inspection
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Air density becomes thinner at higher altitudes. Therefore, the carburetor produces too rich an
air/fuel mixture at higher altitudes. The altitude compensator automatically corrects air/fuel ratio to
an optimum mixture. When vehicle is operated in a high altitude environment, the bellows in the
compensator extends, causing the lever attached to the bellows to push up the needle. When the
needle is pushed up the air passage becomes wider, allowing larger amounts of air to flow from the
altitude compensator to the carburetor, thereby thinning the air/fuel mixture. Electronic Controlled
Carburetor (ECC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Page 2645
Page 2400
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
A/C - New Connections & O-Rings
A/C Coupler O-ring: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New Connections & O-Rings
Classification: HA97-O12
Reference: NTB98-005
Date: February 1, 1998
NEW A/C CONNECTION 0-RINGS
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan (except Quest)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This service bulletin identifies differences in A/C 0-rings as they apply to the NEW and FORMER
type A/C connections.
The NEW type connection has a groove in the tube end in which the 0-ring is seated. The
FORMER type connection does not have a groove but instead has an inflated portion on the tube
end to support the 0-ring. Refer to Figure 1 for illustrations identifying each connection type.
A/T - Fluid Application
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Application
Classification: AT96-001
Reference: NTB98-042
Date: May 15, 1998
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
This amended version of NTB95-055 updates information regarding the Recommendation ATF
usage.
Please disregard previous NTB95-055 and NTB93-065.
SERVICE INFORMATION
IMPORTANT NOTE:
Nissan Matic "D" ATF must be used in performing repairs paid by Nissan, such as warranty,
service contract, or goodwill repairs. Nissan will not reimburse dealers for repairs when
non-genuine Nissan Matic "D" is used.
For current and prior production Nissan vehicles, front wheel and/or rear wheel drive, only Nissan
Matic "D", or other ashless petroleum based ATF, is formulated to meet the requirements of Nissan
automatic transmissions and automatic transaxles. Nissan Matic "D", or other ashless petroleum
based ATF, assists in ensuring transmission durability, smooth driveability, low exhaust emissions
and customer satisfaction.
Only an ashless type petroleum based ATF should be used to repair Nissan vehicles because
other types of ATF may contain compounds which adversely affect transmission performance.
Specifically, ash will impact friction response. In addition, ATF with ash is likely to have a higher
Zinc (Zn) content. Zinc will adhere to clutch linings and cause slippage, resulting in transmission
damage.
For ordering procedures, please refer to the "Dealer Confidential Parts Price List".
Service Precautions
Timing Belt: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will hit
piston heads and damage to the valves may occur.
Page 4269
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 2520
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
Page 4300
> Engine coolant and lubricating oils at specified levels
> Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and floor mats in designated positions
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information about any of the above checks and
inspections.
4. Check the target mounts.
^ If there is any visual damage (bent, worn, cracked, etc), have the equipment repaired before
performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the target mounts are properly adjusted and configured (see Figure 11).
NOTE:
The target mount example shown in Figure 11 is for Hunter "camera type" alignment machines.
Follow the operation manual for your specific equipment.
Page 1435
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 271
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 5288
9. Give the vehicle a final inspection.
Page 790
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE:
Page 2508
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Paint: Customer Interest Paint - Spotting Prevention & Repair
Classification: BF87-030
Reference: TS87-145
Date: September 28, 1987
PAINT SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Paint spotting incidents occurring in the U.S. market are not unique to Nissan, but are being
experienced by all manufacturers. To date, two separate types of paint spotting incidents have
been identified as follows:
1. Particulate Fallout - Tiny solid particles which collect on horizontal panels, causing a dark stain
which will penetrate into the paint if not cleaned.
2. Water Spotting - A ringlet or multiple water-drop-shaped light discoloration on dark painted
horizontal panels.
THESE TYPES OF SPOTTING ARE NOT DUE TO PAINT DEFICIENCY, AND CAN BE
PREVENTED THROUGH PROPER CARE.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Particulate Fallout
Ash, dust, soot and other tiny solid particulate matter from industrial and other sources can be
carried many miles. Particulate fallout is most noticeable on the horizontal surfaces (hood, luggage
compartment lid, and roof) of the vehicle.
If left on a moist, painted surface, the particles will slowly dissolve and bond to the paint, frequently
leaving a red stain. This stain can be present even on plastic surfaces such as bumpers if the
fallout has an iron content. These spots may be visible on both solid and metallic paints (especially
light colors). The particulate can be felt as a sharp point on the paint surface. When viewed through
a magnifying lens, the staining may be evident.
VEHICLE CARE
Every 10 days, or more frequently depending upon local conditions, particulate fallout must be
washed off with mild detergent and water to prevent its bonding and staining action. A good
carnuba wax coating can help protect against damage from particulate fallout.
PARTICULATE FALLOUT REPAIR PROCEDURE
In most cases, thoroughly washing the affected area with a water and mild detergent solution (to
avoid scratching the finish with dislodged particles) will remove the particulates.
After washing the vehicle, a stain, generally orange or red, may still be visible on white or other
light colored vehicles. This stain can be removed with a fine compound material. DO NOT APPLY
THE COMPOUNDING MATERIAL BEFORE ALL PARTICLES IN THE AFFECTED AREA ARE
REMOVED BY THOROUGH WASHING.
Water Spotting
A photograph of typical water spotting is shown on page 26 of the Nissan Paint Refinishing Guide*
(PIN 5REFGD). The spots are most visible when viewed at an angle, usually under fluorescent
light. The paint surface is usually smooth to the touch because the spotting is a change in the top
surface itself. This is not hard-water residue which will wash off with soap and water. These spots
are visible on both solid and metallic paints with dark colors.
VEHICLE CARE
When a vehicle is stored outside and unprotected, dust patterns develop on the painted surfaces.
These patterns guide moisture droplets from a light rain or morning dew to the same location each
time. The strong sunlight, repeatedly concentrated on these water droplets, greatly contributes to
the spotting. When storing a vehicle unprotected, where the painted surface is repeatedly exposed
to a combination of sunlight and light rain (or morning dew), the vehicle MUST be washed AND
thoroughly dried at least every two weeks, or more frequently if there is light rain or dew followed
by strong sunlight.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1845
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 59
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 1017
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Refrigerant Oil Type SUNISO 5GS
On-Vehicle Service
Differential: Service and Repair On-Vehicle Service
Differential Side Oil Seal Replacement
1. Remove drive shaft assembly. 2. Remove oil seal.
3. Apply coat of A.T.F. to oil seal surface, then drive new oil seal into place. 4. Install drive shaft
assembly.
Be extremely careful not to scratch oil seal when inserting drive shaft.
Page 4460
7. After the tire/wheel is balanced, apply an index mark to the tire at the location of the valve stem
(see Figure 6).
^ This index mark will allow you to tell if the tire has slipped on the rim (see Figure 7).
Tire to Rim Slippage:
^ Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs, the tire
may become un-balanced.
^ Overtime the tire lubricate will dry, eliminating the lubricant as a cause of tire slippage.
^ Some tire lubricants may require up to 24 hours to completely dry.
^ If slippage occurs, the tire/wheel will need to be re-balanced.
WORK - AID AVOID CUSTOMER RETURNS FOR VIBRATION
Page 749
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3012
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Locations
Wiper Motor: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Of Cowl
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 1594
Spark Plug: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 4004
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair
Fig. 4 CL18B type front disc brake disassembled
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Plug Type Plug Air Gap Plug Torque
Standard Type BPR5ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Hot Type BPR4ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Cold Type BPR6ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Page 1367
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
API Classification API SF Grade
Energy Conserving Oils.
Oil Viscosity Temperatures Below 32 deg F 5w-30
Temperatures Above 0 deg F 10w-30 or 10w-40
Page 2165
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Idle Speed Control Valve: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 1738
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Page 5294
REFINISHING GUIDE
CAUTION: Air line respirator with full hood or half mask, or vapor/particulate type respirator that is
recommended as effective for isocyanate vapor and mist, must be worn during the entire painting
process.
CAUTION: When painting with pearlescent paint, be sure to keep the panel surface clean and free
from dirt and dust as it will be very conspicuous and difficult to remove.
2-Coat Pearlescent Paint 1.
In general, use the same painting method which is used for metallic painting.
2. Use the same mica base which was originally used on the vehicle, and match the color by
referring to the data and instructions given by the paint manufacturer.
3. Apply paints to the vehicle body under the same conditions and using the same painting
methods as those used to make the color comparison board.
3-Coat Pearlescent Paint
Page 3843
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Start at one end of the circuit and work your way to the other end. (At the fuse block in this
example)
3. Connect 1 probe of the DMM to the fuse block terminal on the load side.
4. Connect the other probe to the fuse block (power) side of swl. Little or no resistance will indicate
that portion of the circuit has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would
indicate an over limit or infinite resistance condition. (point A)
5. Connect the probes between swl and the relay. Little or no resistance will indicate that portion of
the circuit has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would indicate an over
limit or infinite resistance condition. (point B)
6. Connect the probes between the relay and the sensor. Little or no resistance will indicate that
portion of the circuit has good continuity. If there were an open in the circuit, the DMM would
indicate an over limit or infinite resistance condition. (point C)
Any circuit can be diagnosed using the approach in the above example.
Voltage Check Method
To help in understanding the diagnosis of open circuits please refer to the previous diagram. In any
powered circuit, an open can be found by methodically checking the system for the presence of
voltage. This is done by switching the DMM to the voltage function. 1.
Connect one probe of the DMM to a known good ground.
2. Begin probing at one end of the circuit and work your way to the other end.
3. With swl open, probe at swl to check for voltage. voltage; open is further down the circuit than
sw1. no voltage; open is between fuse block and swl (point A).
4. Close sw1 and probe at relay. voltage; open is further down the circuit than the relay. no voltage;
open is between sw1 and relay (point B).
5. Close the relay and probe at the sensor. voltage; open is further down the circuit than the
sensor. no voltage; open is between relay and sensor (point C).
Any powered circuit can be diagnosed using the approach in the above example.
TESTING FOR SHORTS IN THE CIRCUIT
To simplify the discussion of shorts in the system please refer to the schematic.
Resistance Check method
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable and remove the blown fuse.
2. Disconnect all loads (sw1 open, relay disconnected and sensor disconnected) powered through
the fuse.
3. Connect one probe of the ohmmeter to the load side of the fuse terminal and the other probe to
a known good ground.
4. With sw1 open, check for continuity. continuity; short is between fuse terminal and sw1 (point A).
no continuity; short is further down the circuit than sw1.
5. With swl closed, relay disconnected and probes at the load side of fuse terminal and ground
check for continuity. continuity; short is between sw1 and the relay (point B).
Locations
Fig. 1 Timing Mark
Page 3315
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 4278
Page 82
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The Fuse Panel Is Located Under LH Side Of Instrument Panel
Page 2613
Inspection Procedure
Page 1026
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 5092
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 2149
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1913
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3043
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Page 849
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
Removing Spark Plug Boot
REMOVAL 1.
Remove the ignition wire from the spark plug with a twisting and pulling motion. CAUTION: Pull on
the boot only. Do not pull on the wire.
2. Using compressed air, blow out the area at the base of the spark plug to remove any debris USE
SAFETY GLASSES.
3. Using a 5/8" (16mm) flex socket and extension, remove the spark plugs (counterclockwise
rotation).
INSTALLATION 1.
Using a suitable tool, check and adjust the spark plug gap. ELECTRODE GAP
0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
2. Using a suitable rubber hose or designated tool, start the spark plugs by hand (clockwise
rotation).
3. Tighten and torque the spark plugs. SPARK PLUG TORQUE
14 - 22 ft. lbs. (20 - 29 N-m / 2.0 - 3.0 kg-m)
4. Apply a small amount of di-electric compound to the inside of the spark plug boots.
5. Reinstall the spark plug boots.
Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The vehicle speed sensor provides a vehicle speed signal to the E.C.U. for fuel cut, recovery and
idle speed control.
- Needle type speedometer models The speed sensor consists of a reed switch, which is installed
in the speed meter unit and transforms vehicle speed into a pulse signal.
Page 4290
SPECIAL TOOLS
Page 741
Page 5305
Sunroof / Moonroof: Connector Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 4211
> Engine coolant and lubricating oils at specified levels
> Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and floor mats in designated positions
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information about any of the above checks and
inspections.
4. Check the target mounts.
^ If there is any visual damage (bent, worn, cracked, etc), have the equipment repaired before
performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the target mounts are properly adjusted and configured (see Figure 11).
NOTE:
The target mount example shown in Figure 11 is for Hunter "camera type" alignment machines.
Follow the operation manual for your specific equipment.
Page 3059
Idle Speed: Description and Operation
Idle Speed Control
The idle speed is controlled by the E.C.C.S. control unit, corresponding to the engine operating
conditions. The E.C.C.S. control unit senses the engine condition and determines the best idle
speed at each water temperature and gear position. The control unit then sends an electronic
signal corresponding to the difference between the best idle speed and the actual idle speed to the
A.A.C. valve.
INPUT SIGNAL AND AIR FLOW
The opening of the I.S.C. valve is controlled by an ON-duty signal fed to the opening solenoid.
(When the opening solenoid is "ON", the closing solenoid is "OFF", and vice versa.)
The longer the ON-duty signal on the opening solenoid, the greater the I.S.C. valve opening and
the greater the amount of airflow.
Page 2102
Page 721
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5254
When storing a vehicle unprotected, where the painted surface is repeatedly exposed to a
combination of sunlight and light rain (or morning dew), the vehicle MUST be washed AND
thoroughly dried at least every two weeks, or more frequently if there is light rain or dew followed
by strong sunlight.
When washing any vehicle, it must be out of direct sunlight and the painted surfaces should be cool
to the touch.
WATER SPOTTING REPAIR PROCEDURE
The method of repairing a water spotted finish varies with the severity (depth of spot in finish) of the
spotting. After a thorough washing, perform the following:
1. Water spots on light colored vehicles and some vehicles which have had minimal exposure to
the elements can be repaired by buffing. First, apply a fine cutting compound using an orbital buffer
to remove a thin layer of the top coat or clear coat. After removal of the spots, buff with glazing
compound to remove the fine scratches.
2. More severe spotting can be removed with a coarser cutting compound followed by finer
compound and glazing compound to remove the scratches.
3. The most severe water spots on clear coated, dark vehicles can be repaired by wet sanding the
affected areas with 1200 grit sandpaper to prepare the surface then spraying a fresh clear coat on
those areas. Non-clear coated vehicles should be repairable with either step 1 or 2.
* Available through Dyment Distribution Services.
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-015 Date: 940208
Paint - Contamination Identification and Repair
Classification: BF94-003
Reference: NTB94-O15
Date: February 8, 1994
PAINT CONTAMINATION IDENTIFICATION AND REPAIR
This bulletin supersedes NTB93-058 / BF93-014 & NTB91-090 / BF91-023
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
SERVICE INFORMATION
The following procedures and materials have been found effective in removing iron particles, water
or chemical spots, scratches and/or swirl marks which have not penetrated the clear coat/color coat
of painted vehicle surfaces.
NOTE:
The updated repair procedures discussed in this Service Bulletin can be applied to all types of
Nissan clear coat materials, including the new Cross Link clear coat (NCLC)/hard clear coat.
*NOTE:
Measure the paint thickness before and after abrasive cleaning. If abrasive repair is not successful
on the first panel tested, it must be tried on each affected panel (hood, roof, trunk etc.,) to
determine which panel(s) must be re-clear coated or re-color/clear coated and which may be
repaired by abrasive means.
Finish Kare Product Distributors:
1726 Floradale Ave., El Monte, CA 91733 (213) 686-0462
Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid 1.0 - 1.1 qt (US)
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Sensors and Switches - Engine.
Page 4969
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 2178
Bumper - Repair Polyurethane & Polypropylene Fascia
Technical Service Bulletin # BF91011 Date: 910411
Bumper - Repair Polyurethane & Polypropylene Fascia
Classification: BF91-011
Section: Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB91-037
Models: All Models
Date: April 11, 1991
POLYURETHANE & POLYPROPYLENE BUMPER FASCIA REPAIR
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-90 Pulsar XE (KN13) 1990-91 30OZX (Z32)
1988-89 Pulsar SE (KN13) 1989-91 240SX (S13)
1988-90 Sentra Sdn. (B12) 1990 Axxess (M11)
1988-90 Sentra Cpe (B12) 1988-89 Stanza (T12)
1991 Sentra Sdn (B13) 1990-91 Stanza (U12)
1991 Sentra NX (KB13) 1988-90 Van (C22)
1989-91 Maxima (J30)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides detailed instructions to repair polyurethane and polypropylene bumper
fascias. A polyurethane bumper can be distinguished from a polypropylene bumper by using the
following test:
cut a small piece of material from the end of the bumper fascia and hold it over the flame of a
match or lighter until it ignites.
Polyurethane will burn with black smoke and have an odor.
Polypropylene will burn with little smoke and will not have an odor.
Alternate Test:
Sand an area near the damage with a 36 grit disc.
If the material sands cleanly, the bumper is polyurethane.
If the material melts or smears when sanded, it is polypropylene.
BUMPER MATERIAL INFORMATION
MODEL FRONT BUMPER REAR BUMPER
1988-90 Pulsar XE Polypropylene Polypropylene
1988-89 Pulsar SE Polyurethane Polypropylene
1988-90 Sentra Sdn. Polypropylene Polypropylene
1988-90 Sentra Cpe. Polyurethane Polypropylene
1988-91 Stanza Polypropylene Polypropylene
1989-91 240SX Polyurethane Polyurethane
1990-91 300ZX Polyurethane Polyurethane
1988-91 Maxima Polyurethane Polyurethane
1990 Axxess Polyurethane Polyurethane
1988-91 Van Polyurethane Polyurethane
NOTE: OEM replacement bumpers are the same material as original.
Page 1110
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 2472
13. Use compressed air to remove any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
14. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
15. Tilt the manifold/catalyst/front tube so that the metal debris falls out of the part.
16. Apply compressed air through the boss to blow out any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
17. Install the new sensor as described in the applicable Electronic Service Manual (ESM).
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 3442
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 4265
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Page 353
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 2558
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Page 756
Page 3253
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 3013
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4458
3. Apply an approved tire lubricant to the tire and wheel in the areas shown in Figures 1 and 2.
^ Tire lubricant is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process
Tire:
^ Apply lube to the inner bead only of both beads
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area (outer bead area)
NOTE:
Too much tire lubricant may allow the tire to slip on the rim while driving. If this occurs the tire may
become un-balanced.
Wheel:
^ Apply lube to the Safety Humps and Bead Seating area.
^ Do not apply lube to the flange area
4. Before inflating the tire:
^ If there are "match-mount" marks on the tire and rim, align the marks.
Page 1478
Page 5260
3M materials:
Meguiar's materials:
Misc:
8" buffer (1500-1750 RPM) Dual action sander, variable speed Terry cloth towels (100% cloth)
NOTE:
Always use separate pads for each liquid (mark the backside of each pad with the type of liquid
used) and clean the pads frequently. Use of a wool pad on clear coat is limited to the polishing type
of pad and is always followed by a foam Dad on a dual action sander to remove swirl marks.
Measuring Paint Film Thickness
Before any abrasive removal, measure the initial film thickness at several places to establish an
average figure. After each abrasive step measure several places again to determine how much
paint film was removed. Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of the mil gauge you
are using for measurement and calibration. If you do not have a thickness gauge use the following
rule of thumb during abrasive removal; When the "orange peel" surface is removed, 0.5 mil has
been removed.
Polishing
Polishing is done in two steps: The first step is with an 8" buffer and the second step with a dual
action sander to remove buffing and swirl marks. Low speed (1500-1750 RPM) is necessary to
prevent overheating the surface.
CAUTION:
Do not polish or buff a surface dry. More than the usual quantity of liquid must be used to keep the
paint surface cool. Wipe the excess material off with a clean soft towel after each operation
1. Clean the surface of all residue before polishing.
2. Use an 8" buffer (at 1500 - 1750 RPM) with either a 3M wool polishing pad or a Meguiar's foam
pad, apply polishing compound over the work
Specifications
Fig. 2 Compression Pressure Specifications
Locations
Power Transistor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Specifications
Valve: Specifications
Valve Stem Clearance Intake .0008-.0020 in
Exhaust .0018-.0030 in
Valve Stem Diameter Intake .2744-.2750 in
Exhaust .2734-.2740 in
Valve Face Angle 45.5 deg
Page 1779
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Classification: EL93-028
Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-161
Models: All Models
Date: November 5, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS
Electronic control units (ECU's) control the operation of numerous electrical systems and
components on Nissan vehicles. The ECU's do this by either controlling the supply voltage or
ground path of an electrical component. The following is an explanation of how these systems work
and what precautions should be taken while performing diagnostic procedures.
Systems controlled by electronic control units have three (3) basic requirements, Inputs, Controller
Logic and Outputs.
Inputs
Sensors and switches provide electrical signals to the control unit. These signals are provided to
the ECU to inform it of various vehicle operating conditions. The electrical inputs can be either
analog or digital signals. However, all of the signals are converted to digital signals before the ECU
can process the information.
Control Logic
The ECU uses the electrical input signals to determine what the system should do. This decision
may be based on a few or many inputs. After processing the information the ECU will provide a
signal (output) to various electrical components.
Outputs
The signal that the ECU puts out to an electrical component (actuator) is called the output. These
output signals are what operate and control the system.
Digital Input Signals
Page 4346
2. Check outer ball joint rotating force. Rotating force should be 1-26 inch lbs.
3. Check ball joint axial endplay. Endplay should be .051 inch or less on outer ball joint or zero for
inner ball joint.
Boot
1. If boot is excessively cracked, replace it.
Cylinder Tubes & Breather Hoses
1. Check cylinder tubes and breather hoses for scratches or other damage, replacing as
necessary.
Steering Gear Component Parts
1. Check component parts for cracking, wear or other damage, replacing steering gear assembly
as necessary.
ASSEMBLY
Refer to Fig. 28 for power steering gear assembly, noting the following:
1. Install center bushing and rack oil seal with rack assembly.
2. Tighten cylinder end cover assembly, using a suitable tool, then install cylinder end cover
assembly to gear housing by staking into position.
3. Apply suitable grease to seal lip of pinion oil seal, then install pinion oil seal into pinion housing,
using a suitable tool.
4. Install rear oil seal using a suitable tool.
5. Wrap suitable tape around pinion splines to prevent damaging oil seal, then install rear housing
cover assembly to pinion.
6. Install pinion assembly into pinion housing. Use caution not to damage pinion oil seal.
7. Install pinion assembly and snap ring using suitable tools, then tighten self locking nut.
8. Install retainer, retainer spring, gasket and retainer cover.
9. Apply suitable locking compound to threaded portion of inner socket, then install inner socket on
rack end together with new lock plate. Ensure lock plate tabs enter grooves at end portion of rack.
10. Tighten tie rod inner socket, then bend lock plate at two cutout portions of inner socket.
Remove burrs after bending lock plate to prevent damaging boot.
Fig. 7 Adjusting tie rod length. 1987-88 Maxima, Pulsar, Sentra & Stanza exc. 2WD Wagon
11. Tighten outer socket locknut so tie rod length ``L'' is 6.94 inches and screwed length ``l'' is .98
inch or more, Fig. 7.
Fig. 26 Measuring rack stroke. 1987-88 Maxima, Pulsar, Sentra & Stanza Exc. 2WD Wagon
12. Measure rack stroke, refer to Fig. 26. Note that dimension l1 is 2.24 inches on models less
CA16DE engines or 2.07 inches on models with CA16DE engines and dimension l2 is 2.76 inches
on models less CA16DE engines or 2.58 inches on models with CA16DE engines.
Page 4569
^ Make sure the tire is evenly positioned on the lower safety humps.
5. WARNING: Do not exceed the tire manufactures recommended bead seating inflation pressure.
Generally this is 40psi.
If the bead does not seat with the appropriate pressure:
a. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
b. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
c. Remount the tire.
6. After inflating the tires, inspect the bead area.
^ Make sure bead is seated uniformly (the same) around the entire circumference of the wheel.
NOTE:
Many tires have Aligning Rings that will help confirm the bead is uniformly seated.
If uniform; bead is seated correctly. If not uniform
1. Break down the tire/rim assembly.
2. Re-apply lubricant as shown in Figures 1 and 2.
3. Remount the tire.
Page 1506
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The vehicle speed sensor provides a vehicle speed signal to the E.C.U. for fuel cut, recovery and
idle speed control.
- Needle type speedometer models The speed sensor consists of a reed switch, which is installed
in the speed meter unit and transforms vehicle speed into a pulse signal.
Diagrams
Brake Band And Band Serve
Page 1004
Comments regarding condensers:
^ The parallel flow condenser can be identified by the refrigerant end tanks, and smaller, more
closely spaced center section tubes.
Page 3926
* The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
* As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
* Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
NISSAN SERVICE PROCEDURE:
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062 (BR92-004) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Page 3252
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or
Blue Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Page 1741
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
Page 398
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Brakes - On-Car Rotor Refinishing
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - On-Car Rotor Refinishing
Classification: BR04-007
Reference: NTB04-094
Date: August 20, 2004
NISSAN: ON-CAR BRAKE ROTOR RESURFACING
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
If YOU CONFIRM:
A vehicle needs to have the brake rotors resurfaced (front or rear),
ACTION:
Use the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe to perform brake rotor resurfacing and follow
the tips listed in this bulletin.
^ The ProCut(TM) PFM Series brake lathe has been chosen as the approved tool for rotor
resurfacing.
^ The ProCut(TM) PFM Series brake lathe can be ordered from TECH-MATE at 1-800-662-2001.
^ ProCut(TM) technical support or service can be obtained by calling 1-800-543-6618.
NOTE:
Brake rotors may need to be resurfaced during routine brake repair or for brake "Judder" incidents.
^ Brake judder: A brake pedal pulsation and/or steering wheel shimmy when braking that occurs
when there is too much thickness variation of the brake rotors (see NTB00-033).
TIPS FOR USING THE PROCUT(TM) PFM SERIES ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE
^ Read and follow all instructions contained in the Technical Manual provided with your ProCut(TM)
equipment.
^ The ProCut(TM) brake lathe also comes with an instructional video that can be used as a training
aid.
^ Additional training is available from your local ProCut(TM) representative by calling
1-800-543-6618.
A. Make sure the cutting tips are sharp, in good condition and installed "right-side" up.
^ Make sure to use ProCut(TM) brand tips.
^ The cutting tip "UP" side has a groove or letters.
NOTE:
A tip mounted upside-down will produce a surface finish that looks like an old LP record.
^ Each cutting tip has three cutting corners. Rotate or replace the tip as needed.
NOTE:
You should get at least 7 cuts per corner. However, tip life is affected by variables such as rust or
ridges. In order to determine when to rotate tips, monitor the rotor finish. If the rotor finish begins to
look inconsistent or feels rough to the touch, tips should be rotated or replaced. Tips that are
chipped or cracked should never be used.
Page 3276
Page 5340
Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Installed Height 1.54 in
Valve Spring Pressure ---
Page 1531
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other Precautions
Exhaust Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensor - Thread Cleaning and Other
Precautions
Classification: TE98-005
Reference: NTB98-089
Date: November 15, 1998
02 SENSOR THREAD REPAIR FOR EXHAUST TUBE, EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
APPLIED VEHICLE: All models with 02 sensors
SERVICE INFORMATION
When removing a front or rear 02 sensor, material may remain on the internal threads of the
exhaust tube, catalytic converter, or exhaust manifold. Special service tools (see Figure 1) are
available to clean the internal threads in such cases. This will minimize the need to replace these
components. These required special tools will be mailed separately.
Use this bulletin when replacing 02 sensors as part of the 1996 Maxima OBDII Campaign
(NTB98-073) or whenever there is a need to clean 02 sensor threads.
NOTE:
This tool is not to be used for tapping threads.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Always follow these general guidelines when servicing 02 sensors.
Do not apply severe shock to the sensor when installing it. Do not use an impact wrench for
installing it.
Discard any sensor that has been dropped.
Never attempt to clean an 02 sensor by applying solvent to it.
Anti-seize must only be applied to the threads, not the sensing element.
1. Remove the 02 sensor from the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
2. Select the correct thread repair tool based on the thread diameter of the removed 02 sensor (see
Figure 1).
^ Zirconia 02 sensors use the 18 mm diameter tool: J-43897-18.
Audio - Speaker Noise, Cellular Phone Interference
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 807
Idle Speed: Adjustments
Midpoint of range given is the preferred setting speed.
1981-83 L28 Turbo, 1983 E15 Turbo:
With engine at operating temperature, race several times and return to idle. Disconnect idle control
valve and check speed against specified value.
1984-87 E16 2V Federal:
With engine at operating temperature, disconnect vacuum control modulator harness. Race engine
several times and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect vacuum
control modulator harness. Restart engine, race several times, and check idle speed against
specified value.
1987-90 E16 FI, GA16; 1989-90 KA24:
With engine at operating temperature disconnect throttle sensor harness connector. Start engine
and set idle to specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine.
Verify that idle speed is within checking speed. Turn on AC and verify that idle increases to
specified value.
1984-89 VG30 Turbo, 1987-89 CA16, CA18 DOHC:
With engine at operating temperature, turn ignition off and disconnect automatic air control (AAC)
valve harness. Start engine and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect
harness. Restart engine and check idle speed against specified value. Turn AC on and verify that
speed-up is at specified value. All engines, turn AC on and verify that speed-up speed is specified
value.
1987-88 CA18 Turbo, 1987-89 CA20 Stanza:
Disconnect throttle valve and automatic air control valve harness. Start engine and adjust idle to
specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine. Verify that idle is at
specified checking speed.
1989-90 VG30 Maxima:
Turn diagnostic connector on ECU fully clockwise and adjust idle to specified value. Verify that idle
is at specified checking speed. 1990 300ZX:
Attach inductive clamp to loop wire on power transistor behind upper radiator hose. Set idle to
specified value.
Page 3837
Technical Service Bulletin # 93148 Date: 931015
Electrical - General System Diagnosis
Classification: EL93-027 Section: Electrical System Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN
NTB93-148 Models: All Models Date: October 15, 1993
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS
General Inspection Procedure
In general, electrical systems are considered to be complex systems requiring a high level of
technical knowledge. However, if you have a basic understanding of electrical systems and you
understand their operation, you can approach a proper diagnosis and repair.
This is the first in a series of technical bulletins geared toward the diagnosis and repair of vehicle
electrical systems.
How to Perform Trouble Diagnoses for Quick and Accurate Repair
Trouble Diagnosis Steps
The following chart shows the steps required to properly identify an electrical incident. It is
important to follow each step thoroughly.
STEP 1 Listening To The Customer.
Listening to the customer and documenting the conditions which exist when the problem occurs is
critical to properly diagnosing an electrical incident. You will need to understand the symptoms
which caused the incident, to properly diagnose and/or to try to simulate the condition in the
dealership. It may also be important to determine if the car has had any accessories recently
installed or if any service work (collision repair, etc.) has been recently performed.
STEP 2 Verify the parameters of the incident.
Whenever possible, you should operate the complete system to verify the customers comments.
Try to confirm the symptom(s) and under what conditions the incident occurs.
STEP 3 Get the proper diagnosis materials together.
Before beginning the diagnosis, make sure you have all of the necessary information. Along with
these Fix Tips you should have the Power Supply Routing information in the EL section of the
appropriate service manual. You should make sure you have a thorough understanding of how the
system operates. Based upon the customers comments and your knowledge of the circuit
operation, you should be able to identify which component(s) could cause the incident.
STEP 4 Inspect the system.
Page 1581
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
Ignition Wire Visual Inspection
1. Visually inspect the ignition wires for the following:
a. Insulation for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... b. Insulation for cracks or
breaks. c. Insulator boots for swelling or breakdown due to fuel, oil, grease or etc... d. Insulator
boots for cracks or breaks. e. Terminal ends for corrosion, cracks or looseness.
Ignition Wire Resistance Test
2. Using an ohm meter, check the resistance between the terminal ends.
Resistance: Less than 30k ohms
Replace the wire if it fails the above test.
Page 2469
NOTES:
^ Rust penetrant is considered a shop supply.
^ Nissan Rust Penetrant can be ordered through the Nissan Direct Ship Chemical Care Product
Program, Website order via link on dealer portal.
^ WD-40 is available from various local sources.
Removal Tool
^ When removing a seized exhaust sensor with a specialty socket (which contains a slit to
accommodate the wiring harness), it may spread open and
strip the sensor.
^ Before this occurs, it is recommended to cut the wiring harness from the sensor and use a box
end wrench or 6-point deep well socket.
1. Clamp the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube in a vice.
2. Spray the sensor with the rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
^ It is important that the spray is directed at the base of the sensor to ensure it penetrates into the
threads.
Page 729
Page 1819
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Seat Trim - Non-Warrantable Examples
Interior Moulding / Trim: Technical Service Bulletins Seat Trim - Non-Warrantable Examples
Reference: WARRANTY BULLETIN WB/90-011
Date: June 15, 1990
TO: ALL NISSAN DEALERS
SUBJECT: SEAT TRIM WARRANTY CLAIMS
An ongoing analysis of Seat Trim returned through the Part Return Program has shown an
increasing volume of non-warrantable seat trim replacements being claimed as a warrantable
repair. Non-warrantable seat trim examples are cigarette burns, cuts and punctures.
Please instruct your Warranty Administration team that seat trim damage as indicated above is not
covered by the Nissan New Vehicle Limited Warranty and should not be submitted for
reimbursement via the Warranty Claim Processing System.
Thank you for your assistance.
A/C - Refrigerant Oil Recommendations
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Recommendations
Classification: HA91-002
Section: Heater And Air Conditioner
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB91-014
Models: ALL MODELS
Date: FEBRUARY 14, 1991
A/C SYSTEM REFRIGERANT OIL
APPLIED MODEL: All Models equipped with A/C System
SERVICE INFORMATION:
When service repairs on a Nissan A/C system require that lubricant be added to the system, please
be advised that the recommended refrigerant oil for all Nissan A/C systems is SUNISO 5GS. This
oil applies to all rotary, lateral piston, and variable displacement Nissan A/C compressors.
SUNISO 5GS is available throughout the continental U.S. The name and location of the nearest
SUNISO 5GS distributor may be obtained by contacting the Virginia KMP Corporation at
1-800-527-7960.
Audio - Aftermarket Phone/Audio Installation Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Handling When Mounting Tires
Classification: WT06-002
Reference: NTB06-076
Date: November 7, 2006
PRECAUTIONS FOR HANDLING CHROME TYPE WHEELS
APPLIED VEHICLE: All Nissan vehicles with chrome type wheels
SERVICE INFORMATION
The appearance of chrome type wheels can be damaged if they are not handled correctly during
wheel and tire service.
Tire Changing:
^ Make sure to use tire changing equipment that clamps (secures) the wheel from the inside
(internal jaws).
^ Do not use any metal tools that may touch the outside of the wheel.
^ Tools and machine equipment that touch the outside of the rim should be made of plastic, or
have rubber/plastic protective covers.
Wheel Balancing:
Page 746
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2452
be present during future servicing of the emissions system. A supply of labels has been included
with this Technical Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional office.
PARTS INFORMATION
A new sub-harness will be supplied to the owner, along with the notification letter. The owner
should bring the part to the dealership along with the vehicle to be corrected. A small quantity of
parts will be held in reserve by the Technical Compliance Department of NMC in U.S.A. for unusual
circumstances. Dealerships should contact their Regional Service Department if extra parts are
needed for this campaign.
Service Procedure
1. Observe the "check engine" light while the engine is running. If the light is off, stop the engine
and install the appropriate sub-harness (supplied by the customer), using the modification
procedure on page 4/7 (Pulsar SE) or 5/7 (Stanza) of this Technical Bulletin.
Page 1517
Page 3644
Axle Shaft: Specifications Axle Shaft, Halfshaft U-Joint Type
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Bearings" before
making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 3060
BASIC CHARACTERISTICS
An ON-duty signal is fed to the I.S.C. valve in response to the water temperature.
STARTING CORRECTION
A starting correction signal is added in response to the water temperature for improved engine
startability. This function continues for several seconds after the engine starts.
IDLE SPEED FEEDBACK CONTROL
When the following conditions are met after the starting correction has been completed, the idle
speed feedback control function operates. (1) Idle switch-ON (2) Neutral switch - ON or below 8
km/h (5 MPH) (vehicle speed) *: When battery voltage of less than 12 volts continues for a few
seconds, the target idle speed will be maintained higher, in order to improve
charging function. (M/T only)
Page 2076
Page 2269
Inspection Procedure
Page 1434
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4272
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3180
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4234
When the specification is labeled "Toe-Out" and the dimensions are positive (+) numbers (ie: 2 to 6
mm), the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 3).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-out specification = Toe-Out wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-Out
specification = Toe-In wheel setting.
4. Rear Toe is adjustable on some Nissan vehicles with independent rear suspensions. Usually,
the adjustment, itself, is not difficult but, it is extremely important.
Nissan uses two (2) different terms to describe "Rear Toe". "Toe-In" and "Toe-Out". Contemporary
wheel alignment equipment measures rear "Toe-In" and, if the wheels are actually "Toed-Out",
displays the measured values as a negative (Figure 4).
5. Toe is measured as a distance or as an angle. When measuring toe as a distance, it is found by
measuring the difference between the center of the front of the tire and the center of the rear of the
tire at spindle height. The difference between the distances is Total Toe.
When measured as an angle, the center line of the vehicle is zero degrees (0~, 0.00~, or 0~00')
and the angle of a line drawn through the center of the tire and wheel, as viewed from the top, is
the Toe angle for the individual wheel.
6. Nissan Total Toe specifications are given two (2) ways:
Distance: Millimeters and Decimal Inches
Angle: Degrees and Minutes
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 571
^ Apply the brakes as shown.
^ Start the engine to allow brake boost.
^ Turn the engine OFF,
^ Remove all lock pins-front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates".
^ Make sure the bridge plate will not interfere with movement of the turn plate.
Put the bridge plate in the down position.
^ Perform caster sweep by turning the steering wheel from outside the vehicle.
Page 2995
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 4806
^ Do not introduce compressed air to any refrigerant container or refrigerant component, because
contamination will occur.
^ R-134a in the presence of oxygen and under pressure may form a combustible mixture.
Therefore, never introduce compressed air into any R-134a container, cylinder, A/C component,
recover/recycle equipment, or other service equipment. This includes "empty" containers.
Refrigerant Terminology
Please use the correct name or names when specifying refrigerants. The guidelines are listed
below:
^ Freon --> is a registered trademark of DuPont, and should only be used if referring to DuPont
R-12.
^ DuPont's trade name for R-134a (automotive use) is Suva-->Trans A/C.
^ When referring to refrigerants, the terms Freon-->and Suva--> should not be used as a general
reference. The proper terms are R-12 and R-134a
Comments regarding refrigerants:
^ R-12 and R-134a are not compatible with each other and should never be mixed, even in the
smallest amounts.
^ R-134a for automotive use has a special tank fitting size (1/2" - 16 ACME) which is compatible
with automotive service equipment
^ When purchasing R-134a, be certain that the fitting size on the tank is 1/2" - 16 ACME. This
thread size is easy to recognize by the square thread, as shown.
^ Although R-134a has no ozone depletion potential (ODP), it does have a slight global warming
potential (GWP). Due to this slight GWP, as well as its high cost, venting of R-134a into the air is
not recommended.
^ Recovery/recycling of R-134a will be required by U.S. Federal Law, Clean Air Act Amendments of
1990.
Locations
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Component Locations
Seats: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
PDI - Paint Guard Coating (PGC) Removal
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins PDI - Paint Guard Coating (PGC) Removal
Classification: Section:
BF88-015 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-120 Models: All Models
Date: September 15, 1988 PAINT GUARD COATING REMOVAL
This Bulletin supersedes the previously issued "Paint Guard Coating Removal",
BF88-006/TS88-043, dated May 5, 1988. Due to duplicate numbering this Bulletin is being
re-issued with new Classification/Reference numbers. There are NO changes to the contents of the
Bulletin. Please discard the original Bulletin. APPLIED MODELS: All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
The following information should be used to help your wash and detail personnel in the clean-up of
vehicles delivered with PGC (paint guard coating). The paint guard coating remover solution is
supplied with each vehicle and can be found in the glove box. In order to make the removal
process easier, the Ports have improved the application process and are careful to avoid sags and
thick coats of the material.
Please post these directions in your car wash area and review with clean-up personnel. A good
understanding of the PGC and remover will greatly speed your clean-up and preserve the new car
finish.
A Material Safety Data Sheet on PGC has been distributed as part of a National Parts Bulletin.
1. Park vehicle in shade and rinse thoroughly using a spray of water. If the vehicle is extremely
dirty, wash it with soap and water. This will loosen dirt and cool the sheet metal. The surface must
not be allowed to dry during the cleaning process.
When applying the remover solution in the next step, a pair of rubber gloves, eye protection, and
boots should be worn for protection.
Page 3625
4. Use hose clamps and temporarily connect a length of suitable hose between the bypass valve
fittings that go to the oil cooler (see Figure 6).
5. Pinch/clamp the temporary hose to prevent flow through the loop (see Figure 6).
6. Cover the end of the bypass inlet line with a shop rag to catch any oil spray.
7. Blow compressed air regulated to 5-9 kg/sq.cm (70 - 130 PSI) into the outlet for 10 second
intervals, three times (see Figure 6).
8. Re-connect the transmission lines and remove the temporary hose loop (see Figure 7).
9. Go to Diagnosis Procedure (All Vehicles).
1996-98 Pathfinder (R50) Cleaning the Optional Air Cooled Oil-Cooler (Air Cooler)
1. Place an oil drain pan under the A/T air cooler Inlet and Outlet hoses (see Points A and B,
Figure 8).
2. Disconnect the Inlet and Outlet hoses from the air cooler (see Points A and B, Figure 8).
3. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-AM006) into the air cooler Outlet hose (see Point B, Figure 8).
CAUTION:
^ Wear safety glasses and rubber gloves when spraying the Transmission Cooler Cleaner.
^ Spray Cooler Cleaner only with adequate ventilation.
^ Avoid contact with eyes and skin.
^ Do not breath the vapors or the spray mist.
Page 2684
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 1490
Idle Speed: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Page 2078
Page 4221
Page 3415
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
Ignition Wire
The coil wire connects the ignition coil to the distributor cap, allowing high voltage to flow from the
coil to the distributor cap. The spark plug wires connect the terminals in the distributor cap to the
spark plugs, allowing high voltage to flow to the spark plugs. The ignition wires have an internal
resistance to suppress radio static and to eliminate static that may interfere with sensitive computer
components.
Page 4785
Page 102
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 1992
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 5306
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 649
Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Air Bleeder Screw 5 - 7 ft.lb
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2108
Service and Repair
Ball Joint: Service and Repair
1. Remove wheel bearing locknut.
2. Remove tie rod ball joint.
2. Remove strut lower bracket attaching nuts and bolts.
3. Separate driveshaft from knuckle by tapping driveshaft end with a suitable hammer. Use caution
not to damage driveshaft boots.
4. Separate lower ball joint stud from knuckle using a suitable tool.
5. Remove stabilizer bar attaching bolt from transverse link and ball joint assembly.
6. Remove transverse link bracket attaching bolts, then the transverse link bracket.
7. Remove remaining transverse link assembly attaching bolt, then the transverse link and ball joint
assembly.
8. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 874
^ Pulley should turn with some dragging
^ If it locks or has unusual resistance, replace the alternator.
Testing and Inspection
Air Filter Element: Testing and Inspection
Viscous paper type air cleaner filter does not require any cleaning operation until it is replaced
periodically. Brushing or blasting operation should never be conducted, because it causes clogging
and results in enrichment of the mixture ratio.
Page 1208
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 2443
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Main Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Brake Rotor/Disc: Customer Interest Brakes - Explanation of Common Noises
Classification: BR87-005
Reference: TS87-103
Date: June 29, 1987
DISC BRAKE NOISE INFORMATION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models with disc brakes (front or
rear)
SERVICE INFORMATION Some Nissan vehicles may exhibit brake noise under certain driving
conditions. This Bulletin provides some information about normal and common noises and
appropriate service procedures for each noise. Some of this information may be useful when
explaining brake noises to the customer.
Refer to Technical Bulletin BR87-006, "Disc Brake Noise Countermeasure", for information about
abnormal brake noises on Maxima, Stanza, and Stanza Wagon. General Brake Information Nissan
brake systems have been carefully designed to provide optimum braking performance under
various driving conditions. One of the most important components in the brake system is the brake
pad material. The following factors have been taken into consideration to select the best pad
material. ^
technical and government regulations
^ stopping distance
^ vehicle control while braking
^ high operating temperatures
^ pedal force
^ pad and rotor wear rates
^ moisture resistance
^ friction coefficient stability
^ operating noise level
Unfortunately, there is no one brake pad material that provides perfect performance in all of these
areas. Changing the material to improve some factors often causes a performance reduction in
other areas. Higher brake operating noise levels in some instances occur as a result of factors
which ensure proper brake performance and safety.
Common Brake Noises
The following brake noises occur most frequently on Nissan vehicles. These noises do not indicate
any malfunction or improper operation. 1.
GROANING NOISE AT LOW MILEAGE (0-300 MILES) ^
noise occurs with light to medium pedal force
^ noise occurs during medium speed stops (20-40 mph)
^ noise usually does not occur on the first or second stop
^ noise occurs with warm or hot brakes (not cold)
^ there may be a low frequency "judder" vibration
Nissan applies protective coatings to the brake rotors and pads to reduce corrosion during shipping
and storage. These coatings may cause this groaning noise until they are worn off. Under normal
driving conditions, this usually takes about 300 miles. If this noise occurs during the first 300 miles,
it is not necessary to attempt any repairs. Service Procedure:
There is no service procedure to eliminate this noise permanently. Replacing the brake pads or
machining the rotors may cause the noise to disappear temporarily, but it will return and continue
until the coatings are worn off the rotor and pads. 2.
GROANING NOISE (AFTER 300 MILES)
Page 801
BASIC CHARACTERISTICS
An ON-duty signal is fed to the I.S.C. valve in response to the water temperature.
STARTING CORRECTION
A starting correction signal is added in response to the water temperature for improved engine
startability. This function continues for several seconds after the engine starts.
IDLE SPEED FEEDBACK CONTROL
When the following conditions are met after the starting correction has been completed, the idle
speed feedback control function operates. (1) Idle switch-ON (2) Neutral switch - ON or below 8
km/h (5 MPH) (vehicle speed) *: When battery voltage of less than 12 volts continues for a few
seconds, the target idle speed will be maintained higher, in order to improve
charging function. (M/T only)
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 3885
Page 459
For this reason, dealers must follow the campaign procedure as described in NTB95-085a, and
replace only the button on all vehicles unless replacement of the buckles is necessary.
SERVICE-COMM INFORMATION
Vehicles are being flagged in SERVICE-COMM as owner notifications are mailed. This enables
both dealer and NMC personnel to quickly determine which owners have been mailed a
notification. Please refer to the "applied vehicles" section of this bulletin to determine the complete
affected vehicle population.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Button Replacement Tips
The buckle assembly should be replaced only when one of the following conditions is observed:
^ Improper latching or unlatching
^ Buckle mechanism is contaminated with sticky material such as soft drink or juice
^ Foreign material is stuck in the buckle mechanism
^ The seat belt warning system switch is damaged.
Switch Removal and Installation
Reference Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a
Removal: step 5.
On buckles with the white plastic ejector mechanism, care should be taken when removing the
buckle housing from the mechanism. The plastic spring locator and/or the springs can easily
disengage and become loose causing the mechanism to bind when reassembled.
Removal; steps 6 & 7.
Use the recommended cutters and cut the three locating pins flush with the switch. Using a small
flat bladed screwdriver, gently pry up on the switch at the lower portion near the locating pin.
Repeat this at the upper pins. If the pins are cut correctly, the switch will come out with very little
effort.
Installation; steps 18-20.
Follow the procedure in Step 18 exactly. Apply pressure with your thumb or a very small
screwdriver only to the upper corners of the switch. Proper installation does not require that you
hear a "click". The switch needs only to be over the locating pins and flush with the buckle cover.
Before installing the lower buckle cover (Step 19), the switch must be in the upward position.
Failure to place the switch in this position will damage it. You must also depress the release button
(Step 20) when snapping the cover in place. All of the above is clearly illustrated in the video tape
shipped with Campaign Bulletin NTB95-085a.
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
VIN Information for 1986.5 models
Model Serial Number Range
200SX vehicles between 010051-121424
VIN Information for 1991 Models
Not all 1991 vehicles are affected by this campaign. The following are the ending serial numbers
for the 1991 model vehicles affected by this campaign:
Model Ending Serial Number
240SX - Coupe 006837
240SX - Hatchback 023837
Pathfinder 032716
Truck - Japan production 412972
Truck - U.S. production 365000
Page 1694
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Engine Controls - Engine Control Module Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Control Module
Identification
Models: Various Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control Classification: EF & EC94-015 Bulletin
No.: NTB94-097 Date: November 4, 1994
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IDENTIFICATION
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to assure in verifying
that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and
Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new
ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and has the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All vehicles have a label (see illustration above) that has
the vendor part number on the ECM Cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 1058
Page 4594
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "FRONT SUSPENSION / COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND REPAIR PROCEDURES /
AXLE BEARING AND KNUCKLE" before making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 4461
Print this page and keep it by your tire mounting equipment
Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service and Repair" before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 1795
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Page 4709
When servicing the A/C refrigeration loop, refer to the charts (Figure 2 and 3) to identify the correct
0-ring type. The charts list both NEW and FORMER 0-ring types and illustrates the 0-rings in
full-scale size.
IMPORTANT POINTS
^ There is NO interchangeability between NEW and FORMER connection type 0-rings. Improper
use will cause refrigerant leaks. Therefore, the correct type 0-ring must be used with each
application.
^ Nissan vehicles requiring A/C 0-ring replacement should be checked for proper 0-ring part
numbers through the applicable parts microfiche.
^ Insure correct 0-ring installation onto tube (see Figure 1).
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3836
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Page 1081
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Mass Air Flow Sensor
The air flow meter measures the intake air flow rate by taking a part of the entire flow.
Measurements are made in such a manner that the E.C.U. receives electrical output signals varied
by the amount of heat emitting from the hot wire placed in the stream of the intake air. When intake
air flows into the intake manifold through a route around the hot wire, the heat generated from the
hot wire is taken away by the air. The amount of heat depends on the air flow. On the other hand,
the temperature of the hot wire is automatically controlled to a certain number of degrees.
Therefore, it is necessary to supply the hot wire with more electric current in order to maintain the
temperature of the hot wire. The E.C.U. knows the air flow by means of the electric change.
Page 1510
Page 706
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Page 1080
Locations
Receiver Dryer: Locations
A/C Components.
LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 491
CLAIM INFORMATION
NOTE: Al vehicles must have either the release buttons or buckle assemblies replaced. Use this
decision tree to determine when buckle replacement is required.
Rental Car Policy
RENTAL CAR POLICY
Nissan authorizes dealers to provide customers a free rental vehicle under the following conditions:
1. The customer's vehicle has one or more seat belts that will not latch or function as designed,
and;
2. The necessary replacement buckle/belt assembly is not available in the dealer's parts inventory,
and has been ordered "vehicle off road" (VOR) and;
3. The rental period does not exceed 48 hours. Rental cars provided for more than 48 hours must
be approved by Nissan regional personnel.
Failure to comply with these conditions may result in the chargeback of up to the entire rental car
amount paid.
Dealers are instructed to follow the procedure below to minimize the need for rental cars.
1. When the customer calls for an appointment, verify the year and model of his/her Nissan and the
color of the seat belts.
2. Ask the customer if he/she has had any problems with the seat belts latching.
a. If the customer has had no latching problems, ensure that the correct button kits are available at
the time of the appointment.
b. If the customer indicates there has been a latching problem, order a pair of the correct buckle
assemblies so they will be available on the
Page 556
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Page 56
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30E
VAN (C22) Z24i
200SX (S110) Z20E
200SX (S110) Z22E
Page 2129
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 800
Idle Speed: Description and Operation
Idle Speed Control
The idle speed is controlled by the E.C.C.S. control unit, corresponding to the engine operating
conditions. The E.C.C.S. control unit senses the engine condition and determines the best idle
speed at each water temperature and gear position. The control unit then sends an electronic
signal corresponding to the difference between the best idle speed and the actual idle speed to the
A.A.C. valve.
INPUT SIGNAL AND AIR FLOW
The opening of the I.S.C. valve is controlled by an ON-duty signal fed to the opening solenoid.
(When the opening solenoid is "ON", the closing solenoid is "OFF", and vice versa.)
The longer the ON-duty signal on the opening solenoid, the greater the I.S.C. valve opening and
the greater the amount of airflow.
Page 2680
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 2318
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 2988
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 5054
Diagnostic Procedure # 10
SYMPTOM: Alarm will not silence with key.
Diagnostic Procedure # 11
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 5149
2. Grind the surface of the repair with 36 grit disc. Grind about 1-1/2" around the actual damage to
obtain a taper for best adhesion.
3. Featheredge the paint around the repair with 180 grit disc. Wipe with a clean, dry rag and blow
off with air.
4. Mix Flexible Parts Repair Material according to the instructions and apply to the repair with a
squeegee, building it up higher than the undamaged area. Allow it to cure for 20-30 minutes at
60-80~F.
5. After curing, sand with 180 grit disc followed by 240 grit disc.
6. Fill sand scratches and pinholes with Flexible Parts Putty. Allow at least 15 minutes to dry then
sand with 320 grit disc.
Brakes - AMMCO On Car Lathe Operating Guidlines
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-062A Date: 990617
Brakes - AMMCO On Car Lathe Operating Guidlines
REFERENCE: NTB92-062A
CLASSIFICATION: BR92-004A
DATE: June 17,1999
TITLE: AMMCO ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE OPERATING GUIDELINES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
This amended version of NTB92-062 adds a CAUTION and a NOTE to the Service Procedure.
Please discard all paper copies of NTB92-062.
SERVICE INFORMATION
To ensure the best possible surface finish and least amount of run-out and rotor thickness variation
when using the Ammco on-car brake lathe, the following guidelines should be observed.
Service Procedure
SERVICE PROCEDURE Before mounting the brake lathe on the vehicle ensure the following:
1. The V-way between the carriage and carriage gib must be clean and adjusted properly (see
Operation Manual for adjustment procedure). Wipe off
sliding surfaces with a soft cloth after each use.
2. The cutters and cutting bits must be tight in their mounts and positioned properly. Change cutting
bits when they become dull.
3. When securing the adjustable mounting brackets to the caliper mount/knuckle the mounting
surfaces must be smooth and free of burrs.
4. Make sure the adjustable mounting brackets are securely mounted to caliper mount/knuckle.
There should be no movement between the cutting
tool and the caliper mount/knuckle.
ROTOR DRIVING UNIT Before using the drive unit ensure the following:
Page 503
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Towing Information: By Symptom Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Classification: GI88-023
Reference: TS88-150
Date: November 17, 1988
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
APPLIED VEHICLES All Models 1987-1989
SERVICE INFORMATION The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h.
and distances of less than 40 miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when
towing Automatic Transmission vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following
limitations apply when towing Manual Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for
example behind a motor home.)
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
Specifications
Fig. 277 Start signal switch ON/OFF diagnosis procedure.
Page 2347
Page 4366
* The brake rotor run-out exceeds specification limits.
* As the brake pad rubs against the rotor while driving, the high spots on the brake rotor wear
slightly.
* Rotor thickness variation may develop as the high spots on the brake rotor wear. If this thickness
variation becomes large enough, brake judder/shimmy may occur.
NISSAN SERVICE PROCEDURE:
Resurfacing the brake rotor using the Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe is the preferred method of
correcting excessive rotor run-out and thickness variation. Refer to Nissan Technical Bulletin
NTB92-062 (BR92-004) "Ammco On-Car Brake Lathe Operating Guidelines."
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 1853
Altitude Switch: Description and Operation Altitude Switch
This switch, used on some models, is attached on the left side of the instrument panel in the
driver's compartment. This switch consists of a bellows and a microswitch. The switch transmits an
``On'' or ``Off'' signal to the control unit according to change in atmospheric pressure. When the
atmospheric pressure drops below 26 in. Hg, an ``On'' signal is transmitted to decrease fuel by 6%.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 3097
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2302
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
PULSAR (KN12) E15ET
PULSAR (KN13) E16i
PULSAR (KN13) CA16DE
PULSAR (KN13) CA18DE
Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Main Harness Part 1
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing Information
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transmission Vehicles - Towing
Information
Classification: Section:
GI88-023 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-150 Models:
All models 1987-1989 Date:
November 17, 1988 TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h. and distances of less than 40
miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic Transmission vehicles with four
wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when towing Automatic Transmission
vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following limitations apply when towing Manual
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for example behind a motor home).
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES *
These are maximum distances these vehicles may be towed without damage to the gear rain. In
general, any Nissan vehicle should be started, warmed up, and driven at least two miles after it has
been towed these distances - more frequently if possible.
Page 2646
Inspection Procedure
Page 2565
Fig. 303d Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 717
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1509
This bulletin supplements Technical Bulletin EF&EC88-001; (TS88-001) dated January 18, 1988,
and provides information on critical adjustments that, if not made properly, can cause customer
complaints of intermittent stalling when coming to a stop. Please update bulletin EF&QC88-001; by
hand with these specifications.
In order for the electronic idle speed control system to perform properly, it is essential that the
following adjustments be checked and set to the specifications listed on any vehicle with
complaints of improper idle. The Base Idle Speed and the Throttle Switch Adjustment specifications
have been modified for vehicles with less than 3000 miles.
BASE IDLE SPEED
Vehicle Mileage Specifications*
Less than 3000 miles M/T 680 RPM
A/T 600 RPM (in "D" position)
Above 3000 miles M/T 750 RPM A/T 670 RPM (in "D" position)
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 4 for adjustment procedure.
IMPORTANT: The Base Idle Speed must NOT be set ABOVE thses specifications.
THROTTLE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
Specifications* (For all mileages)
M/T Base Idle Speed + 300-450 RPM
A/T Idle Speed in Neutral + 300-450 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; Page 5 for adjustment procedure. IMPORTANT:
The Throttle Switch must not be set above 1200 RPM.
DASH POT ADJUSTMENT
Dash Pot Touch Speed* 2600-3000 RPM
*Refer to bulletin EF&EC88-001; page 6 for adjustment procedure.
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 864
6. Remove upper and lower dust covers. Use a torx wrench.
7. Loosen timing belt tension lock nut and rotate tension clock- wise. Then tighten tensioner lock
nut. 8. Mark rotating direction mark on timing belt and Remove timing belt.
CAUTION:
After removing timing belt, do not rotate crankshaft and camshaft separately because valves will hit
piston heads.
9. Remove belt tensioner and return spring.
10. Inspect the condition of belt tensioner and tensioner spring.
INSTALLATION
1. Confirm that No.1 cylinder is set at T.D.C. on its compression stroke.
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 2553
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Page 4062
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Ignition switch replacement
1. Remove the four upper and lower shell cover retaining screws, then the shell covers.
2. Disconnect electrical connectors from switch.
3. Remove switch retaining screw from steering lock, Fig. 2.
4. Remove switch.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Locations
Air Induction Valve Solenoid: Locations
Engine & Emission Control Components.
Top Of Engine, Right Front
Applicable to: 1987 Sentra w/E16i Engine
Page 1752
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Page 421
Page 2656
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 534
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
^ During the road test make sure the vehicle is pointing straight. Don't worry about steering wheel
position during the road test.
NOTE:
^ If you adjusted the tire pressure or changed the tires before the road test, the issue may have
been resolved.
^ If there are cross winds strong enough to affect the vehicle's straight line movement, then
diagnosis cannot be performed.
4. Determine the vehicles issue - refer to the definitions of "Pull" and Steering Wheel "Off-center"
below.
5. When the road test is completed, remove the Road Crown Gauge, leave the Steering Wheel
Off-Set Gauge in place until the Service Procedure is complete.
6. Refer to the Flow Chart above for the next step.
Other Service Information
Customers may report that their vehicle's steering wheel is "off-center" because the steering wheel
spokes are tilted to the left or right when the vehicle continues straight ahead on a straight flat road
(see example in Figure 1).
If a vehicle's steering wheel spokes are slightly off center while driving straight, it may be the
normal result of road crown. Most roads in the United States are built with a "crown" to help rain
water drain from the road surface. The slope of the road crown varies from place to place.
Vehicles have a natural tendency to drift to the low side of the crown. The greater the slope of the
crown, the faster the vehicle will drift in that direction.
Tires and vehicles are designed to counteract the effect of typical road crown, but may not fully
counteract the effect of a highly crowned road.
Page 660
Alignment: Service and Repair Preliminary Inspection
Prior to checking and adjusting wheel alignment angles, perform the following checks:
1. Check tire pressures and adjust as needed.
2. Ensure tires are of the proper size and that tires are properly matched.
3. Ensure wheel bearings (front and rear) are properly adjusted.
4. Check steering gear adjustment and ensure that steering gear is properly secured to frame.
5. Inspect steering linkage and suspension components for damage and wear, and repair or
replace components as needed.
6. Measure vehicle ride height with vehicle unloaded, and ensure springs are not collapsed.
7. Place unladen vehicle on suitable alignment rack following manufacturer's instructions, then
jounce vehicle several times to settle suspension.
8. Check and correct rear wheel camber and toe first, if applicable, then check and correct front
suspension angles in in the following order: caster and kingpin inclination, camber, toe setting and
turning angle (toe-out on turns).
Page 1192
^ Any tools, equipment cones, or other wheel balancing equipment items should not touch the
outside surface of chrome type wheels.
Wheel Alignment:
^ Alignment sensors with metal mounting hooks should not be used on chrome type wheels.
^ Some alignment equipment manufacturers may have protective rubber pads available that can be
used to cover the metal mounting hooks.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Idle Speed Control Valve: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4271
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Technical
Service Bulletin # 08-097D Date: 110426
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Judder/Pedal Feel/Noise Diagnosis/Repair
Classification: BR00-004d
Reference: NTB00-033d
Date: August 8, 2007
ALL NISSAN; BRAKE NOISE/JUDDER/PEDAL FEEL DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR
This bulletin has been amended. The Applied Vehicles have been updated. Please discard all
previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ This bulletin is to assist you in responding to customer questions about brake operation, and
provides diagnostic and repair information for each item listed, if any should occur.
^ Most brake incidents fall into the following categories:
a. Brake Noise: A squeak, squeal, clunk, or groan that occurs when the brakes are applied or
released.
b. Brake Judder: A vibration that can be felt in the vehicle, steering wheel or brake pedal when the
brakes are applied.
c. Pedal Feel: The effort needed to operate the brakes is too high or too low.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify the condition by road testing the vehicle with the customer.
2. Determine the specific brake incident based on the description in the Service Information above.
3. Follow the appropriate repair procedure(s), shown below, for your specific incident.
BRAKE NOISE
^ Brakes can make a range of noises when applied or released. Some noises are normal and no
repair action should be taken.
^ Use the following descriptions to identify the specific type of brake noise and the appropriate
repair:
Squeak noise when the brakes are cold:
^ Usually occurs during the first few stops in the morning.
^ This is a normal condition. No service action is necessary.
Squeak noise with the brakes at normal operating temperatures:
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ If there are no bulletins for the car you are working on, install OE type pads using the information
listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
Notes about brake pads and brake noise:
Original Equipment (OE) brake pads are installed on all current Nissan vehicles at the factory.
^ The OE pads use a Non-asbestos Organic (NAO) compound. The NAO material provides state of
the art resistance to squeal noise.
^ These pads are available as service parts and must be used if replacing brake pads under the
terms of the Nissan new car warranty.
Key Value brake pads are also available as a high quality service replacement part at a very
attractive price.
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Page 2867
Wiring Diagram
Page 86
240SX (S13) KA24E
240SX (S13) KA24DE
240SX Convertible (S13) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
Page 1889
Page 2114
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Page 2215
Ignition Rotor: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Rotor
1. Remove the screws securing the distributor cap to the distributor.
2. Confirm that the rotor does not turn on the distributor shaft.
3. Remove the rotor.
4. Visually check the rotor for signs of "Burn Through" from the electrode to the distributor shaft.
5. Check the input (center) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
6. Check the output (outer) contact for excessive carbon build-up and corrosion.
7. Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between the input (center) electrode and the output
(outer) electrode. Replace the rotor if it fails the above tests.
Page 292
13. Use compressed air to remove any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
14. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
15. Tilt the manifold/catalyst/front tube so that the metal debris falls out of the part.
16. Apply compressed air through the boss to blow out any remaining debris.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
17. Install the new sensor as described in the applicable Electronic Service Manual (ESM).
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 2106
Page 1633
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
The water temperature sensor, located on the front side of the intake manifold, detects engine
coolant temperature and emits signals to the E.C.U. This part employs a thermistor which is
sensitive to changes in temperature. The electric resistance of a thermistor decreases in response
to a temperature rise.
Page 5001
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 5179
Interior Moulding / Trim: Technical Service Bulletins Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Models All Models
Section Body & Frame
Classification BF91-014
Bulletin No. NTB91-051
Date May 23, 1991
CARE OF LEATHER TRIM
APPLIED MODELS: All Models Equipped With Leather Trim
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Nissan currently uses Cow Hide on all vehicles equipped with Leather Interior Trim (excluding
certain 1988 Maximas which were equipped with Suede Seats). This bulletin refers only to those
vehicles equipped with Cow Hide Leather Interior Trim. Suede seat covers are made of Pig Skin
and should be cared for according to the instructions provided in the U11 Maxima Seat Care Kit
(P/N 999M1-U8000). Leather is typically used on seat surfaces, trim pieces, steering wheels, and
shift knobs in Nissan Vehicles. Maintaining a high quality appearance is best achieved by using the
procedures indicated below.
1. Occasionally, loose dust should be removed from the interior trim and seat surfaces using a
vacuum cleaner or a soft brush. The leather surfaces should be wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
2. Some leather trim, such as the leather wrapped steering wheel, may become grayish in color
with use. The original condition may be restored by rubbing the affected area with a clean soft cloth
dampened in a mild soap solution, and then wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
3. Leather seat surfaces may be regularly coated with a leather conditioner such as saddle soap.
Cautions:
Never use benzene, thinner, or any similar product on leather trim.
Never use car wax on leather trim.
Never use fabric protectors on leather trim unless recommended by the manufacturer. Some fabric
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the leather trim.
Front
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Front
Fig. 15 Windshield wiper system (typical)
1. Remove wiper arms by raising the arms off the glass and removing locknut.
2. Disconnect electrical connector from motor.
3. Remove top grille retaining screws and top grille, where possible, to gain access to wiper
linkage.
4. Remove wiper motor mounting bolts.
5. Pull motor away from firewall if necessary to gain access. Disconnect motor shaft from linkage
taking care not to bend linkage.
6. Remove wiper motor.
7. Remove flange nuts or screws holding pivot to top cowl panel and remove linkage. To install,
reverse procedure. See Fig. 15 for typical installation.
Page 4015
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Page 1403
2. Ensure that marks on camshaft sprocket and upper front cover and marks on crankshaft
sprocket and lower front cover are properly aligned. 3. Temporarily install tensioner and return
spring.
4. Rotate tensioner clockwise about 70° to 80° and temporarily tighten lock nut. 5. Set timing belt.
a. Ensure that timing belt and sprockets are clean and free of oil or water. Do not bend timing belt
tightly. b. Install timing belt with rotating direction mark facing engine rotating direction. c. Ensure
that timing belt is not loose around jack shaft and camshaft sprockets.
6. Loosen tensioner lock nut so that tensioner pushes on timing belt.
7. Turn camshaft sprocket about 20° (2 cogs) clockwise.
NOTE: Ensure that all spark plugs are removed.
8. Tighten nut while preventing tensioner from turning in "free" direction.
Tensioner lock nut: 16 - 21 N.m (12 - 15 ft.lbs.)
9. Install crank sprocket plate and upper and lower dust covers.
Page 5452
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 758
Service and Repair
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove horn cover and steering wheel.
3. Remove steering column shell covers.
4. Disconnect switch electrical connections.
5. For light switch or wiper switch replacement it is not necessary to remove combination switch
base.
6. Remove retaining screw and switch.
7. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 1915
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2220
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Page 2763
Air Induction Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Check it for electric continuity.
Continuity should exist.
2. Check the solenoid valve for normal operation. Supply it with battery voltage, and check whether
there is continuity between ports A, B and C
Page 5180
Interior Moulding / Trim: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Squeak and Rattle Repair Supplies
Classification: BT98-041
Reference: NTB98-110
Date: January 15, 1999
NISSAN VEHICLE SQUEAK AND RATTLE MATERIALS
APPLIED VEHICLES: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
In support of the recent Squeak and Rattle Seminars, this bulletin provides part numbers,
descriptions, dimensions and recommended uses for materials which can be used to help eliminate
noises in vehicle interior components. Many of these part numbers have been referenced in
recently released squeak and rattle bulletins.
These materials will also be included in a Squeak and Rattle Repair Kit that will be sent to every
dealer in early 1999. The materials are currently available and can be ordered separately as
necessary for squeak and rattle repairs.
Please see the Parts Information Section for detailed parts information.
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference Nissan Claims Bulletin WB/98-021a and Section "UX - Squeak & Rattle Repairs"
of the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" for complete details regarding policy and claims
coding applicable to the repair of squeaks and rattles.
Expense Details:
Pro-rate the bulk "Squeak & Rattle Repairs" material(s) and claim only the amount that is actually
used in the repair. Claim this amount using Expense Code: 022. Do not claim the repair material(s)
part number(s) on the claims.
Page 158
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 4996
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Page 5203
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 1552
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Update
Reference: NTB95-111
Date: November 7, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin provides supplemental information to NTB95-085a dated September 22, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES:
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
24OSX (S13) 1989-91* 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91* 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991* 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
* See VIN Information in this bulletin for the ending serial numbers for 1991 models.
ADDITIONAL AND AMENDED INFORMATION
This bulletin contains information regarding the following:
^ Additional campaign background information
^ SERVICE-COMM information
^ Service Procedure:
- Button replacement tips
- Switch removal and installation
^ Vehicle specific information, VIN information for 1986.5 and 1991 models
^ 1987-1989 vehicle and warranty claims information
^ Parts Information:
- Color mix by model.
ADDITIONAL CAMPAIGN BACKGROUND INFORMATION
Industry wide, the Takata Seat Belt Campaign affects approximately 10,000,000 vehicles produced
by most of the Japanese auto manufacturers. Nissan's share is about 2,000,000 cars and trucks.
All companies conducting the campaign are using a button replacement or buckle modification as
the primary repair, with buckle replacement only as necessary. This strategy has been employed to
expedite completion of the campaign because of the limited availability of Takata supplied
replacement buckle assemblies. If this campaign were to require a 100% buckle assembly
replacement, it would take two to three times as long to complete, which could lead to a great deal
of customer dissatisfaction.
Page 3007
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1059
Page 768
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3207
Idle Speed Control Valve: Description and Operation
Idle speed control valve is a rotary solenoid valve. It receives a pulse signal from E.C.U. which
determines the position of slider, thereby varying bypass air quantity. Idle speed control valve has
additional functions below. 1. Idle-up after cold start (Air regulator) 2. Idle speed feedback control
(A.A.C. valve) 3. Idle-up for air conditioner and power steering (F.I.C.D.) 4. Deceleration vacuum
control (Dash pot, A.B. valve & Boost control valve)
Page 4741
b. Evacuate and recharge system, then check for leaks.
Description and Operation
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 Evaporative emission system. (Typical)
Refer to Fig. 37 for a typical evaporative emission system. Complete system schematics are
located in ``Vacuum Hose Routings.''
This system reduces hydrocarbon emissions from the fuel system by the use of activated charcoal
in the carbon canister. With the engine off, fuel vapor from the fuel tank is led into the carbon for
storage. The vapor is retained in the canister until it is moved by air drawn through the bottom of
the canister to the intake manifold with the engine running. The purge control valve is closed when
the engine is running at idle. A small portion of the stored vapor flows through the constant purge
orifice into the intake manifold. As engine speed increases and throttle vacuum rises, the purge
control valve opens and vapor is drawn into the manifold through both the main and constant purge
orifices.
Description and Operation
Distributor Cap: Description and Operation
Distributor Cap
The distributor cap is used to make the connection between the rotor and the correct spark plug
wire. High tension current from the rotor is distributed to the towers of the distributor cap at a
pre-set sequence and then to the spark plug wires which carry the current on to the spark plugs.
Page 1755
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Specifications
Fig. 2 Temperature Sensors
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1932
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88001 Date: 880118
Fuel - Improved Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
1987 & 1988 Sentra Models
and Pulsar Engine Fuel &
Section
Emission Control
Classification EF&EC88-001;
Bulletin No. TS88-001
Date January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
NOTE: This TSB has been updated by tsb EF & EC 88013
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
or improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD Wagon,
1988 Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
Following the sequence below, use the attached procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Locations
Citizens Band Radio (CB): Locations
A/C Relay Connector (2WD): 3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Relay Connector (4WD):
3M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment A/C Switch Connector (2WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P
A/C Switch Connector (4WD): 134M, Under LH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector
(2WD): 148M, Under RH Side Of I/P Acceleration Cut Timer Connector (4WD): 148M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Air Flow Meter Connector (4WD): 68M, On Throttle Body Air Flow Meter & Harness
Connector: On Throttle Body AIV Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 66M, Front Of Engine AIV
Solenoid Valve Connector (4WD): 66M, Front Of Engine A/T Indicator Illumination Connector
(Sedan): 4B, LH Fender Apron Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back
Door Back Door Harness (4WD Wagon): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Harness
(Hatchback): Rear Pillar To Back Door Back Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 3D, Upper LH
Quarter Back Door Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 11D, On Inner Rear Quarter Panel Back
Door Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 5D, On Rear of Back Door Back-Up Lamp LH Connector
(Hatchback): 5D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Hatchback): 9D, In Rear
Of of Back Door Back-Up Lamp RH Connector (Wagon): 10D, In Rear Of of Back Door Back-Up
Lamp Switch Connector: 1E, Rear Of Engine Blower Motor Connector (2WD): 139M, Under RH
Side Of I/P Blower Motor Connector (4WD): 139M, Under RH Side Of I/P Body Ground Connector
(Coupe): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Hatchback): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body
Ground Connector (Sedan): 10B, Inner LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 10B, Inner
LH Quarter Body Ground Connector (Coupe): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground
Connector (Hatchback): 17B, At RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Sedan): 17B, At
RH Side Of Tail Panel Body Ground Connector (Wagon): 17B, At RH Side Inner Quarter Panel
Brake Fluid Level Switch Connector (4WD): 55M, LH Fender Apron Bulb Check Relay Connector
(2WD): 14M, RH Fender Apron Check Connector (2WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Check
Connector (4WD): 144M, Under LH Side Of I/P Cigar Lighter Connector: 10I, At Cigar Lighter
Circuit Breaker Connector (4WD): 103M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clearance Lamp LH Connector
(2WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp LH Connector (4WD): 45M, At Clearance Lamp
Clearance Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clearance Lamp RH Connector
(4WD): 23M, At Clearance Lamp Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (2WD): 118M, Under LH Side
Of I/P Clutch Interlock Switch Connector (4WD): 118M Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch
Connector (2WD): 116M, Under LH Side Of I/P Clutch Switch Connector (4WD): 116M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Combination Flasher Unit Connector (4WD): 104M, Under LH Side Of I/P Combination
Meter Connector (w/Tach): 6I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector (Less
Tach): 7I, Behind Instrument Cluster Combination Meter Connector: 8I, Behind Instrument Cluster
Compressor Connector (2WD): 28M, At Compressor Compressor Connector (4WD): 28M, At
Compressor Condenser Fan Motor Connector (2WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor
Connector (4WD): 27M, At Fan Motor Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (2WD): 2M, RH
Corner Of Engine Compartment Condenser Fan Motor Relay Connector (4WD): 2M, RH Corner Of
Engine Compartment Crank Angle Sensor & Harness Connector: LH Rear of Engine Crank Angle
Sensor Connector (2WD): 63M, At Distributor Crank Angle Sensor Connector (4WD): 63M, At
Distributor Diode Connector (2WD): 110M, Under LH Side Of I/P Diode Connector (4WD): 110M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness
Connector (4WD): 111M, Under LH Side Of I/P Door Harness Connector (2WD): 141M, Under RH
Side Of I/P
Page 916
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Level Checking/Precautions
Models: 1987-89 Sentra & Pulsar
Section: Automatic Transmission
Classification: AT89-008
Bulletin No.: TS89-091
Date: June 30, 1989
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
SERVICE INFORMATION
As with all Nissan vehicles with Automatic Transmissions (and as specified in all Nissan Owner's
and Service Manuals), it is especially important that the automatic transmission fluid (ATF) for the
3-speed RL3F01A automatic transmission (used on 1987-1989 Sentra and Pulsar XE models) be
maintained at the proper level.
CAUTION: Both overfilling and underfilling may cause damage to the transmission.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Steering Wheel: Customer Interest Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Vibration Correction
Classification: BR94-002 Section: Brake Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB94-012 Models:
All models Date: February 3, 1993
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
GENERAL INFORMATION:
Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in any vehicle when excessive
rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in thickness between the thickest and thinnest
points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy.
However, excessive Rotor Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is
the excessive rotor thickness variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is
described in more detail below.
POSSIBLE CAUSE OF BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
A brake judder/steering wheel shimmy incident may develop in any vehicle if the following series of
events occur:
Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Page 4779
Comments regarding PAG refrigerant oils:
^ PAG oil absorbs moisture from the air at an exceptionally fast rate, and moisture can damage the
A/C system.
Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing and Notes
Classification: EL93-028
Section: Electrical System
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB93-161
Models: All Models
Date: November 5, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS
Electronic control units (ECU's) control the operation of numerous electrical systems and
components on Nissan vehicles. The ECU's do this by either controlling the supply voltage or
ground path of an electrical component. The following is an explanation of how these systems work
and what precautions should be taken while performing diagnostic procedures.
Systems controlled by electronic control units have three (3) basic requirements, Inputs, Controller
Logic and Outputs.
Inputs
Sensors and switches provide electrical signals to the control unit. These signals are provided to
the ECU to inform it of various vehicle operating conditions. The electrical inputs can be either
analog or digital signals. However, all of the signals are converted to digital signals before the ECU
can process the information.
Control Logic
The ECU uses the electrical input signals to determine what the system should do. This decision
may be based on a few or many inputs. After processing the information the ECU will provide a
signal (output) to various electrical components.
Outputs
The signal that the ECU puts out to an electrical component (actuator) is called the output. These
output signals are what operate and control the system.
Digital Input Signals
Page 2135
Page 4837
Fig. 335b A/C switch & power steering oil pressure switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 3297
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4813
Page 4246
Some freeways slope to both the left and right from the center. When driving on a freeway that
slopes in both directions, a vehicle may exhibit a small amount of drift to the left when driving in the
left lane and a small amount of drift to the right when driving in the right lane.
This bulletin does not address road crown issues because they are not vehicle related, although
the customer may incorrectly perceive them to be.
Description/Definition of Steering Wheel "Off-center" Condition
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Page 608
Once you have set the target position, DO NOT reset it at anytime during the alignment process.
6. Begin the alignment procedure.
^ Follow all of the instructions for your particular equipment.
^ Refer to the Service Manual for alignment specifications.
If your equipment requires "rolling compensation". follow these additional tips:
^ DO NOT push or pull on the vehicle body.
IMPORTANT:
After performing "rolling compensation", DO NOT reset the target position.
When performing "caster sweep". follow these tips:
Page 2363
Fig. 303c Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 1437
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2987
Page 3029
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Air Register: Customer Interest A/C - White Flakes From Registers
Classification: HA93-014
Reference: NTB93-132
Date: September 12, 1993
WHITE FLAKES FROM VENTS
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Sentra (B13) and Altima (U13)
APPLIED DATE(S): Sentra built before 7/29/93 Altima built before 7/29/93
SERVICE INFORMATION Some air conditioning units may exhibit white flakes blowing from the
vents for a short time when the air conditioning is first turned on. The flakes are 1 mm or less in
diameter and fall on interior surfaces like a light snow. This incident can be resolved by replacing
the evaporator with an improved unit according to the procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Use the appropriate Service Manual instructions to replace the evaporator with the countermeasure
unit listed on the following page (there is no new part number -- check for the proper date stamp
indicated in the Parts Information section). When installing the new evaporator into the vehicle,
make sure that the evaporator case drain tube is correctly aligned to the drain hose and that there
are no obstructions.
NOTE:
To minimize the flakes remaining in the heater and air conditioning system, vacuum or blow out
with compressed air any visible flakes in the heater assembly before reinstalling the new
evaporator assembly. Warm soapy water may be used to clean the inside of the evaporator case,
heater case, and all ductwork.
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 4408
Radius Arm: Service and Repair Parallel and Radius Link
2WD SENTRA
When replacing parallel link and/or radius rod, refer to Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints, noting the
following:
1. Before removing parallel link attaching bolts, scribe alignment marks on toe adjusting pin and
frame.
2. When installing parallel link, install ones with green mark in front and ones with blue mark in
rear.
3. When installing radius rod rubber bushings and/or clamps, ensure proper direction.
Page 4012
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1827
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT
Located under the R.F. seat.
IGNITION WIRES
Routed from the ignition coil to the distributor cap and from the distributor, along side the valve
cover, to the spark plugs.
NUMBER ONE (1) SPARK PLUG
Located at the front of the cylinder bank.
IGNITION COIL
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
POWER TRANSISTOR
Located on the front of the L.H. strut tower.
THROTTLE SENSOR
Located on the throttle chamber at the butterfly.
Page 2024
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 2672
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Page 4935
There are four different customized letters for Nissan owners. The sample letter below, for 19861988 owners, is typical of the letter content and includes the information for the lifetime limited
warranty extension.
Letter # 1 - 1986-1988 Nissan Owners - 3PA
IMPORTANT SAFETY RECALL NOTICE
Dear Nissan Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the defect provisions of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Our records indicate that you are the owner of the Nissan vehicle indicated above. Nissan has
determined that some front seat belt release buttons in certain front lap/shoulder belts have broken,
or may break in the future. Your seat belt buckle release button is made of orange/red plastic and
is marked "Press." If the button breaks, pieces may fall into the buckle assembly. If this occurs, the
buckle may not operate properly, thereby creating a safety risk.
To prevent this problem from occurring, Nissan will replace the release button in both front seat
buckles free of charge, whether or not they are broken. The release buttons in the rear seat belt
buckles in passenger vehicles, and in the center buckle in pickup trucks equipped with a bench
seat are made of a different material, and they are not subject to this campaign.
In addition, Nissan is extending the warranty on all seat belts in your vehicle for the life of the
vehicle. See the enclosed warranty statement for details. This means that if any conditions covered
by the seat belt warranty are found at any time now or in the future, your Nissan dealer will correct
these conditions free of charge.
It is very important that you schedule your Nissan for button replacement as soon as possible. If
your seat belt buckle doesn't operate properly, you might not be able to use your seat belt until it is
repaired. Seat belt use is required by law in almost all states. Also, if you do not use your seat belt,
and you are in a collision, your chances of being killed or seriously injured are much higher than if
you are wearing your seat belt. Nissan urges you to use your seat belt at all times, and to contact
your dealer immediately for button replacement, especially if you notice that a button is broken, or if
you experience any problems with seat belt operation. Even if the buttons are not broken, they
should be replaced.
WHAT YOU SHOULD DO
Contact your Nissan dealer and make an appointment for replacement of your front seat belt
release buttons. The dealer will replace both front seat belt release buttons free of charge. This
replacement will take approximately one hour, but your dealer may require your vehicle for a longer
period of time based on their work schedule. Please bring this notice with you when you keep your
service appointment. Instructions have been sent to your Nissan dealer. If the dealer fails, or is
unable to make the necessary repairs free of charge, you may contact the National Consumer
Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90248-0191.
The toll free telephone number is 1-800-289-0628. If you reside in Hawaii, please call (808)
836-0888.
You may also contact the Administrator of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400
Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590 or call the toll-free auto safety hotline at
1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 202-366-0123.)
Thank you for your cooperation. We are indeed sorry for any inconvenience you might experience.
Page 3117
Dashpot: Testing and Inspection
1. The idle speed of the engine must be well tuned, and the engine warmed up to normal operation.
2. Turn the throttle valve by hand, and read the engine speed when the dash pot just touches the
adjusting screw.
Dash pot touch speed: 2,400 ± 400 rpm
3. If out of the specification, adjust it by turning the adjusting screw.
Page 5355
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 4814
Page 4428
Fig. 2 Rear Suspension (Part 2 Of 2). 4WD Models
Fig. 3 Rear Suspension.
Page 2717
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2644
Idle Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 896
Hose/Line HVAC: Testing and Inspection
1. A restricted suction line is indicated by low suction pressure at the compressor, low discharge
pressure and little or no cooling.
2. A restricted discharge line will usually cause the pressure relief valve to open.
3. A restricted liquid line will cause low suction and discharge pressures and little or no cooling.
Page 1743
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 3003
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Page 1813
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 4934
24. Return the seat to its original position. If the seat was removed, check the seat track locking
operation. Both seat rails should latch securely in the full forward, middle and rearward positions.
25. Inspect the vehicle's interior to ensure it is clean and free of damage. Also make sure the floor
mats are positioned properly if they were removed.
Vehicle Specific Information
VEHICLE SPECIFIC INFORMATION
200 SX (1986.5-88) Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch.
Seat bolt torque 15-20 ft-lbs (21-26 Nm, 2.1-2.7kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
240SX (1989-91)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Seat mounting nut torque 19-24 ft-lbs (25-32
Nm, 2.6-3.3 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
TRUCK (1988-91)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
Note
The center seat belt position buckle on bench seat equipped trucks is not affected by this
campaign.
PATHFINDER (1988-91)
The connector for the seat belt buckle is located under the center console and can be pulled out
from under the console by gently lifting the edge of the console where the wires go under the edge.
Always replace the connector after repairing the seat belt buckle.
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
VAN (C22) (1987-90)
Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs (35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA (1987-89, except Coupe)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 26-34 ft-lbs
(35.8-45.6 Nm, 3.7-4.7 kg-m)
SENTRA Coupe (1989-90)
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA Sedan/Station Wagon (1990)
Remove center console to disconnect the seat belt buckle switch. Also remove the two rear seat
mounting bolts to put slack in the carpet to make the switch wire routing easier.
Seat bolt torque 18-23 ft-lbs (25-31 Nm, 2.5-3.2 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
SENTRA 2-Door (1991)
Seat bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs (43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m) Buckle mounting bolt torque 32-41 ft-lbs
(43-55 Nm, 4.4-5.6 kg-m)
Sample Owner's Letter
SAMPLE OWNER'S LETTER
Page 412
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3840
Improperly routed or improperly clamped harness can become pinched during accessory
installation. Vehicle vibration can aggravate a harness which is routed along a bracket or near a
screw behind or below the dash.
Engine Compartment
There are several reasons a vehicle or engine vibration could cause an electrical complaint. Some
of the things to check for are:
A. Connectors which are inaccessible for diagnosis probing.
B. Connectors which may not fully be seated.
C. Wiring harness which are not long enough and are being stressed during engine vibrations or
rocking.
D. Wires laying across brackets or moving components.
E. Loose dirty or corroded ground wires.
F. Wires routed too close to hot components.
To inspect components underhood, start by verifying the integrity of ground connections. (Refer to
the GROUND INSPECTION described later.) Once you have assured the system is properly
grounded check for loose connections by gently shaking the wiring or component as previously
explained. Using the wiring diagrams in the service manual, inspect the wiring for continuity.
Under Seating Area's
If a harness is not clamped properly or has too much slack, vehicle vibration could cause the wiring
to become pinched by seat components such as slide guides. If the wiring runs under seating
areas inspect wiring routing for possible damage or pinching.
2. Heat Sensitive
If owner indicates the problem occurs during hot weather or after the car has sat for a short period
of time, you will want to check for a heat sensitive
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Filler Cap: Testing and Inspection
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
2. Inhale air through the cap. A slight resistance accompanied by valve clicks indicates that valve is
in good mechanical condition. Note also that, by
further inhaling air, the resistance should be disappeared with valve clicks.
3. If valve is clogged, or if no resistance is felt, replace cap as an assembly.
Page 3444
Power Transistor: Testing and Inspection
Power Transistor Test
Using an ohm meter, check for continuity between terminals as per the image. Replace power
transistor if it fails the above tests.
Page 2012
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 4429
3. Set strut assembly in vise then loosen piston rod locknut. Loosen no not remove.
4. Compress coil spring using a suitable coil spring compression tool.
5. Remove piston rod locknut.
6. Remove spring components from strut.
7. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
Fig. 6 Spring Installation Direction. 1987-90 Models
Fig. 7 Spring Installation Direction. 1991-92 Models
Fig. 8 Installing Coil Spring. 1987-90 Models
a. Install coil spring in correct direction, Figs. 6 and 7. b. Position coil spring in lower spring seat as
shown, Figs. 7 and 8.
Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service and Repair" before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 75
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
300ZX (Z32) VG30DETT
Page 294
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 2181
Idle Speed: Adjustments
Midpoint of range given is the preferred setting speed.
1981-83 L28 Turbo, 1983 E15 Turbo:
With engine at operating temperature, race several times and return to idle. Disconnect idle control
valve and check speed against specified value.
1984-87 E16 2V Federal:
With engine at operating temperature, disconnect vacuum control modulator harness. Race engine
several times and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect vacuum
control modulator harness. Restart engine, race several times, and check idle speed against
specified value.
1987-90 E16 FI, GA16; 1989-90 KA24:
With engine at operating temperature disconnect throttle sensor harness connector. Start engine
and set idle to specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine.
Verify that idle speed is within checking speed. Turn on AC and verify that idle increases to
specified value.
1984-89 VG30 Turbo, 1987-89 CA16, CA18 DOHC:
With engine at operating temperature, turn ignition off and disconnect automatic air control (AAC)
valve harness. Start engine and set idle speed to specified value. Switch engine off and reconnect
harness. Restart engine and check idle speed against specified value. Turn AC on and verify that
speed-up is at specified value. All engines, turn AC on and verify that speed-up speed is specified
value.
1987-88 CA18 Turbo, 1987-89 CA20 Stanza:
Disconnect throttle valve and automatic air control valve harness. Start engine and adjust idle to
specified setting speed. Turn engine off, reconnect harness and restart engine. Verify that idle is at
specified checking speed.
1989-90 VG30 Maxima:
Turn diagnostic connector on ECU fully clockwise and adjust idle to specified value. Verify that idle
is at specified checking speed. 1990 300ZX:
Attach inductive clamp to loop wire on power transistor behind upper radiator hose. Set idle to
specified value.
Page 799
Idle Speed: Specifications
Base Idle Speed Controlled Idle Speed
Adjusted with Throttle Sensor disconnected.
Manual Transmission 750 +/- 25 rpm 800 +/- 100 rpm
Automatic Transmission 670 +/- 25 rpm 700 +/- 100 rpm
In "D" Position.
Page 4161
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Service and Repair
Multi-Function Thermal Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The thermo control temperature sensor is a solid state thermistor connected to the evaporator core
and connected to the control through the
wiring harness. If necessary to replace sensor, refer to ``Evaporator and Expansion Valve,
Replace.''
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove screws securing glove box, then remove glove box.
3. Disconnect wiring harness connector to thermo switch, then remove screws securing switch to
air intake housing and remove switch.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 3536
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Recommended Fluid Nissan ATF Or DEXRON ATF
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications System Capacity
System Capacity
Refrigerant Capacity 1.8-2.0 lb (US)
Refrigerant Type R-12
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Model RN4F31A 5.75 pt (US)
Model RS4F31A 5.875 pt (US)
Page 4791
Comments regarding leak detector use:
^ Existing R-12 leak detectors currently will not detect R-134a.
^ Many R-134a leak detectors will detect R-12; check with the equipment manufacturer.
^ Always refer to and follow the equipment manufacturers recommendations when operating leak
detectors.
Comments regarding weight scale use:
^ If the scale allows electronic control of the flow of refrigerant through the scale, (i.e. internal
solenoid valves) be certain that the hose fitting size is 1/2"-16 ACME, and that no refrigerant other
than R-134a (along with only specified lubricant) have been used with the scale.
Charging Cylinder
^ The use of a charging cylinder is not recommended because:
^ The refrigerant may be vented into the air from the top valve of cylinder when filling the cylinder
with refrigerant.
^ The accuracy of a charging cylinder is generally less than that of an electronic scale or of quality
recycle/recharge equipment.
Service Procedures
^ The service procedures for R-134a A/C systems are basically the same as for R-12 A/C systems,
however, the following should always be kept in mind:
^ Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose, and
throat. Use only approved recovery/recycling equipment to discharge R-134a systems.
^ If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service work.
^ R-134a and R-12 A/C components are not interchangeable. Cleaning of used (in service)
components for use with another type of refrigerant and/or lubricant is not an acceptable practice,
and may result in A/C system failure.
^ Always use the proper PAG oil when servicing an R-134a A/C system. The Nissan part number
for the appropriate PAG compressor oil can be found on the A/C specification label in the engine
compartment, and also in the Factory Service Manual, and on the label on the compressor. These
oils are only available from your Nissan Parts Department.
^ When leak checking an R-134a system, be certain that you are using a detector which will detect
R-134a.
^ As mentioned previously in this bulletin, the R-134a PAG lubricants absorb moisture; PAG oil
containers and A/C components containing PAG oil must remain tightly sealed until ready for use.
^ Unlike R-12 systems, R-134a systems do not exhibit a "clear sight glass", even when properly
charged. For this reason, the R-134a A/C systems have no sight glass.
^ With R-134a systems it is important to properly control the amount of refrigerant charged into the
system during system charging. A charging machine or weight scale must always be used during
charging for proper charge determination.
^ Questions regarding R-12 or R-134a should be addressed to your Regional Service Staff or the
FIXS Hotline.
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Heater: Customer Interest Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve
(ISCV) Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
Page 31
Ignition Relay: Locations Ignition Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88015 Date: 880825
Campaign - Check Engine Light
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel &
EF&EC88-015; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-098 Models:
1988 Pulsar SE & Stanza (California)
Date: August 25, 1988 SPECIAL SERVICE CAMPAIGN
CHECK ENGINE LIGHT
1988 PULSAR SE & STANZA SEDAN
Introduction, Dealer Responsibitily and Parts Information
All 1988 California model vehicles are equipped with a Check Engine Light which will come ON if
the engine control unit (E.C.U.) detects improper operation of a monitored system. Under certain
driving conditions, the light may come ON and the E.C.U. may have a malfunction code for the
E.G.R. system (Code 32) even though the system is operating properly. A special sub-harness has
been produced to correct this incident, and a Special Service Campaign is being conducted to
install this harness.
All owners of the affected vehicles will be notified by letter to bring their vehicles to a Nissan
dealership for installation of the harness. The harness will be sent to the owner along with the
letter.
APPLIED MODELS: 1988 Pulsar SE (N13) (California) with Manual Transmissions 1988 Stanza
(T12) (California) with-Manual Transmissions
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY INVOLVED: Approximately 2,100
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
1. The dealership is responsible for installing the applicable sub-harness on each vehicle which
falls within the range of this campaign. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles on dealership used car lots.
FIGURE 1
2. The dealer must install the underhood label (Figure 1) next to the existing Emission Control
Information label after the sub-harness has been installed. A supply of labels has been included
with this Bulletin and additional labels are available through the Regional Office.
FIGURE 2
3. On Pulsars only, the dealership must also install a label on the Electronic Control Unit (E.C.U.) to
alert service personnel that a trouble code may
Page 5375
FIGURE 1
4. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
NOTE: Installation of this sub-harness may result in a self diagnosis code of 35 appearing during
future system diagnosis. This code is now normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
Stanza Modification Procedure
FIGURE 5
1. Disconnect the E.G.R. temperature sensor connector (24F) (Figure 5).
2. Install the countermeasure sub-harness between the E.C.C.S. harness and the exhaust gas
temperature sensor connector.
FIGURE 1
3. Apply the campaign completion label (Figure 1) to the underside of the hood.
Warranty Instructions and Claim and Owner Letter Information
WARRANTY INSTRUCTIONS
A Service Campaign Claim may be entered via DATANET. The Service Advisor must make certain
that the owner's name, address, vehicle identification number, and PNC are listed correctly on the
repair order to ensure accurate, readable information for claim submission. Dealers who are not yet
on DATANET should submit a standard S-1-S Warranty Claim.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Page 4041
d. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 ten times to complete the burnishing process.
4. Follow-up to ensure customer satisfaction, safety, and proper brake performance.
^ Confirm the procedures described in steps 2 - 4 above have been strictly followed.
ROTOR INDEXING
When installing a new rotor, a rotor that has been surfaced off the car, or a rotor that has been
removed for any reason, use the following indexing procedure to ensure the minimum amount of
rotor run-out.
1. Make sure the rotor is fully contacting the hub. Clean the rotor-to-hub surface if it is rusty.
NOTE:
For cleaning the hub surface, specifically around the wheel studs, it is recommended to use the
Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit # J-42450-A, which can be ordered from Nissan TECH-MATE.
2. Install the rotor and all lug nuts. Tighten the lug nuts to 40 ft-lbs (for this indexing process only).
3. Place a reference mark on the rotor and hub.
4. Measure rotor run-out with a dial indicator. If the run-out is above limit continue with step 5.
For more detail of the run-out limit refer to the ESM.
5. Remove the lug nuts and shift the position of the rotor one lug clockwise, then reinstall the lug
nuts and torque to 40 ft-lbs (again, for this indexing process only).
^ Repeat step 4 and 5 until the rotor is positioned with the least amount of runout.
6. After you find the position with the least amount of runout, if the runout is still more than the limit,
you'll need to turn (resurface) the new rotors using the ProCut(TM) PFM Series on-car brake lathe.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Please reference the current Nissan "Warranty Flat Rate Manual" and submit your claim(s) using
the Operation Code (Op Code) or combination of Op Codes that best describes the operations
performed.
Disclaimer
Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Reach under instrument panel and disconnect multi-pin connector from rear of switch.
3. Depress two switch retaining clips and push switch out of panel.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 5277
The table provides a brief description of some types of paint contamination you may encounter.
Select a 2' x 2' test section to perform the following Contamination Test Removal.
C. RE-Wash
C. Re-Wash with detergent and water solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching
the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution
to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the
terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt. Replace the towel with a clean one once it
becomes soiled. Rinse with a spray of clean water. Repeat up to four times.
D. Clean
D. Clean with Nissan Bug and Tar remover using a clean terry cloth towel and gentle pressure.
Repeat up to four times.
E. Applying Finish Kare
E. Apply Finish Kare to remove iron particles and acids. See procedure below:
Caution:
Attempting to buff iron particles will cause severe scratching.
1. Apply Finish Kare # 1119, solution, keeping it wet for 4-5 minutes. To avoid scratching the finish,
do not rub, gently move the solution around with light pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry
before rinsing.
2. After the wash and rinse, gently dry the contaminated surfaces with the terry cloth towels to
remove the majority of the water. Use gentle pressure
Page 291
9. Use compressed air to remove any metal debris from inside the boss threads.
CAUTION:
DO NOT perform this step if the procedure is being done on the vehicle (Method #1). Doing so may
cause metal debris to enter the engine cylinders.
10. If metal debris remains trapped in the boss threads, use a spiral nylon brush to remove it.
11. Spray the boss threads with rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
12. Run a thread chaser through the boss to clean the threads.
^ Use Kent Moore part number J-43897-18 or J43897-12.
Page 4586
5. Check bearing preload as follows:
a. Place press load onto wheel hub shaft (approximately 5 tons). b. Spin knuckle several times in
both directions. c. Ensure wheels bearings operate smoothly.
Installation
Reverse removal procedure to install.
Page 255
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Change & Oil Filter Replacement
Classification: Section:
EM88-013 Engine Mechanical
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-078 Models: All Date: May 19, 1988 OIL CHANGE & OIL
FILTER REPLACEMENT
SERVICE INFORMATION
It is essential that all vehicles have the engine oil and oil filter replaced at the recommended
mileage/time intervals as stated in the maintenance section of the appropriate Owner's/Service
Manuals. If the service interval is extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time,
the oil will continue to oxidize (increase in viscosity) and result in the formation of sludge.
Excessive sludge may restrict the flow of oil to internal engine components resulting in accelerated
wear and/or severe engine damage.
If the service interval has been extended beyond the manufacturer's recommended mileage/time
interval, inspect the oil pan drain hole for any evidence of oil sludge build-up (i.e. oil will not drain
out). If a significant amount is present, sludge removal is recommended so that the fresh oil can
circulate adequately through the engine parts. In severe cases of oil sludge build-up, it may be
necessary to disassemble the engine in order to properly clear the oil passages.
PARTS INFORMATION
Page 3316
Page 2434
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Page 267
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 120
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 3413
Ignition Cable: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2403
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Antitheft - Security System Trouble Diagnosis
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-011 Date: 960117
Antitheft - Security System Trouble Diagnosis
Classification: EL96-003
Reference: NTB96-011
Date: January 17, 1996
SENTRA/2OOSX VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM (VSS) TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS GUIDE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Sentra (B14) All 2OOSX (B14)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This service bulletin contains information regarding the VSS in the 1995 and later Sentra and
2OOSX. It details troubleshooting and diagnosing incidents that might arise with the VSS.
PARTS INFORMATION
VSS Service Parts Listing
Table of Contents
System Description
System Operational Check
Diagnostic Procedure # 1 No Response from remote control
Diagnostic Procedure # 2 Doors do not lock with remote control
Diagnostic Procedure # 3 Doors do not unlock with remote control
Diagnostic Procedure # 4 System will not passive arm
Diagnostic Procedure # 5 Clearance lights do not flash
Diagnostic Procedure # 6 No sound from siren
Diagnostic Procedure # 7 Console switch LED will not flash
Diagnostic Procedure # 8 Interior light does not operate (with unlock or alarm)
Page 2657
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2789
^ Titania 02 sensors use the smaller 12 mm diameter tool: J-43897-12.
3. Make sure that the tool is clean of all debris from prior usage.
4. Liberally apply the anti-seize compound, specified in the Parts Information section of this bulletin,
into the flutes (see Figure 1) of the thread repair tool.
CAUTION:
Only use the anti-seize material specified. Other materials may chemically damage the 02 sensor.
5. Carefully screw the thread repair tool into the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic
converter by hand. It needs to be installed until the tool's taper is fully inserted within the internal
thread of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
CAUTION:
Ensure the tool goes in straight.
6. After the thread has been adequately started by hand, a tool such as a socket or wrench can be
used to continue the removal of the material.
^ When only light removal of material is needed, screw the thread repair tool in until the cutting
surface of the mating surface shave cylinder (see Figure 1) touches the sealing surface for the 02
sensor. Then turn it one full turn further.
^ When there is a lot of material to be removed, occasionally back off the tool to remove
accumulated material from around the tool before continuing.
CAUTION:
Do not expect the tool to screw in to an absolute stop. The tool's spring and mating surface shave
cylinder will rotate until the spring is completely compressed.
7. Wipe the threads of the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter to remove any
debris or anti-seize before replacing the 02 sensor.
NOTE:
If the 02 sensor could not be removed or there is permanent damage to the internal threads, it will
be necessary to replace the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
8. Install the 02 sensor and confirm that there is no exhaust leak from the mating surface of the 02
sensor to the exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter. If there is leakage, then there
may have been permanent damage to internal threads. This would require replacement of the
exhaust tube, exhaust manifold, or catalytic converter.
9. Completely clean the anti-seize compound and metal debris from the tool to ready it for its next
use.
PARTS INFORMATION
Testing and Inspection
Fig. 336 Neutral/clutch/inhibitor switch circuit diagnosis.
Page 1543
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2140
Page 1788
Engine Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Wiring Diagram
Page 4380
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3.
Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip on
the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid
wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4.
Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation
7.
Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation
8.
Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10.
Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based cleaners
degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the rotor
surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 2124
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
4WD Transfer Control System Components.
On Shift Handle
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-009 Date: 100119
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Classification: EM09-015
Reference: NTB10-009
Date: January 19, 2010
REMOVAL PROCEDURE FOR SEIZED EXHAUST SENSOR
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
If an exhaust sensor is seized in the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube, perform the procedure
described in this bulletin to remove the sensor and prevent unnecessary replacement of the
exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
In most cases this procedure is successful. This is because the threads of the exhaust sensors are
made of a softer material than the part they thread into on the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
NOTE:
The replacement of exhaust manifolds/catalysts/front tubes for stripped exhaust sensor threads
may not be considered a warrantable expense.
This procedure can be performed by two methods:
Method #1 - If the Sensor Can Be Easily Accessed
^ The procedure can be performed on the vehicle.
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube will not have to be removed.
Method #2 - If the Sensor Cannot Be Easily Accessed
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube must be removed from the vehicle.
^ The procedure will be performed with the part clamped in a vice.
Method #2 is described in this bulletin. Method #1 is the same as Method #2 except that it is
performed on the vehicle.
Service Procedure
Rust Penetrant
Recommended rust penetrants to be used in this procedure:
Page 4298
2. Position vehicle on the front turn plates as follows:
^ Stop vehicle just behind the turn plates.
^ Center the turn plates to the tires.
^ Move the vehicle onto the turn plates by turning/pushing the rear wheel.
DO NOT push/pull on the vehicle body.
Page 2954
Page 4929
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
Page 4286
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
Replace the tire(s) or use known good tires from another vehicle for all road tests and diagnostics
in this bulletin.
^ Make sure tire pressure is set to the correct specification.
1. Install the following measuring tools on the vehicle:
^ Steering Wheel Offset Gauge
^ Road Crown Gauge
NOTE:
Refer to "Special Tool" for a description of these tools and an explanation of their use.
2. Obtain a watch with a second hand (preferably a stopwatch) to use during the road test.
3. Take the vehicle for a road test and confirm the customers concern.
^ Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line at a preferred speed of 60
mph.
Page 752
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 590
^ Toe-Out is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the rear (Figure 1b).
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Toe should be the last alignment specification adjusted. Refer to the Front Axle (FA) and Rear
Axle (RA) sections of the appropriate Service Manual to determine the proper locations to adjust
the front and rear Toe.
2. Toe should be equal, side-to-side.
3. Toe-In
When the specification is labeled "Toe-In" and dimensions are negative numbers (ie: -6 to -2 mm),
the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 2).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-In specification = Toe-In wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-In specification =
Toe-out wheel setting.
Toe-Out
EFI Control Relay
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Locations EFI Control Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4930
IMPORTANT
Both the driver's and passenger buckles must be repaired or replaced as a pair to ensure color
match as determined by using the decision tree as illustrated in this bulletin.
Note
This campaign does not include the rear seat belts of any vehicles, or the center belt in the Truck
equipped with a bench seat. Passive front shoulder belts are also not affected. The release buttons
in these buckles are made of a different material.
IMPORTANT
Please review the videotape that was previously sent to you. It will give a demonstration of the
repair procedure.
INSPECTION OF THE RETRACTOR MECHANISM
The retractor should be checked for proper operation and the webbing should be inspected for
fraying or chafing. If the webbing retractor does not
Page 4256
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 682
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 5385
Enter the DATANET claim, or type the S-1-S claim using the following information:
Dear Nissan Owner:
Our records show that you are the owner of a 1988 Nissan Stanza or Pulsar SE equipped with a
manual transmission. Nissan is very concerned about maintaining the highest level of owner
satisfaction with our vehicles. We have discovered that the "check engine" light (illustrated below)
may come on while driving your vehicle when nothing is actually wrong with the engine.
The "check engine" light is part of a system on your vehicle to identify problems in the emission
control system. If the light comes on, your vehicle is still driveable, but you should schedule your
vehicle for service at a Nissan dealer as soon as possible.
Nissan has developed a modification for your vehicle which will ensure that the "check engine" light
only comes on if there is a problem. Any Nissan dealership can make this modification to your
vehicle. You may make an appointment now to have this modification done or you may wait and
have it serviced if the "check engine" light comes on. This service is free of charge whether you
have it done now or if the light comes on at a later time. For your convenience, we have enclosed
the electrical connector which the dealer will need to service your vehicle. We suggest you keep it
in your vehicle so that it will be available if needed.
Also attached are new insert pages for your vehicle's Owner's Manual. Please attach the inserts to
pages 1-5 and 1-6, replacing the information already there.
If you have any questions concerning this letter, please contact the Consumer Affairs Office at the
appropriate Nissan Regional facility listed in your vehicle's Warranty Information Booklet.
Please bring this notice with you when you keep your service appointment as it contains
pre-printed claim information which will assist the dealer. If the dealer fails, or is unable to make the
necessary repairs free of charge, you should immediately contact the Consumer Affairs Office as
stated above. Or, you may contact the National Consumer Affairs Office, Nissan Motor Corporation
in U.S.A. at P.O. Box 191, Gardena, California 90247. The telephone number is 1(800) NISSAN1.
This is a voluntary program. In some states you may have other rights pursuant to law. We are
sorry for any inconvenience this may cause you. Thank you very much for purchasing a Nissan and
we hope to keep you very satisfied with your car.
Page 719
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 219
Fan Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove A/C-heater control as outlined in ``Control
Assembly, Replace.''
2. Remove screws securing switch to control and remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install and adjust control.
Page 1765
Tires - Rotation Requirement
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Rotation Requirement
Models 1987-88 Sentra Wagon & 1986-88 Stanza Wagon
Section Wheel & Tire
Classification WT87-005
Bulletin No. TS87-188
Date December 21, 1987
TIRE ROTATION REQUIREMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra Wagon with four-wheel-drive 1986-88 Stanza Wagon with
four-wheel-drive
SERVICE INFORMATION
On all Sentra and Stanza Wagon four-wheel-drive models, it is very important that regular tire
rotation be performed according to the maintenance schedules in the appropriate service manuals.
On these vehicles, difficulty in shifting out of the four-wheel-drive mode could occur if the front tires
are allowed to wear down more than the rear tires. A difference in tire circumference, front to rear,
causes a strain at the driveline between front and rear axles.
Page 977
Comments regarding liquid tanks:
^ For R-134a, the sight glass has been deleted. Refer to the service procedures section of this
bulletin for additional information regarding the refrigerant charge determination. Pressure switches
are not interchangeable between R-12 and R-134a systems.
Page 1508
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # EF88013 Date: 880616
Fuel - Update For Diagnostic Procedure For Improper Idle
Classification: EF&EC88-013; Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-087
Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar
Date: June 16, 19881
E16i IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
APPLIED MODELS: 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon (B12) 1988 Sentra (all models) (B12)
1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
Page 495
9. Depress the seat belt release button and release the spring using a small screwdriver.
WHITE PLASTIC EJECTOR BUCKLES
9a. These buckles were installed on 1986.5 and some 1987 models. The basic button replacement
procedure is the same except for the button removal procedure. When the button is removed there
is no spring attached to the button, Instead of lifting up and pulling to remove the button, it is
necessary to push down so the retaining tabs are free of the buckle.
Note
Some 1987 200SX (S12) models may be equipped with both a white ejector plate buckle and a
black ejector plate buckle on the same vehicle. This needs to be identified prior to starting repairs
so the correct parts can be ordered.
10. Remove the button and spring by applying a slight upward force while pulling the button out of
the buckle assembly while holding down the spring guide to prevent it from moving from its original
position. A new spring is provided with the new button kit (except on the white ejector mechanism
buckles, which do not use this spring).
11. Inspect the buckle assembly for dirt, dust, or other foreign material. If the buckle is
contaminated with items such as soft drink, juice or other sticky material, replace both buckle
assemblies. Do not attempt to clean the buckle.
12. If the buckle passes this inspection, remove any dust from the buckle using dry compressed air.
Page 1549
Idle Speed: Description and Operation
Idle Speed Control
The idle speed is controlled by the E.C.C.S. control unit, corresponding to the engine operating
conditions. The E.C.C.S. control unit senses the engine condition and determines the best idle
speed at each water temperature and gear position. The control unit then sends an electronic
signal corresponding to the difference between the best idle speed and the actual idle speed to the
A.A.C. valve.
INPUT SIGNAL AND AIR FLOW
The opening of the I.S.C. valve is controlled by an ON-duty signal fed to the opening solenoid.
(When the opening solenoid is "ON", the closing solenoid is "OFF", and vice versa.)
The longer the ON-duty signal on the opening solenoid, the greater the I.S.C. valve opening and
the greater the amount of airflow.
Locations
Neutral/Park (NP) Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3023
1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Brakes - Ammco On Car Brake Lathe Operating
Guidelines
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Ammco On Car Brake Lathe Operating
Guidelines
Classification: BR92-004
Section: Brake
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-062
Models: All models
Date: August 18, 1992
AMMCO ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE OPERATING GUIDELINES
APPLIED MODEL: All models
SERVICE INFORMATION
To ensure the best possible surface finish and least amount of run-out and rotor thickness variation
when using the Ammco on-car brake lathe, the following guidelines should be observed.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Before mounting the brake lathe on the vehicle ensure the following:
1. The V-way between the carriage and carriage jib must be clean and adjusted properly (see
Operation Manual for adjustment procedure). Wipe off sliding surfaces with a soft cloth after each
use.
2. The cutters and cutting bits must be tight in their mounts and positioned properly. Change cutting
bits when they become dull.
3. When securing the adjustable mounting brackets to the caliper mount/knuckle the mounting
surfaces must be smooth and free of burrs.
4. Make sure the adjustable mounting brackets are securely mounted to caliper mount/knuckle.
There should be no movement between the cutting tool and the caliper mount/knuckle.
Rotor Driving Unit Before using the drive unit ensure the following:
Page 4207
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
4. Make sure the "turn plates" and "slide" plates are in good working order:
^ The surface of the front turn plates must be level with (the same height as) the rack surface.
If height is not the same; have the equipment repaired before performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the front turn plates:
> Do not wobble (no up/down movement).
> Operate (slide and turn) smoothly in all directions.
If there is any issue with the turn plate operation - have the equipment repaired before performing
any alignments.
Page 580
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 3036
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4684
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
When installing new condenser, it is not necessary to add refrigerant oil when there are no signs of
a major oil leak, except on the Sentra. When installing new condenser on Sentra that shows no
sign of oil leak, add .3 oz. of new refrigerant oil. On all models that show signs of major oil leak,
except 200SX, 300ZX or Sentra, add 1.7 oz. of new refrigerant oil. On Sentra and 300ZX that show
signs of major oil leak, add 2 oz. of new refrigerant oil.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and discharge system refrigerant.
2. Remove radiator grille.
3. Disconnect refrigerant lines at condenser, plugging all openings.
4. Remove condenser cooling fan.
5. Remove radiator attaching bolts and nuts.
6. Remove condenser attaching bolts, then the condenser while pushing radiator toward engine.
7. Reverse procedure to install, evacuate and recharge system, then check for leaks.
Page 4927
PARTS INFORMATION
Note
Parts information for other affected models will be supplied at a later date.
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Page 1145
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power steering high pressure tube and
detects the power steering load, sending the load signal to the E.C.U. The E.C.U. then sends the
idle-up signal to the I.S.C. valve.
Page 1722
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 4 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) GA16DE 5 SPEED M/T
SENTRA (B13) SR20DE
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Page 343
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit.
Page 3000
Page 1330
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Drive Belts Inspection
1. Inspect for cracks, fraying, wear or oil adhesion. If necessary, replace with new one.
The belts should not touch the bottom of the pulley groove.
2. Inspect drive belt deflections by pushing on the belt midway between pulleys.
Adjust if belt deflections exceed the limit.
Inspect drive belt deflections when engine is cold. If engine is hot, wait 30 minutes or more and
check deflections.
Page 4053
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect brake lines from master cylinder. Plug lines and master cylinder ports.
2. Remove master cylinder retaining nuts and the master cylinder.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 5347
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-152 Date: 981121
Tires - Vibration, Diagnosis & Out of Round Measurement
Classification: WT88-003
Reference: TS88-152
Date: November 21, 1988
TIRE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
Page 4367
Due to limited clearance, this machine cannot be used on the rear rotors of some vehicles. To
resolve this issue, two (2) methods of repair are identified in the flow chart. Use this chart, as
appropriate, when performing brake pad or rotor service.
GENERAL BRAKE REPAIR GUIDELINES
To properly perform brake repairs, it is important to observe the following.
1. Do not tighten wheel lug nuts with an impact wrench. Uneven or high torque applied to the lug
bolts may distort the brake rotor and hub, resulting in increased rotor run-out.
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3. Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip
on the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Diagnostic Flow Chart
Road Test
Determine if the vehicle has a pull or steering wheel off-center issue that requires repair.
IMPORTANT:
^ If the vehicle has any tire issues, such as:
> Tires that are different sizes (except when specified from the factory)
> Significant difference in the amount of wear between any of the tires
> Any other tire irregularity or damage to any tire
A/C - Refrigerant Leaks From Connections
A/C Coupler O-ring: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Leaks From Connections
Classification: HA09-003
Reference: NTB09-099
Date: September 25, 2009
A/C SYSTEM O-RING SEAL LEAKS
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles with A/C system
IF YOU CONFIRM
A refrigerant leak at a refrigerant pipe/hose joint location,
NOTE:
Follow the leak detection information in the Service Manual to determine the source of refrigerant
leaks.
ACTIONS
NOTE:
The O-ring seal is the most common cause of a refrigerant leak at an A/C joint.
1. Inspect the metal surfaces of the pipe/hose joint for damage or contamination.
NOTE:
Do not replace a refrigerant pipe, hose, or other A/C component if an o-ring seal will solve the leak
incident, if it should occur.
2. If no damage is found to the joint metal surfaces, replace the O-ring seal.
CAUTION:
^ When replacing O-ring seals, use lint-free gloves,
^ Make sure no foreign material is introduced into the system when the joint is open.
^ Apply A/C oil to the O-ring before installation.
^ After recharging the system, recheck for leaks.
PARTS INFORMATION
Reference an electronic parts catalog (FAST or equivalent) for any needed parts.
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Reference the current Nissan Warranty Flat Rate Manual and use the correct coding for repairs
performed.
Page 467
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
A/C - Refrigerant Oil Recommendations
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Oil Recommendations
Classification: HA91-002
Section: Heater And Air Conditioner
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB91-014
Models: ALL MODELS
Date: FEBRUARY 14, 1991
A/C SYSTEM REFRIGERANT OIL
APPLIED MODEL: All Models equipped with A/C System
SERVICE INFORMATION:
When service repairs on a Nissan A/C system require that lubricant be added to the system, please
be advised that the recommended refrigerant oil for all Nissan A/C systems is SUNISO 5GS. This
oil applies to all rotary, lateral piston, and variable displacement Nissan A/C compressors.
SUNISO 5GS is available throughout the continental U.S. The name and location of the nearest
SUNISO 5GS distributor may be obtained by contacting the Virginia KMP Corporation at
1-800-527-7960.
Page 4022
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
BRAKE JUDDER
^ Brake Judder is caused by rotor thickness variation and/or rotor run out.
Rotor Thickness Variation: When the inner and outer surface of the rotor are not flat and not
parallel, the brake pads will travel in and out as they follow the low and high spots on the rotor (see
Figure 1).
Rotor Run Out: If the brake rotor is not true to the hub center, the brake pads contact one point on
each side of the rotor with each wheel rotation, even if the brakes are not applied. Over time, this
point contact will cause the rotor to wear more in these areas and cause rotor thickness variation
(see Figure 2).
^ This motion of the brake pads is transferred through the caliper pistons and is felt in the brake
pedal as a pulsation. In severe cases it can also cause a back and forth oscillation in the steering
wheel.
Vehicle Storage:
^ If the vehicle is not operated for periods of time, the area of the brake rotors not covered by the
brake pads will rust.
^ The friction characteristics between the rusted and un-rusted areas of the rotor braking surface
will be different.
^ This difference may cause brake judder at low and/or high mileage, even after the rust wears off.
Lug Nut Overtorque:
^ Another contributor of brake judder is lug nut overtorque. This can occur if the lug nuts are over
tightened, especially with an air impact
Page 5017
Parts Information: Antenna Rod
Page 683
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3579
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
PARTS INFORMATION
CLAIMS INFORMATION
Page 1617
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Anti-Freeze Ethylene Glycol Base
Page 628
DEFINITION: Partial (Figure 6A) or complete (Figure 6B) separation between the rubber and the
tire cord, or between the layers of the tire cord.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge on the tire shoulder, and a longitudinal crack on the bottom of the grooves,
possibly accompanied by a break through the rubber surface. Both are usually accompanied by
localized wear in the tread above the separation.
Chunks of Missing Tread
Damage Description: Chunks of missing tread
NISSAN CODE: 7D
DEFINITION: Partial peeling of new tread (Figure 7).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tearing off, partial peeling or chipping of the tire tread. (NOTE: Tread rubber chipping
caused by off-road driving is not warrantable.)
Tread Cracking
Damage Description: Tread Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7A
Page 2634
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
The exhaust gas sensor, which is placed into the exhaust manifold, monitors the amount of oxygen
in the exhaust gas. The sensor has a closed-end tube made of ceramic zirconia. The outer surface
of the tube is exposed to exhaust gas, and the inner surface to atmosphere. The zirconia of the
tube compares the oxygen density of exhaust gas with that of atmosphere, and generates
electricity. In order to improve generating power of the zirconia, its tube is coated with platinum.
The voltage is approximately 1V in a richer condition of the mixture ratio than the ideal air fuel ratio,
while approximately 0V in leaner conditions. The radical change from 1V to 0V occurs at around
the ideal mixture ratio. In this way, the exhaust gas sensor detects the amount of oxygen in the
exhaust gas and sends the signal of approximately 1V or 0V to the E.C.U.
Page 3155
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 1214
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "FRONT SUSPENSION / COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND REPAIR PROCEDURES /
AXLE BEARING AND KNUCKLE" before making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 4583
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Note: Preload adjustment of wheel bearing is not necessary.
Rear Wheel Bearing
1. Tighten wheel bearing lock nut to:
137 - 188 ft lbs (186 - 255 Nm)
2. Check bearing for smooth operation.
3. Check axial end play. Should be:
.002in (0.05mm) or less
Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2094
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3375
Page 716
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1436
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision Damage
Wheel Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Bearing Collision
Damage
Classification: FA10-006
Reference: NTB10-126
Date: October 21, 2010
WHEEL BEARING COLLISION DAMAGE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
Impacts to wheel bearings (such as a collision or other suspension damage) may create slight
indents in the bearing surfaces. These indents may not be visible but can cause bearing noise.
NOTE:
Hub/bearing replacement due to impact (collision or other suspension damage) is not a
warrantable repair
If a vehicle has visible wheel or suspension damage due to impact (collision or other suspension
damage), it is recommended that the wheel bearing assembly be inspected as follows:
1. Remove the hub/bearing assembly from the vehicle.
2. Hold the hub/bearing assembly with both hands.
3. Rotate the hub/bearing assembly in both directions (clockwise and counterclockwise).
4. If any gritty or rough feeling is detected in the bearing replace it with a new one.
Page 2577
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - E.F.I./Fuel Pump Relays
Reversed Images
Models: 1988-89 Sentra
Section: Amendments
Classification: AM89-011
Bulletin No.: TS89-060
Date: April 13,1989
E.F.I./FUEL PUMP RELAYS
APPLIED MODELS: 1988-89 Sentra (B12)
Pages EL-68 in the 1988 Sentra Service Manual (June 1987 (03) printing) and EL-73 in the 1989
Sentra Service Manual (July 1988 (05) printing), show an illustration with the E.F.I. Relay and the
Fuel Pump Relay reversed. Please correct these illustrations by hand as shown.
Front Wheel Alignment
Alignment: Specifications
Front Caster Angle + 11/12 to +2 5/12 deg
Caster Angle Desired 1 2/3 deg
Camber Angle -1 1/12 to + 5/12 deg
Camber Angle Desired 3/4 deg
Toe -.03 to +.05 in
King Pin Inclination 14 2/3 in
Page 2337
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
300ZX (Z31) VG30ET
300ZX (Z32) VG30DE
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Plug Type Plug Air Gap Plug Torque
Standard Type BPR5ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Hot Type BPR4ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Cold Type BPR6ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Page 1528
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Classification: BT97-014
Reference: NTB97-060
Date: August 13, 1997
BUMPER REFINISHING TECHNIQUES
Applied Vehicles: All models with plastic bumper covers (fascia) SERVICE INFORMATION This
bulletin describes proper plastic bumper cover refinishing with specific paint manufacturer
procedures and materials. For information on repairing bumpers refer to the 1992 Technical
Bulletin book, page BF-31 for NTB92-043/BF92-013. When refinishing replacement plastic bumper
covers (i.e. service parts), it is important to follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure
exactly. Failure to do so may result with paint not fully adhering to the bumper, and with time, the
paint not adhering to the bumper may peel off. The bumper covers contain mold release agents
which must be removed prior to painting. If the bumper cover is not properly cleaned and prepped,
the paint may not adhere. Please follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure for proper
bumper preparation. NOTE:
You can heat the bumper at 140°F for 45 minutes to bring the mold release agent to the surface.
Allow the bumper cover to cool completely before cleaning. This cleaning (degreasing) is
necessary to remove the mold release agent on the surface completely.
The chart indicates which cover; polyurethane (PUR) or polypropylene (PP) is used on each model.
The procedures and appropriate materials for each paint vendor are attached for your reference. If
you should have any difficulty: ^
Obtaining materials
^ Following the published procedure
^ Obtaining a proper finish
^ If you are in a VOC regulated area
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Page 4576
^ Any tools, equipment cones, or other wheel balancing equipment items should not touch the
outside surface of chrome type wheels.
Wheel Alignment:
^ Alignment sensors with metal mounting hooks should not be used on chrome type wheels.
^ Some alignment equipment manufacturers may have protective rubber pads available that can be
used to cover the metal mounting hooks.
Page 1780
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Fig. 303a Input/Output signal inspection chart.
Page 4904
appointment date.
Service Procedure Outline
SERVICE PROCEDURE OUTLINE
Illustrated is the button replacement guide for all vehicles.
ECM - Green or Blue Relay Caution
ECCS (Engine Management) Relay: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Green or Blue Relay
Caution
Classification: EC95-014
Reference: NTB95-070
Date: July 5, 1995
GREEN OR BLUE (FUEL PUMP & A/C) RELAY CAUTION
SERVICE INFORMATION
When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing / checking the harness at
any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When diagnosing the harness at any green or blue colored relay (Fuel pump & A/C) connector,
observe the following pre-cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module (ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the relay is different than the orientation of the relay terminals in the
harness connectors (see diagram):
2. Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector
during diagnosing / checking.
NOTE:
Use a circuit tester first to verify the terminals that are supplied with battery voltage. If battery
voltage is connected to terminal 2, the ECM will be damaged if the circuit being tested has terminal
2 connected to the ECM.
Page 2957
Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T Vehicles
Towing Information: All Technical Service Bulletins Towing Information - Updated Precautions M/T
Vehicles
Classification: GI88-023
Reference: TS88-150
Date: November 17, 1988
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
APPLIED VEHICLES All Models 1987-1989
SERVICE INFORMATION The Service and Owner's Manuals state that speeds below 30 m.p.h.
and distances of less than 40 miles should be observed when towing Manual or Automatic
Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground. These restrictions should be observed when
towing Automatic Transmission vehicles. However, the Factory informs us that the following
limitations apply when towing Manual Transmission vehicles with four wheels on the ground (for
example behind a motor home.)
Tow forward only. Do not tow a Nissan vehicle backward.
TOWING NISSAN MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES
Page 2627
3. Loosen the sensor approximately 10 degrees.
4. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
5. Tighten the sensor 10 degrees, then loosen the sensor 10 degrees.
^ Repeat this motion several times until the sensor begins to turn more easily.
6. Continue the tightening/loosening motion while gradually unscrewing the sensor. Stop when the
sensor will not unscrew any further.
7. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 until the sensor is removed.
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Shift Fork: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Page 848
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plugs for:
^ Improper gap
^ Carbon deposits
^ Cracked center electrode insulator
^ Burned or worn electrodes (may be caused by):
^ Excessive mileage ^ Lean fuel mixture ^ Advanced ignition timing ^ Loose spark plug ^ Plug heat
range too high ^ Insufficient Cooling
^ Fouled plug (may be caused by):
^ Rich fuel mixture ^ Retarded ignition timing ^ Oil in combustion chamber ^ Incorrect spark plug
gap ^ Plug heat range too low ^ Excessive idling/low speed running ^ Clogged air cleaner element
^ Deteriorated ignition coil, coil wire or ignition wires
2. Replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded.
Standard Type
BCPR5ES-11 (NGK)
Hot Type
BCPR4ES-11 (NGK)
Cold Type
BCPR6ES-11 (NGK)
Spark Plug Gap
3. Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool.
Electrode Gap: 0.039 - 0.043 in. (1.0 - 1.1 mm)
Diagnostic Note
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Diagnostic Note
Whenever control cables are disconnected or heater case is disassembled for service, control
cables and operating rods should be adjusted as outlined in adjustments.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Recalls Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles Addendum
Classification: 95V-103.002
Reference: NTB96-020
Date: February 7, 1996
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN UPDATE - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
APPLIED VEHICLES: BELT TYPE
200SX (S12) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (Except Center Belt Position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt
1991 (door mounted)
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides supplemental button kit information. Refer to NTB95-085a, dated September
22, 1995, for complete service and claims information.
PARTS INFORMATION
Takata Buckle Type by Model
Page 2356
Truck (D21) Z24i(4WD)
Pathfinder (WD21) Z24i(2WD)
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Truck (D21) KA24E
Truck/Pathfinder (D21/WD21) VG30i
Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service and Repair" before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 4303
^ Apply the brakes as shown.
^ Start the engine to allow brake boost.
^ Turn the engine OFF,
^ Remove all lock pins-front "turn plates" and rear "slide plates".
^ Make sure the bridge plate will not interfere with movement of the turn plate.
Put the bridge plate in the down position.
^ Perform caster sweep by turning the steering wheel from outside the vehicle.
Page 4025
Brake Shoe: Specifications Thickness Specifications
Thickness Specifications
Minimum Lining Thickness 0.059 in
Page 3050
All
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin has been developed to address complaints of an engine which cranks over normally,
but is difficult to start or will not start at all.
Service Procedure
1. Connect CONSULT. If the vehicle you are working with is not CONSULT compatible, connect a
tachometer (digital readout if possible).
2. Start the engine (the accelerator may have to be opened and/or the fuel pump fuse removed
during cranking to get the engine to start), and warm it to operating temperature.
Note: If the engine will not start after performing the above procedure, clean and dry the spark
plugs, and attempt to start the engine again.
3. Run the engine at 2000 rpm (no load) for two minutes. Then shut the engine off.
4. Check the oil level and correct if necessary (between the "L" and "H" marks on the dipstick). If
the oil level is overfull and has a gasoline odor, change the oil and filter before performing this
procedure. If the crankcase is overfull with oil, idle speed adjustment may be affected.
5. Disconnect the throttle position sensor (TPS) connector. Now re-start the engine.
Note: When the engine is in this condition (TPS disconnected), the IACV-AAC valve and the
ignition timing are held in a "fixed" position, and the idle speed is called "base idle." If the engine
stalls with the TPS disconnected, the base idle speed is adjusted too low. Temporarily increase the
base idle speed by turning the adjusting screw on the IACV-AAC valve until the engine will idle.
Note: On 1989-1994 Maxima's (J30) with VG30E engine the IACV-AAC valve is a "stepper motor"
type valve. To set base idle on these vehicles, set the ECCS ECM mode screw fully "clockwise".
This will close the IACV-AAC valve completely to allow base idle speed adjustment. Return the
ECCS ECM mode screw fully counter-clockwise after setting the base idle (see step 9).
6. Rev the engine 2-3 times to 2000-3000 rpm, then allow it to idle (all accessories "off").
7. Check the ignition timing with a timing light and adjust it to specification (if necessary).
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Page 5341
Seats: Technical Service Bulletins Seats - Care of Leather Trim
Models All Models
Section Body & Frame
Classification BF91-014
Bulletin No. NTB91-051
Date May 23, 1991
CARE OF LEATHER TRIM
APPLIED MODELS: All Models Equipped With Leather Trim
SERVICE INFORMATION:
Nissan currently uses Cow Hide on all vehicles equipped with Leather Interior Trim (excluding
certain 1988 Maximas which were equipped with Suede Seats). This bulletin refers only to those
vehicles equipped with Cow Hide Leather Interior Trim. Suede seat covers are made of Pig Skin
and should be cared for according to the instructions provided in the U11 Maxima Seat Care Kit
(P/N 999M1-U8000). Leather is typically used on seat surfaces, trim pieces, steering wheels, and
shift knobs in Nissan Vehicles. Maintaining a high quality appearance is best achieved by using the
procedures indicated below.
1. Occasionally, loose dust should be removed from the interior trim and seat surfaces using a
vacuum cleaner or a soft brush. The leather surfaces should be wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
2. Some leather trim, such as the leather wrapped steering wheel, may become grayish in color
with use. The original condition may be restored by rubbing the affected area with a clean soft cloth
dampened in a mild soap solution, and then wiped clean with a soft dry cloth.
3. Leather seat surfaces may be regularly coated with a leather conditioner such as saddle soap.
Cautions:
Never use benzene, thinner, or any similar product on leather trim.
Never use car wax on leather trim.
Never use fabric protectors on leather trim unless recommended by the manufacturer. Some fabric
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the leather trim.
Component
EGR Control Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Component
1. Check the solenoid valve for electric continuity, after disconnecting the harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
2. Check the solenoid valve for normal operation, after disconnecting the harness connector and all
the vacuum hoses. Supply the solenoid valve with
battery voltage, and check whether there is continuity between ports A, B and C
Page 2556
Stanza (T11) CA20E
Stanza (T12) CA20E
Stanza (U12) KA24E
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (2WD)
Stanza Wagon (M10) CA20E (4WD)
Truck (D21) Z24i(2WD)
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Page 2874
Fig. 8 EGR control valve.
Fig. 9 EGR control valve.
Page 2793
Catalytic Converter: Service Precautions
a. After installation, check that mounting brackets and mounting insulator are free from undue
stress. If any of above parts are not installed properly,
excessive noises or vibrations may be transmitted to vehicle body.
b. When connecting flanges, use a new gasket to eliminate gas leakage at the joint. c. Check all
tube connections for exhaust gas leaks, and entire system for unusual noises, with engine running.
d. When connecting rear exhaust tube and Main Muffler, use Genuine Nissan Sealant "Exhaust
Sealant Kit 20720-N2225", or an equivalent to
eliminate gas leakage at the joint.
Page 5257
F. Inspect for damage using fluorescent light source and magnification. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
G. Use abrasive cleaning on test section to remove up to 0.5 mil of damaged top/clear coat.* If
damage is less than 0.5 mil deep, clean affected panels with abrasive method. After polishing,
inspect for swirl marks using halogen lights. If damage is more than 0.5 mil deep, the affected
panels must be repaired either by re-clear, re-color/clear coat, or re-color coated (on vehicles with
no final clear coat).
A. Wash Procedure
Wash Equipment and Materials:
Spray wash system (a mobile or stationary unit with hand held spray similar to a coin operated car
wash that provides soap solution, rinse water and de-ionized final rinse).
Car wash detergent containing no phosphates, (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100).
Clean 100% cotton terry cloth towels.
De-ionized water for the final rinse. De-ionized water is highly recommended as it reduces water
spotting. De-ionizing cylinders can be purchased or rented from water purification companies
1. During the summer months, the early morning hours are the best time to wash a car unless you
can wash and dry it in the shade. Never wash a car under the hot sun. All paint is subject to water
spot damage when washed under the sun due to high surface temperature.
2. Thoroughly rinse oft the surface dirt and foreign materials with a spray of clean tap water.
3. Gently apply detergent and water solution (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), keeping it wet for 4-5
minutes. To avoid scratching the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light
pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry
cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt.
Replace the towel with a clean one once it becomes soiled.
Caution:
When washing a convertible rear window use gentle horizontal and vertical strokes, do not use a
circular motion.Use a clean terry cloth towel. Also refer to NTB92-092 for additional information on
convertible wash procedure.
4. Rinse with a spray of clean tap water. Make sure all detergent is flushed off the body. If soap
dries on the convertible rear window or some moldings it may cause streaking. Use a spray of
de-ionized water for the final rinse.
5. Use a clean damp terry cloth towel and gentle pressure to remove the majority of the rinse water
allowing the remaining water film to air dry. Replace the towel frequently to avoid scratches from
entrapped dirt.
6. Always wash, rinse, and dry a vehicle beginning with the roof and glass. Then the hood and
trunk followed by the vertical surfaces. Wash, rinse, and dry one section at a time if low humidity
causes fast drying. Do not allow soap solution or rinse water to dry on the finish.
B. Identifying Contamination
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier with
a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp or a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is most easily done with a
8X and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Page 2718
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.) Operation
Idle Speed Control Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.)
Operation
Classification: Section: Engine Fuel
EF&EC88-017; Emission Control
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS88-115 Models:
1988 Sentra & Pulsar (E16i) Date:
September 8, 1988 IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED MODEL: 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16i
SERVICE INFORMATION
Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988 Sentras and Pulsars (E16i)
is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models. Any attempt to interchange
these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle Speed Control Valve
(I.S.C.V).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below. PARTS INFORMATION
Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number for the 1988
mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your reference, the part
numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
PART DESCRIPTION 1988 PART NUMBER 1987 PART NUMBER
E16i Mixture Heater 16174-61A61 16174-69A10
(B12/N13)
Page 3955
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3.
Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip on
the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid
wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4.
Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation
7.
Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation
8.
Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10.
Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based cleaners
degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the rotor
surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Page 5224
on the towel to avoid scratching the paint with any loosened iron particles.
3. Apply Finish Kare # 883 directly from the bottle using the applicator provided. Keep the affected
areas wet for 5 minutes and allow the solution to lift the particles. Agitate gently, but do not rub as
this will scratch the color coat or clear coat of paint. Reapply # 883 to spots which start to dry
before rinsing
CAUTION:
Do not exceed the 5 minute soak time as this solution may damage the paint or trim.
4. Rinse thoroughly with tap water, dry and inspect the surface.
5. Reapply # 883 as often as needed to remove more difficult spots.
6. When all iron particles are removed, wash with Finish Kare # 118SC (Neutralizer and Shampoo)
and rinse thoroughly. Gently dry with a fresh towel. Do not use towels used in the above steps, as
they may have iron particles in the nap and could scratch the color coat or clear coat.
F. Inspect For Damage Severity
After washing and iron particle/chemical removal are performed on the test section, inspect the
surface to determine the severity of damage. Levels 2 and 3 are determined using abrasive
removal on test sections on each affected panel.
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and/or indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier
with a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp and a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is easily done with an 8X
and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Level 1 No damage, the contamination did not penetrate the paint surface and washed off using
the detergent and water and the iron particle remover.
Level 2 Minor damage, the contamination did not penetrate more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Abrasive cleaning will resolve.
Level 3 Substantial damage, the contamination penetrated more than 0.5 mil of the color coat or
clear coat. Re-color and clear coat is necessary
G. Abrasive Cleaning
IMPORTANT:
All iron particles and acids must be removed and the surface neutralized with the above procedure
before proceeding. Iron particles and acids which remain will not be fully removed by abrasive
cleaning. Small amounts of contamination will wick moisture into the clear coat or through a
re-color/clear coat and cause blistering
The goal of abrasive cleaning is to remove the damaged layer of color coat or clear coat (up to 0.5
mil in thickness) using the least abrasive process. The steps below demonstrate the sequence of
operations to use on the test section to identify the severity of damage and the repair needed.
1. Measure paint film thickness.
2. Polish and evaluate. If OK Polish all affected surfaces. If NG go to step 3.
Also determine film thickness removed.
3. Buff and evaluate. If OK Buff and then polish all If NG go to step 4.
affected surfaces.
Also determine film thickness removed
4. Wet sand and evaluate. If OK wet sand then buff and If NG go to step 5.
polish affected surfaces
Also determine film thickness removed.
5. Re-clear/color coat after neutralizing surfaces.
6. Apply color coat and clear coat if damage is completely through clear coat
NOTE:
Polishing to remove buffing or swirl marks requires a foam finishing pad on a dual action sander.
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger. (1) Remove
fuse for fuel pump. (2) Start the engine. (3) After the engine stalls, crank the engine twice or three
times to make sure that fuel pressure is released. (4) Turn the ignition switch "OFF" and install fuse
for fuel pump.
Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Bumper - Cover Refinishing Technique
Classification: BT97-014
Reference: NTB97-060
Date: August 13, 1997
BUMPER REFINISHING TECHNIQUES
Applied Vehicles: All models with plastic bumper covers (fascia) SERVICE INFORMATION This
bulletin describes proper plastic bumper cover refinishing with specific paint manufacturer
procedures and materials. For information on repairing bumpers refer to the 1992 Technical
Bulletin book, page BF-31 for NTB92-043/BF92-013. When refinishing replacement plastic bumper
covers (i.e. service parts), it is important to follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure
exactly. Failure to do so may result with paint not fully adhering to the bumper, and with time, the
paint not adhering to the bumper may peel off. The bumper covers contain mold release agents
which must be removed prior to painting. If the bumper cover is not properly cleaned and prepped,
the paint may not adhere. Please follow the paint vendor's recommended procedure for proper
bumper preparation. NOTE:
You can heat the bumper at 140°F for 45 minutes to bring the mold release agent to the surface.
Allow the bumper cover to cool completely before cleaning. This cleaning (degreasing) is
necessary to remove the mold release agent on the surface completely.
The chart indicates which cover; polyurethane (PUR) or polypropylene (PP) is used on each model.
The procedures and appropriate materials for each paint vendor are attached for your reference. If
you should have any difficulty: ^
Obtaining materials
^ Following the published procedure
^ Obtaining a proper finish
^ If you are in a VOC regulated area
Page 1991
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2089
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2260
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 545
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 2626
NOTES:
^ Rust penetrant is considered a shop supply.
^ Nissan Rust Penetrant can be ordered through the Nissan Direct Ship Chemical Care Product
Program, Website order via link on dealer portal.
^ WD-40 is available from various local sources.
Removal Tool
^ When removing a seized exhaust sensor with a specialty socket (which contains a slit to
accommodate the wiring harness), it may spread open and
strip the sensor.
^ Before this occurs, it is recommended to cut the wiring harness from the sensor and use a box
end wrench or 6-point deep well socket.
1. Clamp the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube in a vice.
2. Spray the sensor with the rust penetrant for 2 to 3 seconds.
^ It is important that the spray is directed at the base of the sensor to ensure it penetrates into the
threads.
Page 1726
240SX (S14) KA24DE
280Z (S30) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28E
280ZX (S130) L28ET
810 L24E
300ZX (Z31) VG30E
Page 4312
2. Turn wheels from straight-ahead position until the inner wheel is at the position specified for
``Toe-Out On Turns'' shown in Fig. 18. If the outer wheel reference angle is incorrect, check for
damaged or improperly adjusted tie rods. Perform check in both left and right directions.
3. On models less rack and pinion steering, proceed as follows:
a. Rotate steering to full lock in each direction. b. Adjust inner wheel ``Turning Angle'' to value
specified in Fig. 18, by adjusting position of steering stop. c. With inner wheel adjusted to
specifications, outer wheel turning angle should be as specified in Fig. 18. If outer wheel turning
angle is
incorrect, repair or replace steering linkage as needed.
4. On models with rack and pinion steering, proceed as follows:
a. Turn steering to full lock and measure inner and outer wheel turning angles. b. If ``Turning
Angles'' at full lock are not within specifications, Fig. 18, check for damaged steering linkage or
improperly adjusted tie rods. c. If steering linkage and tie rods are satisfactory, check for improper
rack or rack piston stroke and repair steering gear as needed.
Rear Wheels
The proper alignment of the rear suspension and wheels is essential for proper handling and to
providing a reference for front wheel alignment. Always ensure that rear wheel alignment is within
specifications prior to checking and adjusting front wheel alignment.
CAMBER
On models with independent rear suspension, rear wheel camber must be within specifications for
proper vehicle handling and to prevent uneven tire wear. Rear camber cannot be adjusted. If rear
camber is not within specifications, check for damaged or worn suspension components and
deformed sheet metal, and repair as needed.
Fig. 1 Measuring Toe-in
TOE-IN
On models with independent rear suspension, rear toe is the measurement of the rear wheels in
relation to the vehicle centerline, Fig. 1. The leading edge of each rear wheel should toe-in slightly
toward the vehicle centerline to ensure proper vehicle tracking. Rear toe should be inspected using
suitable alignment gauges, following manufacturer's instructions. When checking or adjusting rear
toe, always ensure that the amount that the left and right wheels toe-in is as nearly equal as
possible.
Fig. 6 Rear toe-in adjustment. 1986-88 Stanza Wagon, 1987-88 Sentra w/4WD similar
1986-88 Stanza Wagon & 1987-88 Sentra 4WD
Rear toe-in is adjusted by rotating the cam bolts which secure the transverse link to the axle
carrier, Fig. 6.
1. Measure total toe-in and toe-in for each wheel following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. Scribe matching mark between cam and control arm, then loosen nut securing cam bolt.
3. Rotate cam bolt as needed, Fig. 6, to bring toe-in within specifications. Ensure that total toe-in is
within specifications and divided equally between left and right wheels.
Page 772
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
Page 4361
2. Prevent contamination, such as rust, dirt, or metal chips between the hub and rotor mating
surface. An uneven mating surface between the hub and rotor results in increased rotor run-out.
Always check and clean the mating surfaces prior to resurfacing.
3.
Use a sharp tip on the brake lathe when resurfacing a brake rotor. A dull or damaged cutting tip on
the brake lathe causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very rapidly. This rapid
wear results in rotor thickness variation.
4.
Use the largest silencer band possible when resurfacing the rotor. The silencer band reduces
chatter during resurfacing. Chatter causes a rough surface cut with large ridges, which wear very
rapidly. This rapid wear results in rotor thickness variation.
5. Ensure that the brake lathe cutting head operates properly and is calibrated by the manufacturer
or servicing agent. A damaged or uncalibrated brake lathe cutting head can result in increased
rotor run-out and/or thickness variation
CAUTION:
When using an on the car brake lathe, be sure to prevent metal shavings from contacting or
collecting on the ABS wheel speed sensor. Remove any shavings that stick to the ABS wheel
speed sensor's magnet.
6. Prior to installation, lubricate the brake caliper slide pins and/or clips. Corrosion from lack of
lubrication results in sticking caliper slide pins and reduced pad movement. The sticking of the
caliper slide pins and reduced brake pad movement, increases the rotor wear rate. This increased
brake rotor wear results in increased brake rotor thickness variation
7.
Inspect the caliper pin boots or plugs and replace, if necessary. Corrosion may develop on the
caliper slide pins. This corrosion reduces caliper movement which increases the brake rotor wear
rate. This increased brake rotor wear rate results in brake rotor thickness variation
8.
Measure the brake rotor run-out after performing brake service. There are many reasons why
brake rotor run-out may be above specification. To ensure that the brake rotor run-out is within
specification, it is important to measure brake rotor run-out after every brake service
NOTE:
The Warranty Flat Rate Time includes time to perform run-out measurement
9. The On-Car brake lathe cutting head must be mounted properly. Do not mount the cutting head
on one (1) knuckle and attempt to resurface both sides of the rotor from this one location. The
On-Car Brake Lathe matches the rotor to the hub to achieve the least possible run-out. When the
brake rotor is moved from the position in which it was resurfaced, this matching is lost.
10.
Do not use harsh or corrosive chemicals to clean the wheels. Strong alkalis or acid-based cleaners
degrade the surface finish on the caliper components and may, additionally attack the rotor
surface, resulting in increased thickness variation.
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 5222
F. Inspect for damage using fluorescent light source and magnification. If spots are removed, clean
affected panels.
G. Use abrasive cleaning on test section to remove up to 0.5 mil of damaged top/clear coat.* If
damage is less than 0.5 mil deep, clean affected panels with abrasive method. After polishing,
inspect for swirl marks using halogen lights. If damage is more than 0.5 mil deep, the affected
panels must be repaired either by re-clear, re-color/clear coat, or re-color coated (on vehicles with
no final clear coat).
A. Wash Procedure
Wash Equipment and Materials:
Spray wash system (a mobile or stationary unit with hand held spray similar to a coin operated car
wash that provides soap solution, rinse water and de-ionized final rinse).
Car wash detergent containing no phosphates, (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100).
Clean 100% cotton terry cloth towels.
De-ionized water for the final rinse. De-ionized water is highly recommended as it reduces water
spotting. De-ionizing cylinders can be purchased or rented from water purification companies
1. During the summer months, the early morning hours are the best time to wash a car unless you
can wash and dry it in the shade. Never wash a car under the hot sun. All paint is subject to water
spot damage when washed under the sun due to high surface temperature.
2. Thoroughly rinse oft the surface dirt and foreign materials with a spray of clean tap water.
3. Gently apply detergent and water solution (Nissan P/N 999MP-A3100), keeping it wet for 4-5
minutes. To avoid scratching the finish, do not rub, gently move the solution around with light
pressure. Do not allow the solution to dry before rinsing. Use, clean warm water and a clean terry
cloth towel. Frequently rinse off the terry cloth towel to avoid scratches from entrapped dirt.
Replace the towel with a clean one once it becomes soiled.
Caution:
When washing a convertible rear window use gentle horizontal and vertical strokes, do not use a
circular motion.Use a clean terry cloth towel. Also refer to NTB92-092 for additional information on
convertible wash procedure.
4. Rinse with a spray of clean tap water. Make sure all detergent is flushed off the body. If soap
dries on the convertible rear window or some moldings it may cause streaking. Use a spray of
de-ionized water for the final rinse.
5. Use a clean damp terry cloth towel and gentle pressure to remove the majority of the rinse water
allowing the remaining water film to air dry. Replace the towel frequently to avoid scratches from
entrapped dirt.
6. Always wash, rinse, and dry a vehicle beginning with the roof and glass. Then the hood and
trunk followed by the vertical surfaces. Wash, rinse, and dry one section at a time if low humidity
causes fast drying. Do not allow soap solution or rinse water to dry on the finish.
B. Identifying Contamination
Examine the vehicle in both strong sunlight and indoor fluorescent lighting (inspection is easier with
a hand held 500 watt halogen lamp or a hand held fluorescent lamp) to identify which type of
contamination may be affecting the vehicle. Magnified viewing of spots is most easily done with a
8X and 30X illuminated magnifier from Radio Shack (catalog no. 63-851).
Page 332
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 1325
Auto tensioner Inspection (if equipped)
1. With the engine running at idle and the AC turned ON, observe the pulley angular (side to side)
movement (see Example 1):
^ See above table for maximum movement specification.
^ Visual comparison of movement with a known good vehicle is recommended.
Page 585
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Page 2944
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3079
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Page 969
A Dangerous Trend
By the most reliable estimates, the total ozone level in the Earth's upper atmosphere decreased
about 2.5% between 1978 and 1985. A 1% loss of ozone results in an estimated 2% increase in
the amount of ultraviolet radiation (UV) that reaches the surface of the earth. This has dangerous
implications for life as we know it. A 2% increase in UV will increase the number of human deaths
from skin cancer by approximately 5%. UV also increases the number of eye cataracts, causes
damage to the human immune system, damages crops and marine life. The Montreal Protocol
An agreement, called the Montreal Protocol, signed in 1987 by representatives of 31 countries
including the United States, limits world production of CFCs to 1986 levels and calls for further
reductions of 50% by 1999. Another International Conference will be held in June, 1990, with the
likelihood that the schedule for a complete phase-out of CFCs will occur even earlier. This means
that the supply of R12 refrigerant will decrease dramatically over the next few years and the cost
will increase.
Recycling Makes Good Sense
It's already established that making sure CFCs are not vented to the atmosphere is essential for
the environment. With the supply of R12 decreasing and the cost increasing, recycling all of the
refrigerant you remove from vehicles during repairs or before a vehicle is crushed will make more
and more economic sense.
Page 2470
3. Loosen the sensor approximately 10 degrees.
4. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
5. Tighten the sensor 10 degrees, then loosen the sensor 10 degrees.
^ Repeat this motion several times until the sensor begins to turn more easily.
6. Continue the tightening/loosening motion while gradually unscrewing the sensor. Stop when the
sensor will not unscrew any further.
7. Spray with rust penetrant again for 2 to 3 seconds.
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 until the sensor is removed.
Page 2762
Air Induction Valve Solenoid: Description and Operation
Fig. 116 Air Injecton Valve (AIV) Operation
The air injection valve system delivers secondary air to the exhaust manifold, utilizing a vacuum
caused by exhaust pulsation in the exhaust manifold. Specific operating conditions are outlined in
Fig. 116
Accessory Relay
Ignition Relay: Locations Accessory Relay
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4052
bore is located, then the cylinder is a "fast fill" type. SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Do not allow brake fluid to splash on painted surfaces. It will damage paint.
Do not re-use drained brake fluid. It may have absorbed moisture, which can cause corrosion
inside the brake system. Use only fresh DOT 3 fluid.
Carefully monitor the brake fluid level at the master cylinder during the bleeding operation.
BLEEDING PROCEDURE THAT SHOULD BE USED WHEN TFE VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH
A "FAST FILL" CYLINDER:
^ To Bleed Air Out of Master Cylinder:
1. Carefully place a catch-pan underneath the master cylinder.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal several times.
3. With brake pedal depressed, carefully loosen the brake line at the primary bore of the master
cylinder until fluid leaks out of the connection and the brake pedal goes to the floor.
4. Tighten the brake line.
5. Release the brake pedal slowly.
6. Wait 5 seconds (for the secondary piston to return all the way).
7. Repeat steps 3 through 6 until clear brake fluid (no bubbles) comes out of the brake line at the
primary bore of the master cylinder.
8. Perform the same procedure at the brake line of the master cylinder secondary bore.
^ To Bleed Air Out Of Lines, Wheel Cylinders and Calipers:
--Bleed air in the following sequence:
left rear wheel cylinder--right front caliper--right rear wheel cylinder--left front caliper
1. Connect a transparent vinyl tube to the air bleeder valve. Place the other end of the vinyl tube in
an empty container.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal several times.
3. With the brake pedal fully depressed, open the bleeder valve to allow fluid to flow into the vinyl
tube.
4. Continue depressing the brake pedal until it reaches the floor, then close the air bleeder valve.
5. Release the brake pedal slowly.
6. Wait 5 seconds (for the secondary piston to return all the way).
7. Repeat steps 3 through 6 until clear brake fluid (no bubbles) comes out of the bleeder valve.
BLEEDING PROCEDURE THAT SHOULD BE USED WHEN THE VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH
A STANDARD MASTER CYLINDER--NOT FAST FILL:
In this case, the procedure is the same, except it is not necessary to wait 5 seconds each time after
the bleeder valve is closed and the pressure is released from the brake pedal.
Page 4347
13. Apply suitable sealing compound to contact surfaces between boot and cylinder, then install
boot and boot clamps. Ensure boot clamps do not interfere with any other parts. Also, use caution
not to twist boot.
14. Apply suitable grease to pinion bearing, then coat threads of housing plug with suitable locking
compound. Install housing plug and stake in three places.
15. Place rear cover cap in neutral position by aligning mark toward front of vehicle.
16. Adjust pinion rotating torque as follows:
a. Place gear in neutral position, then torque adjusting screw to 43 inch lbs. b. Loosen adjusting
screw, then retorque to .43-1.74 inch lbs. c. Apply suitable locking compound to base of adjusting
screw and locknut, then torque adjusting screw locknut to 7-11 ft. lbs. Ensure adjusting
screw does not turn.
d. Move rack over its entire stroke several times, then return to neutral position. e. Measure pinion
rotating torque within a range of ±100° from neutral position. Rotating torque should be 7-11 inch
lbs. f.
If pinion rotating torque is not as specified, readjust as required.
Page 3006
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2792
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Heater: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed
Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
Page 688
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2000
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 2592
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 5064
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Fan Switch: Customer Interest A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Models All Models
Section Heater & Air Conditioner
Classification HA87-023
Bulletin No. TS87-190
Date December 21, 1987
HEATER-A/C BLOWER FAN SYSTEM TEST PROCEDURES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan models equipped with heater only or heater and manual air
conditioning.
SERVICE INFORMATION
In some vehicles, the blower fan for the heater/AC system may become inoperative or it may not
operate in all blower speeds. The following test procedures may be used to diagnose and repair
malfunctions in blower fan operation.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
BLOWER FAN CONDITION PERFORM TESTS
DOES NOT OPERATE 1 and 2
ONLY OPERATES AT HIGHEST SPEED (# 4 POSITION)
DOES NOT OPERATE IN ONE OF THE LOWER SPEED
POSITIONS (1, 2 or 3) 1 and 3
TEST PROCEDURE #1:
Page 4021
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 577
Adjustments
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments
Throttle Wire Adjustment
1. Loosen throttle wire double nuts "A" and "B" on carburetor side.
2. With throttle drum set at "P1" (fully-open), move fitting "Q" fully in direction "T" and tighten nut
"B" in direction U". 3. Reverse nut "B" 1.0 to 1.5 revolutions in direction "T", then tighten nut "A"
securely. Throttle drum should be held at "P1".
4. Ensure that throttle wire stroke "L" is within specified range between full throttle and idle.
Throttle wire stroke "L": 27.4 - 31.4 mm (1.079 - 1.236 in.)
Page 4281
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Wrist Pin Diameter 0.7479 in
Page 2320
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (4WD)
STANZA (T11) CA20E
STANZA (T12) CA20E
STANZA (U12) KA24E
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Plug Type Plug Air Gap Plug Torque
Standard Type BPR5ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Hot Type BPR4ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Cold Type BPR6ES-11 0.039-0.043 in 14 - 22 ft.lb
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Locations
Fig. 20 Engine And Emission Control Parts Location
Page 3192
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance Per Cable 30 K ohms
Page 2698
Inspection Procedure
Page 4120
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Battery - Charging/Replacement Procedure
CLASSIFICATION: EL94-001
REFERENCE: NTB94-009
DATE: MARCH 4, 1994
BATTERY CHARGING/REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE APPLIED VEHICLE(S) All
SERVICE INFORMATION As the demands on the vehicle battery increase with the complexity of
electrical systems, there is a need for a usable, consistent and repeatable procedure for
determining the need for charging or replacement of vehicle batteries.
It is the Dealer's responsibility to determine the condition/chargeability of a battery, prior to
replacement of the battery. SERVICE PROCEDURE See the following illustrations for BATTERY
CHARGING/REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE. Battery Charging/Replacement Procedure
Page 2533
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Description and Operation
Detonation Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 44 Detonation control system.
This system, Fig. 44, incorporates a detonation sensor to monitor detonation in each combustion
chamber and send a corresponding signal to the control unit. The detonation control unit, located
under the driver's seat, varies ignition timing to minimize detonation.
Page 2566
Engine Control Module: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 2349
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker Bolts
Door Locks: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker Bolts
Section:
Classification:
BF90-003 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-036 Models: All models Date: April 12, 1990
Front door
Page 5052
Diagnostic Procedure # 7
SYMPTOM: Console switch LED will not flash
Diagnostic Procedure # 8
SYMPTOM: Interior light does not operate (with unlock or alarm).
Page 2748
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Valve Switch
Fig. 14 Throttle valve switch
The throttle valve switch is attached to the throttle chamber, Fig. 14, and actuates in response to
accelerator pedal movement. This switch has two sets of contact points. One set monitors the idle
position and the other set monitors full throttle position. The idle contacts close when the throttle
valve is positioned at idle and open when at any other throttle position. The full throttle contacts
close only when the throttle valve is positioned at full throttle or more than 34 to 40° opening of the
throttle valve. The contacts are open when the throttle valve is at any other position. The idle switch
compensates for enrichment during idle and after idle, and sends fuel cut signal. The full throttle
switch compensates for enrichment in full throttle.
Page 1803
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transaxle Fluid Capacity 6.6 qt (US)
Approximate, Make final check with dipstick.
Page 4260
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 1305
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Intake and Exhaust Valve Clearance Adjustment
Adjustment must be made while engine is warm but not running.
1. Set No. 1 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve clearance (1),
(2), (3) and (6). 2. Set No. 4 cylinder in top dead center on its compression stroke, and adjust valve
clearance (4), (5), (7) and (8).
Valve clearance:
Intake and exhaust
0.28 mm (0.011 in) Tighten Pivot lock nut
16 - 21 N.m (1.6 - 2.1 kg-m, 12 - 15 ft-lb)
Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 2157
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1962
Inspection Procedure
Page 1476
Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Cover Bolts 4 - 5 ft.lb
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Synchronizer Hub: All Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Page 3263
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Air Flow Meter Self-Cleaning Control System
Air Flow Meter Self-cleaning Control
After the engine is stopped, the E.C.C.S. control unit heats up the hot wire to approximately
1,000°C (1,832°F) to burn out dust which adhered to the hot wire. Self-cleaning will actuate when
all the following conditions are met. Engine speed has exceeded 2,000 rpm before key is turned OFF.
- Vehicle speed has exceeded 20 km/h (12 MPH) before key is turned OFF.
- Water temperature is between 60°C (140°F) and 95°C (203°F).
- Engine has been stopped by turning the ignition key OFF. (Not caused by engine stall.)
The hot wire will be heated for an instant, once several seconds have passed after ignition key is
turned OFF.
Page 4299
^ Center the front wheels on the turn plates.
^ Chock the left rear wheel.
Preliminary Checks:
3. Perform pre-alignment checks.
^ Tire condition (wear, partial wear, flaws, etc.)
^ Road wheel condition (damage and deformation)
^ Tire pressure
^ Inspect for visible damage to any suspension components
^ Wheel bearing axial play
^ Ball joints of suspension arms
^ Shock absorber operation and visual check for oil leakage
^ Condition of axle and suspension (check for bushing cracks and slack)
^ Vehicle weight
> Empty - no cargo, luggage, or passengers
> Fuel level is full
Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Inspection & Adjustment
Alignment: Service and Repair Inspection & Adjustment
Front Wheels
Correct front wheel alignment is necessary to provide proper handling and to prevent uneven tire
wear. To ensure correct alignment, angles should be checked, and if necessary corrected, in the
following sequence: caster and kingpin inclination, camber, toe-setting, and the turning angle and
toe-out on turns. Front wheel alignment should only be checked after ensuring that the rear wheels
are properly aligned in relation to the vehicle centerline, as most equipment uses the rear wheels
as reference for correct front wheel alignment. Front wheel alignment should be checked with the
vehicle unladen, at normal ride height, and following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
CASTER & KINGPIN INCLINATION
Kingpin inclination is a function of the steering knuckle design and cannot be adjusted. Caster, the
alignment angle which provides the self-centering steering effect, is only adjustable on truck
models which do not use strut-type front suspensions. If caster or kingpin angle are not within
specifications on models with strut-type front suspension, check suspension components and sheet
metal for damage, distortion and excessive wear, and repair as needed. For caster adjustment On
Pathfinder, Pickup and Van, refer to camber adjustment, as the caster and camber are both
adjusted by inserting shims between the upper control arm spindle and the crossmember.
CAMBER
Fig. 4 Camber Adjusting Pin.
Camber is adjusted by rotating the eccentric strut mounting pin, Fig. 12. The pin is factory installed
with the flat portion facing down. If camber is not within specifications, the pin must removed and
reinstalled with the flat portion facing up.
1. Check camber following equipment manufacturer's instructions.
2. If camber is not within specifications, remove adjusting pin as outlined in strut replacement
procedures, then install pin with flat side facing up and leave nut loose to allow adjustment.
3. Turn adjusting pin as needed to bring camber within specifications. One graduation of the
adjusting pin changes camber by approximately 1/4°.
4. When camber is within specifications, hold adjusting pin and torque nut to 72-87 ft. lbs., then
ensure camber is still within specifications.
Fig. 1 Measuring Toe-in
TOE SETTING
The toe setting is the measurement of the wheels in relation to the vehicle centerline, Fig. 1. The
leading edge of each wheel should toe-in or toe-out slightly in relation to the vehicle centerline to
ensure proper vehicle tracking. Toe should be inspected using suitable alignment gauges, following
manufacturer's instructions. When checking or adjusting toe, always ensure that the setting of the
left and right wheels is as nearly equal as possible.
Page 4786
Diagrams
Component Locations
Mirrors: Component Locations
A/C Condenser Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl A/C Relay: Engine
Compartment, RH Side Of Cowl Acceleration Cut Timer: Behind Dash, On Heater Housing
Accessory Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block Air Flow Meter: On Throttle Body AIV
Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body AIV Control Solenoid Valve: Top Of Engine, Right Front
Back Door Harness (Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (4WD
Wagon): Rear Back Door Pillar Back Door Harness (Hatchback): Rear Back Door Pillar Body
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Tail Lamps Body Harness (Hatchback): Instrument Panel To Tail
Lamps B.P T. Valve: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body Bulb Check Relay: RH Side Fender Apron,
Front Of Shock Tower Carbon Canister: LH Side Of Cowl EFI Relay: Under Instrument Panel,
Above Fuse Block EFI Control Relay: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column EGR
Control Valve: In Intake Manifold EGR Canister Control Solenoid Valve: RH Side Front Of Engine
Electric Fuel Pump: In Gas Tank Engine Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): On Engine
Engine Harness (4WD Wagon): On Engine Exhaust Gas Sensor: In Exhaust Manifold Front Door
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Front Door Front Door Harness (4 WD Wagon): Front
Door Fuel Filter: LH Side Of Cowl Near Carbon Canister Fuel Pump Relay: Under Instrument
Panel, Above Fuse Block Fuse Block: Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Horn
Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Idle Speed Control Valve: On Throttle Body
Ignition Coil & Power Transistor: RH Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Ignition Relay (4WD):
Under Instrument Panel, Left Of Steering Column Inhibitor Relay: RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of
Shock Tower Injector: Top Of Throttle Body Instrument Panel Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Harness (4WD Wagon): Instrument Panel Main
Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Main Harness (4WD
Wagon): Instrument Panel To Front Lamps Mixture Heater: Top Of Engine Near Throttle Body
Operation Switch (4WD): On Shift Handle Pressure Regulator: On Throttle Body PTC Relay: RH
Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower Radiator Fan Relay: Engine Compartment, Left Front
Fender Apron Near Battery Receiver Drier: LH Side Of Radiator Support, Near Battery Resistor:
Behind I/P, On Heater Housing Room Lamp Harness (Sedan, Coupe & 2WD Wagon): A-Pillar To
Roof Room Lamp Harness (4WD Wagon): A-Pillar To Roof Stop lamp Switch: On Brake Lever
Thermo Switch: Lower Left Corner Of Radiator Thermal Protector: On Top Of Compressor Transfer
Control Relay (4WD): LH Side Of Cowl Near Hood Hinge Transfer Control Unit (4WD): Under
Instrument Panel, LH Of Steering Column Water Temperature Sensor: Front RH Side Of Engine
Wiper Amplifier: RH Side Of Cowl Wiper Motor: RH Side Of Cowl
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Brakes - AMMCO On Car Lathe Operating Guidlines
Technical Service Bulletin # 92-062A Date: 990617
Brakes - AMMCO On Car Lathe Operating Guidlines
REFERENCE: NTB92-062A
CLASSIFICATION: BR92-004A
DATE: June 17,1999
TITLE: AMMCO ON-CAR BRAKE LATHE OPERATING GUIDELINES
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All models
This amended version of NTB92-062 adds a CAUTION and a NOTE to the Service Procedure.
Please discard all paper copies of NTB92-062.
SERVICE INFORMATION
To ensure the best possible surface finish and least amount of run-out and rotor thickness variation
when using the Ammco on-car brake lathe, the following guidelines should be observed.
Service Procedure
SERVICE PROCEDURE Before mounting the brake lathe on the vehicle ensure the following:
1. The V-way between the carriage and carriage gib must be clean and adjusted properly (see
Operation Manual for adjustment procedure). Wipe off
sliding surfaces with a soft cloth after each use.
2. The cutters and cutting bits must be tight in their mounts and positioned properly. Change cutting
bits when they become dull.
3. When securing the adjustable mounting brackets to the caliper mount/knuckle the mounting
surfaces must be smooth and free of burrs.
4. Make sure the adjustable mounting brackets are securely mounted to caliper mount/knuckle.
There should be no movement between the cutting
tool and the caliper mount/knuckle.
ROTOR DRIVING UNIT Before using the drive unit ensure the following:
Engine Controls - Engine Control Module Identification
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Control Module
Identification
Models: Various Section: Engine Fuel & Emission Control Classification: EF & EC94-015 Bulletin
No.: NTB94-097 Date: November 4, 1994
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IDENTIFICATION
SERVICE INFORMATION:
This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number and cross-references to a
Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference guide to assure in verifying
that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with the VIN number and
Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number when ordering a new
ECM.
An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM and has the same
programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part number containing "M" and "RE",
disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart.
On any CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the
CONSULT connector using CONSULT. All vehicles have a label (see illustration above) that has
the vendor part number on the ECM Cover.
ALTIMA (U13) KA24DE
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Page 728
Page 1916
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 1445
Page 4561
DEFINITION: Separation between the tread rubber and tire cord materials (Figure 9A), or between
the tire cord ply layers (Figure 9B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for tread separation at the tire shoulder area and the corresponding location inside the tire.
There should be no evidence of accidental injury by sharp, perforating objects (e.g., screws, nails).
Open Splice
Damage Description: Open Splice
NISSAN CODE: 7C
DEFINITION: An open area of the tire tread where the tread rubbers overlap (Figure 10).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check the edge of the splice opening; it will have a beveled appearance. The cracks do not
penetrate through the tire cord, and the possibility of air leakage does not exist.
Out of Round
Damage Description: Out of Round
NISSAN CODE: 7P
DEFINITION: Excessive vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition of the tire with the
rim.
General Information
Vehicle vibration caused by an out-of-round condition will generally appear within the first 100-200
miles of driving. If it appears later, the vibration is probably caused by some other condition. Please
note that more than 90% of vehicle vibration Problems are caused by conditions other than
Page 4077
JIS = Japan Industrial Standard, used for Japan produced batteries CCA = Cold Cranking Amps,
standard for North American produced batteries
IMPORTANT:
^ JIS batteries have different testing specifications than CCA batteries.
^ If you must use the GR-8 Battery Tester in a mode other than MODEL mode, JIS Mode MUST
ALWAYS BE USED for JIS batteries otherwise an
incorrect result will occur. NEVER test a JIS battery using the CCA test in the GR-8; the test
software in the GR-8 is different for JIS and CCA modes. ANY CCA value you may have for a
JIS-type battery is inaccurate for testing purposes.
^ ALWAYS test with the GR-8 using the MODEL mode (if available).
^ Selecting MODEL and vehicle type will automatically select the proper JIS or CCA value for the
Original Equipment battery.
^ If the applicable vehicle is not listed, update the GR-8 to make sure it has the most recent data
package. (1)
(1) To run the Midtronics Update Wizard for the GR-8 tester in CONSULT III:
^ Make sure the cables from the GR-8 to the multitasker are connected and both units are turned
on.
^ Click on the ASIST icon.
^ Click on INFO. Tool Box.
^ Select Midtronics GR-8.
^ Midtronics Update Wizard file screen displays.
^ Click on Change MUP File.
^ The Select a MUP file window displays with the path: C:\ProgramFiles\Midtronics\MUW.
^ Select 192-725C and click OK.
^ Click on next and follow the prompts on the Midtronics Update Wizard screen.
If the applicable vehicle still is not listed:
1) Determine which type of battery (CCA or JIS) is installed in the vehicle. See below for
descriptions of each battery.
2) Select CCA or JIS in the GR-8 based on the type of battery installed. See below for more
information.
Determine the Battery Type
Batteries with JIS (Japanese Industrial Standard) Number
Page 2989
Page 3246
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 2881
Exhaust Pressure Regulator Vacuum Valve: Description and Operation Vacuum Control Valve
Fig. 17 Vacuum control valve. (Typical)
During rapid acceleration, the vacuum control valve, Fig. 17, monitors vacuum in the reservoir and
engine vacuum. The control valve serves to activate a second EGR control valve when there is a
sudden drop in the vacuum signal.
Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Engine Oil: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Level and Grade, Driveability
Classification: EM95-01
Section: Engine Mechanical
Reference: Technical Bulletin NTB95-017
Date: February 8, 1995
ENGINE OIL LEVEL AND GRADE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All
SERVICE INFORMATION
The cause of some driveability incidents is incorrect oil level or viscosity. Whenever you evaluate a
vehicle for a driveability problem, check the oil level first. (It is a good practice to check oil level on
every vehicle that you work on.)
Overfilling may cause engine vibration or valve train clatter on vehicles with hydraulic lash
adjusters due to oil aeration when the crankshaft hits the oil. Using the wrong viscosity oil can
cause rough or low idle resulting from improper operation of the hydraulic lash adjusters.
When you add or change the engine oil, follow the service manual recommendations regarding
proper oil fill level. Do not overfill the crankcase. If you find a vehicle to be overfilled with oil, drain
the excess oil and dispose of properly. Remember to wait ten (10) minutes after refilling before
checking. This allows time for the oil to drain back to the pan.
Always use the proper viscosity oil specified by the service manual for the temperature range in
your geographic area. The viscosity specifications ensure proper engine operation and best engine
efficiency.
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Technical Service Bulletin # 95085A Date: 950922
Recall - Front Seat Belt Buckles
Classification: 95V-103
Reference: NTB95-085a
Date: September 22, 1995
VOLUNTARY CAMPAIGN - FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLES
This bulletin replaces NTB95-085. Please discard all copies of NTB95-085, dated August 28, 1995.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION NO.: 95V-103.002
APPLIED VEHICLES BELT TYPE
200SX (512) 1986.5-88 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
240SX (S13) 1989-91 2 Point manual lap belt
Truck (D21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt (except center belt position)
Pathfinder (WD21) 1988-91 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Van (C22) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt
Sentra (B12) 1987-90 3 Point active lap/shoulder belt & 2 Point manual lap belt
Sentra (B13) 2 Door Sedan 1991 3 Point passive lap/shoulder belt (door mounted)
AUTHORIZATION
Nissan Motor Co., Ltd. authorizes Nissan Motor Corporation., U.S.A. (NMC) to conduct a campaign
on certain 1986.5-1991 Nissan vehicles.
INTRODUCTION
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) has been investigating certain seat
belt buckles manufactured by Takata Corporation for vehicle model years 1986.5 through 1990 and
a part of 1991. These buckles were installed in numerous models built by several manufacturers
including certain 1986.5-91 Nissan and Infiniti models. Nissan is aware of a small number of
reports of seat belt buckle release button breakage in vehicles equipped with these Takata buckles.
A broken piece may prevent the buckle from latching or prevent it from unlatching.
NUMBER OF VEHICLES POTENTIALLY AFFECTED: Approximately 2,000,000.
DEALER RESPONSIBILITY
It is the dealer's responsibility to check each vehicle within the range of this campaign which for
any reason enters the service department. This includes vehicles purchased from private parties or
presented by transient (tourist) owners and vehicles in dealer inventory.
WARRANTY EXTENSION
Owners of 1986.5 through 1988 vehicles affected by this campaign have been given a lifetime
limited warranty on the entire seat belt assemblies in their car. This lifetime limited warranty is the
same as applied to 1989 and later Nissan vehicles.
OWNER NOTIFICATION
Current owners of vehicles involved in this campaign will be notified by mail over a 10-11 month
period beginning September 29,1995. A sample owner's letter is illustrated in this bulletin.
Page 4942
Parts Information
Locations
Radiator Fan Thermal Switch: Locations
A/C Components.
Lower Left Corner Of Radiator
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 4649
Fig. 26 Exploded view of heater system. 1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra
4. Refer to Fig. 26 to complete removal of heater core.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Page 4285
out-of-round tires.
Out-of-roundness can only be measured as a radial force variation and most tire dealers do not
have the equipment necessary to make this measurement. Because of this, the most effective way
to inspect for this condition is to use a specific diagnostic procedure to rule out or confirm other
causes for the vibration. The following pages of this Technical Bulletin contain a procedure that can
be used to confirm/eliminate tire out-of-round as a cause of vehicle vibration. Listed are the lateral
and radial runout specifications for the 1989 Nissan models to assist you when performing the
procedure.
Technical
Service Bulletin # 08-097D Date: 110426
Steering/Suspension - Pull Or Drift Diagnostics
Classification: ST08-001D
Reference: NTB08-097D
Date: April 26, 2011
DIAGNOSIS OF VEHICLE PULL (DRIFT) AND STEERING WHEEL OFF CENTER
This bulletin has been amended. Changes have been made to the off-center specification. The
off-center specifications for NV vehicles is 4 mm or less. Please discard previous versions of this
bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
SERVICE INFORMATION
If a customers reports their "vehicle pulls" or the "steering wheel is off-center," use the Diagnostic
Flow Chart below and the other information in this bulletin to diagnose and correct the issue.
Page 339
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2677
Fig. 4 Throttle Position Sensor
ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Description and Operation
Vacuum Control Flap Switchover Valve: Description and Operation
Fig. 53 Vacuum switch.
When intake manifold vacuum increases during deceleration, this switch is activated, interrupting
the electrical signal which is sent to the vacuum switching valve.
Audio - Aftermarket Phone/Audio Installation Precautions
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Aftermarket Phone/Audio Installation
Precautions
Classification: Section:
GI92-001 General Information
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-003
Models:
All Models
Date:
January 16, 1992
AFTERMARKET CELLULAR PHONE AND AUDIO
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
APPLIED MODELS: All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION
Many customers request installation of aftermarket cellular phones and audio equipment at the
time of new vehicle purchase. Nissan does not authorize or warrant non-Nissan approved parts or
accessories installed in Nissan vehicles. If these installations are made, they should be checked
routinely after sublet work has been performed to help eliminate customer complaints. The
following guidelines should be followed:
1. Route wires at least 18" away from ECU and air bag controller. Use high quality shielded cables
for all signal cables (98% shielded).
2. Do not tap into wires that are part of any safety or ECCS equipment, such as airbag, brake
lights, turn indicators, warning lights, ABS, fuel injection, etc. Power should come from the battery
or the accessory circuit. Ground leads should terminate at the battery. Always use inline fuses as
close to the power source as possible.
3. Use wire ties to securely fasten new harness in vehicle.
4. Before any panels or finishers are replaced, ensure that all fasteners are in good condition and
are properly located.
5. When it is necessary for additional harnesses or cables to pass under the edge of a finisher,
such as a cellular phone antenna coaxial cables, notch the finisher at that point so that it will fit
back into place correctly.
6. Glass-mounted cellular phone antennas are affected by defroster wires in the window. Mount the
antenna as high on the glass as possible and at least 1/2" away from defroster wires.
7 Test drive all vehicles to listen for squeaks or rattles.
NOTE: Please supply a copy of these guidelines to accessory installation shops that your
dealership or customers use regularly.
Page 734
Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker Bolts
Front Door Striker: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Revised Torques For Door Lock & Striker
Bolts
Section:
Classification:
BF90-003 Body & Frame
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-036 Models: All models Date: April 12, 1990
Front door
Page 1586
Distributor Cap: Testing and Inspection
Distributor Cap
1. Remove the screws securing the cap to the distributor.
2. Remove the ignition wires from the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for cracks or damage due to heat or arcing.
4. Inspect the terminals inside the cap for excessive corrosion and damage.
5. Inspect the ignition wire terminals for excessive corrosion. If the corrosion cannot be removed
with reasonable measures, replace the cap. Replace the cap if it fails the above tests.
Page 4499
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 606
> Engine coolant and lubricating oils at specified levels
> Spare tire, jack, hand tools, and floor mats in designated positions
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for information about any of the above checks and
inspections.
4. Check the target mounts.
^ If there is any visual damage (bent, worn, cracked, etc), have the equipment repaired before
performing any alignments.
^ Make sure the target mounts are properly adjusted and configured (see Figure 11).
NOTE:
The target mount example shown in Figure 11 is for Hunter "camera type" alignment machines.
Follow the operation manual for your specific equipment.
Page 3193
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 4560
DEFINITION: Fine longitudinal cracks appearing on the bottom of the tire grooves which do not
penetrate into the cord material of the tire (Figure 8).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check all the vehicle tires. If there are only one or two "cracks" in the tire groove, or if the "crack"
continues up the side of the groove wall, the cause of the "crack" was a cut inflicted by a road
hazard, and is not warrantable.
Ply Separation
Damage Description: Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7B
Page 422
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 747
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 3044
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 1890
Inspection Procedure
Page 1537
1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and 1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 1773
Pulsar (KN13) GA16i
Sentra (B12)E16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Sentra (B12)GA16i (2WD)
Sentra (B12)E16i (4WD)
Page 5280
area (2' x 2' or less). Spread the liquid around with the pad before turning the buffer "ON". Use an
overlapping pattern to assure even polishing effort on all areas.
3. Second use a dual action sander with either a 3M foam pad or a Meguiar's foam pad, apply
polishing liquid over the work area (2' x 2' or less). Polish with the same technique as above. Do
not polish dry, wipe off excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
If build up occurs, cool the surface with clean water and dry with a clean terry cloth towel and clean
the foam pad. Use a slower speed to prevent heating the surface and ground the vehicle to a metal
water pipe to reduce static electricity.
INSPECTION
Gently clean a small section with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover,
using a clean towel to remove any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing
between buffing scratches and towel scratches. Inspect the surface for swirl marks under full
sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away.
CAUTION:
If you clean with an alcohol and water cleaning solution it will cause damage to plastic lenses. The
damage is not immediately visible, but develops later
Buffing
Buffing is done with a 8" buffer at 1500-1750 RPM to remove sanding scratches.
1. Clean the surface of all residue before buffing.
2. Apply a buffing liquid and spread it over the work area (2' x 2' or less) with the buffing pad before
turning the buffer "ON". Keep the pad nearly flat and move it slowly but continuously over the area.
Use an overlapping pattern to assure even buffing effort on all areas. Do not buff dry, wipe off
excess material with a clean terry cloth towel.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for sanding marks under full sunlight or with a 500 watt halogen work lamp held
at an angle about an arms length away. If necessary, gently clean a small section of the surface
with PPG DX330 Wax and Grease remover or similar wax remover, using a clean towel to remove
any polish/filler. Wipe in one direction to aid in distinguishing between buffing scratches and towel
scratches.
Sanding
1. Soak the sand paper in water with lubricant such as Meguiar's # 0016, for at least 15 minutes
before use. Mask the fenders and doors to reduce cleanup time. Wet sanding with a lubricant
prevents buildup on the paper and consequent gouging of the finish.
2. Sand with 2000 grit sand paper using a sanding pad, never by hand alone. Apply plenty of water
while sanding in one direction only, no more than 12-15 strokes. Do not sand in a circular pattern.
Do not sand over body lines and panel edges. Rinse the paper frequently to prevent gouging.
NOTE:
Wet sanding vehicles with the New Cross Link Clear Coat (NCLC) hard clear coat requires a more
aggressive sanding stroke. Vehicles with a conventional clear coat require a normal sanding
stroke.
3. Rinse with water and squeegee gently. As the squeegee clears the water, inspect for damage.
INSPECTION
Inspect the surface for damage under both strong fluorescent lights and full sunlight (a 500 watt
halogen work lamp held at an angle about an arms length away is necessary on cloudy days). A
smooth dull sanded surface is expected at this time. Bright spots or other irregularities indicate the
damage needs more sanding, up to the 0.5 mil standard.
4. After the damage is removed, measure the paint thickness in several places to determine if less
than 0.5 mil has been removed.
5. If the damage was deeper than 0.5 mil, the surface must be re-clear coated, or re-color coated
on vehicles with no clear coat. Refer to the Warranty Paint and Body Self-Study Course, or the
Warranty Flat Rate Manual for assistance.
6. If the damage has been removed with less than 0.5 mil of the color/clear coat removed, buff and
polish to remove the sanding marks.
Page 3856
^ These pads use a semi-metallic compound, similar to the material used in Nissan OE pads prior
to the introduction of the NAO compound.
^ Key Value semi-metallic pads offer excellent braking performance but do not offer the same level
of noise resistance as the OE-NAO pads.
^ Service customers have varying sensitivity to brake noise and the individual customer must
decide which product best suits his or her requirements, balancing price and noise resistance.
^ Make sure the Service Advisor adequately explains the differences between Key Value brake
pads and Nissan OE-NAO brake pads to the customer when discussing brake service.
Loud continuous squeak/squeal noise:
^ Occurs with or without braking.
^ This is a normal brake function. It occurs when the brake pad wear indicators contact the rotor.
^ It indicates the brake pads are worn out and need to be replaced. Install new brake pads using
the information listed under Brake Service shown in this bulletin and the appropriate Service
Manual procedures.
Groan noise when slightly releasing the brakes after coming to a stop:
^ This is sometimes called "creep groan".
^ It is a normal condition. No repair or service is necessary.
Groan noise during stopping:
^ Usually caused by glazing of the rotor's surface as a result of heavy or frequent braking.
^ Refer to technical bulletins specific to the model of vehicle regarding this incident.
^ Replace the brake pads, then resurface the rotors and finish them with sand paper. Refer to
Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Single clunk noise from front suspension when applying the brakes:
^ The noise is a result of the brake pads shifting in the direction of rotor rotation when the brakes
are applied.
^ Can be duplicated by lightly touching the brake pedal.
^ If the brake pedal is pushed hard, the noise is less likely to occur.
^ Make sure the brake pads and pad hardware (shims, springs, clips, etc) are installed correctly.
^ Refer to ASIST for vehicle specific brake service information.
^ Refer to Brake Service shown in this bulletin for additional detail.
Multiple clunk noise and/or pedal pulsation that occurs only one time after the engine is started:
^ This is a normal ABS Self Check noise. No service action is necessary.
^ The vehicle's ABS system performs a self check. On some models this self check occurs with the
first application of the brakes after the engine is started. On other models the self check occurs the
first time the vehicle reaches 5 mph after the engine is started.
Rear Brake Squeal:
^ Usually due to an accumulation of brake dust and dirt between the pads/shoes and rotors or
drums.
^ Clean all dust and dirt from the brake shoes, backing plates and related components.
WARNING:
Brake dust may be hazardous if inhaled. Refer to the Service Manual (ESM) for brake dust
precautions and use approved brake cleaning equipment.
Page 338
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Testing and Inspection
Air Filter Element: Testing and Inspection
Viscous paper type air cleaner filter does not require any cleaning operation until it is replaced
periodically. Brushing or blasting operation should never be conducted, because it causes clogging
and results in enrichment of the mixture ratio.
Page 2978
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Locations
Lamp Out Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment Components.
RH Side Fender Apron, Front Of Shock Tower
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 2678
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 788
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3247
Inspection Procedure
(Not self-diagnostic item)
Page 625
Vibration Diagnosis
Please note that exact out-of-round specifications are hard to define. Because of this, when
submitting a warranty claim for a gross out-of-round condition, the claim should be supported with
actual measurement figures.
Service Information
This Technical Bulletin contains descriptions of the types of tire damage that are covered by the tire
manufacturer's warranties (Limited to Bridgestone, Toyo, Yokohama and Dunlop). For tires not
available through Nissan, please direct the customer to the manufacturer's nearest dealer. When a
customer returns a tire for inspection and adjustment, refer to the information in this bulletin to help
identify causes of tire failures and consequential damage to tires.
To determine warranty status, it is essential to ascertain if tire damage is caused by road hazards,
mechanical problems, workmanship or materials. In determining the cause of tire failure, inspect
both the exterior and interior of the tire.
Sometimes the cause of tire failure is immediately apparent. In other cases however, only a
thorough inspection of the tire will show the cause of failure, and whether the damage should result
in replacement under manufacturers warranty. Thorough inspection requires good lighting, a clean
dismounted tire and close examination of the tire surface. Finding a point of penetration can
sometimes be very difficult and should be done on a tire spreader.
NOTE:
For a full description of tire damage not covered by manufacturers warranty, please refer to the
Passenger Car & Light Truck Tire Inspection & Adjustment booklet, sent to you with Technical
Bulletin WT88-002 (TS88-084).
Sidewall Blister
Damage Description: Sidewall Blister NISSAN CODE: 7N
DEFINITION: A lifting of the rubber layer (i.e., portions of sidewall stock or white sidewall rubber)
from the tire's sidewall structure, caused by lack of adhesion between the rubber and structure.
This lifting will often "pocket" air (see Figure 1).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue Precautions
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Engine - Coding System to Match Bearings to Crankshaft
Crankshaft: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Coding System to Match Bearings to Crankshaft
Classification: Section:
EM90-002 Engine Mech.
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-011 Models: All 1987-90 Models
Date: February 15, 1990 IDENTIFYING CRANKSHAFT BEARINGS FOR SERVICE
APPLICATIONS
APPLIED MODELS: All 1987-90 Models.
SERVICE INFORMATION
Beginning with engines manufactured in 1987, Nissan has utilized a coding system to precisely
match bearings to the crankshaft. Certain ways of marking/coding the crankshaft have varied. The
purpose of this bulletin is to explain those coding variations so that the correct replacement
crankshaft bearings can be selected.
Some Crankshafts utilize marks on the No. 1 Counterbalance. There may be one or two rows. If
there are two rows, the top one identifies the grade for the main bearings; the bottom one identifies
the grade for the connecting rod bearings. If there is only one row, it will indicate the grade for the
main bearings and the engine rebuilder should use the "standard" bearings for the connecting rod
application. NOTE:
Some Crankshafts were additionally marked on the No. 5 Counterbalance. In this application, the
marks on the No. 5 Counterbalance represent the grade for the connecting rod bearings and the
marks on the No. 1 Counterbalance represent the grade for the main bearings.
One other variation in Crankshaft marking is the use of horizontal scribe marks on certain
Crankshafts and Arabic numerals (1, 2, 3, etc.) for others.
^ Those Crankshafts graded with Arabic numerals need no interpretation because their grades
directly correspond to the Parts Microfiche and Service Manual for the respective vehicle.
^ Those Crankshafts graded with vertical scribe marks can be interpreted by using the following
table.
Crank BRG. Counterbalance "vertical slash"
Grade Grade #
0 no mark
1I
2 II
3 III
Refer to the "S.D.S." chart at the back of the EM section of the appropriate Service Manual for
bearing color code application.
Page 4215
^ DO NOT push/pull on the tire to perform the caster sweep.
7. Make sure the steering wheel is centered when performing toe-in measurements and
adjustments.
NOTE:
If you are using a Hunter alignment machine equipped with the WinToe(R)-Adjustment System:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The WinToe(R) system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ Bumping the tire or re-centering the steering wheel when adjusting "near frozen" tie rods is not
necessary. This makes the adjustment process faster
and easier.
^ WinToe(R) eliminates the effect of lash in the steering system.
If you are using a John Bean alignment machine equipped with EZ Toe:
^ There is no need to lock the steering wheel. The EZ Toe system is not affected by steering
system movement during the adjustment process.
^ This software routine is an improved method of setting front toe, making it easier to obtain a
centered steering wheel.
^ With EZ Toe, it is possible to adjust toe with the steering wheel turned at any angle left or right.
This is helpful when setting toe on engine wall
mounted rack and pinion units.
IMPORTANT:
If during the alignment process the vehicle was lifted off of the rack; after lowering, make sure to
jounce (bounce) the vehicle before confirming adjustments are correct.
After you have checked and adjusted vehicle alignment
8. Print the BEFORE and AFTER measurements and attach them to the Repair Order.
9. Road test the vehicle to make sure the steering wheel is "centered" when driving on a straight
flat road.
Page 5028
Parts Information: Antenna Rod
Page 2051
8. If the vehicle is not CONSULT compatible, monitor the idle speed using the tachometer
connected in step 1. If using CONSULT, perform the following procedure:
Monitor the idle speed (CMPS^RPM) on the CONSULT screen.
9. Check the idle rpm and adjust to specification (if necessary) using the screw on the IACV-AAC
valve.
The table shows ignition timing and base idle speed for some models.
If the model or model year you are working on is not listed, refer to the appropriate service manual
(EF &) EC section, and perform the "IDLE SPEED/IGNITION TIMING/IDLE MIXTURE RATIO
INSPECTION" procedure.
10. Turn the engine off, and re-connect the TPS.
Page 4402
Control Arm: Service and Repair Transverse Link and Ball Joint
1. Remove wheel bearing locknut.
2. Remove tie rod ball joint.
2. Remove strut lower bracket attaching nuts and bolts.
3. Separate driveshaft from knuckle by tapping driveshaft end with a suitable hammer. Use caution
not to damage driveshaft boots.
4. Separate lower ball joint stud from knuckle using a suitable tool.
5. Remove stabilizer bar attaching bolt from transverse link and ball joint assembly.
6. Remove transverse link bracket attaching bolts, then the transverse link bracket.
7. Remove remaining transverse link assembly attaching bolt, then the transverse link and ball joint
assembly.
8. Reverse procedure to install.
Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Recommendations For Winter
Models: All models
Section: Wheel & Tire
Classification: WT90-004
Bulletin No.: NTB90-099
Date: November 8, 1990
NISSAN WINTER TIRES
APPLIED MODELS: All Nissan Vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some vehicles are equipped with performance tires from the factory to enhance dry weather vehicle
performance. In order to improve vehicle traction during winter driving, all-season or radial mud &
snow (M&S;) tires may be installed.
Upon customer request, dealers may recommend alternative tires for improved traction in snow.
When doing so, these guidelines should be followed:
1. A tire with the M&S; rating is recommended for winter driving in snow.
2. The replacement tires must have the same size and load carrying capacity as the original
equipment tires.
3. All four (4) tires must be replaced, without exception. The mixed use of different types of tires
(i.e., radial mixed with bias ply, M&S; mixed with non-M&S;) should be avoided because of adverse
effects on vehicle handling and ride characteristics.
4. The requesting customer should be informed of the speed rating of the current tires, so that tires
of the same speed rating could be purchased as replacement tires.
NOTE: ^ All-season or snow tires may have lower speed ratings than factory-equipped tires. ^
When 4 mud & snow (M&S;) tires are installed on the vehicle, the tires should be inflated to the
pressures recommended on the vehicle tire placard. The maximum inflation pressure shown on the
side of the tire should never be exceeded.
A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Case: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Leakage From Front Cover/Converter Housing
Classification: Section:
AT90-002 Automatic Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB90-010
Models: 1987-1990 Sentra, Pulsar NX
Date: February 8, 1990 F01A AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL LEAKS
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-1990 Sentra XE 1987-1990 Pulsar NX XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
Some of the Applied Models equipped with the F01A Automatic Transaxles may exhibit
transmission fluid leakage from the converter housing and/or the front cover gasket area(s). To
improve the sealing performance at these locations, new bolts for the torque converter housing and
the front cover are now used in production, and the tightening torque for these bolts has been
changed to eliminate this condition. In addition, a new torque converter housing gasket is available
as a service replacement part for these vehicles.
PARTS/TORQUE INFORMATION
If transmission oil leakage is observed at the indicated areas, or if transaxle service is required,
upon disassembly of the front cover and/or torque converter housing, thoroughly clean and inspect
(for porosities, surface damage, etc.) all mating surfaces. Install a new converter housing gasket
and new bolts, being certain to apply sealant to the appropriate bolts (see Service Manual). Torque
as indicated below. After assembly has been completed, test drive the vehicle, then inspect the
incident area to ensure a proper seal between the mating halves.
Page 2176
AB-/BC VALVE CONTROL
When the idle switch is OFF, the I.S.C. valve opens in response to the amount of intake air and
engine speed. When the accelerator pedal is released, additional air is led into the intake manifold,
actuating as AB- or BC valve.
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-009 Date: 100119
Engine Controls - Seized O2 Sensor Removal Procedure
Classification: EM09-015
Reference: NTB10-009
Date: January 19, 2010
REMOVAL PROCEDURE FOR SEIZED EXHAUST SENSOR
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION
If an exhaust sensor is seized in the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube, perform the procedure
described in this bulletin to remove the sensor and prevent unnecessary replacement of the
exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
In most cases this procedure is successful. This is because the threads of the exhaust sensors are
made of a softer material than the part they thread into on the exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube.
NOTE:
The replacement of exhaust manifolds/catalysts/front tubes for stripped exhaust sensor threads
may not be considered a warrantable expense.
This procedure can be performed by two methods:
Method #1 - If the Sensor Can Be Easily Accessed
^ The procedure can be performed on the vehicle.
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube will not have to be removed.
Method #2 - If the Sensor Cannot Be Easily Accessed
^ The exhaust manifold/catalyst/front tube must be removed from the vehicle.
^ The procedure will be performed with the part clamped in a vice.
Method #2 is described in this bulletin. Method #1 is the same as Method #2 except that it is
performed on the vehicle.
Service Procedure
Rust Penetrant
Recommended rust penetrants to be used in this procedure:
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 3022
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon
Page 2002
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Adjustments
Air Door Cable: Adjustments
Fig. 14 Water valve adjustments.
1. Set temperature control cable at maximum COLD position.
2. With air mix door knob moved in toward passenger compartment, connect temperature control
rod to link lever.
3. Connect control cable to link lever and clamp the cable.
4. Pull water valve control rod in direction of arrow to provide clearance of approximately .08 inch
between ends of rod and link lever and connect rod to door lever, Fig. 14.
Page 4029
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Fig. 18 Exploded view of drum brakes. 1985-88 Pulsar & Sentra
1. Raise and support vehicle and remove wheel and tire assemblies.
2. Release parking brake.
3. Remove dust cap, then remove and discard cotter pin.
4. Take out adjusting cap and wheel bearing nut.
5. Remove brake drum with outer bearing and washer.
6. Remove parking brake rear cable.
7. Remove anti-rattle spring and pin, Fig. 18.
8. Remove retainer, then the return springs and brake shoes.
9. Separate equalizer and rear cable.
10. Remove adjuster assembly.
11. Remove toggle lever spring and clip, then separate toggle lever and shoe.
12. Apply suitable lubricant to lubricating points, Fig. 18.
13. Reverse procedure to install.
14. Adjust brakes by apply parking brake several times.
15. Adjust parking brake.
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Technical Service Bulletin # 94-012A Date: 990617
Brakes - Judder/Steering Wheel Shimmy
Classification: BR94-002a
Reference: NTB94-012a
Date: June 17, 1999
This amended version of NTB94-012 adds a caution and a note to the service procedure. Please
discard all paper copies of NTB94-012.
This bulletin supersedes TS89-105/BR89-004
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): ALL
BRAKE JUDDER/STEERING WHEEL SHIMMY
SERVICE INFORMATION Brake judder/steering wheel shimmy is a condition which may occur in
any vehicle when excessive rotor thickness variation is present on one (1) or more of the vehicle's
brake rotors.
Rotor Thickness Variation (RTV) is the variation in thickness around the rotor. The RTV can be
determined by measuring the rotor thickness with a micrometer at several locations around the
circumference of the rotor. The RTV is the difference in a thickness between the thickest and
thinnest points on the rotor.
Rotor Run-Out is the distance that the rotor surface travels in and out, in relation to the vertical
plane of the hub, as the rotor turns with the hub. The distance is measured with a dial indicator.
NOTE:
Rotor Run-Out does not cause brake judder or steering wheel shimmy. However, excessive Rotor
Run-Out does lead to rotor thickness variation as the rotor wears. It is the excessive rotor thickness
variation that causes judder and/or steering wheel shimmy. This is described in more detail below.
Page 2219
Spark Plug: Locations
Fig. 68 Component Location
DISTRIBUTOR
Located on the L.H. side of the cylinder head.
DISTRIBUTOR CAP
Located on top of the distributor.
DISTRIBUTOR ROTOR
Located on top of the distributor shaft, inside the cap.
Page 1748
Altima (U13) KA24DE
Axxess (M11) KA24E (2WD)
Axxess (M11) KA24E (4WD)
Maxima (910) L24E
Maxima (U11) VG30E
Maxima (J30) VG30E, VE30DE
Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Wheel Bearing Nut Torque
ALL MODELS
Refer to "Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service and Repair" before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 4264
Electrical - Electronic Component Damage Prevention
Battery: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Electronic Component Damage Prevention
Classification: EL09-011
Reference: NTB09-030
Date: April 6, 2009
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT DAMAGE CAN RESULT FROM IMPROPER BATTERY
CONNECTION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ The vehicle 12 volt battery is an important part of the vehicle electrical system and is required to
stay connected when the engine is running.
^ To prevent damage to vehicle electronic components follow the instructions / cautions below.
IMPORTANT:
Damage to electronic components (ECM, TCM, BCM, etc.) due to improper battery connection will
not be covered under warranty.
CAUTION:
^ Make sure the ignition is OFF during battery service and replacement.
^ Do not disconnect or connect any battery cables while the ignition switch is turned ON.
^ When disconnecting a battery, always disconnect the negative cable first.
^ When connecting a battery, always connect the positive cable first.
^ Do not leave a battery cable loose. Tighten battery cables immediately after attachment.
^ If a battery cable is loose, do not operate any electrical loads. (This includes turning the ignition
ON, starting the engine, operating accessories such as
the A/C system, power seats, interior lights, exterior lights etc.).
^ When "jump starting" or "boosting" a battery - be careful. Don't accidentally reverse the polarity of
the cables.
Disclaimer
Specifications
Axle Bearing: Specifications
ALL MODELS
Refer to "STEERING / COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND REPAIR PROCEDURES / AXLE
BEARING AND KNUCKLE" before making any adjustments to the wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 3437
Detonation Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 45 Detonation control unit test
1. Run engine at idle until normal operating temperature is reached.
2. Disconnect detonation sensor electrical connector with engine idling.
3. Slowly increase engine speed and check ignition timing with a suitable timing light.
4. If timing retards 10° when engine speed increases more than 2000 RPM, replace detonation
sensor.
5. If timing does not retard, measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 4, Fig.
45, and ground with engine running above 2000 RPM. If voltage measures .4-.7 volts, proceed to
step 6. If voltage does not measure .4-.7 volts, check distributor and wiring harness and repair as
necessary.
6. Measure voltage between detonation control unit terminal No. 3 and ground with engine running
above 2000 RPM. If voltage does not measure 3.7-3.8 volts, replace detonation control unit.
Service and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and drain cooling system.
2. Remove power steering drive belt and the power steering oil pump.
3. Remove alternator drive belt.
4. Loosen alternator attaching bolts and push alternator toward engine.
5. Remove water pump pulley, then the water pump and gasket.
6. Reverse procedure to install, using new gasket.
Page 1776
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 2675
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 2141
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance Per Cable 30 K ohms
Page 5186
Rear Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 19M, RH Fender Apron Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Coupe): 6D, In Rear Of Back Door
Rear Wiper Motor Connector (Hatchback): 8D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper Motor Connector
(Wagon): 9D, In Rear Of Back Door Rear Wiper/Washer Switch Connector: 14I, Under I/P At
Switch Resistor Connector (2WD): 47M, LH Fender Apron Resistor Connector (4WD): 47M, LH
Fender Apron Seat Belt Switch Connector (Coupe): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat
Belt Switch Connector (Hatchback): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch
Connector (Sedan): 7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Switch Connector (Wagon):
7B, Under I/P, LH Of Steering Column Seat Belt Timer Connector: 9I, Under I/P, RH Of Steering
Column Starter Motor Connector: 2E, RH Rear Of Engine Starter Relay Connector (2WD): 18M, RH
Fender Apron Starter Relay Connector (4WD): 18M, RH Fender Apron Stop Lamp Connector
(2WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P Stop Lamp Connector (4WD): 123M, Under LH Side Of I/P
Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Coupe): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor
Connector (Hatchback): 15B, At Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Sedan): 15B, At
Tail Panel Stop & Tail Lamp Sensor Connector (Wagon): 15B, At Tail Panel Thermo Control
Amplifier Connector (2WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermo Control Amplifier Connector
(4WD): 137M, Under RH Side Of I/P Thermal Switch Connector (2WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal
Switch Connector (4WD): 40M, At Switch Thermal Transmitter Connector: 4E, RH Side Of Engine
Throttle Sensor Connector (2WD): 65M, At Throttle Body Throttle Sensor Connector (4WD): 65M,
At Throttle Body Transfer Control Actuator Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27E, RH Side Of Engine
Transfer Control Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 27B, At Transfer Control Switch Transfer Control
Unit Connector (4WD): 151B, Under LH Side Of I/P Warning Lamp Connector (Coupe): 15I, Under
I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Warning Lamp-A Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 17I, LH Side
I/P Near Steering Column Warning Lamp-B Connector (Sedan & Wagon): 5I, LH Side I/P Near
Steering Column Washer Sensor Connector (2WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Washer Sensor
Connector (4WD): 21M, RH Fender Apron Water Temperature Sensor Connector (2WD): 69M, RH
Side Of Engine Water Temperature Sensor Connector (4WD): 69M, RH Side Of Engine Wiper
Motor Connector (2WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Motor Connector
(4WD Models): 1M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment Wiper Switch Connector (2WD): 133M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Wiper Switch Connector (4WD): 133M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Indicator
Lamp Connector (4WD): 152M, Under LH Side Of I/P 4WD Switch Connector (Wagon 4WD): 26E,
RH Side Of Engine
Page 2502
AXXESS (M11) KA24E (4WD)
MAXIMA (910) L24E
MAXIMA (U11) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VG30E
MAXIMA (J30) VE30DE
MAXIMA (A32) VQ30DE
Page 2350
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Relay (Type 1M) Green or Blue
Precautions
Classification: EC93-016
Reference: NTB93-176
Date: November 29, 1993
GREEN OR BLUE (TYPE 1M) RELAY CAUTION APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All Models
SERVICE INFORMATION When servicing a customer's vehicle, exercise caution when diagnosing
/ checking at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally open relay). SERVICE
PROCEDURE When diagnosing at any green or blue colored relay (type 1M, 1 make-normally
open relay), observe the following cautions to prevent damage to the Engine Control Module
(ECM):
1. Note that the schematic on the fuel pump relay is rotated 90 degrees from the orientation of the
relay terminals in the relay connector (see diagram):
2.
Exercise caution to ensure that the correct terminals are being probed at the relay connector during
diagnosing / checking.
Note:
If terminals 2 or 3 (battery voltage) are connected to terminal 1, the ECM will become damaged if
the circuit being tested has terminal 1 connected to the ECM.
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Technical Service Bulletin # 88-001 Date: 880118
Idle Speed - Diagnostic Procedure
Classification: EC88-001
Reference: TS88-001
Date: January 18, 1988
E16i IDLE SPEED DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1987 Sentra Coupe and 4WD Wagon 1988 Sentra (all models) 1987 and
1988 Pulsar XE
SERVICE INFORMATION
This bulletin provides an improved diagnostic procedure for use in correcting customer complaints
of improper idle, including intermittent conditions, on the 1987 Sentra coupe and 4WD wagon, 1988
Sentra (all models), and 1987-1988 Pulsar with E16i engine.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Following the sequence in the illustration, use the procedures to verify correct engine adjustment,
E.C.C.S. system operation, and Electro Injection adjustment. It is important that the Engine
Adjustment and the E.C.C.S. Operation Checks are completed before proceeding to the Electro
Injection Unit Inspection and Adjustment.
Page 143
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Cranking Signal: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 1772
NX1600 (KB13) GA16DE
NX2000 (KB13) SR20DE
Pulsar (KN12) E15ET
Pulsar (KN13) E16i
Pulsar (KN13) CA16DE
Pulsar (KN13) CA18DE
Page 4267
3. There should be no signs of scuff marks, abrasions, or chafing on the immediate area (i.e., on
the bubble).
Sidewall Cracking
Damage Description: Sidewall Cracking
NISSAN CODE: 7K
DEFINITION: Several fine cracks on the tire sidewall, running in a radial or circumferential direction
(Figure 4).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINTS:
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for several fine cracks on the sidewall, running in a lateral direction. These sidewall
cracks are generally less than 1/10 of an inch in width, and do not penetrate to the interior of the
tire.
Bead Separation
Damage Description: Bead Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7I
DEFINITION: Separation of the various tire materials (i.e., rubber, cord and wires) at the bead area
near the rim line (Figures 5A, 5B).
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
Check for a bulge and/or jagged cracks visible near the tire rim fitting line.
Tread/Shoulder Separation
Damage Description: Tread/Shoulder Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7F
Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Identification List
Classification: EC93-013
Reference: NTB93-167
Date: November 16, 1993
ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULE IDENTIFICATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S):
1993 Altima (U13) 1990 Axxess (M11) 1981-84 Maxima (910) 1985-88 Maxima (U11) 1989-93
Maxima (J30) 1991-93 NX 1600 (KB13) 1991-93 NX 2000 (KB13) 1983.5 Pulsar Turbo (KN12)
1987-90 Pulsar (KN13) 1987-90 Sentra (B12) 1991-93 Sentra (B13) 1984-86 Stanza (T11)
1987-89 Stanza (T12) 1990-92 Stanza (U12) 1982-89 Stanza Wagon (M10) 1987-93 Truck (D21)
1987-93 Pathfinder (WD21) 1987,88,90 Van (C22) 1980-83 200SX (S110) 1984-88 200SX (S12)
1989-93 240SX (S13) 1975-78 280Z (S130) 1979-83 280SX (HLS30) 1981-83 280ZX Turbo
(HLS30) 1984-89 300ZX (Z31) 1984-89 300ZX Turbo (Z31) 1990-93 300ZX (Z32) 1990-93 300ZX
Turbo (Z32) 1977-80 810
SERVICE INFORMATION This bulletin contains a chart that lists the ECM Vendor serial number
and cross-references to a Nissan part number. This chart is intended to be used as a reference
guide to determine that a vehicle has the correct ECM installed in it. The parts catalog along with
the VIN number and Date of Manufacture should be used to determine the correct part number
when ordering a new ECM. An ECM with a part number with 2371M-*****RE is a replacement ECM
and should have the same programming as the original. If a vehicle has an ECM with a part
number containing "M" and "RE", disregard the "M" and "RE" when using this chart. On any
CONSULT compatible vehicle the ECM part number can be accessed through the CONSULT
connector using CONSULT. All other vehicles have a decal that has the vendor part number on the
ECM cover.
Page 730
Page 134
Positive Temp Coefficient (PTC) Relay: Testing and Inspection
Wiring Diagram
Page 423
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 3148
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
a. Tighten the clamp so its end is 3 mm (0.12 in) from the hose end. b. Make sure that the screw of
the clamp does not contact with any adjacent parts. c. Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
: Fuel hose clamps
1.0 - 1.5 N.m (0.10 - 0.15 kg-m, 0.7 - 1.1 ft-lb)
1. Release fuel pressure.
2. Disconnect the fuel inlet hose at the electro injection unit.
3. Install a pressure gauge. 4. Start the engine and check the fuel line for fuel leakage. 5. Read fuel
pressure gauge.
At idling speed:
2WD Model: Approximately 98 kPa (1.0kg/cm2, 14 psi) 4WD Model: Approximately 250.1 kPa
(2.55 kg/cm2, 36.3 psi)
6. Release fuel pressure again. 7. Remove the pressure gauge from the fuel line. 8. Reconnect the
fuel inlet hose.
Page 615
^ Toe-Out is present when the tire is closer to the center line at the rear (Figure 1b).
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Toe should be the last alignment specification adjusted. Refer to the Front Axle (FA) and Rear
Axle (RA) sections of the appropriate Service Manual to determine the proper locations to adjust
the front and rear Toe.
2. Toe should be equal, side-to-side.
3. Toe-In
When the specification is labeled "Toe-In" and dimensions are negative numbers (ie: -6 to -2 mm),
the wheels should be adjusted to the "Toe-Out" position (Figure 2).
NOTE: Positive (+) Toe-In specification = Toe-In wheel setting. Negative (-) Toe-In specification =
Toe-out wheel setting.
Toe-Out
Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Mounting Information
Classification: WT11-003
Reference: NTB11-029
Date: March 21, 2011
TIRE MOUNTING INFORMATION
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When mounting tires to wheels, it is important that the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ A tire bead that is not seated correctly may cause a vehicle vibration.
^ High performance tires and tires with shorter sidewalls (low aspect tires) may require more care
to make sure the tire bead is seated correctly.
^ Follow the Tire Mounting Tips in this bulletin.
Tire Mounting Tips:
NOTE:
These tips are not intended to be a complete instruction for mounting tires to wheels. Make sure to
read and follow the instruction for your specific tire service equipment
1. Clean the tire bead with an approved rubber cleaning fluid.
^ Rubber cleaning fluid is a locally sourced common product used in the tire service process.
2. Clean the wheel (flange and bead seat area) see Figure 2 Make sure to clean off all rust and
corrosion.
Page 373
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Description and Operation
Idle Switch: Description and Operation
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and actuates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor has two functions. It contains an idle switch and throttle sensor. The idle
switch closes when the throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any other position.
The throttle sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds the voltage signal to E.C.C.S. control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
the opening or closing speed of the throttle valve, and feeds the rate of voltage change to the
E.C.C.S. control unit
Page 53
PULSAR (KN13) GA16i
QUEST (V40) VG30E
SENTRA (B12) E16i (2WD)
SENTRA (B12) E16i (4WD)
SENTRA (B12) GA16i (2WD)
Page 1061
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Localized separation, with or without an air pocket, between the sidewall rubber and tire casing.
3. There should be no evidence of chafing, shock, or abrasion on the tire sidewall.
4. There should be no tread penetrations or perforations in the tread area directly adjacent to the
blister.
Open Splice In Sidewall
Damage Description: Open Splice in Sidewall
NISSAN CODE: 7M
DEFINITION: A localized detachment of the rubber stock between the block and/or white sidewall,
caused by a lack/loss of adhesion where the rubber stock is joined (Figure 2). An open splice may
be a partial opening, or a complete detachment and total perforation to the interior.
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. There should be no evidence of cuts or perforations in the failed area.
2. At the point of failure, interior rubber surfaces will be smooth and will appear joined at an angle.
Sidewall Ply Separation
Damage Description: Sidewall Ply Separation
NISSAN CODE: 7L
DEFINITION: Localized separation of the sidewall ply cord (Figure 3)
MAJOR INSPECTION POINT(S):
1. Check for proper air pressure.
2. Check for an air bubble on the tire sidewall.
Page 4437
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Note: Preload adjustment of wheel bearing is not necessary.
Rear Wheel Bearing
1. Tighten wheel bearing lock nut to:
137 - 188 ft lbs (186 - 255 Nm)
2. Check bearing for smooth operation.
3. Check axial end play. Should be:
.002in (0.05mm) or less
Page 2536
Van (C22) Z24I
200SX (S110) Z22E
200SX (S110) Z24E
200SX (S12) CA20E
200SX (S12) CA18ET
200SX (S12) VG30E
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Wiring Diagram
Page 99
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Testing Precautions
CLASSIFICATION: EC95-011
REFERENCE: NTB95-059
DATE: June 7, 1995
PRECAUTIONS FOR TESTING/DIAGNOSING THE ECCS SYSTEM TO AVOID DAMAGING THE
ECM
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): All
SERVICE INFORMATION
Observing the following precautions when testing/diagnosing the Electronic Concentrated Control
System (ECCS) may help prevent damaging the Electronic Control Module (ECM).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Most relays in the ECCS system (Fuel pump, A/C, etc.) and actuators (Injectors, etc.) are
powered by the battery. The ECM controls the relay or actuator by supplying the ground.
DO NOT apply battery voltage directly to any of the ECM pins (or wires connected to them) which
supply the ground to any relays or actuators (see circled areas in illustration). Doing so will
permanently damage the ECM.
2. Do not connect or disconnect any ECCS connectors when the ignition key is in the "ON"
position.
3. Do not remove the cover of the ECM.
Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Aftermarket Chroming of Nissan Alloys
Classification: WT92-003
Section: Wheel & Tire
Reference: TECHNICAL BULLETIN NTB92-123
Models: All
Date: December 22, 1992
AFTERMARKET CHROMING OF NISSAN ALLOY WHEELS
SERVICE INFORMATION
The Original Equipment Alloy Wheels on Nissan vehicles are specifically developed in order to
achieve the Nissan design and performance standards. These Original Equipment wheels are also
subject to rigorous testing procedure's to ensure they meet Nissan's standards.
Nissan cannot ensure that Original Equipment Alloy Wheels which are subjected to aftermarket
chroming meet these same standards, and therefore Nissan does not recommend the use of such
wheels, nor does Nissan make any representations concerning their performance.
Indeed, if these Original Equipment Alloy Wheels are subjected to aftermarket chroming, there are
serious potential problems which may occur as a result of the chroming process:
1. The chroming process removes the original paint coating by "burning" or "chemical" methods,
both of which cause the alloy surface to be changed. The application of chrome plating has to be
controlled correctly, as the alloy can be harmed by a poorly controlled process.
2. Overall aftermarket chroming may degrade the durability, long term appearance, and may affect
safety and performance of the wheels.
Accordingly, Nissan recommends that Original Equipment Wheels NOT be chrome plated.
Please consult the Nissan Warranty Policies and Procedures Manual pertaining to the Dealer's
responsibility when altering or modifying vehicles.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Note that damage to Nissan Alloy road wheels due to any non-factory-authorized process, such as
chroming, is the responsibility of the customer, and is not covered by the Nissan Warranty, please
consult the "Nissan Warranty Information Booklet" for specific details.
Page 1810
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Passenger Compartment Components.
Under Instrument Panel, Above Fuse Block
Applicable to: 1988 Sentra
Page 3304
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 720
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 4582
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
ALL MODELS
Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints before making any
adjustments to the rear wheel bearing axle nut.
Page 1430
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check
Page 2306
TRUCK (D21) KA24E
TRUCK/PATHFINDER (D21/WD21) VG30E
VAN (C22) Z24i
200SX (S110) Z20E
200SX (S110) Z22E
Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
Throttle Position Switch: Description and Operation Throttle Sensor & Idle Switch
1987-88 Pulsar & Sentra w/E16i Engine, Pathfinder, Pickup & Van
The throttle sensor is attached to the throttle body and activates in response to accelerator pedal
movement. This sensor is a potentiometer which transforms throttle valve position into output
voltage, and feeds voltage signal to ECCS control unit. In addition, the throttle sensor detects
opening or closing speed of the throttle valve and feeds rate of voltage change to the ECCS control
unit. The idle switch closes when throttle valve is positioned at idle and opens when it is at any
other position.
Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Synchronizer Hub: Customer Interest Manual Transaxle - Jumping Out of 5th Gear
Classification: Section Manual
MT89-002A Transmission/Transaxle
Reference:
TECHNICAL BULLETIN TS89-064A Models: 1987-88 Sentra & Pulsar NX Date: September 28,
1989 MANUAL TRANSAXLE JUMPING OUT OF 5th GEAR
This Bulletin supersedes Bulletin MT89-002 (TS89-064) dated April 20, 1989, giving additional
Parts Information. Please discard the original Bulletin.
APPLIED MODELS: 1987-88 Sentra (B12) 1987-88 Pulsar NX (N13)
SERVICE INFORMATION
The 5-speed manual transaxle (Model RS5F31A) on some 1987 and 1988 Sentra and Pulsar NX
vehicles with E16 and CA16DE engines may slip out of 5th gear while cruising. This incident is
caused by wear on the 5th gear shift fork by the control bracket, causing insufficient gear
engagement. This results in the transmission slipping out of gear. *Use the following Service
Procedure to repair these transaxles.
PARTS INFORMATION *This Bulletin recommends replacing the control bracket, adding the shifter
cap and replacing parts (3) thru (6), regardless of wear.
Figure 1
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the transaxle following the procedures described in the appropriate Service
Manual.
2. Replace the shift fork and install the countermeasure control bracket and shifter cap (Figure 1).
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): Customer Interest Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV)
Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
Page 3369
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve (ISCV) Operation
Fast Idle Control Device (F.I.C.D.): All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Control Valve
(ISCV) Operation
Classification: EC88-017
Reference: TS88-115
Date: September 8, 1988
IDLE SPEED CONTROL VALVE (I.S.C.V.) OPERATION
APPLIED VEHICLE(S): 1988 Sentra (B12) 1988 Pulsar (N13) with E16I
SERVICE INFORMATION Because of production modifications, the mixture heater used on 1988
Sentras and Pulsars (E16i) is not interchangeable with the mixture heater used on 1987 models.
Any attempt to interchange these components will result in no idle-up compensation from the Idle
Speed Control Valve (I.S.C.V.).
When servicing a 1988 Sentra or Pulsar (E16i) that exhibits no fast-idle or no idle-up operation,
ensure that the correct mixture heater is installed in the vehicle. The 1988 mixture heater can be
identified by the I.S.C.V. air passage in the area indicated below.
Parts Information Please note that the current Sentra Parts Microfiche does not list the part number
for the 1988 mixture heater. This number will be added to the next microfiche issue. For your
reference, the part numbers for both mixture heaters are shown below.
Page 780
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Audio - Speaker Noise, Cellular Phone Interference
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Speaker Noise, Cellular Phone Interference
Classification: EL99-005
Reference: NTB99-017
Date: April 1, 1999
NISSAN SPEAKER NOISE DUE TO CELLULAR PHONE INTERFERENCE
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan Vehicles
SERVICE INFORMATION Cellular phone charging may cause a popping or crackling noise in the
audio speakers of Nissan vehicles. If this condition exists, it is most likely to occur when the
customer's cellular phone is turned off, plugged into the 12 volt cigarette lighter socket nearest the
audio head unit, and placed within one foot of the audio head unit. The condition may occur more
frequently in vehicles with audio systems with amplified speakers. Refer to the appropriate owner's
manual for cautions regarding the use of the cigarette lighter socket as a power source for other
accessories. Use the procedure below to verify that the condition exists as described above and
provide instruction for the customer to reduce the possibility of future cellular phone interference.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Perform the following test procedure to verify the condition exists as
described: 1.
Ask the customer for the cellular phone and charging adapter.
2.
Confirm the cellular phone has been turned off for at least 30 minutes before proceeding.
NOTE:
Do not turn the cellular phone on at any time during the procedure. If the phone has to be turned
from on to off, you will have to wait 30 minutes for the phone to reset to proceed with the test.
3. Plug the phone into the 12 volt cigarette lighter socket nearest the audio head unit.
4.
Turn the ignition to the "ON" position (do not turn the cellular phone on).
5.
Turn the audio unit on.
6.
Place the cellular phone close to the front of the audio head unit.
7.
Listen for a popping or crackling noise from the audio speakers.
8.
If the noise is heard, move the cellular phone back from the audio unit. The noise should be
reduced as the cellular phone is moved further away from the audio unit.
9.
If the condition is confirmed through the above procedure, advise the customer to keep the cellular
phone at least one foot away from the audio head unit to reduce the possibility of future cellular
phone interference.
Page 1900
Idle Switch: Adjustments
1. Warm up engine sufficiently.
2. Disconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector. 3.
Check idle speed.
M/T: 750 rpm A/T: 670 rpm (in "D" position)
If not correct, adjust by turning throttle adjusting screw.
4. (A/T model) shift transaxle to "N" position and read idle speed NAT at that point.
5. Manually open throttle valve to about 2,000 rpm, lower engine speed slowly and read the engine
speed at which the idle contact turns from OFF to
ON.
M/T: 1050 ± 150 rpm A/T: (NAT + 300) ±150 rpm (in "N" position)
If not correct, adjust by loosening throttle valve switch securing screws and turning the throttle
valve switch.
6. Reconnect throttle valve switch harness connector and throttle sensor harness connector.
Locations
Fig. 28 Component location
Page 4815
Comments regarding tubes and hoses:
^ Some R-134a tubes and hoses have reversed male/female connections to prevent
interchangeability with R-12 components.
R134A Service Tools & Equipment
^ R-12 and R-134a require separate and non-interchangeable sets of recovery, recycle, and
recharge equipment, because the refrigerants and lubricants are not compatible and cannot be
mixed even in the smallest amounts.
^ DO NOT attempt to use one set of equipment for both R-12 and R-134a, as all equipment
contains residual amounts of refrigerant and/or lubricant,
Page 5056
Diagnostic Procedure # 13
Main Power Supply and Ground Circuit Checks. VSS Control Unit Main Power Supply
A/C Blower Fan System - Inoperative
Technical Service Bulletin # 04-054C Date: 110406
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Info.
Classification: WT04-004C
Reference: NTB04-054C
Date: April 6, 2011
WHEEL ALIGNMENT INFORMATION
This bulletin has been amended to correct some typographical errors in SERVICE INFORMATION.
No other changes have been made. Discard all previous versions of this bulletin.
APPLIED VEHICLES: All Nissan - except GT-R
Warranty Claim Information: In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the
following item MUST be attached to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
IMPORTANT:
If you do not attach the above item to the Repair Order, the claim may be denied (rejected or
charged back).
ALSO: A copy of the yearly alignment machine calibration certification must be held on file in the
Service Dept.
General Information and Recommendations
SERVICE INFORMATION
^ When performing a wheel alignment it is important that you read and follow all of the instructions
supplied with your alignment equipment.
^ The information in this bulletin is not intended to be complete wheel alignment instructions.
^ Use the information in this bulletin as a supplement to the instructions for your equipment.
General Information and Recommendations
1. Four-Wheel Thrust Alignment should always be performed.
^ This type of alignment is recommended for all Nissan vehicles.
^ The four-wheel thrust process ensures that the vehicle is properly aligned, and helps ensure
proper "centering" of the steering wheel.
2. Use the right alignment machine.
^ You must use a quality alignment machine that will give accurate results when performing
alignment checks.
^ Refer to the Nissan TECH-MATE Service Equipment Catalog for recommended alignment
equipment.
^ The alignment rack itself should be capable of accepting any Nissan vehicle. The rack should be
checked to ensure that it is level.
3. Make sure the alignment machine is properly calibrated.
^ Your alignment equipment should be regularly calibrated in order to give accurate readings.
^ If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged, calibration should
be checked immediately.
^ Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended
service/calibration schedule.
NOTE:
In order to properly document any warranty alignment claim, the following item MUST be attached
to the Repair Order:
^ A copy of the alignment machine printout showing the BEFORE and AFTER alignment readings.
Page 3583
2. Identify which hose is the Inlet and which hose is the Outlet to the oil cooler (refer to Charts A
and B).
3. Disconnect the oil cooler Inlet and Outlet rubber hoses from the steel cooler tubes (see Figure
3).
^ For Frontier (D22) w/bypass valve, remove the oil cooler inlet and outlet rubber hoses from the
bypass valve fittings (see Figure 6 shown)
NOTE:
If rubber material from a cooler hose remains on the steel tube or fitting, replace the rubber hose.
4. Allow any transmission fluid that remains in the cooler hoses to drain into the oil pan.
5. Insert the "extension adapter hose" from a can of Transmission Cooler Cleaner (Nissan P/N
999MP-A0006) into the cooler Outlet hose (see Figure 4).
Page 5184
Door Harness Connector (4WD): 141M, Under RH Side Of I/P Door Switch LH Connector (Coupe):
5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Hatchback): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch
LH Connector (Sedan): 5B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch LH Connector (Wagon): 5B, Lower Door
Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Coupe): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector
(Hatchback): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Door Switch RH Connector (Sedan): 6B, Lower Door Jamb
Door Switch RH Connector (Wagon): 6B, Lower Door Jamb Dual Pressure Switch Connector
(2WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier Dual Pressure Switch Connector (4WD): 41M, At Receiver/Drier
ECCS Control Unit Connector (2WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat ECCS Control Unit Connector
(4WD): 145M, Under Passenger Seat EFI Relay Connector (2WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P
EFI Relay Connector (4WD): 119M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (2WD):
153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EFI Safety Relay Connector (4WD): 153M, Under LH Side Of I/P EGR
& Canister Solenoid Valve Connector (2WD): 67M, Front Of Engine EGR & Canister Solenoid
Valve Connector (4WD): 67M, Front Of Engine Engine Ground Connector: 5E, RH Side Of Engine
Engine Body Ground Connector: 6E, RH Fender Apron Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (2WD):
36M, At Sensor Exhaust Gas Sensor Connector (4WD): 36M, At Sensor Fan Switch Connector
(2WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Fan Switch Connector (4WD): 135M, Under Center Of I/P Front
Turn Signal Lamp LH Connector (2WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp LH
Connector (4WD): 44M, At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (2WD): 24M,
At Turn Signal Lamp Front Turn Signal Lamp RH Connector (4WD): 24M, At Turn Signal Lamp
Front Washer Motor Connector (2WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Front Washer Motor Connector
(4WD): 20M, RH Fender Apron Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Coupe): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank
Gauge Unit Connector (Hatchback): 9B, At Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Sedan): 9B, At
Tank Fuel Tank Gauge Unit Connector (Wagon): 9B, At Tank Fuse Block Connector (2WD): 121M,
Under LH Side Of I/P Fuse Block Connector (4WD): 121M, Under LH Side Of I/P Fusible Link
Holder Connector (2WD): 50M, LH Fender Apron Fusible Link Holder Connector (4WD): 50M, LH
Fender Apron Hazard Switch Connector: 16I, Under I/P Above Heater Control Assembly Headlamp
LH Connector (2WD): 42M, At Headlamp Headlamp LH Connector (4WD): 42M, At Headlamp
Headlamp RH Connector (2WD): 22M, At Headlamp Headlamp RH Connector (4WD): 22M, At
Headlamp Heater Control Illumination Connector (2WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P Heater Control
Illumination Connector (4WD): 136M, Under Center Of I/P High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector
(Coupe): 7D, In Rear Of Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Hatchback): 7D, On
Bottom Of Back Door High Mounted Stop Lamp Connector (Wagon): 3D, On Top Of Back Door
Horn Connector (2WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly Horn Connector (4WD): 25M, At Horn Assembly
Horn Relay Connector (2WD): 12M, On RH Fender Apron Horn Relay Connector (4WD): 12M, On
RH Fender Apron Horn Switch Connector (2WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Horn Switch
Connector (4WD): 131M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Relay II Connector (4WD): 102M, Under LH
Side Of I/P Ignition Switch Connector (2WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Ignition Switch
Connector (4WD): 128M, Under LH Side Of I/P Illumination Control Switch Connector: 4I, LH Side
Of I/P Near Steering Column Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side Of Engine
Inhibitor Switch Connector (Auto Trans.): 15E, RH Side of Engine Intermittent Wiper Amplifier
Connector (4WD): 4M, RH Corner Of Engine Compartment License Lamp LH Connector (Coupe):
21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Hatchback): 21B, At License Lamp License
Lamp LH Connector (Sedan): 21B, At License Lamp License Lamp LH Connector (Wagon): 6D, In
Rear Of Back Door
Page 1963
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Before removing air flow meter, remove throttle valve switch.
- When removing the air flow meter, extract it vertically, taking care not to bend or damage the plug
portion.
- Never touch the sensor portion with your finger.
- When installing, apply silicone grease to mating face between air flow meter and throttle body to
allow heat to escape.
1. Apply battery voltage between terminals (E) (+) and (C) (-).
2. Measure the voltage between terminals (A) (+) and (D) (-).
Page 1545
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-032 Date: 960417
Engine Controls - Idle, Base Idle & Timing, Startability
Classification: EC96-004
Reference: NTB96-032
Date: April 17, 1996
ENGINE CRANKS, BUT WILL NOT START OR IS HARD TO START
APPLIED VEHICLE:
Page 413
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment (continued)
Page 3098
Electro Injection Unit Inspection & Adjustment
Page 3110
Engine Adjustment & E.C.C.S. Operation Check (continued)
Page 2477
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
The exhaust gas sensor, which is placed into the exhaust manifold, monitors the amount of oxygen
in the exhaust gas. The sensor has a closed-end tube made of ceramic zirconia. The outer surface
of the tube is exposed to exhaust gas, and the inner surface to atmosphere. The zirconia of the
tube compares the oxygen density of exhaust gas with that of atmosphere, and generates
electricity. In order to improve generating power of the zirconia, its tube is coated with platinum.
The voltage is approximately 1V in a richer condition of the mixture ratio than the ideal air fuel ratio,
while approximately 0V in leaner conditions. The radical change from 1V to 0V occurs at around
the ideal mixture ratio. In this way, the exhaust gas sensor detects the amount of oxygen in the
exhaust gas and sends the signal of approximately 1V or 0V to the E.C.U.
Page 648
The steering wheel spokes are tilted to the left or right more than allowable (see example in Figure
2) when driving straight ahead on a straight flat road.
Allowable specifications for steering wheel off-center
^ All Nissan (except NV1500, 2500, and 3500): 2 mm or less.
^ NV1500, 2500, and 3500: 4 mm or less.
When driving straight on a highly crowned road, the steering wheel may be turned (off-center) to
counteract the affect of the road crown. When road testing for an off-center condition, the vehicle
should be driven on a straight flat road.
Although the vehicle does not pull in either direction, the customer may perceive that the vehicle
pulls because it will respond if he or she tries to bring the steering wheel back to center. This
condition can occur if the tie rod length is uneven (not adjusted correctly) from side to side.
Description/Definition of a Vehicle "Pull" Condition
The vehicle consistently drifts to one side while driving at a constant speed on a straight, flat road.
^ A vehicle is said to "pull" if it completes a lane change in less than 7 seconds (with no steering
correction from the driver) when driving at 60 MPH on
a road with less than 2 degrees of road crown slope. All four wheels must pass into the other lane
during this time (7 seconds).
Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Fluid Type Nissan Brake Fluid or DOT 3
Page 2742
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
5 volts reference.
GA16: 2WD measured between red wire and ground; 4WD, measured between white wire and
ground.
EI6 TBI: Measured between white wire and ground.
CA16, CA18 DOHC: Measured between L/W wire and ground.
Page 4014
wrench.
Brake Judder Repair
^ Brake judder incidents must be corrected by turning the rotors with a ProCut(TM) PFM series
On-Car Brake Lathe.
^ Refer to NTB04-094 for information on using this lathe.
^ If the rotors are replaced, make sure you index them to the axle hub to ensure minimum runout
(see Rotor Indexing shown in this bulletin).
PEDAL FEEL
^ Some customers may say that the brake pedal feels too high or low when applying the brakes.
^ This may indicate the brake system needs service or it may be the result of the customer
comparing the feel of the brakes in a new car with the feel of the brakes in a previous car.
^ Road test the vehicle with the customer. Compare brake operation to a "know good vehicle and
determine if brake service is necessary. If so, refer to the following service items:
a. Inspect the brake calipers and make sure they are correctly installed and sliding freely.
b. Inspect the front and rear brakes and make sure the brake pads and/or shoes are properly
installed.
c. Bleed all air from the brake system.
d. Make sure the brake pedal stroke and free play are adjusted correctly. Refer to the BR section of
the appropriate service manual.
NOTE:
Use Essential Tool J-46532 (Brake Pedal Height Tool) for brake pedal height check and
adjustment. This tool is available from TECH-MATE.
BRAKE SERVICE
To ensure a high quality brake service be sure to:
1. Finish rotors properly.
^ This is one of the most important aspects of preventing and eliminating brake noise.
^ Use the ProCut(TM) PFM series on-car brake lathe. It has been chosen as the approved tool for
rotor resurfacing (refer to NTB04-094 for additional information).
2. Correctly install pads and shims.
IMPORTANT:
Correct installation and lubrication of brake pads and all caliper parts and hardware is essential for
proper brake operation and will help dampen noise-causing movement and vibrations.
^ Refer to ASIST (Service Bulletins and ESM) for correct installation and lubrication of brake pads,
caliper parts, and hardware.
CAUTION:
Do Not get grease on the brake pad friction surface.
3. Perform the following post-installation checks.
^ Confirm that brake pads fit snugly in the calipers. Replace worn components as necessary.
^ Test drive after repairs and burnish the new brakes. This will influence brake performance,
including noise.
a. Drive the vehicle on a straight smooth road at about 30 mph (50 kph).
b. Use medium brake pedal/foot effort to bring the vehicle to a complete stop from about 30 mph
(50 kph). Adjust your pedal/foot pressure so that the vehicle stopping time is 3-5 seconds.
c. Cool the brake system by driving at about 30 mph (50 kph) for approximately one minute without
stopping.